The communities of south coast New Guinea were the subject of classic ethnographies, and fresh studies in recent decades...
89 downloads
952 Views
6MB Size
Report
This content was uploaded by our users and we assume good faith they have the permission to share this book. If you own the copyright to this book and it is wrongfully on our website, we offer a simple DMCA procedure to remove your content from our site. Start by pressing the button below!
Report copyright / DMCA form
The communities of south coast New Guinea were the subject of classic ethnographies, and fresh studies in recent decades have put these rich and complex cultures at the center of anthropological debates. Flamboyant sexual practices such as ritual homosexuality have attracted particular interest. In the first general book on the region, Dr Knauft reaches striking new comparative conclusions through a careful ethnographic analysis of sexuality, the status of women, ritual and cosmology, political economy, and violence among the region's seven major language-culture areas. The findings suggest new Melanesian regional contrasts and provide for a general critique of the way regional comparisons are constructed in anthroplogy. Theories of practice and political economy as well as postmodern insights are drawn upon to provide a generative theory of indigenous social and symbolic development.
Cambridge Studies in Social and Cultural Anthropology Editors: Ernest Gellner, Jack Goody, Stephen Gudeman, Michael Herzfeld, Jonathan Parry 89 South coast New Guinea cultures
A list of books in the series will be found at the end of the volume
SOUTH COAST NEW GUINEA CULTURES History, comparison, dialectic
BRUCE M. KNAUFT
Department of Anthropology, Emory University
CAMBRIDGE UNIVERSITY PRESS
Published by the Press Syndicate of the University of Cambridge The Pitt Building, Trumpington Street, Cambridge CB2 1RP 40 West 20th Street, New York, NY 10011-4211, USA 10 Stamford Road, Oakleigh, Victoria 3166, Australia © Cambridge University Press 1993 First published 1993 A catalogue record for this book is available from the British Library Library of Congress cataloguing in publication data South coast New Guinea cultures: history, comparison, dialectic Bruce M. Knauft p. cm. - (Cambridge studies in social and cultural anthropology: 89) Includes bibliographical references. ISBN 0 521 41882 8. - ISBN 0 521 42931 5. (pbk.) 1. Ethnology - New Guinea. 2. New Guinea social life and customs. 3. Melanesians - Sexual behavior. 4. Melanesians - Social life and customs. I. Title. II. Series. GN671.N5K641993 306'.0995-dc20 92-12472 CIP ISBN 0 521 41882 8 hardback ISBN 0 521 42931 5 paperback Transferred to digital printing 2003
GO
Contents
List of List of tables Acknowledgments
figures
PaSe
vm
ix x
Part 1: Grounding 1 Theoretical and ethnographic context 2 Historical background and regional configuration
Part 2: Critique 3 Sexuality in the regional analysis of south New Guinea 4 The analytic legacy of homosexual emphasis: language, subsistence, and political economy 5 Women's status 6 Trends in comparative analysis
3 25
45 60 86 117
Part 3: Reconfiguration 7 8 9 10
Theoretical reconfiguration Marind-anim Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations Regional characteristics and comparisons
129 136 172 210
Appendix: evidence concerning Asmat homosexuality Notes List of references Index
228 238 252 288
Figures
1 2 3 4 5
Language-culture areas of south coast New Guinea Asmat bis-po\e Marind-anim gari sunburst ornament Purari kaiemunu Trans-Fly (a) sacred hawk stone (b) bullroarer 6 Kiwai horiomu costume 7 Elema hevehe mask
page xiv 73 145 174 186 186 198 202
Tables
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
South lowland New Guinea language families and presence/ absence of indigenous ritualized homosexuality page Geography and subsistence regimes of south coast New Guinea Leadership and exchange in south coast New Guinea Big Man society characteristics in south coast New Guinea Great Man society characteristics in south coast New Guinea Comparative estimates of female status in south coast New Guinea Female status and importance of male warrior prestige Female status and starch staple subsistence
49 63 78 81 81 106 108 109
Acknowledgments
The ethnographic analysis of south coast New Guinea has been a captivating field of study. My greatest acknowledgment is to the intrepid ethnographers who produced such detailed studies of this region during early decades of ethnographic research. Their timely commitment to extended fieldwork was extraordinary and carried out under logistical conditions that are difficult to fully appreciate from our own late twentieth-century vantage point. Second, I owe an intellectual debt to those contemporary scholars who have rekindled anthropological interest in the regional analysis of south New Guinea, and in particular to Gilbert Herdt, Harriet Whitehead, Shirley Lindenbaum, and Daryl Feil. Though this book is in part a critique of their work, it stands on their shoulders, and I have great respect for their efforts. Third, I thank several persons who have commented with care and insight on previous versions of this manuscript, in particular, Fredrik Barth, James Carrier, Donald Donham, Simon Harrison, Terence Hays, Gilbert Herdt, Raymond Kelly, Stuart Kirsch, Sherry Ortner, Andrew Strathern, James Weiner, Harriet Whitehead, anonymous press reviewers, and the members of the 1990 ASAO "Migration and Transformations" symposium. Their insights have helped sharpen my portrayals and analyses, though they bear no responsibility for this book's shortcomings. Members of my home Department of Anthropology at Emory University provided intellectual stimulation and logistical support; a thanks goes to all of them. Thanks also go to Jessica Kuper, anthropology editor at Cambridge University Press, and to Kathleen Much, editor-in-residence at The Center for Advanced Study in the Behavioral Sciences, Stanford.
XI
I thank Carole Welp for verbally translating many parts of the Dutch depopulation report and John Richens and Carol Jenkins for bringing publications concerning early Marind-anim medical history to my attention. The Crosier Missions supplied me and the Emory Library important publications concerning Asmat; relatedly, the comments of David Eyde and Tobias Schneebaum were helpful as I wrote the Appendix. Unpublished information on the presence or absence of ritual homosexuality in various south New Guinea societies was graciously supplied by Robert Depew, Peter Dwyer, Stuart Kirsch, Billai Laba, and Robert Welsch. Reference suggestions from James Baker and Anton Ploeg concerning particular aspects of west New Guinea history are acknowledged with appreciation. A large thanks goes to Deanna Knickerbocker for producing the map, to Robin Mouat for drawing the figures, to Lynn Gale and Judy Robertson for computer help in formatting the index, and to Marie Cantrell for help in proofreading. Great and cheerful help procuring bibliographic materials was given by Margaret Whittier and the Inter-Library Loan staff at Emory's Woodruff Library, by Kathryn Creely from The Melanesian Studies Resource Center at The University of California Library, San Diego, and by the several library staff members at The Center for Advanced Study in the Behavioral Sciences, Stanford, California. Permission to quote liberally from previously published materials is gratefully acknowledged from Ethnology, Grove Weidenfeld Press, Kluwer Academic Publishers, Macmillan Press Ltd, Oxford University Press, Stanford University Press, The University of Chicago Press, and Van Gorcum Press. A special thanks to Tobias Schneebaum, Mark Sexton, and the Peabody Museum of Salem, MA for permission to use their photograph of an Asmat ancestor skull on the cover of this book. The photograph (original in color) was taken by Sexton; it was printed in Schneebaum's Embodied Spirits: Ritual Carvings of the Asmat, (p. 50), published and copyrighted in 1990 by the Peabody Museum of Salem, MA. The skull, obtained from Buepis village, is from Schneebaum's personal collection. The Center for Advanced Study in the Behavioral Sciences at Stanford provided the ideal intellectual and logistical environment for the completion of this book during a fellowship year in 1991-92. My fellowship support from the Center was provided by their National Science Foundation Grant BNS-8700864 and supplemented by matching salary support from Emory University. Funding support for earlier phases of this research project was supplied by the Harry Frank
xii
Acknowledgements
Guggenheim Foundation in the form of a research grant and a Career Development Award. Funds for summer research in 1989 were received from the Emory University Research Committee. My final and deepest thanks go to my colleague and wife, Eileen Cantrell, and to my son, Eric. They have given me more energy to complete this project than they realize.
MAPI LANGUAGE-CULTURE AREAS OF SOUTH COAST NEW GUINEA §§§§§? mountains I language-culture areas
mm,d.
:S3S8® k- 5
STRICKLAND -BOSAVI Afea
0
i
100
i
200
i
300
i
KILOMETERS
Figure 1 Language-culture areas of south coast New Guinea
PART 1 GROUNDING
1 Theoretical and ethnographic context
How can anthropologists describe and compare ethnographic regions? Much information has been gathered since the nineteenth century that assumes a satisfactory answer to this question, but the problems that attend it are larger than ever. As emphasized from a politicoeconomic perspective, ethnographic regions are interwoven through trade, coercion, and economic dependence or political domination, particularly as states engage their ever-shrinking peripheries (e.g., Wolf 1982, 1988; Lomnitz-Adler 1991). As a result, the autonomy, divisibility, and uniqueness of ethnographic regions cannot be assumed. From a postmodern perspective, the ethnographic characterization of culture areas and regions is an artifact - the result of a Western academic discourse that projects its own cultural biases and assumes incorrectly that these characterizations reflect other people's reality (e.g., Clifford and Marcus 1986; Clifford 1988; Boon 1990). Culture area comparisons thus neglect the irreducible authority of indigenous voices and collapse them into pigeon-holed categories deriving from the analyst's own time, place, and disposition. What becomes untenable from both the postmodern and the politicoeconomic vantage point is synchronic objectivism: the assumption that cultures have coherent, stable traits that render them comparable within the analytic space of a timeless ethnographic present. In the current academic climate, few can deny the intellectual importance of these two critiques, much less their scholarly influence. How best to draw on their insights for purposes of regional characterization and comparison, however, remains problematic. Each critique, indeed, would seem to undercut if not eviscerate the other: the plurality of voices stressed in postmodern intertextuality is intrinsically opposed
4
Grounding
to the reductionism and homogenous perspective of both world system political economy and, to a slightly lesser extent, the longue duree structural history of the French Annales tradition.l This tension underlines the uneasy confluence between postmodernism and critical or Marxist theory that has recently developed in American anthropology, as reflected in the journal Cultural Anthropology and in a number of influential recent works.2 Though they are often melded together, these perspectives work from opposed premises: Marxist or politicoeconomic perspectives strive to identify underlying patterns through integrated analytic assertions, whereas postmodernism stresses fragmentation and disorder, both as an object of study and as a style of analysis. In recent works combining these perspectives, ethnographic authority is questioned by quoting diverse voices in a way that highlights their conflict, irony, and intertextual absurdity. This pastiche confounds the assumptions of received analytic categories and implies a highly critical analysis of social practices, particularly those of colonial or neocolonial agents, including ethnographers (e.g., Taussig 1987; Clifford and Marcus 1988). Restricted by its postmodern impetus, however, this criticism is often unable to progress beyond irony or parody and state a more positive alternative. The opposition often recognized between Marxism and postmodernism - postmodernism denying and Marxism embracing a vision of grounded criticism, transcultural humanism, and enlightened progress - makes them contradictory if frequent bedfellows in much current anthropological work.3 The problems posed by these competing critiques become increasingly apparent as more ethnography is considered for purposes of comparative regional analysis. The transparent factuality of ethnographic accounts cannot be assumed. Yet just how deeply and thoroughly must one question and contextualize their voices? (see Fardon 1990; Manganaro 1990). How and when does one stop analyzing the ethnographers and get on with the ethnographic analysis per sel If one ultimately refuses the objectivist leap, doesn't anthropology lose its center and become something else - intertextual art or representational criticism? On the other hand, a dedication to political economy, Marxism, or history in the longue duree makes a move into objectivity, but ultimately with a vengeance. These approaches have a tendency to grind up local trends and events into a universalizing theoretical mill. This problem increases at more general and inclusive levels of analysis; cultures become reflexes of a hegemonic world system and are stripped of
Theoretical and ethnographic context
5
distinctiveness.4 At what point should one assert the importance of local structures over larger regional or global trends? How do diverse subjectivities and cultural propensities compete with political or economic rationality in determining action? If one fails to address these questions, cultural process becomes an epiphenomenon of politicoeconomic structure; anthropology becomes economics or political science. This book engages the problems raised by postmodern and politicoeconomic theories with the spatial comparison of sociocultural formations. My goal is not to give up on comparative ethnographic analysis, but to drive it forward. In so doing, I draw heavily on the important work of Bourdieu (1977, 1984, 1988a, 1990a-c, 1991a), Giddens (1979, 1984, 1987, 1989, 1990), Sahlins (1981, 1985, 1990), Ortner (1989, 1990a,b), and more generally on approaches that have been gathered loosely under the label of practice theories (Ortner 1984). At the micro-level or "on-the-social-ground," these approaches (notwithstanding their many differences) emphasize the relationship between structural constraint and agency or event. Thus, for instance, Bourdieu (1977, 1990a) introduces the notion of habitus, in which structure is both constituted by and constituent of practice; Giddens' (1979, 1984, 1987) notion of structuration5 stresses the recursive nature of social life and encodes the mutual dependence of structure and agency; Sahlins' (1981, 1985:ch.5) "structure of the conjuncture," suggests that historical development occurs as the interface between structural disposition and contingent event; and Ortner (1990a) discusses sociocultural hegemonies, which engage dominant cultural orientations with the historical possibilities of social practice. In these approaches, cultural logics are kept in play with, rather than reduced to, political economy on the one hand, and the contingency of personal agency on the other. As such, these approaches are in a unique position to mediate some of the important tensions between politicoeconomic and postmodern orientations in anthropology. To critically expand the theoretical relationship between culture and practice seems to me a promising avenue in anthropology at present. In theoretical work to date, the relationship between culture and practice has been less fully considered in its spatial than in its temporal dimension; theories implicating "practice" are not yet well developed for comparative ethnographic analysis.6 To develop practice theories in this respect requires, as Bourdieu (1990c:49) himself puts it, "thinking with them against them" - drawing on their insights to transcend some of their limitations. Criticism here presupposes appreciation. The
6
Grounding
following discussion of practice theories draws on the postmodern and the politicoeconomic critique of comparative analysis mentioned above and underpins parts 2 and 3 of the present volume, respectively. Research practice and postmodernism
It is evident from the postmodern critique of ethnographic objectivity that theories of structure and practice have paid insufficient attention to the historical and cultural assumptions that inform the information they use. This tendency poses particular problems when the ethnographic net is widely cast and a detailed comparison attempted of different regions. The relativity of ethnographic reports written in different time periods and with different personal and theoretical aims needs to be actively considered. Though this concern need not take over the analysis, ethnography needs to be critically appraised in terms of its historical context before the objectivist leap can be made.7 Of those authors mentioned earlier, Bourdieu (1988a, 1990a-c, 1991a) is the most aware of discourse pragmatics, and he cogently reminds us that "in the social sciences, the progress of knowledge presupposes progress in our knowledge of the conditions of knowledge" (1990a: 1). But though he is highly attuned to the academic politics of current disciplinary debates, Bourdieu is less concerned with how information has been encoded in the ethnographic and historical record. In this respect, practice theorists have not drawn sufficiently on the insights of Foucault (1984) and de Certeau (1988) concerning the archeological structures of our own episteme, and, particularly, the effect these have on how information is historically encoded as factual knowledge.8 Part 2 of this volume, chapters 3-6, illustrates the biases that result from an uncritical use of the ethnographic record when making a comparative analysis. This problem is particularly evident in recent contrasts drawn between south New Guinea and the New Guinea highlands. But rather than pursuing a critique through impressionistic or intertextual pastiche, I remain committed to an objectivist account; I take seriously the analytical problems raised by postmodernism, but I don't adopt postmodern theory as a basis of presentation or argument. As I hope to show, a systematic and detailed review of ethnographic evidence is not incompatible with and, indeed, is central to comprehending the relevance of postmodernism for comparative regional analysis. In the case at hand, the classic south coast ethnographies have been
Theoretical and ethnographic context compared as if on a par with those about core highland areas. But the south coast ethnographies were based on primary fieldwork conducted largely during the 1910s, the 1920s, and the 1930s, whereas the classic highlands fieldwork was initiated in the 1950s and 1960s. Highland fieldwork was first configured largely by the concerns and critiques of British structural-functionalism, on the one hand, and American cultural materialism, on the other. (By contrast, the symbolic-interpretive impetus in interior New Guinea took root particularly in the late sixties and the seventies in fringe as opposed to core highland areas [e.g., Wagner 1967, 1972; Schieffelin 1976].) Unsurprisingly, the classic highlands monographs tended to focus on issues of politicoeconomic and socioecological organization - Big Man politics, competitive exchange, clanship, politicoeconomic intensification, and the causal ramifications of these for issues such as gender relations.9 The classic south coast ethnography, in contrast, was shaped by the Victorian anthropological legacy of Tylor and Frazer. Their interests engaged turn-of-the-century British and continental European concern with diffusionism, on the one hand, and ethnography as the comparative natural history of native customs and beliefs, on the other (see Urry 1972, 1984:44-48; Stocking 1984). Guided by figures such as A. C. Haddon at Cambridge and R. R. Marett at Oxford (mentor to F. E. Williams), as well as Dutch and German anthropologists, early south coast ethnography was particularly focused on spirit cults, totemism, moieties, magic, and material culture.10 As discussed in chapter 4, evidence from south coast societies for highly developed systems of leadership and exchange was scattered and assigned to the background, despite the fact that politics was frequently rooted, among other things, in elaborate and competitive gift exchange, large-scale residential and military organization, and even systems of rank. More generally, the polar contrasts often drawn between core highland and south lowland New Guinea are in significant part a function of synchrony in comparison - the uncritical comparison of accounts gathered at different times and with different ethnographic goals and theoretical assumptions. As discussed in chapters 3-6, most of the prominent characterizations made of south New Guinea are highly inadequate if not incorrect for the south coastal regions. Many of these comparative assessments treat ethnographic accounts in an ahistorical manner even though some of them focus on developmental transformation at the level of manifest ethnographic content. Core highland areas of New Guinea are justifiably remarkable for
7
8
Grounding
their high population density and agricultural intensification; genuine differences existed and continue to exist between highland and south coastal New Guinea, as analyzed in chapter 10. There is also some truth to the self-fulfilling statement that societies deserve the theoretical orientations of their ethnographers; a dovetailing emerges between ethnographic approaches and the regions they best illuminate. Nevertheless, predisposing theoretical orientations and selective areal emphases tend to reinforce one another over academic time. This bias is magnified as the scale of analysis is increased and regional comparisons are attempted: it is all too easy to find polar contrasts between regions for which primary accounts were gathered at different times and/or with different ethnographic and theoretical agendas. Critically analyzing this process allows us to see more clearly how key "traits" become associated with ethnographic "regions": the New Guinea highlands become widely associated with Big Men, elaborate systems of competitive exchange, clanship, and heterosexuality, while the south coast becomes associated with Great Man leadership, restricted exchange, cross-totem affiliation, and homosexuality (Lindenbaum 1984, 1987; Feil 1987:ch.7; Herdt 1984a; Whitehead 1986; Godelier and Strathern 1991). As name and place become associated, characteristics thought to be "key" are inappropriately reified and then elevated as metonyms for ethnographic regions as wholes. This general trend has been critically exposed by Appadurai (1986). There has been a particular recent tendency for south lowland New Guinea to become sexualized in anthropological discourse. Prominent archetypes have emerged, depicting the area as a "homosexual" region populated by "homosexual societies" (Feil 1987:ch.7; Lindenbaum 1984, 1987; cf. Herdt 1984a, 1991). The homosexual practices of a few constituent societies are taken as the primary lens through which many other customs and beliefs of the larger region are viewed. In fact, however, most of the south New Guinea population belonged to societies in which ritualized homosexuality was absent (see chapter 3). Along the south coast, ritual heterosexuality was far more prevalent than ritual homosexuality or boy-insemination. As discussed in chapter 3, the important work of Gilbert Herdt (1981, 1984a, 1991, 1992) draws attention to Melanesian homoerotic customs and emphasizes their differences from customs and beliefs in the West. In terms of ethnographic history, it is quite understandable that Melanesian homosexuality was the focus of great attention during the 1980s, since this was the time that homosexuality came out of the closet
Theoretical and ethnographic context
9
in our own public and academic discussions.11 To assess anthropological trends in the context of other social concerns is not to disparage them, and it is not possible for the analyst to escape history in any event. In this regard, I note reflexively that my perspective, which emphasizes the powerful diversity of extramarital heterosexuality as well as the more limited distribution of homosexual orientations in south coastal New Guinea, has been influenced by the postmodern feminist consideration of poly sexuality, including its critique of eroticaphobia, phallogocentrism, and the uncritical attribution of discrete "sex" and "gender" categories.12 In this respect, my perspective extends Herdt's underlying impetus while at the same time targeting his approach for critical evaluation. One point deserves emphasis: Herdt is fully correct that homosexual and homoerotic beliefs and practices are an important topic of anthropological investigation. His insistence is underscored by the fact that anthropologists paid little theoretical or comparative attention to Melanesian homosexual customs from the late 1800s to virtually the 1970s despite their intensive analysis of many other Melanesian customs and beliefs during this period. Nevertheless, I am wary of extending Herdt's emphasis too far and assuming that sexuality is a "fictitious unity" or "causal principle," as asserted generally by Foucault (1980a:154). Hence, I do not use sex as a privileged point of entry for the wider ethnographic analysis of south coast New Guinea. Instead, I consider variants of sexual practice and gender relations as dimensions of larger sociocultural formations. As Herdt (1992: forthcoming) states in his preface to the second edition of Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia, "sexuality must be analyzed as part of a whole, contextual, social tradition." By putting the complexity of individual experience back in its social and political context, the postmodern critique should not prevent analysis from being systematic. That absolute objectivity is impossible is beside the point; the goal is to move in the direction of clearer, more explicit, and more refined understanding. In opposition to the excesses of postmodernism, then, its own insights may be appropriated to illuminate rather than obliterate the nature of ethnographic regions and the extent of their differences. In Bourdieu's (1990a; cf. 1988a) terms, this goal is achieved by objectifying the subjective dimensions of our own analysis as a critical tool. We need increased sensitivity to epistemic relativity - a reflexive awareness of our diverse ways of knowing - without succumbing to
10
Grounding
ontological relativism. The latter, which views "being" as relative and questions the existence of any coherent reality to know about, paralyzes the anthropological endeavor (e.g., Tyler 1990; contrast discussion in Shore 1988). Though ethnography is always relative to the ethnographer's concerns, ethnographic differences are not simply Western projections. Ethnographic relativity is one dimension of anthropology to be continually wrestled with (and never "resolved"), but it should not compromise an alternative moment in which critical objectivism is embraced. Practice theories and political economy
The politicoeconomic critique of ethnographic comparison engages some of the important recent developments in theories of culture and practice. These developments will be presently discussed at a high level of theoretical generality to provide a broad basis for the empirical discussion that is developed in subsequent chapters. Readers more interested in ethnographic specifics or in middle-range theory may prefer to move on to page 16 and read the present section after considering the book's ethnographic analysis. In their various American anthropological formulations, theories of practice tend to champion the independent or at least the confounding influences of indigenous cultural structures vis-a-vis the political economy of an intruding world system.13 For instance, Ortner (1990a,b) and Sahlins (1981, 1990) suggest that local developments cannot be subsumed in the spatial hegemony of Western political economy; local structures and indigenous agency must be kept in focus. Donham (1990) similarly stresses the tension between internalist "historical" and externalist "epochal" analysis. These approaches stress that local cultural influences are not simply confronted and transformed by politicoeconomic intrusion, they rebound on and shape these intrusions, both locally and regionally. As if to provide more coherent resistance to politicoeconomc theory, however, theories of structure and practice tend to adopt a hegemonic view of indigenous structure itself. Structure in these approaches is generally held to be an all-encompassing "cultural logic" or "schema." Though the matter is one of relative emphasis rather than absolutes, practice theories do tend to rely too much on a Durkheimian notion of structural stasis at the expense of a more dialectical Marxist formulation.14 Bourdieu's theory, for all its interplay of structure, agency,
Theoretical and ethnographic context
11
and domination, places surprisingly great emphasis on structural hegemony and surprisingly little on sociocultural development or transformation (see critique by Harker et al. 1990:216f.). Bourdieu attempts to respond to this criticism and to the charge of tautology, but it is questionable whether he sufficiently counters them either in his many substantive analyses or on a theoretical level, for instance, when he writes (1990c: 118): The problem of change. I do not see where my readers could have found the model of circular reproduction which they attribute to me (structure —» habitus —> structure). Indeed, I could show how the opposition between statics and dynamics, structure and history, reproduction and transformation, etc., is totally fictitious, in so far as it is the structure . . . which constitutes the principle of the strategies aimed at preserving or transforming the structure. This assertion does little to alleviate the suspicion that structure, for all its internal dynamics and articulation through practice, remains selffulfilled unless impacted from the outside. For Sahlins (1981, 1985), structure can be transformed, but more from the outside than from the inside; if anything, it is the persistence of structure that causes change; structural categories are revalued in the light of externally imposed economic and political contingencies. What needs greater complementary attention is how structures feed upon changes that they themselves generate. It is important to show not only the effects of structure as a synchronic entity, but how structures self-transform from the inside how they respond dialectically to their own prior actualizations. There is a corresponding tendency for theories of structure and practice to attribute change-inducing motivation to political and economic self-interest. In the process, the active and transformatory power of symbolic formations is relegated to the background; Weber's Protestant Ethic is forgotten. Thus, though theories of structure and practice give strong weight to agency, the subjective power of this agency tends, particularly in the theories of Giddens and Bourdieu, to be confined to "power", "interest," "strategy," "schema," and control over various "rules" and "resources." Within such a conceptual armature, Western assumptions about motivation are easily accepted; interest is tacitly presumed to be self-interest, and it tends toward economic and political domination. Ironically, this assumption also smuggles itself into Sahlins' (1981:68-72) analysis of change, which transects indigenous cultural value with the somehow different "pragmatic" interests of actors when they apply signs in a world of political
12
Grounding
and economic contingency (cf. discussion of motivation by Ortner 1984:151f.). Bourdieu (1977, 1990a-c), Giddens (1979, 1984), Sahlins (1981, 1985), and Ortner (1990a) all attempt to transcend motivational reductionism by making culture categories of thought and symbolization the condition as well as the consequence of inequity in the social distribution of resources. Particularly important are Bourdieu's notions of symbolic capital and symbolic power, which expand upon a reductionist or vulgar Marxist emphasis on economic class interest (in which inequality is limited largely to the social relations of material production - contrast also Donham [1990]). But, as Harker et al. (1990:211) note, Bourdieu's notion of symbolic capital tends, in the final analysis, to boil down to political capital after all, with politics . . . seen as a field of its own, a ghostly deus ex machina which works unseen behind the facade of appearance, or . . . as the ultimate form of capital, for which all other lesser currencies arefinallycashed in. It is as if the driving force of symbolization must be made to appear particularly "hard" - politically and economically authoritative - to justify culture as more than an epiphenomenon, more than superstructural fluff. Bourdieu (1990c: 106) notes this fairly explicitly: the use I make of the notion of interest, which can call forth the accusation of economism against a work which, from the very beginning (I can refer here to my anthropological studies), was conceived in opposition to economism. The notion of interest - I always speak of specific interest - was conceived as an instrument of rupture intended to bring the materialist mode of questioning to bear on realms from which it was absent and into the sphere of cultural production in particular. In essence, Bourdieu attempts to deal with charges of economism by asserting that his homology between the economic and the cultural was a tool to combat a simpler economic reductionism. But his position should be extended further, since the borrowed concepts of "interest" and "strategy" continue to smuggle in reductionist assumptions particularly the assumption that politicoeconomic domination, however it may "use" culture, is still paramount in the final instance. In short, the attempt to widen a more reductive material perspective to one that takes culture seriously has been limited by the very motivational contours it has borrowed for purposes of opposition. Thus, in analyzing conditions of change, Bourdieu's cultural capital and even Sahlins'
Theoretical and ethnographic context
13
(1981:78-81) "signs in action" are too easily fused with economic advantage and political domination. A reductive view of change-inducing motivation in practice theories points to a final and greater issue: the use of an omnibus notion of "structure" (see Sewell 1989). On the positive side, practice theorists use a dual notion of "structure" - structure is both constitutive of and constituted by action - as an effective tool in their drive to subsume and transcend pernicious theoretical polarizations, particularly those between objectivism and subjectivism, and, relatedly, between base and superstructure. All of the authors currently considered - Bourdieu, Giddens, Ortner, and Sahlins - would appear to subscribe to such transcendence, and we may generally concur with such a goal. But, there is a danger that in the rush to transcend these oppositions, the notion of "structure" becomes overly enlarged and coherent in order to fill the resulting conceptual vacuum. In the process, it is easy for structure to become overly hegemonic as well: a large and vague black box. This problem becomes particularly evident as spatial variation is considered - the comparative variation of structures across regions. Where, exactly, is the juggernaut of "structure" located, and where does one structure end and another begin? This question exposes the problems that stem from an overly systematized notion of structure and an overly coherent or even hegemonic cultural logic (e.g., Bourdieu 1990a).15 This problem lurks generally in approaches that replace the classic concept of "culture" - a highly relative but publicly shared symbolic formation - with a more hegemonic notion of structure that heuristically fuses the symbolic and the existential components of action. Ultimately, I find an overarching notion of structure too vague and thus restrict the concept to a symbolic and ideological field, that is, as "cultural structure." Languages do have grammars, and symbolic formations can be heuristically treated as having structures of symbolic logic that motivate and underpin their organization. To assume with Bourdieu (1990c: 126) that social action has structural rules and logic in the same way, however, is to blur the complex socio-symbolic interface. Social action emerges as the interplay between cultural orientation and individual motivation, on the one hand, and the contingencies and constraints of a nonsymbolic world, on the other. Insofar as the world of symbols and the world of physical bodies and materials are not isomorphic, their connection
14
Grounding
needs to be systematically teased apart rather than fused in order to assess their dialectical relationship. Instead of a broad notion of "structure," I favor an internally delineated concept of the "sociocultural formation." Within this, first and foremost, is the patterning - or structure - of ideation. This dimension of reality is ultimately grounded in people's minds: the symbolic impetus for the development of cultural formations and the subjective orientations of motivation, value, and driving cultural geist ("spirit"). On the other hand, the sociocultural formation holds in tension the effects of motivated action on bodies and materials - its aggregated "hard world" actualization. Subject to the laws of biology and physics as well as to the influence of culture, these actualizations have unintended consequences that can act as irritants and stimulate further symbolic elaboration. Culture, correspondingly, develops in part by the reappropriation of its own hard-world embodiments, as brilliantly illustrated by Kelly (1985) in his analysis of the Nuer conquest. The dialectical relationship between cultural impetus and its existential manifestation is a core dynamic of sociocultural development. This formation both draws upon and inverts Marxist base-superstructure models. In these, culture elaborates as it strains over time to reproduce and maintain objective social inequalities (Friedman 1974; Cohen 1978, 1988; cf. Donham 1990:ch.2). According to this line of reasoning, the social and political conservatism of cultural orientation exists in tension with infrastructural forces that make change inevitable. My own perspective retains this inherently disjunctive and dialectic relationship between subjective and existential dimensions of action. But the infrastructural, material, or economic dimensions of social life and even less so, a narrow focus on economic and class inequality cannot be assumed to be the ultimate prime movers of sociocultural development, even in "the final instance." If anything, analysis must start on the other side, with a consideration of cultural impetus. As emphasized by Weber (1958 [1904-1905], 1978 [1956]), social action is importantly influenced by the distinctive features of local symbolic geist. As reflected in the awareness of the early Marx (1964 [1844]; Marx and Engels 1970 [1846]), social relations are a reflex neither of productive forces nor of simple universal motives of social domination. This insight is at present becoming more prominent in post-Marxist anthropology (see Donham 1990; Roseberry 1989). The subjective dimensions of action, because they are culturally
Theoretical and ethnographic context
15
distinctive, are not easily reconstituted ex post facto, especially if analysis takes its point of departure from reductive motivational assumptions. By the same token, however, one must go beyond the manifestation of subjective impetus in action, as Weber did, and see how social and material results systematically rebound back on subjective orientations themselves. The material world is not reducible to symbolic formulations, even endogenously, and culture is always altered and compromised in its existential manifestation. Cultural impetus has important and often unintended consequences, as Giddens has rightly and repeatedly emphasized. For "the elementary forms of the symbolic life" as Sahlins (1985:148f.) puts it, this entails the risk of cultural action, which is a risk of the categories in reference. In action, people put their concepts and categories into ostensive relations to the world. Such referential uses bring into play other determinations of the signs, besides their received sense, namely the actual world and the people concerned. Praxis is, then, a risk to the sense of signs in the culture-as-constituted, precisely as the sense is arbitrary in its capacity as reference. Having its own properties, the world may then prove intractable. It can well defy the concepts that are indexed to it. Man's symbolic hubris becomes a great gamble played with the empirical realities. The gamble is that referential action, by placing a priori concepts in correspondence with external objects, will imply some unforeseen effects that cannot be ignored.
The challenges, dissonances, and refractoriness of culture's own existential manifestation provide tensions that drive development in the symbolic formation itself. As a result, subjective orientations cannot be said to completely determine the hard-world dimensions of social action, though they exercise a tremendous influence on them. Rather, a core dialectic is constituted by the recursive qualitative impact that symbolic and existential dimensions of social action exert on each other over time. Along with internal cultural dynamics, this dialectic drives the endogenous development of sociocultural formations. As I explore in part 3 of this book, an awareness of this sociocultural dialectic allows one to delineate and expose for analysis a range of factors that tend to be polarized and then transcendentally fused in several theories of structure and agency. Chapters 8 and 9 illustrate ethnographically that indigenous sociocultural formations house an internal dialectic; it pits developing symbolic or ideological formations against the legacy of their own existential manifestations, which hence confront them as an Other. It is not only the case that symbolic or ideological formations are invariably compromised in practice, nor that
16
Grounding
their concrete results in social action are subject to the material constraints of the configuration of politicoeconomic, residential, and demographic organization. These existential embodiments themselves rebound on subjective value orientations as a provocative stimulant; they are reacted to and reappropriated in further symbolic elaboration. In Marxist terms, there is a dialectic between social being and social consciousness. The recursive tension between subjective impetus and its sociomaterial existence drives development in the sociocultural formation as a whole. What results is not failed cultural reproduction or simple alteration, but directional change. This development does not require the influence of foreign forces or events and is hence not dependent on external politicoeconomic imposition (although it does accommodate external influences as part of the existential conditions of social action). The present approach entails a theory of sociocultural formation that comprehends the generation of change, including transformatory change, from within sociocultural formations themselves. As discussed in chapter 2, the political and research history of south New Guinea make it particularly feasible to consider these issues without taking the external impact of state systems as fully into account as one would have to in most other world areas. The case at hand thus allows internal dialectics to be viewed with particular clarity. The dialectical relationship between symbolic formations and their sociomaterial actualization has had distinctive characteristics in each of the seven language-culture areas of south coast New Guinea. A striking diversity of political, economic, and religious forms have become elaborated within a broad compass of cultural and geographic features shared in common. The process of generative development has been similar in each case, and this provides an axis for cross-case comparison. A revised application of practice theories thus retains the possibility of comparison within and between regions while allowing for the exploration of local cultural diversity. The Melanesian ethnographic context
South coast New Guinea is academically framed by the history of Melanesian ethnography hinted at earlier. Anthropological knowledge concerning Melanesia is very diverse - gained over more than a century of research by different waves of scholarly and nonscholarly observers. As a result, there is no hope of finding rigid consistency between the ethnography of specific regions and theoretical or historical trends.
Theoretical and ethnographic context
17
Nevertheless, general patterns do emerge, and these have strongly shaped the Western perception of Melanesia's constituent regions. As the political history of Melanesian anthropology remains to be written, 16 a cursory review such as the present one will be open to criticism and compromise. Such historiography, however, is a critical prelude to the comparative study of Melanesia and its constituent areas. To rephrase Bourdieu (1990c:35) for an anthropological context, "the ethnology of ethnology is itself one of the first conditions of ethnology." In the late nineteenth and early twentieth century, Melanesian ethnography was pursued primarily as the comparative natural history of native customs, beliefs, and artifacts.17 A "Notes and Queries" style of ethnography was strongly propounded by A. C. Haddon. Trained as a zoologist interested in comparative natural history, Haddon organized the Cambridge expedition to the Torres Straits in 1898, converted to anthropology with a sense of zealous mission, and acceded to one of British anthropology's first regular academic positions, at Cambridge (see Urry 1982; Quiggin 1942). As Michael Young (1988:4) rightly comments, Haddon was "arguably the most influential British anthropologist in the first two decades of the century." Haddon took an eminent role in fostering the ethnographic study of New Guinea and adjacent areas of Melanesia, and his impact on south coast ethnography (which he himself inaugurated during his first expedition of 1888) was particularly great. As mentioned earlier in this chapter, the interests of Haddon and of British diffusionist anthropologists included prominent concern with material artifacts, on the one hand, and with religious customs and beliefs, on the other. As Urry (1972:47) notes, the early edition of Notes and Queries on Anthropology contained 245 questions on religion and only "a single descriptive sentence on the topic of 'social relations.'" In Melanesia, this concern articulated not only with the theoretical interests then applied to primitive societies (see generally, Kuper 1988; Stocking 1987), but also with the influential role of missionaries.18 Missionaries' religious interests, knowledge of local customs, and logistical support had a significant impact on nineteenth- and early twentieth-century Melanesian survey ethnography (Langmore 1989; Whiteman 1983; cf. Knauft 1990a:258f.). Intellectually, missionaries and early scholarly observers shared literacy, education, and an Enlightenment vision of Melanesians as savages capable of improvement. Thus, for instance, they tended to ally in objecting to the depredations of the Queensland labor trade and in
18
Grounding
urging stricter government regulation of European traders and recruiters.19 While early Melanesian ethnologists such as Haddon and the early Rivers studied the slow processes of diffusion that informed their concept of evolutionary improvement, missionaries worked as agents of change to catapult their subjects into moral and social advancement. These objectives were seen as different ends of a developmental continuum; hence the easy linkage between them by early Melanesian missionary-anthropologists such as Codrington (1891) and in the joint academic-missionary volume edited by Rivers (1922) on Melanesian depopulation, the proceeds of which were dedicated to the Melanesian Mission. As Whiteman (1983:110) notes, early Melanesian survey ethnologists and missionaries shared a common moral interest in "salvaging" natives from coastal areas before they were degraded by contact with Western gun-runners, labor recruiters, and unscrupulous traders. It was their practical goals that differed: ethnologists wanted to preserve Melanesians for academic study; missionaries wanted to preserve them in order to save their souls. For reasons of practical accessibility, early ethnographic work was most common in insular Melanesia and along the coastal or riverine areas of New Guinea. At least until the contributions of Rivers (1914), it tended to view native customs as a potpourri of separate and diffusing traits (e.g. Haddon 1901-1935, 1920b; Lewis 1932). A potpourri view of culture is also characteristic of German survey ethnography and museum collecting in Melanesia, which gained an important if short-lived momentum until they were sharply curtailed by World War One.20 Prior to World War One and thereafter along the south coast, observers documented customs and beliefs as discrete if not autonomous facts, viewed not so much as parts of a social whole but as isolable entities for the armchair theorist to chart in patterns of regional diffusion. There was little emphasis on politicoeconomic interconnection or developmental trajectory, and the understanding of exchange was generally preMaussian, with rigid division maintained between religion, social custom, and material culture. In the years between the World Wars, progressively greater emphasis was placed on the study of Melanesian political, social, and economic organization. This shift was consistent with the legacy of Rivers and then Malinowski and with the general trajectory of British social anthropology over the first half of the twentieth century (Kuper 1983). In Melanesia, these trends were politically consistent with the dispossession of German colonies by the Australians and the increasing entrenchment of English
Theoretical and ethnographic context
19
and Australian colonial control in insular eastern Melanesia, the Massim, and large sections of the New Guinea coast. In these areas of Melanesia, anthropologists and government workers shared a common interest in native law, custom, kinship, and political organization: the interests of British structural-functionalism articulated with those of colonial administration (Asad 1973; cf. Said 1978). Though general, this linkage was far from uniform or straightforward across Melanesia. For instance, Malinowski's emphasis on the coherence and integrity if not rationality of indigenous customs and beliefs served at one level as a bulwark against the need for colonial intervention: indigenous communities that were "functioning" just fine on their own had little need to be tampered with by the authorities.21 The ethnographic structure given to such institutions did, however, provide an ostensibly rational framework on which colonial regulations could be systematically built or superimposed, and many ethnographers, including Malinowski, supported a British colonial policy of indirect rule (Feuchtwang 1973).22 How to impose colonial authority in an enlightened manner was of particular concern to administrators such as Hubert Murray, Papua's long-standing Lieutenant-Governor (West 1968:ch.lO; Griffin et al 1979:ch.3; cf. Lett 1949; Murray 1912). A more violent precursor to this orientation can be found in the rough-and-ready combination of exploration, documentation, and unilateral though "fair" imposition of order by Sir William MacGregor, who preceded Murray and governed British New Guinea from 1888 to 1898 (Griffin et al. 1979:ch.2; MacGregor 1897; Joyce 1971:chs.6-9). By the standards of the day, the Papuan colonial experience was humanitarian and liberal, with high tolerance for anthropological sensibilities. Murray, for instance, was an advocate of the professional position of government anthropologist, held for many years by the intrepid F. E. Williams (West 1968:ch.l0). More typical for English colonies was the attitude of naturalist-turned-administrator Charles Woodford, who governed the Solomon Islands for the British in the late nineteenth and early twentieth century (Woodford 1890; cf. Guppy 1887). In contrast to Murray and even MacGregor, Woodford had much less concern with "native welfare" and more with economic exploitation. On the assumption that natives were dying out anyway, little thought was given to studying or understanding them. Woodford engineered massive alienation of indigenous lands and paved the way for the institution of head taxes and forced plantation labor (Bennett 1987:chs.5-7).
20
Grounding
Similar policies were attempted by Albert Hahl and other administrators in German New Guinea. The Germans, however, were yet more violent and punitive in their efforts: though they developed a highly organized administrative and economic infrastructure in a few selected areas, such as Rabaul, most of their territory remained unexplored, uncontrolled, and subject to punitive raids and open colonial warfare (S. Firth 1978,1982; Hempenstall 1978). The tie between colonial administration and ethnographic documentation was nonetheless strong in German and particularly in Dutch Melanesia; it was most contentious and oppositional among the French. In both German New Guinea and Dutch West New Guinea there was a significant fit between military/exploratory patrols and ethnographic surveys (see Souter 1963:ch.lO; van Baal et al. 1984:44-54). With a few notable exceptions, such as the work of Richard Thurnwald, Felix Speiser, and the self-taught Paul Wirz, much of the early ethnography from German and Dutch Melanesia does not come from long-term in situ fieldwork. Instead, it derives from expeditionary surveys and more locally detailed accounts by nonacademic but highly educated government officials, missionaries, and commercial entrepreneurs. Among the Dutch, the link between colonial administration and anthropology was particularly strong, and intensive ethnographic instruction (with special emphasis on "customary law") was a regular part of training for Dutch officials (Ellen 1976; de Josselin de Jong 1960; Kennedy 1944; Held 1953). Regarding the French colonial experience in southeastern Melanesia, there was yet less concern with documenting or understanding indigenous customs, and - to put it baldly - much greater concern with killing or at least marginalizing the indigenous people who adhered to them (see critique in Guiart 1983; Weitzman 1985). This oppression was consistent with French nineteenth-century colonial policy and with the status of New Caledonia as an annexed part of France, first as a penal colony and then as a major site of industrial mining and colonization (see Aldrich 1990:ch.6; Connell 1987; Thompson 1984). Consequently, the ethnography of French Melanesia in the first half of the twentieth century was pitted against fervent French colonial interests. 23 It consists of the heroic work of a few select figures such as missionary Maurice Leenhardt, Maurice Lenormand, and later, the Marxist Jean Guiart. In the years before World War Two, the bulk of Melanesian ethnography was in the legacy of British functional and structuralfunctional traditions. With the benefit of hindsight, it is evident that
Theoretical and ethnographic context
21
important French counterthrusts were provided by the armchair ethnographic analysis of Massim exchange by Marcel Mauss in The Gift (1967 [1925]) and the pioneering work on person and myth by Leenhardt (1947). Additionally, there are important ways in which Dutch ethnography (though largely from Indonesia) pre-dated some of Levi-Strauss' structuralist concerns (see de Josselin de Jong 1972). Melanesia also provided the grounding point for several new theoretical emphases that emerged in English and American anthropology in the first half of the century. These included not only Rivers' (1914) important contributions to social organization and Malinowski's (1922, 1926, 1929, 1935) revolution infieldworkand functional analysis, but pioneering studies of socialization, gender, and emotion by Mead (1930, 1935) and Bateson (1936). The important and still-neglected work of Harrisson (1937) presaged and in some respects transcended important dimensions of anthropological postmodernism, that is, by combining an ironic pastiche of competing voices with a highly critical historiography and a solid base of documentary evidence - all within an experimental and highly evocative ethnographic format (cf. Taussig 1987). These works notwithstanding, the larger part of Melanesian ethnography from the 1910s to the 1940s combined the functionalism of Malinowski and the structural-functionalism of Radcliffe-Brown with the Firthian partitioning of society into discrete institutions (e.g., R. Firth 1936, 1939, 1940). These collective influences led to a proliferation of stolid descriptive volumes and articles on coastal and insular Melanesia during the inter-war years and beyond.24 Within these, ethnographic description was divided into separate topical units, with special emphasis on social and political organization. Correspondingly, spiritual beliefs and practices tended to be treated either through normative description of "cult" organization or through the decontextualized presentation of myths, stories, and legends, that is, as separate from both world view and social action.25 The structural-functional description of isolated ethnographic topics is highly evident in the influential first decades of Oceania, which began publication in 1930. In the post-World War Two period, a new geographic focus began in Melanesian anthropology. In the pre-war years, more than a million highlanders had been discovered in the fertile valleys of interior New Guinea; now their societies became available for anthropological research. The distinctiveness of this endeavor was linked to special features of colonial intervention and pacification; in world-comparative terms, highland New Guinea colonialism was both historically late and
22
Grounding
relatively benign. These twin facts greatly facilitated fieldwork by Western anthropologists. In the 1950s and 1960s highland New Guinea became a hot spot for fieldwork; though other features and directions of Melanesian ethnography emerged or continued, the study of highland cultures became preeminent (Hays 1992). Core highland areas of New Guinea stimulated a torrent of detailed and fascinating ethnographic studies in the fifties, sixties, and seventies.26 Highland New Guinea of the 1960s virtually inherited the African mantle as the locus classicus of tribal formations, and it generated a corpus of high-quality ethnography that rivalled or surpassed that of almost any other "pre-state" world area. This work continued to address issues of particular concern to British structural-functionalism, such as kinship and politics, but it was broadened by the concerns of American cultural materialism. It was also increasingly problem-oriented and tried to explain the linkage between various dimensions of political and socioeconomic organization. Important monographs by Meggitt, A. Strathern, M. Strathern, Reay, Salisbury, Berndt, Pospisil, Glasse, Ploeg, P. Brown, Rappaport, and others focussed on the relationship between social structure, politics, warfare, economic exchange, and ecology. Such work was progressively widened to include a consideration of gender relations and other topics.27 In the process, empirical grounds were laid for critiques of both structural-functionalist and materialist paradigms.28 By the mid 1960s, the principal highland groups had been studied, and fieldwork shifted perceptibly to the fringe highland and adjacent areas of interior New Guinea. Here the richness of Melanesian ethnography was augmented yet further. Though political and economic issues, rejuvenated by Marxist concerns, continued to dominate interest in core highland areas (e.g., A. Strathern 1982), American interpretive interests of the Geertzian era came more strongly to the fore in fringe highland and adjacent regions, as did interest in French structuralism. In the 1970s and early 1980s topical interest in fringe highland and other less densely populated areas of interior New Guinea shifted decidedly toward matters of cultural belief, cosmology, and ritual. This change is reflected in the symbolic focus of more than a score of monographs, beginning with those of Roy Wagner (1967, 1972, 1978), and including those by E. Schieffelin (1976), Feld (1982), Barth (1975, 1987), Gell (1975), Juillerat (1986), Tuzin (1980), Gesch (1985), Harrison (1990), G. Lewis (1980), Herdt (1981,1987a), Godelier (1986), Knauft (1985a), Shaw (1990), LeRoy (1985a,b), Weiner (1988a), and Meigs (1984), see
Theoretical and ethnographic context
23
also Kelly (1976,1977). Taken as a whole, the ethnography of interior New Guinea had by this time contributed substantially to most of the ongoing theoretical debates in anthropology, for example, concerning structuralism, cultural interpretation, gender and sexual identity, Marxism, exchange theory, and, more recently, colonialism and postmodernism. The trends of the present, though difficult as yet to judge, appear to include a rejuvenated interest in other areas of Melanesia, particularly the Massim, the Sepik, and insular Melanesia.29 This work both engages and reflects the longer contact of these areas with Westerners and the increasing anthropological interest in cultural history, on the one hand, and post-colonial identity, on the other. As part of this process, the rediscovery of historical material recorded by earlier ethnographers as well as missionaries, government officials, and explorers has begun. Yet to be determined is how the total corpus of Melanesian ethnography inarguably so rich and arguably so classic - is to be at once both the object and the vehicle of anthropological analysis. For ethnographic comparison, the question raised is a large one: how to begin configuring and comparing regions that collectively encompass perhaps one-sixth of the world's languages. This question is of increasing concern to Melanesianists as the embarrassing richness of primary ethnography is orchestrated within roughly defined regional perspectives. An accelerating trend towards regional analysis is evident in recent works on the New Guinea highlands by Feil (1987) and P. Brown (1978); for the Sepik by Gewertz (1983) and Lutkehaus et al (1990); for the Mountain Ok by Barth (1987) and Craig and Hyndman (1990); for the southern fringe "Mountain Papuans" by Weiner (1988); for the Massim's kula by Leach and Leach (1983; cf. also Damon 1990; Damon and Wagner 1989); for Vanuatu by Allen (1981); and tackled in a somewhat postmodern vein for Melanesia generally by Marilyn Strathern (1988). As more regional analyses are constructed, the criteria by which ethnographic areas are configured and then compared become increasingly important and open to scrutiny. What kinds of internal similarity and external differences are sufficient to constitute an area as an "ethnographic region"? How does one preserve the cross-cutting importance of both intersocietal connection and political, ethnic, or linguistic polarity? What criteria, if any, are adequate to designate regional "key features" or "key processes," much less a defined "culture area" for analysis? How is the historical dimension of ethnography to be dealt with - the effect of primary information collected at different intellectual periods and with different goals and biases?
24
Grounding
The present work sheds a distinctive light on these questions by considering the Papuan language-culture areas of the New Guinea south coast. Long known to Oceanists as a "flamboyant" region of Melanesia where headhunting, elaborate cult enactments, and various kinds of ritual sexuality were practiced, this area was, in the first part of the twentieth century, subject to intensive ethnographic documentation. Indeed, as discussed in chapter 2, early anthropological interest in this area combined with late Western intervention to yield a corpus of published ethnography that rivals that of any comparably sized pre-state coastal area. The detail of these accounts enables a comprehensive comparative analysis of the region's constituent language-culture areas. This documentation allows us to push beyond the postmodern lament that ethnography is an inextricable melange of others' metaphors and our own. Nonetheless, the material calls equally for a critical historicist examination. As exemplified in subsequent chapters, analysis of the south coast New Guinea ethnography illuminates issues of central concern to theories of culture and practice as discussed earlier. My purpose in part 2 of this book (chapters 3-6) is to evaluate existing generalizations about south New Guinea and to elucidate general properties and pitfalls of comparative analysis. This exercise entails detailed and critical ethnographic reassessment. My goal is to illuminate the process by which regional analyses are themselves elaborated, refined, and transcended over time. Though I attempt to penetrate the relativity of ethnographic comparison, I remain committed to a documentary view, and I liberally use quotations from primary sources to let the tone and flavor of their observations shine through. In part 3 (chapters 7-10), I construct an alternative regional analysis of the language-culture areas of the New Guinea south coast as they existed in the early colonial era. In so doing, I attempt to maintain a tension between substantive ethnographic analysis and larger theoretical concerns. This book is intended neither as an exhaustive regional analysis of early colonial south coast New Guinea nor as a critique showing the impossibility of comparative analysis. It is rather an ethnographic reconfiguration and counterbalance to existing generalizations about this region, a commentary on the tensions and the value of regional analysis in general, and a plea for more open consideration of the historical nexus within which ethnographic comparisons are located. In theoretical terms, I explore a model of the dialectical relationship between cultural impetus and sociomaterial existence.
Historical background and regional configuration
The Papuan or nonAustronesian language-culture areas of south New Guinea undulate along the coast for over 2,500 km, stretching from the Elema language-culture area in the east to the Asmat regions in the west (see figure 1, after Wurm and Hattori 1981). Most of this extensive coastline is an inaccessible maze of swamps, mangroves, muddy tidal flats, and sand bars, connected by innumerable shifting channels and occasional reefs. Buffeted by strong winds and surf, complex currents and tides, this murky boundary between land and sea was resistant to easy landing and contact by sailing ships, and even shallow-draft steamers of the twentieth century had difficulty navigating the everchanging coastline (e.g., Chalmers 1895; Butcher 1964; see Cook 1955:1:408^11). In many areas, when one finally arrived at coastal villages, they could even then be reached only on foot across an extensive area of mud or swamp.x Apart from difficulty of access, south coast New Guineans had a strong reputation among nineteenth-century Europeans as marauding headhunters and cannibals - as savages who would decapitate and eat visitors at will.2 Headhunting of enemies was in fact practiced along the entire nonAustronesian south coastal area, except by the Elemaspeaking groups, and Europeans in the nineteenth century could easily be victimized by such violence once they left their boats.3 To the logistical impediments and danger of south New Guinea was added a dearth of resources that might be profitable for colonial entrepreneurs (see BNG Annual Reports; McLaren 1923). The alluvial coast gave no prospect of mineral deposits. Coconuts and timber were difficult to obtain in any quantity and were unprofitable, and trade in bird-of-paradise plumes and crocodile skins was arduous and produced
26
Grounding
uncertain returns; contacts were highly sporadic and limited largely to a few Chinese and Malay traders in the western half of the area. The nineteenth-century labor trade was a general failure in the region; in contrast to many other coastal areas of Melanesia, where indentured laborers were recruited extensively to work in Queensland sugar plantations, such recruitment was so difficult as to have been virtually nil along the Papuan south coast.4 Lack of economic potential or profit thus combined with difficulty of shoreline access and a strong reputation of indigenous hostility to keep all but a very few Europeans away from Papuan south New Guinea in the nineteenth century and, in many places, well into the twentieth century. By contrast, most of the world's other coastal areas were intensively contacted by Western powers and their agents in the seventeenth or eighteenth century (Wolf 1982). At maximum distance from Western metropoles, most of the Pacific, including the coasts of Australia, insular Melanesia, and the Massim, was intensively contacted by traders and labor recruiters (or settlers) during the nineteenth century. By the closing decades of the nineteenth century, areas along the northern and eastern New Guinea coast were finally subjected to intensive labor recruitment and attempts at large-scale "pacification" by German armed forces (Hempenstall 1978; S. Firth 1982). The coasts of northwestern New Guinea had long been subject to Indonesian slave trading, which articulated with the eastern periphery of southeast Asian trade in cloth and spices (Galis 1955; Redlich 1876; Held 1957:16). But the Papuan south coast of New Guinea continued to receive surprisingly little political or economic influence until at least the 1890s. Only at the far west of the southern coast, in the Kamoro or Mimika areas, did regular contact with Chinese, Indonesian, or Dutch traders precede this period (Miklouho-Maclay 1874; Pouwer 1991:206). As a region, the nonAustronesian south coast of New Guinea appears to have remained effectively outside the purview of state political economies for longer than any other major non-arctic coastal population. Early history of the Papuan Gulf and Fly River areas west to the international border
In the 1880s and 1890s, the Reverend James Chalmers of the London Mission Society became the first European to establish regular contact in the eastern south coast areas, traveling laboriously westward among Elema, Purari, Kiwai, and eastern Trans-Fly peoples (Chalmers 1895, 1903a,b; see Langmore 1974, 1978).5 Other explorers had charted the
Historical background
27
coasts and ascended the rivers, including D'Albertis, who journeyed far up the Fly River in 1876, but none of these expeditions involved much social contact with indigenous populations. 6 The killing of the pacifist Chalmers, along with his companion the Reverend Oliver Tomkins and their party of eleven at Goaribari Island in 1901, capped the lay perception of the south coast as a region where contact with indigenes was highly dangerous and best avoided (Langmore 1972,1974:ch.5). In 1884, the eastern part of the south coast became part of the British New Guinea Protectorate; in 1888 it was annexed by England along with the rest of British New Guinea, which stretched west to the 141st meridian. The Fly River and Gulf regions of this territory were several days sailing from the administrative center in Port Moresby, the harbor of which was itself not discovered until 1873 (Moresby 1876a). The south coast was distant as well from gold prospectors, who constituted the greatest, if transient, commercial influx into Papua further to the east (Nelson 1976). After annexation, the de facto exclusion of traders, planters, and labor recruits from south Papua was reinforced in a series of ordinances by Lieutenant-Governors MacGregor and, later, Murray. Reacting against the unprofitable and violent entanglements of British colonial government with the labor trade in eastern Melanesia, MacGregor and especially Murray prevented long-distance labor recruitment, outlawed trade in guns and liquor, and severely restricted land alienation (Griffin etal 1979:chs.2-3; Parnaby 1964:ch.6; West 1968; Murray 1912). Though bitterly resented by commercial interests, these dicta were supported by cost-conscious British and Australian colonial governments as well as by the London Mission Society, the region's primary source of Western religious influence. There was insufficient promise of profitable commerce or exploitation for entrepreneurs to contravene these policies systematically or on a large scale, especially westward along the south coast. Official restrictions thus combined with lack of exploitable resources and difficulty of access to make the Gulf of Papua and the Fly River areas the coastal backwater of what was itself one of the world's most economically undeveloped colonial territories. Between about 1890 and 1920, government control was gradually established through sporadic and quite laborious patrols (Hope 1979; Beaver 1920; Lett 1935:pt. II., ch.4). In the populous Elema area, closest to the government center in Port Moresby, a Gulf Division headquarters was established at Kerema in 1906, and a Delta Division headquarters was established further west at Kikori in the eastern Kiwai
28
Grounding
language area in 1913 (Mair 1970:30; Hope 1979:43ff.). Mission stations had by this time also been established in both areas. By 1920, the main conduits of outside influence remained visits by a very few government officers, widely dispersed missionaries, and a few transient and unsuccessful traders and would-be planters (ibid.; Langmore 1989; McLaren 1923). Plantation work was most developed, at least in relative terms, among Elema, where dried coconut - or copra - was produced. In 1918, the area was targeted for various development schemes, including rice plantations. Local men were required to work but fervently resisted, and about 200 a year were temporarily jailed (Williams 1923a: 10, 42f.; Mair 1970:121f.). About the same time, a cargo cult called the Valaila Madness broke out and was gradually suppressed (Williams 1923a; Worsley 1968:ch.4; Cochrane 1970:ch.4). By 1923, there were 476 acres of Elema land under rice cultivation. Nevertheless, "as with the compulsory coconut planting, rice cultivation had little impact on the economy of the Gulf Division because there were no marketing arrangements" (Cochrane 1970:40). All rice-growing in the area was subsequently abandoned (Mair 1970:122). Outside influence spread slowly westward. Between 1912 and 1930 there were but three commercial ventures in the Delta Division, which encompassed the Purari and eastern Kiwai language areas: a copra and rubber plantation which was founded near Kikori in 1914 (and struggled until being liquidated and auctioned in 1929); a saw mill and trade store in the Purari, begun in 1922; and a short-lived palm-spirit enterprise from 1920 to 1923 (Hope 1979:vii; Maher 1961:41ff.). For much of the eastern south coast, nevertheless, a temporary period of "sign on" labor at a plantation, distant town, or boat became gradually more common for young men during the 1910s to 1930s. The western Kiwai area was contacted by Chalmers, who established a mission base on Kiwai Island in 1896. In the 1880s there had been hope that some of the pearlshelling and beche-de-mer waters of the northern Torres Strait might be included as an area of economic development in British New Guinea, but the area remained under the control of Queensland. A permanent government post was set up among the western Kiwai at Daru in 1893, but the area languished economically (Beaver 1920). There was even less development in the Trans-Fly area, which was for many decades patrolled from Daru. No Europeans lived there when Williams wrote the preface to his monograph on the region in 1935
Historical background
29
(1936:vi). A government station, a mission post, and a school were finally set up at Rouku near the Morehead River in 1951 (Ayres 1983:14). The history of the Trans-Fly and Kiwai language areas from 1900 to 1950 is sketchy at best, but published accounts suggest there was very little in the way of economic development. Until at least World War Two, the main Western influence was the suppression of headhunting, a trickling influx of Western goods, Christianization that was superficial outside of a very few established mission stations, and sporadic and largely unsuccessful attempts by a few outsiders to establish trading or commercial projects (e.g., McLaren 1923:ch.7). Though outside commercial ventures were minimal, Kiwai did adopt Torres Straits sailing techniques to extend their lively indigenous trade yet further, and Western goods, when available, were considered purchase items of major value (Beaver 1920:77, 163-165; Landtman 1927:211-217). A similar pattern occurred much further east among the Elema, who borrowed Motu sailing techniques to extend their indigenous trading networks during the colonial era (Williams 1977c). In 1925, the entire colony of Papua, with an indigenous population of perhaps one million scattered over 90,000 square miles, was administered by thirty-six field officers (Schieffelin and Crittenden 1991:21, 41). Within this territory, the south coast areas in question were the most remote, expansive, and understaffed; they had a combined officer staff of a half dozen or so. Langmore's (1989:283ff.) London Mission Society register for New Guinea from 1874 to 1914 lists but nine resident missionaries stationed along this section of the south coast, and several of these succeeded each other rather than working contemporaneously. Though young Papuan men might sign on for a period of work at one of the few plantations, contact with outsiders was sparse and sporadic in many areas well into the twentieth century. It was politicoeconomic disinterest that stimulated burgeoning ethnographic attention to south New Guinea from 1910 to the late 1930s. This followed on the keen interest of zoologist-turned-ethnologist A. C. Haddon (Urry 1982). Haddon visited parts of south New Guinea briefly in 1888 and organized the large Cambridge Anthropological Expedition to the Torres Straits a decade later.7 As one of the first anthropologists with a regular academic position, Haddon recognized the unique persistence of precolonial customs in southern New Guinea and promoted their ethnographic study (e.g., Haddon 1897). This promotion is reflected in his mentorship of Landtman's research among the Kiwai
30
Grounding
from 1910 to 1912 and in his fostering of, and writing introductions for, other important monographs concerning the region. 8 Haddon (1927:ix) begins his introduction to Landtman's Kiwai monograph by stating: Many years ago my friend, Dr. Gunnar Landtman, came to see me at Cambridge, and as soon as we had greeted one another, he said, "I will go anywhere in the world you like to send me" . . . It did not take much consideration on my part to make a suggestion [to study the Kiwai]. Jenness wrote in 1920, Every student who goes out from England to work amongst the [New Guinea] natives turns naturally to Professor A. C. Haddon, and I, like many others, am indebted to him for much counsel and assistance. (Jenness and Ballantyne 1920:12f.) During the 1920s and 1930s, government contact, trading, and coconut plantations inched forward in influence along the south coast. At the same time, Papua's intrepid government anthropologist, F. E. Williams, completed his monumental studies of the Purari delta peoples (1924), the Trans-Fly region (1936), and the Elema (1940) (see Schwimmer 1977; Griffiths 1977). Combined with the weighty monographs of Landtman (1917, 1927; cf. 1933), compendium work by Wirz (1934b), and books by missionaries such as Riley (1925), Holmes (1924), and Chalmers (1895, cf. 1903a,b), these volumes provide an extraordinarily rich corpus of information concerning the eastern south coast languageculture areas during the early stages of colonial contact. Most of these accounts are written following Haddon's "Notes and Queries" style of ethnography, in which synoptic coverage of diverse topics is attempted (see Urry 1972; Haddon 1905).9 Within his perspective, "traits" and "customs" were isolable units rather than interactive parts of a developing social system. In relative topical emphasis, most extensive treatment was given to ritual, ceremony, and related dimensions of myth and totemism. The preeminent south New Guinea monographs based on fieldwork in the first half of the century - those of Landtman (1927), Williams (1924, 1936, 1940), and van Baal (1966) collectively devote more than half of their prodigious bulk to matters of spiritual belief and cult activity. These emphases followed the early interests of Frazer, Durkheim, and others such as F. E. Williams' teacher at Oxford, R. R. Marett, who was particularly interested in the evolution of magico-religious beliefs.
Historical background
31
In its south New Guinea version, this early twentieth-century ethnography described discrete ethnographic features, which were then largely left to the armchair ethnologist at the university to put together in a wider comparative mosaic. The goal of this comparison was to chart the evolution of cultural forms by reconstructing patterns of trait diffusion and migration across ethnographic regions. Haddon devoted much time and effort to the tracing of hypothetical cult diffusion and racial migration patterns in south New Guinea (e.g., Haddon 1920b, 1924, 1927, 1936; see 1911). The corollary of this sometimes dubious diffusionary reconstruction was that the ethnographer as fact-collector had both the freedom and the illusion of freedom from comparative and theoretical concerns. The accounts of Williams and Landtman thus emerge as description for its own sake. In Williams' case, his later work wrestles with Malinowskian functionalism (he attended Malinowski's London School of Economics seminar during a research stay in 1933-1934 [see Williams 1936:viii-ix; 1977a]). Williams eschews more than a tenuous integration among sociocultural features, however, and he takes frequent dry delight in citing disparate social and cultural facts that resist a larger coherence. As he states with typical self-effacement in the preface to his Trans-Fly monograph, The old-fashioned monograph, then, which aims at an all-round description of any given people or culture, is something like a long and perhaps ill-assorted menu from which the anthropological diner is invited to take what tempts him. It is open to question whether this is the best method of dishing up one's results . . . But, for good or ill . . . [this] method has been adopted here. (Williams 1936:x) Williams' remarks effectively describe the classic south coast monographs from nonAustronesian Papua. Early history of the west New Guinea south coast The western half of the New Guinea south coast was formally claimed as part of Dutch New Guinea in 1828. By then the region had already been known by Europeans for several centuries, including an early landing by Carstenz in 1623. His reception, however, had not been friendly: The natives attacked without warning, tore one man to pieces, killed eight others with arrows and spears, and wounded the remaining seven. More than one water party met this kind of reception. (Souter 1963:7)
32
Grounding
Little contact was made with indigenous populations of the region in subsequent centuries, and even the perspicacious Captain Cook was unable to make friendly contact, being forced to withdraw by an attacking party when he attempted to establish relations along the Casuarina coast in 1770 (Cook 1955:1:408-411). Not until the twentieth century was significant contact made with the bulk of the population along the south coast of Dutch New Guinea, as there was little to gain and much to lose by interaction. From a colonial standpoint, the Dutch had acquired west New Guinea as an impenetrable buffer against foreign access to their lucrative spice trade further west; they showed very little interest in lowland New Guinea as long as no other foreign powers did either (Bone 1964). This lack of influence contrasts with the extensive slave-raiding and trade in firearms that affected regions of the Vogelkop or "Birds Head" peninsula of Dutch New Guinea further northwest (Galis 1955). Conjoined with political and economic networks of southeast Asia, this commerce had been going on for centuries via Chinese, Indonesian, and Dutch traders; by the mid-1800s, Ceramese Islamic traders had appointed nominal local representatives or "rajahs," who used their access to firearms to lead followers in slave-raiding incursions against neighboring and inland groups (Miklouho-Maclay 1874; Strachan 1888:chs. 11-15; Miedema 1984, 1988a,b). In the early twentieth century, "rajahs" were also appointed in the far west of the nonAustronesian south coast, particularly in the westernmost part of the Kamoro area, where swampy sago areas were relatively scarce (Pouwer 1991:206f.). This political connection to outside areas prompted trade of slaves, local foods, and resin for outside ironware, textiles, earrings, and beads (ibid.). Developments such as these were absent among the quagmired coastal areas of the populous central Asmat and further east along the south coast, which even the intrepid Malay traders frequently shunned as too logistically difficult, violent, and unprofitable. The bulk of the southwest coast population had but sporadic contact with and little influence from outsiders at the close of the nineteenth century. Like the British and Australians in Papua, the Dutch wanted to keep their administration expenses to a bare minimum in their unproductive New Guinea territory. Wanting to hold title to the area without actually governing it, the Dutch left west New Guinea under the indirect and practically fictitious rule of the Sultan of Tidore until virtually the
Historical background
33
mid-1900s (Bone 1964; see van Baal et al. 1984:56; Souter 1963:ch.lO). The first Dutch presence along their portion of the lowland south coast was provoked by British protests in the 1890s that the unpacified Marind-anim were being allowed to conduct long-distance headhunting raids across the international border into British New Guinea. The Dutch finally responded in 1902 by setting up an armed post among the Marind-anim at Merauke (South Pacific Commission 1952-1953:102104; Pratt 1906:ch.2; cf. Haddon 1891). Renowned for their headhunting and flamboyant sexual customs, the Marind-anim were gradually pacified and missionized by the Dutch during the next three decades (South Pacific Commission 19521953:102-122; see Vogel and Richens 1989). Their precolonial way of life has been painstakingly and exhaustively reconstructed by van Baal (1966) on the basis of Wirz's (1922-1925, 1928) early monographs and van Baal's voluminous correspondence with Father Jan Verschueren, who was fluent in the language, sensitive to Marind belief and custom, and lived many years in the area. Van Baal's 988 page monograph on the Marind-anim, Dema, holds a special interest for ethnographic history. Van Baal was himself the administrator of the Merauke district, starting in 1936, and was later the Dutch Governor of West New Guinea as a whole. Having written an anthropological dissertation on the Marind from secondary sources at Leiden in 1934, van Baal later resumed his efforts to more thoroughly reconstruct the precolonial features of Marind culture - features that he, in his administrative capacity, had been charged with controlling and curtailing. Few have sustained the contradiction between deep anthropological study and the strong exertion of colonial influence as has van Baal,10 who became a professor of cultural anthropology at Utrecht and has published many significant books in this capacity (e.g., 1975, 1981, 1982,1985 [with van Beek], 1986,1989; see Ploeg 1987,1991). Second and relatedly, van Baal reconstructed Marind culture through an intricate and very dense evaluative sifting of information supplied by other observers - observers who had little or no anthropological training. This information is both multitudinous and of highly uneven quality. By contrast, van Baal was academically trained as an anthropologist but was unable to conduct much systematic fieldwork, especially in the important coastal regions, during his posting among the Marind (van Baal 1966:9). His ethnography is hence a rich and sometimes frustrating melange of competing points of view through which ethnographic facts are slowly and often incompletely reconstructed. The
34
Grounding
ethnographic information that is corroborated, however, is wonderfully elaborate as well as exhaustively examined. In format, van Baal's monograph follows those of Landtman (1927) and Williams (1940) in providing a topical ethnographic overview while devoting the vast bulk of the work to issues of cult life, ceremony, and mythical and spiritual belief (see also Wirz 1922-1925,1928).n Outside the Merauke district, foreign social contact along the lowland south coast of Dutch New Guinea was extremely spotty until the mid twentieth century. Until 1925, official contact was limited to a few exploratory and mountaineering expeditions passing to the interior and a few missionaries attempting with much difficulty to establish a foothold.12 The biggest influence was likely Malaysian, Chinese, and a few intrepid European traders seeking crocodile skins and especially bird-of-paradise plumes. From 1905 to the early 1920s, thousands of bird-of-paradise skins were obtained from New Guinea for sale in Europe, and some of these were taken from the southwest lowlands. Whereas the Australians outlawed this trade from an early period, the Dutch did not prohibit it in west New Guinea until the mid 1920s. Hunting had all but ceased by 1928 (Kirsch 1991:35). A government post was established in 1925 among the Mimika in the northern Kamoro-Asmat region and another in the late 1930s at Kolopom Island, known at the time as Frederik-Hendrik Island (Trenkenschuh 1982a:25; Serpenti 1977:9 [1965]). In the Kolopom region, the extreme difficulty of penetrating extensive swampland retarded the first official visits even to the largest villages until the late 1920s and 1930s. Serpenti (1977:9), the region's principal ethnographer, states that Europeans regard the region "as one of the least attractive and accessible districts of New Guinea," and he notes, in the ethnographic present of 1960, that many villages had remained for protracted periods outside effective government control "until quite recently." His monograph describes the remarkable gardening and ecological regime of the Kolopom, and, in the Dutch tradition of descriptive ethnography, he provides informative synopses of social life in tightly organized topical segments, examining, for example, stages of the life cycle, feasting, and the several Kolopom levels of residential organization and social structure. In the populous central Asmat area further west, a government post was first opened in 1938 and abandoned during the Japanese occupation in World War Two. It was re-established only with the founding of a mission post by Father Gerard Zegwaard in 1953 (Zegwaard 1982;
Historical background
35
Trenkenschuh 1982a; Sowada 1961:ch.2). At the time, the Asmat were still unpacified, and they remained so to a significant extent for another decade, as reflected in the death of Michael Rockefeller among them in 1961 (Machlin 1972; cf. Rockefeller and Gerbrands 1967; see Dongen 1982). Ethnographic information on the Asmat was collected at an early period of contact by Zegwaard himself13 and is supplemented by doctoral theses completed by Eyde (1967) and van Arsdale (1975; see also van Arsdale 1978) and eight informative volumes of An Asmat Sketch Book published by the Crosier Missions between 1972 and 1984. Important works on Asmat art are also available, sometimes combined with discussions of spiritual belief and cosmology.14 Schneebaum (1988) has also authored an intriguing and highly personal account of his experiences among the Asmat, and Sowada (1961) has written an English compilation of material from early Dutch sources. For present purposes, the Asmat information is more problematic than that from the other south coast language-culture areas. None of it has been published as a standard ethnographic monograph, and virtually all of it is unindexed. The theses of Eyde and van Arsdale concentrate on materialist concerns of ecology and labor activity respectively, and Eyde's work in particular has valuable information on social organization and warfare. On many other issues, it is hard to know how much can be generalized from passing commentaries. The same is true of the intriguing collage of accounts published in the Asmat Sketch Books for a primarily nonanthropological audience. Happily, this series contains English translations of important Dutch ethnographic manuscripts by Zegwaard (1978, 1982; Zegwaard and Boelaars 1982). The Kamoro or Mimika of the northern Asmat language family have been studied by Pouwer (1955, 1956, 1975, 1991; see further references in van Baal et al. 1984:124-127). South coast ethnography past and present
The difficulties of the Asmat ethnography notwithstanding, the range and quality of information concerning the various language-culture areas of coastal south New Guinea are impressive - and only the major sources have been cited here. Indeed, it is arguable that just as the region was perhaps the last major section of tropical or temperate coast to be regularly influenced by Europeans or other agents of state societies, so its "tribal ethnography" is perhaps the richest of any comparably sized coastal area. Most of the region's constituent language-culture areas were subject to intensive ethnographic study
36
Grounding
within a decade or two of regular contact and pacification by Europeans. Just as strikingly, however, the richness of this primary ethnography declines markedly after the early colonial period. Very little has been published about the colonial and post-colonial development of south coast New Guinea. The principal exceptions pertain to developments among Asmat and Purari. The former were reported with great commitment by the Crosier Missions, while Robert Maher (1961, 1967, 1984), in pioneering work on social change, reported on developments among the Purari between the 1950s and the 1970s (cf. for the Elema, Morauta and Ryan 1982). A further exception, but one that rather confirms the rule, is Williams' much-cited study and later reflections on the "Valaila madness" cargo cult in the elema district (Williams 1923a, 1934; see also 1935a,b). These writings remain disconnected from Williams' monumental work on "traditional" ceremonies among the Elema and the neighboring Purari (Williams 1923b, 1924, 1939a-c, 1940; cf. Cochrane 1970:chs.2-4).15 For one part of the Trans-Fly area, an exceptional account of local developments from an indigenous perspective has been published in article format by the Papua New Guinea researcher Billai Laba (1975a,b). Further ethnographic data have been presented more recently from the Trans-Fly area by Ayres in an unpublished thesis (1983) and in a confined ecological study by Ohtsuka (1977a,b, 1983). Selected studies for the Elema also exist.16 But trends of contemporary development along the south coast remain largely unpublished by anthropologists. For the Indonesian half of the region (what was formerly Dutch New Guinea), research on this topic is now largely prevented by governmental regulation (see Gietzelt 1988). The contemporary situation in Merauke and among the Asmat has been described on the basis of surreptitious travels by the journalist George Monbiot (1989:chs.3-4, 8-9; see also Hughes-Freeland 1989 and Dutch and Indonesian references in van Baal et al. 1984:ch.9). For the extensive Trans-Fly, Kiwai, Purari, and Elema areas in Papua New Guinea, however, this lack of public documentation is due to disinterest or disinclination among anthropological fieldworkers themselves. With the exception of Maher's 1961 work, no monographs have been published on any of these south coast New Guinea culture areas taking developments during the colonial or post-colonial periods directly into account. 17 This neglect contrasts
Historical background
37
with the richness of earlier ethnographic attention, and it greatly deserves to be remedied. South coast New Guinea as an ethnographic region
How should south New Guinea be configured for regional analysis? Arguably, the definition of a region and its constituent areas is inextricable from the ethnographic and theoretical goals of analysis. As French Annales historian Marc Bloch suggested in 1913 (1971:122), the very notion of a bounded region for analysis depends on the theoretical problems one is concerned with. It could be suggested that coastal south New Guinea has important geographic as well as cultural features that, as will be discussed in chapter 10, have shaped its comparative history in the longue duree (see Braudel 1973; 1980a). These are particularly the relative ease of water transport through coastal inlets, swamps, and deltas: the same features that were impervious to larger Western sailing craft were ubiquitous roads for the large and small canoes so deftly paddled by Papuans. In many coastal areas, abundant stands of wild sago palms - rich in starch but low in protein (Ruddle et al. 1978) - were complemented by maritime or riverine faunal resources. In the context of water travel and transport, this resource base provided the potential for large-scale political affiliations or residential aggregations despite a relatively low population density in the coastal region as a whole. A great diversity of sociopolitical formations developed alongside the elaborate ritual and cult systems that made the region ethnographically famous. Linguistically, the south coast region (see map on page xiv) is comprised of Papuan or nonAustronesian language families that contrast with Austronesian languages found immediately to the east and further to the west. Early observers quickly noted the contrast between "Papuans" and "Melanesians" - the former extending from the eastern boundary of the Elema language family westward across the south lowlands (Seligmann 1910:1-6; Haddon 1920b). Geography varies between these areas as well, with inland ranges and hilly or mountainous ecozones coming much closer to the sea in Austronesian than in nonAustronesian areas of the south coast. Coastal versus inland language-culture areas are arguably differentiated on the basis of saltwater as opposed to freshwater ecozones, but here the boundaries of the coastal region are more tenuous. Coastal peoples do seem to have exploited a greater range of maritime fauna than their inland counterparts, and they tended to sustain larger
38
Grounding
settlements and larger population densities as well. Political and ethnic asymmetries paralleled these differences, with coastal populations raiding "bush" ethnic groups along significant portions of the south coast (e.g., Beaver 1920; Landtman 1927; van Baal 1966:ch.l2). Though more ephemeral to grasp, coastal areas also appear to have sustained a greater internal coherence and integrity of their cultural beliefs and organizations than most of the smaller and shifting groups of the interior, such as the Muyu or Yonggom and the Kamula (Schoorl 1957, 1988, 1991; Kirsch 1991; Wood 1982, 1987). But the coast-versus-bush distinction is in many places a gradient rather than a boundary, which begs the question of the similarity between coastal populations and those of adjacent Jaquai, Gogodala, and Boazi peoples, among others. Of equal importance are the practical realities of ethnography: there are few substantial accounts published concerning peoples on the inland side of the coastal language families. Exceptions could be suggested, particularly for the Jaquai and Gogodala,18 and on the Papua New Guinea side of the border there is hope for future monographs on regions abutting coastal language families.19 In published accounts, however, the ethnographic picture of the large region immediately beyond the coastal language families remains sketchy. By contrast, the coastal culture areas are "of a piece" in being both well documented in published accounts and described for the most part in a similar "classic" ethnographic format at roughly similar stages in the early colonial history of each area. This circumstance lends itself well to comparison of a number of features across the range of coastal language-culture areas. It is thus for ethnographic as well as geocultural reasons that the New Guinea south coast is configured for our present purposes as infigure1. Just as there are no totally natural boundaries for south coast New Guinea, so, too, the decision to adopt an expansive east-west configuration as opposed to a narrower but more "vertical" one stretching further inland is to some extent based on analytic choice. Admittedly, the present configuration is undertaken in part as an exercise to recontextualize the existing perception of south New Guinea as an area. But as discussed in chapter 3, ritual homosexuality was not practiced by most south New Guinea lowlanders even when interior lowlands groups are considered. Ritual homosexuality was present along the central south New Guinea coast and extended inland from the Kolopom, Marind, and Trans-Fly peoples north to the Strickland-Bosavi area. 20 Features of comparative method as well as ethnographic content are
Historical background
39
brought to light by comparing a wide geographic area along an east-west coastal axis to one that extends from a narrow coastal section inland to the northeast. The difference between these two overlapping regions is itself sometimes unclear in existing accounts, with features of one region generalized to implicitly characterize the south lowlands as a whole. It is in part for this reason that the boundaries of the present analysis are clearly demarcated. Language family and culture areas The culture areas shown in figure 1 correspond, except for the four language families that compose the Trans-Fly area, to the Papuan language family boundaries delineated for New Guinea by Wurm and Hattori (1981). These regions also conform in rough measure to the existing "monographic" division of the south coast region - that is, the division of the region into populations subject to separate and rigorous scholarly monographs by Williams for the Elema (1940), the Trans-Fly area (1936), and the Purari or "Namau",21 by Landtman (1971, 1927) for the Kiwai; by van Baal (1966) following Wirz, Verschueren, and others for the Marind-anim; by Serpenti (1977 [1965]) for the Kolopom; and by Zegwaard (1959, 1978[1953]), Zegwaard and Boelaars (1982[1954]), and Eyde (1967) for the Asmat. Although dividing the south coast region into these component areas has a linguistic and cultural as well as scholarly "reality," we must not lose sight of the legitimizing impact of discrete culture and associated ethnographer designations. Thus, for instance, the "Kiwai" region of the early colonial era is often considered to be archetypally described by Landtman (1917, 1927, 1954). Yet Landtman's fieldwork was conducted in the western sector of the Kiwai language family and his account deals almost not at all with the many groups in the eastern half of this large area (see Wirz 1934b; Beaver 1920:chs. 17-20). Similarly, with the partial exception of the Kamoro (Pouwer 1955), the large Asmat language family encompasses many variants outside of its central area that are not well documented (see discussion in Eyde 1967). The present consideration of "Asmat" thus focuses on the main central Asmat population. Also for convenience, the Trans-Fly area is here considered as a single unit, though it in fact comprises four small language families that are not well known enough to consider separately for present purposes.22 Chain-link permutations of symbolic and political practice cross-cut south coast language-cultural areas and provided a basis for interaction
40
Grounding
across linguistic and cultural boundaries - as reflected in trading linkages and cult diffusions. It is thus somewhat artificial to use bounded language-culture areas as discrete units in comparative analysis. Further, the key locales where intensive ethnographic fieldwork was done almost invariably become the center points for positing contrasting cultural units; cultural homogeneity is easily assumed to expand outward from an ethnographic site until an adjacent area of intensive ethnographic study is reached. Conversely, however, establishing fieldwork/culture/language areas remains a convenient if not mandatory point of departure in comparative analysis: one has to extrapolate from whatever good data points one has. Being explicit about the limitations of these data points and their geographic, historical, and ethnographic context is preferable to the common tendency to make regional comparisons that are vague about the units being characterized and compared. In its time frame, the present work follows prominent recent analyses of south New Guinea as well as the bulk of currently available information, and focuses on practices and beliefs that were indigenous, that is, those prevalent during the late precolonial and early colonial era. In the late precolonial and early colonial era, the principal Papuan language families of coastal south New Guinea exhibited significant cultural similarities. These can be summarized as including: (i) fervent mythic-cosmological beliefs in the need for fertility regeneration, and (ii) the close articulation of fertility beliefs with: (a) highly elaborate ritual enactments employing costumed or artistic embodiments of mythic or ancestral beings (b) elaborate heterosexual and sometimes homosexual fertility and rejuvenation rites23 (c) feast-giving (d) warfare, particularly in the form of headhunting, to both reflect and augment the spiritual and social force of the local group Variations on these themes generated crucial cultural divergences along the New Guinea south coast; distinctive local axioms of social and spiritual rejuvenation articulated subsistence, political economy, gender, and warfare as well as myth and ritual in unique areal configurations. The larger pattern was one of regional themes cross-cut by areal
Historical background
41
gradients of cultural and sociopolitical permutation (Knauft 1985b, 1989a). How one might conduct a structuralist or "transformational" cultural analysis on a regional comparative scale has baffled many anthropologists and no satisfactory plan of attack has yet presented itself. Though Sahlins (1981, 1985) and others have stressed the interface of cultural structure and history, how this interface may be combined with systematic comparison among adjacent language-culture areas remains unclear. The lead of Levi-Strauss (1964-71) himself is largely unsuccessful in this regard, devolving as it does into a comparative panoply in which New World myths are all transformations of each other in a dizzying and irrefutable pattern. How to compare differing areal configurations of cultural structure and sociopolitical practice thus remains an important question requiring further theoretical development. The second part of the present work uses criticism to clear an ethnographic path for such a study; the third part initiates it.
PART 2 CRITIQUE
Sexuality in the regional analysis of south New Guinea
Appadurai (1986, 1988) has suggested that pairing conceptual labels with ethnographic places easily compromises our understanding of local cultural variability. A few focal traits and their presumed correlates are often taken as metonyms to represent an entire ethnographic region, thereby reducing appreciation of its cultural richness and complexity. As these designators become routinized, they are easily taken for granted and used to generate or justify other idealized features attributed to the region. Concerning south New Guinea, strong emphasis has recently been placed on the indigenous practice of ritualized homosexuality or boy-insemination (Herdt 1984a, 1992; Lindenbaum 1984; Feil 1987:ch.7). As will be discussed in chapter 4, these authors have also used male homosexuality as the conceptual centerpiece for analyzing a wide range of other presumed practices in south New Guinea, including a supposed dearth of competitive exchange, decentralized leadership, restricted marital reciprocity, and low (or high) female status. Herdt's (ed. 1984) initial emphasis on south New Guinea ritual homosexuality was more than justified by the fact that homosexuality in Melanesia had been neglected for many years as a topic of comparative or theoretical study. Quickly, however, other writers have taken homosexuality as a point of orientation for south New Guinea as a whole. Lindenbaum (1984:342) posits societies of the highlands and south lowlands of New Guinea as ideal types and suggests, "The broadest contrasts among Melanesian cultures emerge, then, from a comparison between the so-called semen groups of the Lowlands and the Highland cultures in which semen is not the ritualized stuff of life." More recently, she has extended this dichotomy and elaborates "a
46
Critique
contrast between semen-focused societies in which male homosexual behavior occurs during initiation rites and 'heterosexual' societies in the central and western highlands that lack semen exchange" (Lindenbaum 1987:222). Analogously, Schiefenhovel (1990:415) categorizes as "sperm cultures" those Melanesian societies in which ritual homosexuality was practiced. Whitehead (1986:87) generalizes that "among the south coastal people . . . an individual inseminator is selected for each boy, a married man or older bachelor with whom the boy has regular contact. In addition the boy must at times participate in collective insemination activities in which he receives semen from a number of his elders." These widespread characterizations are ensconced further in Daryl Feil's analysis of lowland south New Guinea gender and political economy through the lens of what he repeatedly terms "homosexual societies" (1987:ch.7). Lindenbaum (1987) has also argued for conceptualizing "homosexual societies" for south New Guinea, and Herdt (1991:606) has recently stated, a seemingly absurd representation - that the whole of a culture is homosexual finds credence in generalizations, both old and new, to the "homosexual societies" of New Guinea. Are these purely rhetorical representations? I think not.
As Herdt (1992) himself implies in other contexts, however, we may question the advisability of characterizing entire societies by a few selected precolonial sexual customs. Doing so inappropriately gives sexuality preeminence over other dimensions of society and culture, and, as I will show, singles out some types of sexual practice rather than others. Ritualized homosexuality as an areal designator?
In his edited volume Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia, Herdt (1984a) placed strong conceptual as well as titular emphasis on ritual dimensions of homosexual practice. Melanesian homosexuality was considered a cosmological as well as an erotic orientation, mandated by life-force beliefs that insemination was necessary in order for boys to become men. Homosexual practices were regularized in ritual practice, especially as a precursor to male initiation in the context of a male warrior cult, and became a practically universal part of the male life cycle in a significant percentage of Melanesian societies, especially those of south New Guinea (see Herdt 1984a, 1987a:ch.7,1987b, 1991:pt.2). Herdt's concept of Melanesian homosexuality as ritualized was
Sexuality in the regional analysis
47
important on at least two counts. First, it highlighted the type of information the contributors to his edited volume - mostly mid-career or elder anthropologists, largely trained in the methods of status-androle ethnography - had to offer (see Knauft 1987b:157f.; cf. 1987a). Second, by emphasizing the actual transmission of semen in rituallyordained sexual orgasm, Herdt guarded the ethnographic study of homosexuality from the accusation levelled at Dundes (1976, 1978) and others of conflating latent but unexpressed homosexual desires with actual sexual behavior. In his preface to the second edition of Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia (1992), Herdt reformulates his terminology and questions the concept of "homosexuality" in general. For indigenous Melanesian homosexual customs, he suggests "boy-insemination" might be a more effective descriptor than "ritualized homosexuality." This altered language softens or blurs the distinction between Melanesian practices and less cosmologically enjoined boy-insemination in many other areas of the world, such as ancient Greece (Dover 1989; Halperin 1990; see, similarly, Adam 1986). However, the homosexuality described in Herdt's edited volume was indeed distinctive for its cosmological and ritual prominence. Along the south coast, as considered in the present book, homosexual practices that fall under the rubric of boyinsemination also qualify as ritualized homosexuality. Hence, I retain the concept in its original form. Though the nature and quality of ethnographic data may always be debated, available information makes it highly questionable that ritualized homosexuality (or boy-insemination) was in fact prevalent across lowland south New Guinea. The custom was by all accounts entirely absent among the Purari and the Elema (Williams 1924, 1940:428). To the west, ritual homosexuality was also undocumented and doubtful in the populous central Asmat area; it was absent further west among the Kamoro and present in a distinctive or "partial" form southeast along the Casuarina coast. Since information concerning Asmat homosexuality is not widely known, a compilation and analysis of it is included as an Appendix to this book. For the Kiwai language family, there is strong evidence that ritualized homosexuality was absent or limited to a few far-western Kiwai settlements, where it may have been adopted as a transient practice from adjacent Trans-Fly peoples (Beardmore 1890:464). As discussed elsewhere in detail (Knauft 1990a), perceptions to the contrary reveal an intriguing legacy of historical and ethnographic misattribution of
48
Critique
Trans-Fly sexual customs to Kiwai peoples. The absence of ritual homosexuality among Purari and Elema as well as Kiwai language families disconfirms Herdt's (1987b:448) suggestion that uin the Papuan Gulf region of New Guinea, it [ritualized homosexuality] was universal."1 In all, ritualized homosexuality was present along the south coast among Casuarina Asmat, Kolopom, Marind, and many of the Trans-Fly peoples; it was absent among the Kamoro, Kiwai, Purari, and Elema. The populous central Asmat should probably also be included in the latter group as a negative case, but since the data are circumstantial, it is conservatively considered as "unknown" for comparative purposes (see Appendix). The relative size of populations that did or did not adhere to ritualized homosexual customs can be estimated by using the population figures compiled by Wurm and Hattori (1981). Though necessarily imperfect, their tabulations are culled from a large array of survey sources, systematically cover all the language groups in New Guinea, and are blind to the question of the presence or absence of homosexual practices. If we use their tabulations, the south coast language-culture areas where ritualized homosexuality was present had a combined population in the order of 27,509. By contrast, the population of the Elema, Purari, Kiwai, and Kamoro tabulates as 73,175. These figures suggest that under thirty percent of the south coast population were members of societies that indigenously practiced ritualized male homosexuality. The discrepancy would be greater if the central Asmat were included as a negative case. Given that demographic changes have certainly occurred in the colonial and postcolonial period, one cannot assume that these figures give more than a rough estimate of precolonial populations. Whatever changes and reporting inaccuracies these data may reflect, however, there is every reason to expect that they occur similarly in the estimates for both groups of societies, that is, those among which ritualized homosexuality was and was not practiced. This being the case, it appears quite reasonable to assess the relative size of these two populations on the basis of Wurm and Hattori's data. It may be objected that many inland societies where ritualized homosexuality was practiced are not included in the present coastal survey. Nevertheless, comparative estimates of the entire south lowland population practicing and not practicing ritualized male homosexuality do not significantly alter the conclusion (see table 1).
Sexuality in the regional analysis Table l a . South lowland New Guinea language families and presence!absence of indigenous ritualized homosexuality (RH) Family/languages
RH
Asmat-Kamoro Asienara Casuarina Coast Asmat 8,559 Central Asmat Citak Asmat Iria Kamoro
non-RH
22,457 4,784 8,400
900
700
Schneebaum 1988 (see Appendix) Pouwerl955; Herdt 1984a: 30
1,000 29,500
Lowland Ok Yonggom Ningerum Iwur South Kati North Kati Awin-pa Awin (Aekyom)
Kirsch p.c. Welsch p.c.
2,200 4,000 (l,100)b 4,500 8,500 6,500
Pa
Kaluli Kasua Kware Onabasulu Tomu River East Strickland Agala Konai Nomad Gebusi Samoe Honibo Kubor Boazi Boazi Zimakani Suki (isolate) Kayagar Kolopom Yaqay Warkay-Bipim Yaqay
Reference
800
North Asmat Sempan Awyu-Dumut
Bosavic Sonia Beamid
Unknown
Kirsch p.c. Kirsch p.c. 1,500
(409) 4,200
S0rum 1984; Kelly 1976 Schieffelin 1976 Freund 1977
967
(400)
Depewp.c.
199
Ernst 1984, 1991
433
(300) 300 400
450
(700) (1,100)
Knauft 1986,1987b Shaw 1990
(650)
Dwyerp.c.
1,962 (1,062) (1,000)
Busse 1987
7,200
3,300
Serpenti 1977, 1984
(300) 9,000
Boelaars 1981
49
50
Critique
Table 1 cont Family/languages
RH
non-RH
Unknown
Reference
Yelmek-Maklew Marind Bian Marind Marind
(900) 7,200
van Baal 1966, 1984
Morehead & Upper Maro River Pahoturi River
3,250 2,000
Williams 1936 Williams 1936
Eastern Trans-Fly Bine Gidra Gizra Miriam
470
(1,700) 1,650
(600)
700 1,100 1,350 1,450
Porome (isolate) Tirio Turama-Omatian Waia (isolate) Inland Gulf Kamula (isolate) Gogodala Ari-Waruna Gogodala
Landtman 1917; see Knauft 1990b B. Labap.c.
1,000 1,000 Wood 1982
300
(3,500) 7,000
Wirz 1934a; Crawford 1981
Kiwaian
22,700
Knauft 1990b
Eleman Purari (isolate)
35,575 6,500
Williams 1940 Williams 1924
Totals
60,592 RH
100,824 non-RH
78,261 Unknown
a
Special thanks are due Terence Hays for his keen suggestions concerning the organization of this table, and to Robert Depew, Peter Dwyer, Stuart Kirsch, Billai Laba, and Robert Welsch for their respective personal communications concerning Aekyom (Awin); Kubor and Samo; Yonggom and Kati; Gizra; and Nigerum. b Parentheses indicate unconfirmed but presumed cases. c Bosavi language families reside in hilly or mountainous areas adjacent to the lowlands; their inclusion here as lowlands groups practicing ritualized homosexuality is methodologically conservative for the argument presented in the text. d Wurm and Hattori's categorization of Beami includes Bedamini and Etoro. e Shaw, primary ethnographer of the Samo, has stated that ritual homosexuality was absent (1990:29nl, 154nlO). Informal reports from other sources in contact with Samo, however, suggest it may have been present among at least some Samo groups.
The totals show that the lowland south New Guinea population known or believed to have practiced ritualized homosexuality would have to be increased by sixty-six percent (adding 40,232 to an existing
Sexuality in the regional analysis
51
total of 60,592) to match the population known or believed to have not followed this custom. If the "presumed" cases are omitted (those listed in parentheses in table 1), the population among which ritual homosexuality was practiced would have to be increased by more than 100 percent to equal the population among which it was absent. ("Presumed" cases are those contiguous with several other groups in which ritual homosexuality is known to have been present or absent, though its presence or absence is undocumented in the specific group in question.) The several undocumented and inestimable cases make unclear the exact boundaries of ritual homosexuality in south lowland New Guinea. It is likely that several of the larger language families in the "not known" category fell partly if not altogether outside the purview of ritual homosexuality (e.g., the Aywu-Dumut linguistic group, southeast of Dani and southwest of Mountain Ok; and the Inland Gulf and TuramaOmatian language families, south of Simbu and southern highland areas respectively). These groups, in addition to areas documented as not having practiced ritualized homosexuality, make it extremely unlikely that the practice could have predominated in lowland south New Guinea as a whole. Overall, available evidence suggests that more than three-fifths (62.5 percent) of the population of lowland south New Guinea lived in societies in which ritualized homosexuality and boy-inseminating practices were normally absent. Even apart from the problems of labelling whole societies as "homosexual" in the ethnographic present on the basis of precolonial male sexual practices, the notion that lowland south New Guinea was generally associated with ritual homosexuality is empirically erroneous. This finding prompts examination of other customs that are being overlooked in these formulations and the historical patterns that have shaped the ethnographic sexualization of south New Guinea. Ritualized heterosexuality as an areal designator?
Institutionalized sexual liaisons in the form of extra-marital heterosexual coitus or ceremonial heterosexual hospitality were pronounced in all the Papuan language-culture areas of the south New Guinea coast, excepting only the Elema at the far eastern end. 2 Much of this heterosexual practice was highly ritualized. South coast heterosexual practices were wide-ranging:
52
Critique
(a) Among Purari, extra-marital coitus was ceremonially routinized and subject to collective ritual arrangement among men and women. Ritual heterosexuality was especially elaborate following successful headhunting raids and included procurement of armshell valuables from sexual partners by women (Williams 1924:211-214; Holmes 1924:172,175). (b) Among Kiwai, coitus was undertaken frequently to obtain mingled sexual fluids for diverse fertility purposes. Largely promiscuous sexual intercourse for this purpose culminated the most important fertility rituals, the mouguru, and combined on other occasions with collective heterosexual hospitality (Landtman 1927:ch.24). Ritual coitus was also conducted by older husbands and wives to obtain sexualfluidsfor other spiritual strengthening purposes. (c) Among Marind, extra-marital heterosexual intercourse was undertaken at most large-scale feasts and ceremonies, that is, for a diverse array of strengthening and fertility-inducing purposes (van Baal 1966:808-818). Some of these sexual rites were collective - among groups of married men and women; others involved sexual intercourse by several men in succession with one or two young women. A South Pacific Commission Report (1952-1953, 1955) concluded that the great frequency of ritual heterosexuality precipitated a high rate of primary sterility among Marind women in the precolonial era (see also Vogel and Richens 1989). (d) Among Trans-Fly peoples, ceremonial heterosexual hospitality and wife-lending were pronounced (Williams 1936:24,159-60). (e) Among Kolopom, ceremonial sexual intercourse occurred between married men and prepubescent girls who had been betrothed to adolescent male initiate novices. The sexual fluids obtained were rubbed on the initiate novices to promote their growth. Promiscuous heterosexual intercourse among married persons (as well as with girls) took place on the occasion of final mortuary feasts and headhunting expeditions (Serpenti 1968,1977,1984). (f) Among Asmat, regular wife-exchange between distantly related "bond friends" was practiced, sometimes in a large-scale ceremonial context. More general and promiscuous heterosexual intercourse, for which women collectively decorated themselves, was undertaken following headhunting, after erection of a men's house, at the closing of feasts celebrating the elaborately carved bis ancestor poles, and in times of great social or cosmological threat (Zegwaard and Boelaars 1982:21-23; Eyde 1967:205-210; Schneebaum
Sexuality in the regional analysis
53
1988:83; Kuruwaip 1984:14; Sowada 1961:95, van Kampen 1956:7376). Among most of these groups, ritualized heterosexuality was strongly associated with cosmological and social fertility as well as with feasting and warfare. In those areas where ritualized Ziomosexuality was also present, extra-marital heterosexual practices were arguably given cultural, mythic, and ritual emphasis at least as strong as homosexual ones. For south coast New Guinea, an emphasis on "semen-exchange" and "semen-culture" belies the very strong emphasis on mingled male and female sexual secretions obtained through heterosexual intercourse. Perhaps a more appropriate term than "semen-exchange" would be "sexual substance exchange," or "reciprocal exchange of sexual fluids," which do not encode a male bias. Cultural emphasis on ritualized heterosexuality in south coast New Guinea contrasts strongly with groups of the western New Guinea highlands, where heterosexual avoidance, including heterosexual taboos and female pollution beliefs, was much more in evidence. In light of this contrast, Lindenbaum's (1987:222) assertion seems most curious, i.e., that the "homosexual" orientation of the south lowlands was diametrically opposed to a "heterosexual" emphasis in the highlands. Focus on lowland heterosexuality brings out the importance of women in analysis. In many south coast groups - including particularly the Purari, Kiwai, Elema, and to some extent the Marind - women took a strong initiative in establishing sexual and marital relations (see chapter 5). In some cases, women could take the initiative in nonmarital exchange of sexual fluids and had a degree of ownership over valuables thereby obtained. Female status could be quite high, as indicated by sexual choice, female property ownership, and positive cultural valuation of female sexuality and fertility. This possibility is obscured by assuming that lowland fertility cults epitomize male domination and that male ritual homosexuality is the dominant trope, that is, betokening men's cultural appropriation of female reproductive powers. This bias is further reflected in the female status implications of describing lowlands marital systems in a "prescriptive" mode. As discussed below, the current analytic tendency is to relegate the structural role of south New Guinea women to one of "sister-exchange," by virtue of which women easily become passive objects of prescriptive rules rather than active agents in marital transaction (contrast Cantrell n.d.). The unwitting backgrounding of women
54
Critique
through an emphasis on male homosexuality is highlighted by the fact that female homosexuality has been documented in none of the south coast culture areas under consideration.3 The characterization of sexual patterns, let alone whole societies, as "semen" or "sperm" cultures reifies a biased ethnographic presentation of culture as an exclusively male province. The cultural salience of pronounced extra-marital heterosexuality in south coast New Guinea is also attested by historical developments. Although homosexual customs died out along most of the coast, as Lindenbaum (1984) effectively notes, extra-marital heterosexual exchange elaborated during the colonial era in several south coast areas. In contrast, using homosexuality as a culture-region designator tends to construct an ethnographic present around sexual customs of little relevance to most south coast cultures today. Ultimately, however, ritual heterosexuality harbors several of the same analytic traps that befall ritual homosexuality. First, depicting south coast New Guinea through the lens of ritual heterosexuality would metonymically represent it on the basis of a single focal trait and its presumed correlates, thereby reducing appreciation of the region's ethnographic richness and complexity. Correspondingly, it would "sexualize" the area. By concentrating on sexual practices that seem exotic from our own cultural viewpoint, other dimensions of indigenous action and belief are too easily seen as correlates of these unusual customs (contrast advancements made by Whitehead 1986). Third, taking ritual heterosexuality as a master trope would imply generalities for south lowland New Guinea based on the populous groups of the coastal region. Who is to say that a coastal reference point for south New Guinea is better than one restricted to a smaller portion of the coast but extending inland to selectively encompass additional regions where ritual homosexuality was practiced? Fourth and finally, it is difficult to force gradations of cultural emphasis into binary categories. This is particularly true concerning features as intimate and interpersonally variable as sexual orientation (see Herdt and Stoller 1990). Such complexity was particularly evident among peoples such as the central Asmat, where the apparent absence of ritualized homosexuality is thrown into relief by voluntary, reciprocal, and age-symmetrical male homosexuality (Eyde 1967:206; see Appendix). The importance of individual choice and its variance from an ostensible cultural prescription of homosexuality have also been documented among Gebusi (Knauft 1986, 1987a), Onabasulu (Ernst
Sexuality in the regional analysis
55
1991), Bedamini (S0rum 1984:331), and Kolopom (Serpenti 1984:305),4 and in insular Melanesia at East Bay (Davenport 1965, 1977; but cf. Herdt 1992). Neglecting such interpersonal complexity easily underwrites a blanket assumption that semen exchange encodes age-grade inequality and requires structural balancing by marital, labor, or sexual exchange (e.g., Creed 1984; Lindenbaum 1984). In the process, reciprocal homosexuality among age-mates is analytically neglected or presumed to be a function of introduced change. Analogous criticisms could easily be made concerning ritualized /jeterosexuality: that it collapses a wide range of inter-regional and interpersonal variation into a single sexual "type." Rather than asserting one or another mode of sexual practice as archetypal of south New Guinea, we can consider the confluences that these divergent characterizations both reflect in the ethnographic record and evoke in the history of ethnography. First, however, it bears emphasizing that the analyses of Herdt, Lindenbaum, Whitehead, and Feil have been path-breaking, influential, and important. By generating provocative hypotheses with laudable scope and theoretical ingenuity, they have re-awakened comparative interest in south New Guinea that had lain largely dormant since the days of A. C. Haddon. As might be anticipated, this surge of interest promotes more careful study and the possibility of alternative configurations and regional characterizations. As I will discuss in chapter 6, it can be expected that idealized contrasts between ethnographic regions will be compromised as the ethnographic evidence within each region is considered more closely and critically. Much of the motivation for this reanalysis comes from historical developments within anthropology; emphases shift with changing academic agendas and Western cultural developments. It is this process in the ethnographic context of south New Guinea to which we now turn. Ethnographic sexualization of south New Guinea
Since the 1920s and 1930s, it has been known that diverse or "flamboyant" forms of ritual sexuality were practiced in much of south coast New Guinea, as documented for the Marind and the Gogodala by Wirz (1922-25, 1928, 1934a,b), for the Purari and the Trans-Fly peoples by Williams (1924, 1936) and for the Kiwai by Landtman (1927). Yet it was only half a century later, in the 1980s, that homosexuality became central to general and comparative assessments of the region. Drawing on a groundswell of interest in feminism, the 1970s saw issues of gender and sexuality catch fire in anthropology. By considering
56
Critique
gender in a comparative ethnographic context, a wealth of pathbreaking volumes emerged.5 Though many directions evolved, the twin motives of exploring cross-cultural sex-role variation and exposing gender domination were among the most prominent. By the 1980s, these twin goals broke further ground in advancing the anthropological study of homosexuality, which had remained in the ethnographic closet for many years. This interest was undoubtedly fuelled by the Gay liberation movement and a heightened public awareness of AIDS (e.g., Greenberg 1988:ch.ll; Adam 1987; Seidman 1991:ch.6). It is consistent in this context that Herdt's strong and prolific scholarly emphasis on Melanesian homosexuality during the 1980s has drawn widespread attention.6 The historical underpinnings of his comparative assessment of Melanesian homosexuality are also understandable in this context, though they are by no means either reducible to or tainted by it. First and foremost, Herdt emphasizes the rich distinctiveness of Melanesian sexual practices and erotic attractions. In addition to its great ethnographic contribution, this salutary relativism confounds lingering assumptions that sexual orientations normative in the West are natural or universal. Herdt has made this point forcefully in several of his recent publications (1987a: 199-206, 1987b, 1991; Herdt and Stoller 1990; Stoller and Herdt 1985a,b). Correspondingly, Herdt emphasizes that insemination of boys was not aberrant but culturally expected if not required as a dimension of male socialization in a number of Melanesian societies. This undercuts the persistence of Western psychiatric notions that homosexuality may be inherently abnormal or socially dysfunctional.7 Third, Herdt contrasts Melanesian and Western homosexuality with respect to life-cycle development. He emphasizes that Melanesian homosexuality did not produce a permanent or exclusive same-sex orientation, being frequently transitional to exclusive heterosexuality in subsequent marriage (Stoller and Herdt 1985a,b). Finally, he stresses that Melanesian homosexuality was age-graded, asymmetric, and prescriptive rather than undertaken reciprocally between age-mates in a voluntary fashion (e.g., 1984a, 1987a:ch.7,1987b: 448-450,1991,1992). Herdt contrasts ritual homosexuality implicitly and in a few places explicitly with a scenario of Western Gay culture in which individuals volitionally express a long-lasting if not permanent homosexual orientation through reciprocal sexual liaisons with partners from their same-sex cohort (1987a:203-4; 1987b:448, 451-2; 1992). Herdt's portrayal in his comparative essays and papers thus suggests the following antinomies:
Sexuality in the regional analysis Melanesian male homosexuality -ritualized/prescriptive -normative -asymmetric, nonreciprocal inserter/recipient relationship -age-structured/stratified -often transitional to bisexuality or heterosexuality
57
Western male homosexuality -optional/free-choice -minority status (e.g., Gay) -frequently reciprocal inserter/ recipient relationship -frequently age-symmetric -often non-transitional or mutually exclusive with heterosexuality
These contrasts have rhetorical as well as scholarly functions: (1) they undercut the notion that homosexuality cannot be normal or viable as a general sociocultural practice, and (2) they show that not just sexuality but Ziomosexuality is cross-culturally variable. As the range of homosexual variation within Melanesia is considered, however, the strengths that cultural relativism gives Herdt's analysis emerge also as a weakness. Herdt shows great sensitivity to this issue in his path-breaking exposition of individual differences in Sambia sexual and erotic orientation (Herdt and Stoller 1990). But this moment of individual relativism is in tension with Herdt's general comparative assessments of Melanesian homosexuality (e.g., 1984a, 1987b), particularly when he attempts to deal with individual variation and crosscultural comparison in the same work (1991). This conflict engages a frequently occurring general problem of comparative analysis: features that appear adequate for a broad comparative analysis become inadequate as the scale of analysis is reduced and patterns of local variation are considered more closely. If indigenous Melanesian homosexuality is considered on a large comparative scale - as a relatively homogeneous bloc in implicit contrast to an assumedly coherent Gay culture in the US - Herdt's characterizations hold in the main. But when regional variations are confronted on a smaller scale within Melanesia, his characterizations appear overgeneralized as well as geographically overextended. Herdt (1984a, 1991 :pt.2, 1992) defends his comparative model of Melanesian homosexuality in part by skimming over or attributing to introduced change evidence of Melanesian homosexuality that was mutual, age-symmetric, or optional. As mentioned above, however, a variety of these descriptions apply to some forms of homosexuality among Asmat, Onabasulu, Kolopom, Gebusi, and Bedamini, as well as in East Bay, at least during the colonial era. As David Halperin
58
Critique
(1990:ch.3) has recently argued in the context of ancient Greek homosexuality, the designation of homosexuality as ritualized creates a risk of underplaying or homogenizing the complexities of erotic attraction. Though Herdt certainly agrees,8 the same caveat applies equally to "boy-insemination" in the Melanesian context. At a finer-grained scale of analysis, then, we are led beyond Melanesian homosexuality, even in its precolonial guise, as a singular "it entity" - an entity that Herdt has helped create and now would seem to defend for Melanesia while at the same time attacking the topicalization of homosexuality more generally (see 1991, 1992). This parallels in a Melanesian context the awareness of diverse homosexualit/es that has emerged so powerfully for the US in the work of Bell and Weinberg (1978). The south New Guinea coast exemplified a diverse and overlapping range of heterosexualities, homosexualities, and bisexualities. These erotic modalities were not uniformly ritualized, prescriptive, agestructured, tied with warrior cults, or bound up with initiation socialization practices. It can no longer be taken for granted that "the Sambia type of ritualized homosexuality occurs widely in the southern coastal and southwestern areas of New Guinea" (Herdt 1987a:201). Rather than devolving to a disagreement about categories, definitions, or Western tropes - or, worse, leading one to give up comparative analysis altogether - such differences should be recognized as an expected outcome of changing the scale of comparative analysis. Though such questions may appear for the generalist to be quibbles, they expose larger theoretical issues. As the notion of sexuality is increasingly relativized, the conceptual categories upon which it is based become increasingly problematic. Postmodern feminists such as Butler (1990) suggest that the oppositional reification of sex/gender categories itself contributes to their categorical asymmetry and reproduces an intrinsically flawed view of gender and sexuality. As she puts it, "the internal paradox of this [sexual] foundationalism is that it presumes, fixes, and constrains the very 'subjects' that it hopes to represent and liberate" (1990:148). Arguments in some ways analogous are made by Marilyn Strathern (1988) for New Guinea gender relations. These criticisms can also be directed at the reification of ritualized homosexuality or boy-insemination in Melanesia. As Sedgwick (1990) has recently pointed out in her critical study of homophobic epistemology, the tendency to polarize gender categories is a necessary stage in the awareness of alternative sex-choices but should
Sexuality in the regional analysis
59
itself be transcended in a greater awareness of sociosexual plurality. The modernist tendency to place the sexual in a "privileged relation to our most prized constructs of individual identity, truth, and knowledge" (ibid.:3) is easily projected into areas such as south New Guinea in the over-sexualization of their indigenous cultures. It is for such reasons that the rest of this book does not assume south New Guinea sexualities as a classificatory preeminence but views them inductively in conjunction with other dimensions of social relationship and social inequality. On the one hand, south coast sexual orientations need not be emotionally bleached by straining to link them isomorphically with prescriptive sister-exchange, low intensity subsistence production, sexual antagonism, or some other sociological or psychological feature. They may be appropriately treated as creative erotic expressions in their own right, flamboyantly and distinctively heterosexual and sometimes also homosexual. On the other hand, the marshalling of south New Guinea as a counter against Western homophobia has already been orchestrated by Herdt. It is time now to go beyond both implicit global binarism and irrevocable particularism, and to look for processes of interconnection that articulate sexual practices with other ethnographic specifics in a developmental framework.
The analytic legacy of homosexual emphasis: language, subsistence, and political economy
Several authors have recently used ritualized homosexuality as the basis for elaborating a series of generalizations about south New Guinea. These posit homosexuality as a crucial correlate of marital, political, and economic practices presumed general to the region. Ritualized homosexuality in the central portion of the south lowlands was indeed linked to the belief that male initiate novices should be inseminated to give them male life-substance for growth and maturation (Herdt 1984a). In the comparative south New Guinea literature, this notion is expanded; ritualized male homosexuality is reasoned to reflect male autonomy from women in both cultural reproduction and male status acquisition, notwithstanding the strong countervailing emphasis on ritual heterosexuality along the south coast. Lindenbaum (1984:339, 343) and Feil (1987:ch.7) correspondingly reason that male cultural autonomy in "homosexual societies" engenders lack of male status dependence on female productive labor, with men's status being dependent on their own semen-exchanges rather than on surplus production of valued foods or material goods (cf. Whitehead 1986). As a result, south lowlands production systems are said to support only direct rather than delayed exchange, for example, entailing person-forperson exchange in marriage and warfare rather than large-scale wealth exchanges in bridewealth or homicide compensation: Homosexual societies are thoroughly 'egalitarian' in ethos. Restricted, direct and balanced exchange predominates; asymmetrical or delayed reciprocity has no place in social arrangements. (Feil 1987:178) As for political economy, these portrayals correspond with claims that: No homosexual society has a ceremonial exchange system based on intensive, surplus production from which male prestige and renown are gained, (ibid.: 179)
Language, subsistence, and political economy
61
As a result, south New Guinea has "production systems . . . of very low intensity" (ibid. :177). It is pointed out as support of this reasoning that ritualized male homosexuality tends to co-occur with sister-exchange. Such a correspondence holds for the Trans-Fly, Kolopom, Jaquai, and inland groups such as Boazi and Gebusi but is contravened by Kamoro and eastern-central Kiwai and appears problematic among Asmat, and, further inland, Etoro and Bedamini.1 In all, the entailments and correlates of ritual homosexuality are seen as homologous with the political decentralization and fragmentation the authors presume are characteristic of lowland south New Guinea. They correspondingly assert that these societies are "small in size" (Lindenbaum 1984:343), are divided into "numerous tiny language families" (Whitehead 1986:90), "inhabit precarious environments" (Lindenbaum 1984:343), and are "marginal in terms of subsistence, and are demographically tenuous" (Feil 1987:177). Such generalizations have a selfsustaining effect; Feil writes (1987:178): "As Lindenbaum perceptively remarks, the 'precariousness of survival is matched in homosexual societies by the seemingly precarious "struggle" to create masculine identity'." Such generalizations reflect the current comparative perception of lowland south New Guinea political economy.2 Before I evaluate them in more detail, it may be noted, first, that they follow the 1960s legacy of Peter Lawrence and Mervyn Meggitt (1965) by viewing lowland New Guinea as the polar opposite of the New Guinea highlands. Feil, Lindenbaum, and Whitehead all develop their models for south New Guinea on the basis of presumed highland/lowland antinomies. Second, these generalizations tend to collapse the societies of rich coastal areas with those of more sparsely settled lowland areas further inland. Third, like many of the recent Melanesian theoretical models, these were developed by researchers whose New Guinea fieldwork has been primarily in highland areas of interior New Guinea. Language family size
The populations of language families documented by Wurm and Hattori (1981) for coastal south New Guinea range from more than 47,000 for Asmat-Kamoro and more than 35,000 for Elema to 22,700 for Kiwai, 8,100 for Marind-anim (cf. van Baal's 1966:24 estimate of 14,50016,000), 6,500 for Purari (cf. an estimate of 10,000 or more by Maher 1961:17; cf. Williams 1924:4), and 3,300 for the distinct geocultural
62
Critique
Kolopom Island area (cf. Serpenti's 1977:9 estimate of 7,000). The area that mostfitsthe "tiny language family" thesis is the Trans-Fly, composed of four language families ranging from 1,350 to 4,650 speakers.3 Ease of communication along the coast facilitated the spread of language, and Williams (1940:26, map) notes that Eleman dialects were mutually intelligible for 200 km along the seaboard. Some south lowland language families further inland were also substantial in size; Wurm and Hattori (1981) estimated the largely unstudied Awyu-Dumut language group to have a population of 29,500, and the Lowland Ok's population to be 20,300. Though not as large as the bigger highland groups, these language families are commensurate in size with those in many other areas of New Guinea. Collectively, south lowland language families cannot be characterized as small or fragmented, and this is particularly true of the more populous coastal areas. In Sepik areas to the north of the highlands, many language families are significantly smaller than those of the south lowlands (ibid.). The average language family population for south lowland groups among which ritualized homosexuality was absent was 21,268 (from table 1, chapter 3). This number compares to an average language family population of 4,530 for south lowland language families among which ritual homosexuality was practiced. The former category is more than four and a half times larger than the latter. 4 These data strongly support the notion that language families among which ritualized homosexuality was practiced were relatively small. But they also greatly reduce the applicability of this assessment to south New Guinea as a whole; the large language families in which the custom was absent constitute the great bulk of the south lowland population. Subsistence
Reliance on sago as a starch staple is commonly assumed to indicate low-intensity food production in south New Guinea (see generally Ruddle et al. 1978), but evidence is equivocal for coastal languageculture areas (see table 2). In Brookfield's assessments of Melanesian subsistence intensity, three of the forty-four places considered are from the New Guinea south coast (Brookfield with Hart 1971 :ch.4; cited hereafter as Brookfield). Of these, Kolopom is assessed as having "high intensity," and Marind-anim assessed as "partially intensive," with respective intensity rankings of sixth and twelfth out of the forty-four entries. Ritual homosexuality was practiced in both of these culture areas.
Language, subsistence, and political economy
63
Table 2. Geography and subsistence regimes of south coast New Guinea Geography
Subsistence
Reference
Asmat
Mangroves; swamp; rainforest
Sago/fish
Kolopom
Swamps; manmade isles; floodplain forest Grassland; savanna; woodlands; swamp
Taro/yams
Eyde 1967 Arsdale 1975,1978 Serpenti 1977
Group
Marind-anim
Sago and yarns3
van Baal 1966:16-21; Brookfieldl971:98f., inn.
Barraul958:16f Trans-Fly
Grassland; savanna; woodlands
Yams/tarob
Kiwai
Mangrove swamp; raised alluvial deposits
Sago/fishc
Purari
Mangrove swamp; rainforest Beach; rainforest
Sago/fish
Elema
Sago/taro/yams
Beaver 1920:88; Williams 1936:17, 218. Beaver 1920;154, 160,214f.,250; Brookfield 1971:95 Williams 1924:10-12; Holmes 1924: ch.20 Williams 1940:12-14
a
Brookfield (1971:95, 98-99,109) tabulates the Marind-anim starch staple as sago, with important subsidiary dependence upon yams (cf. also Barrau 1958:16f). b Sago is found in the Oriomo Plateau of the eastern Trans-Fly area (Ohtsuka 1983:26, 117-119), but the general Trans-Fly pattern documented by Williams (1936) features yam and taro cultivation with a dearth of the highly-prized sago. Root-crop staples shade into sago dependence north among the Wiram (Williams 1936:220) and throughout the Kiwai area, with progressively exclusive reliance on sago among the eastern Kiwai and Purari (Beaver 1920:88,154). c Among Kiwai, sago is lacking only among far western settlements such as Mawatta, where there is only one sago swamp area and a dearth of sago production (Beaver 1920:75; Landtman 1927:65).
The Kolopom cultivated yam and taro in man-made garden islands reclaimed from the swamp by piling layers of clay and floating grass on a floating bed of cut swamp reeds (Serpenti 1977:ch.4). Island beds were laboriously constructed to ensure proper moisture levels for various crops and different seasonal conditions. To further maintain proper soil temperature and moisture content, the entire cropped area was regularly covered with thin layers of mud fertilizer sifted through net strainers and then overlaid first with humus and then with dried grass compost. Tuber production was especially important for competitive mortuary feasts (ndambu). Kolopom subsistence intensity is rated on Brookfield's scale as higher than that of core highland societies such as Enga and Simbu, and he notes that the Kolopom exhibit "one of the most remarkable cultivation systems in all Melanesia" (Brookfield 1971:106,113).
64
Critique
A significant degree of agricultural intensity was also found among some sago-dependent peoples of the south coast. The Marind-anim made prismoidal garden ridges, up to one and a half meters high and surrounded by drainage ditches, in which smooth-trunk sago palms were planted (Barrau 1958:16, 37; Brookfield 1971:109). Brookfield rates Marind-anim cultivation as "partially intensive," that is, as exhibiting "either the presence of intensive practices over a significant part of the total productive system, or else of a generally high level of technical competence in land management which leads to the partial creation and maintenance of a tame ecosystem." He notes that Marind subsistence "serves as a reminder that people depending on wild food [such as sago] are not necessarily at the most primitive technological level" (Brookfield 1971:109). As van Baal (1966:20) suggests, Marind cultivation practices beg comparison with those of the Kolopom, especially during the precolonial period, when gardening and feast-giving were highly developed: gardening, to-day rather insignificant, was important in the old days, when feasts were frequent, which made the availability of great quantities of kava and bananas as well as of yams and taro an urgent necessity. Enquiring further into the matter, he [Verschueren] found that formerly not only did every man have a garden from the time he was an ewati [adolescent bachelor initiand], but that he always had more than one, and that even a number of women made their own gardens.
Elema subsistence combined sago processing with intense gardening and pig husbandry. Elema had a population density of approximately fifty persons per square km in the coastal area, making it commensurate with that of many eastern highland areas. 5 Though it has been rarely noted until recently (Kelly 1988:150), the pig population per capita among the Elema was equal to that of the Mae Enga of the highlands (see Williams 1940:12). The social significance of pigs for the Elema is poignantly captured by Williams (1940:llf): the village pig is . . . the living symbol of wealth . . . He is the means of cementing friendship, of maintaining proper relations between kin; and at every social and ceremonial gathering of importance his dying squeals are pleasantly audible. A large supply of them [pigs] all round makes for a social and ceremonial activity, and so they are highly prized. At the same time, and as a consequence, they give rise to a good many disputes and quarrels. Indeed the principal sources of joy and dissension in the life of Orokolo males are their women and their pigs.
This description parallels common claims about the role of pigs in the New Guinea highlands. In the Trans-Fly area, where ritual homosexuality was strongly evident,
Language, subsistence, and political economy
65
the staple foods were small and large yams. Among Keraki (the Trans-Fly group studied by Williams), the collective houses built to store the yams could be well over 100 meters long - with a width of about a meter and a height of about a meter and a half (Williams 1936:233). Ayres (1983:70f.) cites patrol officer L. A. Flint as measuring one yam storehouse almost 200 meters long. Stored food supported massive competitive feasting exchanges, in which the amount and size of tubers given were carefully tallied. Williams calculated that the average family of one man and two wives amassed and put in storage 1362 kg. (3,000 lbs.) of small yams each year (1936:227). The number of yams was carefully recorded in an elaborate base-6 counting system: one dameno (considered the "bare minimum" for a family's seasonal efforts) equalled 6 x 6 x 6 x 6 = 1,296 tubers for storage. Among Trans-Fly peoples as well as Elema, Kolopom, and Kiwai, the piles of food given in feasts could be enormous. Keraki display racks presenting the food comprised up to two and a half kilometers of fence line heaped with produce (Williams 1936:231-235). One of the less extensive feasting racks was estimated to hold an exchange display of at least twenty-five to thirty tons of yams. That the seasonal Trans-Fly biotic environment could support significant food production is further evident in Harris and Laba's (1982) discovery of prehistoric garden mounds and large-scale drainage ditches in the southeastern Trans-Fly area. Among Kiwai, sago was the starch staple except in the far west of the language family (Beaver 1920:88, 160-162). But yams and taro were highly important for large-scale ceremonial giving and display. Intensive cultivation practices were used for feasting gardens, including fencing from pigs, shading seedlings, and extensive drainage ditching (Landtman 1927:67-68). Sago itself was frequently cultivated rather than harvested wild (ibid.:6S, 101). To judge from Landtman's lengthy description (ibid. :ch.5), crop cultivation was culturally important among Kiwai as well as being linked to political achievement. It may also be noted that land was reclaimed for settlement sites in some eastern Kiwai areas through compost heaping and stockading (Butcher 1964:146). Root-crop cultivation was relatively undeveloped among Purai and Asmat, who both relied on sago and fish. This subsistence pattern did not compromise the intensity of their economic and political development, however, which among Purari included significant rank divisions and hereditary chiefs (Williams 1924; Maher 1974). Purari produced
66
Critique
prolific amounts of surplus sago, which was traded to visiting Motu trading parties. The Motu arrived in large lakatoi ships up to eighteen meters long and typically stocked with over a thousand earthenware pots and scores of shell valuables (Seligmann 1910:115). The visitors were hosted for about a month while their Purari hosts amassed sago for exchange. A large pot was traded for about thirty-five kg. of sago, and a large armshell valuable could be obtained for between 110 and 150 kg. of sago in plaited bags. The ships each returned carrying between twenty-three and thirty-one metric tons of sago {ibid.). In essence, Purari surplus sago production underwrote a significant proportion of their trading partners' subsistence needs and procured for themselves large numbers of pots and armshell valuables. Purari villages were extremely large and could attain a size of more than 2,000 persons (Maher 1961:32). Asmat villages could swell to more than a thousand persons (Sowada 1961:16), and Schneebaum (1988:168) came across one Asmat longhouse ninety meters in length.6 Among Kiwai - for which early population figures were not collected - the huge communal living houses could be more than 150 meters long (Landtman 1927:5).7 The significance of these residential and political aggregations in societies relying on sago as a "low intensity" subsistence base is considered further below. Statements that south New Guinea was ecologically "marginal" or "precarious" may be misleading or inaccurate, particularly for the coastal regions. Available information suggests there was no significant protein deficiency among coastal groups, as most of them had substantial access to maritime and riverine fauna or to savannah or inland forest game as well as to plentiful sago or tubers. A plentiful diet of diverse food sources has been noted explicitly for the Marind (van Baal 1966:19; see Luyken 1955), the Trans-Fly area (Ayres 1983:8; see also Ohtsuka 1983), the Purari (Williams 1924:2, 81), the Kiwai (Landtman 1927:64), and the Asmat (see van Arsdale 1975,1978). Subsistence was precarious primarily among Kolopom, whose intricate cultivation system was highly susceptible to floods and drought (Serpenti 1977:ch.2). In areas where sago was the starch staple, fish and sea creatures ranging in size from tiny prawns to huge dugong provided important and often regular protein supplements. A number of early observers noted that south coastal populations were physically more robust as well as more residentially aggregated than their inland "bush" counterparts (e.g., Beaver 1920). Whether the predatory headhunting practiced by several coastal populations against their inland neighbors
Language, subsistence, and political economy
67
was facilitated by nutritional, demographic, or ecological advantage is difficult to say with certainty, but such a pattern is plausible. Overall, subsistence intensity was relatively high among Kolopom, Marind, Elema, and possibly among prehistoric Trans-Fly peoples. In all of these areas, root crops were significant food sources. A tenuous subsistence base is evident only among Kolopom. It is important to note that where subsistence relied heavily on sago and was technically low in intensity, low intensity of economic exchange or sociopolitical life did not necessarily follow. The ability to produce quickly a large and easily-stored food source such as sago was complemented by ease of water transport. As a result, groups such as Purari, Kiwai, and Asmat were able to aggregate considerable populations in very large villages for residence, feasting, and/or for warfare. Among Marind, Elema, and Kiwai, ease of sago procurement also freed labor for cultivation of root-crop gardens, which were important for feasting and competitive exchange. In short, the scale and organization of political life were not rigidly dependent on the extent or intensity of starch staple procurement. Gift exchange and leadership South coast patterns of exchange and leadership diverge strongly from characterizations of them as economically nonintensive and politically decentralized. Kiwai Among Kiwai, who have been erroneously considered to be a "homosexual society," large gaera feasts were held yearly in preparation for mouguru heterosexual fertility rituals (Landtman 1927:ch.26). These feasts were held by one or more leaders who had taken an oath upon being challenged by a rival leader to reciprocate the gifts of a previous feast. In preparation, leaders had special large gardens cultivated, reserving their entire produce for distribution at the event. More generally, "an enormous quantity of food must be supplied, during which hardly any regular work can be done, except bringing home provisions from the gardens" {ibid. :383). Among eastern Kiwai, Butcher (1964:223) observed one feast at which twenty pigs and forty sago bundles, each over three meters in height, were presented. Beaver (1920:180) estimates that at least ten to eleven tons of food were distributed at one feast he attended. At the event itself, a large tree was cut down and transported whole to the ceremonial ground, where it was
68
Critique
replanted and festooned with huge quantities of food. Landtman (1927:389) notes: An enormous mass of garden produce is hung up on the different parts of the gaera tree: on the stumps of the several branches, on the platform [bamboo structure to support the tree and frame its base], on every spot of the outer bamboo structure, wherever there is room, and the remaining food is heaped up on the ground round the tree, where mats have been spread.
In addition to food, shell ornaments, dogs' teeth necklaces, belts, and other valuables were hung in the tree's branches and piled about its base. When everything is ready, all the people are summoned to come and look, and they burst out in exclamations of wonder at the imposing sight of the gaera. A great "kaikai" is held on the dancing ground round the gaera. {ibid. :390) When the food and valuables had been distributed and only the empty gaera tree was left, its master climbed to the top, berated those who had challenged him to the feast, and savored his accomplishment. If the opposing leader had not sponsored a similar feast, he challenged him (as rendered to Landtman in pidgin): "I clear now; I been make gaerafinish.Where you now? You there along water; me there along shore." No words could cut deeper than these. The man alluded to feels his honour at stake, and he and his people will put forth every effort to wash away the shame. They will carry on their garden work with untiring zeal during the next season, {ibid. :395) The most successful Kiwai leaders, called "chiefs" by Landtman, were strongly polygynous and commanded the work of others to such an extent that they themselves did little subsistence labor {ibid.: 168-169). One who is able to entertain many guests enjoys a greater reputation than others . . . "Me fellow look along kaikai," the people say when giving the cause of social pre-eminence. For this reason a man is greatly assisted in his social ambitions by a plurality of wives: "another woman go garden, another woman go take firewood, another woman go catch fish, another woman go cook him husband he sing out plenty people come kaikai." Women of a successful man would sometimes ask him to marry co-wives to help them in their work: It is by no means rare where there is only one wife for her to scold her husband for burdening her with too much work instead of procuring a second wife to share it. "Me tired," she is supposed to say; "make garden, carry firewood, catch
Language, subsistence, and political economy
69
fish, make kaikai for you - hard work. More better you take him another woman." (ibid.:241) Elema Feasting was also highly developed among Elema, Purari, Asmat, Marind-anim, Keraki, and Kolopom (the last three of these practiced ritualized homosexuality). Among the Elema very large exchanges of pork and shell ornaments were conducted in the course of numerous mortuary and costume rites. Of particular importance were the gift exchanges of the hevehe ceremonial cycle, during which "some forty piles [of food] were ranged in the right order, each consisting of roast sago in wrappings of palm-leaf, pots of stew . . . piles of fresh coconuts, green and yellow bunches of areca-nut, red boiled crabs, and hunks of pork" (Williams 1940:363-364). The gift-giving of food and valuables occurring at the conclusion of this event, as at other ritual feasts, was "in native eyes . . . the climax of the whole ceremony . . . One may see the donors work themselves into what seems like fury, while the recipients, loaded with ornaments as they are but looking very sheepish, are obliged to listen in silence" (ibid. :145). Frequent exchanges were transacted between affinal or matrilateral relatives, with armshells or pearlshells given to wife-givers and pigs given in return (ibid. :61). The uncle or the brother who makes the gift likes to do so with liberality and so enhance his good name. If, on the other hand, he fails to make a creditable showing he is afflicted with maioka, or shame; he feels small; and he may have to endure the actual taunts of those directly or indirectly associated with the gift, for there is no convention of polite silence on such matters. The ideal thing, since the principle of reciprocity holds here as strongly as elsewhere, is both to give and to receive on a lavish scale; but failing equivalent return, a man has his reward in the respect, or even fame, which liberality, or the mere display of wealth at appropriate moments, will bring him. (ibid. :97) In addition to affinal gift giving, Elema conducted large exchanges in hereditary trading partnerships (okeahi) between nonrelatives. These were initiated in each generation by "the spectacular hoera kor, or 'taro tree.'" A tree trunk some twenty meters long was loaded with perhaps 700 taro, "which grow to such splendid proportions at Orokolo," as well as haulms of bananas and bundles of sugar cane. The laden timber required 70 to 80 men to carry it (ibid. :72): Made gay with croton, dracaena, and new white hii [bark cloth] fluttering from arrows as flagpoles, the whole imposing contraption is borne along the beach to
70
Critique
the eravo [longhouse] of the okeahi who is to receive it. The bearers, as many as can find a place to put their shoulders to, struggle and stagger under the weight. If they actually collapse, or if the bamboo [support] poles crack andfinallybreak in the middle, all the better, (ibid. :72) Williams notes that "nothing reaches more deeply into the soul of an Elema native than does the traffic in ornaments and pigs" (ibid. :91). Elema leadership emphasized generosity in feasting, hortatory control over female labor (though polygyny was extremely rare), and incipient hereditary rank. Gerontocracy was strongly developed, and "in the oldest men of the tribe we meet with something like a ruling class" (ibidrM). Purari Among Purari, just west of Elema, a system of hereditary chieftainship co-existed with general rank classification. Maher (1974) found that Purari maintained a careful genealogy of up to nine generations of chiefs, tracing the origin of Purari spirituality from immunu "life-force" beings to its human distribution in living chiefs and their ancestors. Purari politics cross-cut hereditary rank with competitive leadership grounded in shell ornament exchanges and control of female labor for feast-giving. The aim of precolonial Purari exchange, according to Maher (1967:315f.), was to invest resources and establish debtor relations in order to gain wives and increase one's political power. Rank was formally inherited, but competitive exchange was an important means of maintaining and increasing upward mobility. Maher (ibid.) remarks that: A man's holdings in shell ornaments underlay much of his ability to influence his community, but if he were to have the influence appropriate to a mari [chief] or amua [man of rank], he must also maintain an extensive network of relationships to individuals through regular gifts of food. At feasts, a careful investment of large-scale resources was made, creating exchange debts that were called in to underwrite major feasts by leaders on later occasions. As a result, a village of up to 2,000 persons could be galvanized into concerted action as people responded to the leader's demand that "now was the time for old obligations to be honored." Keen manipulation of the exchange system was particularly important:
Language, subsistence, and political economy
71
His [the leader's] skill lay in being able to think in terms of large numbers of marriages involving many relatives, occurring through a substantial dimension of time. Most successful men made their moves within a mental perspective of a generation or more. What one contributed today to the bride wealth which a paternal uncle was gathering for his third wife could be influenced by the expectation one had of outliving the uncle and thereby achieving a strong position to claim the lion's share of the bride wealth at the eventual marriage of the uncle's two-year-old daughter, (ibid.) The connection with gender in the production of food for exchange was direct (ibid.): for the ordinary [Purari] man, an extra wife was desirable but not usually possible. For the Purari mari [chief] or amua [man of rank], however, polygyny was essential. Although men had their significant roles in the division of labor, women were the principal providers of foodstuffs.
Williams records an average of 1.5 wives per married man, with chiefs having up to eight wives, and he notes, "In days not long gone by certain Purari chiefs are said (possibly with some heroic exaggeration) to have had eighty wives and more apiece" (1924:55). Asmat It has often been remarked that prowess in headhunting was an important dimension of Asmat leadership (e.g., Zegwaard 1959). Other dimensions of Asmat leadership are much less widely known, and because much of this information is unpublished, a selective synopsis of it is appropriate. Among Asmat as among Purari, polygyny was crucial to male leadership. Not only were multiple wives vital to facilitate extensive affinal alliances and feasting relations, but a man, upon marriage, became the exclusive owner of the sago stands inherited by his wife from her clan (Eyde 1967:227, 255; Trenkenschuh 1982b:46). Control of these sago stands and the female labor to work them was critical to the leader; it enabled him to stage ceremonial feasts and to attract cognatic or distantly related men and their families to himself, thus swelling the size of his settlement. Large settlements as well as strong affinal linkages to other settlements were in turn crucial for the staging of successful headhunting raids and for resisting the raids of others (Eyde 1967). Asmat leaders had several wives as well as additional sexual-exchange partners (papisj), and Zegwaard (1978:18) states, "I know of 6 wives, 10
72
Critique
wives and even a case of 17 wives [married] to one man." Eyde (1967:228) states: It should be stressed that the equation between prowess in warfare on the one hand, and wealthy plural wives and surplus sago on the other hand, is extremely important. It is by this equation that prowess in warfare becomes transformed into the ability to make massive distributions of food, and thus into political power.
More explicitly, "a successful man, thus, accumulates sago and fishing areas, and the female labor necessary to translate these areas into surplus food to be distributed, by marrying more than one wife" (ibid. :235). Asmat warfare was connected directly to their exchange economy in that the ceremonial cycle of feasting culminated in headhunting. Concomitantly, women disparaged and were loath to marry men who had not proven themselves by taking heads in warfare. Warrior prowess alone, however, was not sufficient to attain high-level leadership: Leadership above the level of the core conical kindred [house-doorway section within the longhouse] is everywhere related to the ability to distribute food in ceremonial cycles, (ibid. :306)
Unfortunately, little is known of the economic, much less the religious, dimensions of the elaborate Asmat ceremonial cycles. Eyde (ibid. :338) summarizes the bare outlines: The ceremonial cycles last from one to several months, while the elaborate ceremonial objects which are the center of interest are fashioned. During this time there are repeated ritual distributions of food in the men's house accompanied by chanting, drumming, the recitation of myths, games, and dancing. The ceremonial cycle concludes with a massive distribution of food and, usually, the public display of the completed ceremonial object. Often, only a few weeks elapse between the conclusion of one cycle and the beginning of another. There can be no doubt that the cycles play an important part in stimulating the overall productivity of the village economy.
Many of the ceremonial exchanges were quite substantial. In the more extravagant climactic distributions, leaders invited large numbers of men to cut sago or obtain other food from the leaders' extended lands, ending in a mass distribution. Food received in the course of ceremonial cycles was later reciprocated (ibid. :343, 348f., 357f.). A particularly important ceremonial concerned the construction and dedication of the Ws-pole, an elaborately carved trunk five to seven meters long fashioned in a series of ancestor and hornbill embodiments
Language, subsistence, and political economy
73
Figure 2 Asmat bis-po\e. Wood, paint, fibre, 6 m high. The carved canoe with seatedfiguresat the base of the pole is a receptacle for the life-essence of headhunt victims as described in chapter 9. (Illustration after Rockefeller and Gerbrands 1967:302-311.)
74
Critique
from which an intricately fretted aerial root protruded (figure 2; see Rockefeller and Gerbrands 1967:302-311; Schneebaum 1990:42f.). The poles were commissioned by the leaders of the men's house moieties and took two to three months for master carvers to fashion in a special carving building (Zegwaard 1954; Renselaar and Mellema 1956; see Sowada 1961:47). During this period, the carvers were fed as well as paid for their work by the leader, who also hosted the ceremonial inauguration at which the village as a whole and people from other neighboring villages were feasted. The combined population of these groups was perhaps 2,000 or more. 8 The importance of leaders' own spiritual force and its connection with group reproduction were highly evident in the ceremony's conclusion (summarized by Sowada 1961:38): Moreover, at the completion of the Bis-rite, the ancestor pole used for the occasion is solemnly transferred to the sago groves. Ancestor poles are not fashioned except for noted headhunters. A person of this sort is believed to possess much nammu - mana which permeates the ancestor pole during the Bis ceremony. The pole, once placed within the locus of the sago forest, is released of its mana which in turn is absorbed by the sago palms. Afterward the people, upon consuming the nammu-infested sago, will participate in the strength and the fearlessness of their ancestor. Staging the bis ceremony strongly identified leaders as the paramount living embodiments of spiritual force: not only was the leader himself a renowned headhunter, but he had commissioned the pole to honor his own deceased relatives and had prevailed upon his many wives and widespread kin alliances and dependents to work his extensive sago areas to stage the feast. The planting of the bis-po\e back in these areas to replenish and rejuvenate sago underscores the economic and political as well as the cosmological and military cycle of this undertaking. Not surprisingly, conflict over possession of sago territories was an important underpinning both of Asmat headhunting between settlements and of fission within villages (Eyde 1967; Sowada 1961:36; cf. Zegwaard 1959:1037). Despite granting usufructory rights, Asmat adages strongly counselled: Do not seek any food in another's territory or another's sago area! Another's sago area only gives trouble! (from Drabbe 1959:133; quoted in Sowada 1961:36) Kolopom Among Kolopom, whose sexual customs included ritualized homosexuality, success in feasts of competitive giving, termed ndambu, was
Language, subsistence, and political economy
75
the sine qua non of political status (Serpenti 1972-73, 1977:ch.6). factions within village wards were paired in feasting opposition and were part of a nested hierarchy of feasting oppositions between village wards as wholes, between village-halves, and between whole villages. Competitive feasts escalated to encompass larger political groups as the mortuary feast cycle progressed, and great food gifts could also be initiated ad hoc by a warrenwundu or "great cultivator" to challenge and defeat a rival. Many garden islands were reserved for competitive feasting exchanges. The largely nonpolygynous men did most of the gardening work themselves. At feasting exchanges, raw foods were heaped up in a large culinary display, including specially cultivated taro up to a meter in length and yams more than two and half meters long {ibid.:28-38). In comparing the size and amount of food given by each side, the prestige of the leaders and their competing factions were fully at stake, and careful tallies were kept of the amounts presented. Leadership depended above all else on the ability to threaten and then formally challenge and oust rivals through competitive food exchanges. When a feast has been a large one, it might take a long period of time to mount a sufficient return feast (Serpenti 19721973:169). Serpenti provides a detailed case study of feasting competition between rival leaders and their factions, noting within this process the: great importance . . . [of] the pure struggle for power and prestige. The derogatory remarks addressed to the opponent . . . arise . . . from one warrenwundu [great cultivator's] ambition to outdo his rivals and thus raise himself a further step on the ladder of social prestige. Not only on subjects directly or indirectly connected with agriculture, but in the most diverse matters, the opinion of the warrenwundu carries great weight. Less important persons will not readily contradict him or ignore his express wishes, for it is in his power at any time to 'defeat' a refractory member of his kwanda [village ward] or paburu [village-half sector] at ndambu [competitive mortuary feast-giving], which would mean public humiliation for the man in question. (1977:235f.)
Serpenti notes that the warrenwundu as leader fixes the times for planting, for rituals, and for competitive feasting; he acts as spokesman for his followers, and in general is the embodiment of his group's influence and prestige. "Through the ndambu-contest against warrenwundu from other local groups he gains prestige and influence
76
Critique
not only for himself but also for the whole group who helped him" (ibid.:236). Keraki [Trans-Fly] Among Keraki, where ritualized homosexuality was also practiced, large-scale feasting was highly important to male prestige. In Keraki as well as Kolopom, the huge food piles given were carefully recorded by an elaborate set of measuring devices tallying the amount of food given and the length and girth of the largest tubers. The large quantity of yams and the size of display-racks used to hold them for Keraki ceremonial presentation have been mentioned above. Ayres (1983:165) states: To successfully grow big and plentiful yams is a great achievement. A man is a "big man" kavar kambei, by virtue of his success in yam gardening. He will also be known as a "garden man," ndau kamei. To accuse a man of not having many yams, or of growing small yams is a formal insult. Williams (1936:235) notes that "the headmen are expected to stand above others as food-producers and feast-makers." In elaborating this point, he remarks {ibid. :233): There is no doubt that the [Keraki] native is deeply impressed by the sight of a quantity of food . . . and he takes a corresponding pride in being the producer or owner of it. To cast doubt upon the food-producing capacity of an individual or group is a fertile source of quarrels; and an acknowledged type of rejoinder in any dispute is to challenge your adversaries to display as much food as you can display. Unlike Kolopom men, Keraki men were highly dependent on female labor for amassing food stores, and polygyny was frequent. Forty-five percent of married men had more than one wife - an average of 1.55 wives per married man {ibid. :149). Older wives were inherited through the levirate and appear to have been more important to Keraki men as a source of labor than as sexual partners. Commenting on the Trans-Fly emphasis on gardening and cumulative food-display, Williams {ibid. :234f.) remarks that one could write a whole monograph on the social and exchange significance of food in Keraki life. Marind-anim Among Marind-anim, by contrast, the linkage between leadership and the political economy of food and wealth exchange appears weaker than in other south coast culture areas. Polygyny was rare and there appears
Language, subsistence, and political economy
77
to have been little ethic of competitive exchange in feasting. It is true that subsistence was partially intensive, that feasts were large, and that headmen (pakas anim) were leaders of the men's houses. The ideal pakas anim exerted decisive initiative in many areas: organizing ritual feasts (including setting the day and inviting the guests), organizing hunting andfishingtrips, legitimizing community marriages, supervising and coordinating community garden work, exercising rights over uncultivated land, adjudicating disputes, organizing and leading rituals, and being "the great and uncontested religious leader, listened to in silence and respect by everyone in the village, even by the elders" (South Pacific Commission 1952-53:56f.). The pakas anim nominated his own successor "after exhaustive deliberation with the elder men" {ibid.). His most important function, however, was as the preeminent warrior of the men's house, leading the group in organizing and carrying out headhunting raids. For subsistence, van Baal (1966:20) notes that Verschueren's information is fully corroborated by Wirz's statement that the Marind usually have gardens in many different places and that a man's status is determined by the number and extent of his gardens.
The largest feasts were those celebrated in the wake of successful headhunting expeditions, which could necessitate arranging for sitting and sleeping areas to accommodate 1,500 people (van der Kroef 1952:232). The competitive dimension of feasting and status rivalry, however, is largely absent from Marind politics as portrayed in ethnographic accounts. This absence might in part be due to a deterioration of leadership as a result of heavily armed Dutch intervention and suppression of headhunting, which began in the early 1900s. Probably more important, however, is that the above-mentioned leadership features were closely articulated with, and were in many ways subordinated to, community interdependence in ritual, totemic, and headhunting concerns. This interdependence reflects the overarching mythico-ritual system of phratry organization that linked Marind communities as collective partners (see chapter 8). Van Baal (1966) emphasizes that ritual and political interdependence placed strong constraints on internal political rivalry. Correspondingly, Marind were distinctive and indeed striking among south coast societies by the absence of warfare between their own communities. (Van Baal rightly notes this tendency as being perhaps "the most remarkable of all . . .") Instead, warfare was cooperatively directed against non-Marind-anim in long-distance
78
Critique
Table 3. Leadership and exchange in south coast New Guinea Group
Rating
Reference
Asmat Kolopom" Marind-anim Trans-Fly6 Kiwai Elema Purari
++ + ++ ++ + ++
Eyde 1967:228,235,349 Serpenti 1977:ch. 6,132 van Baal 1966:65-68,163 Williams 1936:99,149,215,233,235,243 Landtman 1927:168, 247 Williams 1940:13, 49-51, 91, 97f, 145 Maher 1967:315f; Williams 1924:55
Key: -I- + male leadership is highly competitive, including material exchange competition in which male leadership prestige is dependent on polygyny and differential access to female labor. + leaders' prestige is crucially linked to eminence in giving valuables or food in exchange relations, but such gifts do not depend on polygyny or differential access to female labor. leadership is not significantly dependent on eminence in material exchange relationships and not reliant on polygyny or female labor. a Though not common, polygyny was both possible and prestigious among Kolopom. In some respects, Kolopom polygyny was an index or result of productive prowess and material wealth rather than a cause of it; it was the industrious cultivator who could garner enough food/valuables to "meet the demands of the numerous relatives" of more than one wife (Serpenti 1977:132). It is possible that general cultural assessments underestimate the labor that women contributed to Kolopom leaders' productive prowess, since "agriculture is, ideally, an affair of men only, no matter how considerable the women's share may be" {ibid.: 121, my emphasis). It would appear, however, that much - perhaps most - of the physical as well as magical labor needed to become a Kolopom "great cultivator" derived from male effort. Kolopom leadership was highly competitive and may have had polygyny as a significant element ex post facto, but polygyny did not appear to be a prerequisite for leadership success. b Keraki may be contrasted to sago-dependent Oriomo groups of the Trans-Fly, east of Williams' study area, where polygyny was minimal and not related to competitive leadership, which was itself undeveloped (Ohtsuka 1983:15,12).
headhunting raids. Celebration feasts concluding the headhunt were held for allies, including distant allies, who had helped make the headhunt possible (ibid. :24, ch.12, 720f). Comparative assessment of leadership and political economy
With the exception of the Marind-anim, south coast political economies cannot be described as lacking asymmetric or delayed reciprocity, lacking major wealth transactions, lacking fervent leadership competition through exchange, or having low intensity political economy in general (see table 3). In four of the seven language-culture areas, male leadership prestige was highly dependent upon polygyny and differential access to female labor. Again excepting the Marind, none of these features appears incompatible with the highly elaborate myth and ritual
Language, subsistence, and political economy
79
systems that were of such deep cultural significance in all south New Guinea language-culture areas. A cosmological system with elaborate social concomitants, including ritual homosexuality or ritual heterosexuality, is neither indicative of nor exclusive to significant dimensions of politicoeconomic intensification (or vice versa). In contrast to the New Guinea highlands, however, this intensification did not depend on high population density or a highly localized subsistence base. It depended rather on exploitation of dispersed subsistence resources and a high degree of geographical mobility both in amassing foodstuffs and in aggregating population. These differences mark contrasting configurations of politicoeconomic intensity in highland and south coastal New Guinea rather than polar differences in the scale of politicoeconomic intensification. Great Men or Big Men?
It remains possible that the principles of exchange along the New Guinea south coast contrast distinctively with those found in core areas of highland New Guinea. The most prominent recent model addressing this issue is Godelier's (1986, 1991) typology, which systematically contrasts "Big Man societies" in core highland areas to "Great Men societies" elsewhere in New Guinea, including along the south coast. Godelier suggests that a number of factors co-vary with these exchange types. Big Man societies are reasoned to exchange material wealth for human life and hence to reflect a complex exchange system in which nonequivalent items are transacted. Control over exchange of material wealth in elaborate competitive exchanges is then the key to a coalesced pattern of Big Man leadership. Great Man systems, by contrast, are reasoned to be based on restricted exchange of like-for-like - for instance, a person-for-person model of exchange, as reflected in sister-exchange marriage and blood feuding rather than bride wealth marriage or homicide compensation. Leadership roles tend to be multifarious in Great Man societies and based on spiritual domination or on coercive force rather than on domination by control of material wealth. In short, Godelier's argument suggests the following kinds of antinomies:
80
Critique
Big Man societies
Great Man societies
Competitive/nonequivalent exchange: bridewealth marriage homicide compensation Leadership domination through wealth accumulation
Restricted/equivalent exchange:
Coalescence of leadership functions (singular leadership role)
sister-exchange marriage blood feud Leadership domination through spiritual prerogative or physical coercion Division of leadership functions (multiple leadership roles)
The distribution of these features can be assessed across the New Guinea south coast; if Godelier's hypothesis of discrete exchange logics holds, we would expect Great Man features to appear as a cluster, with a corresponding absence of Big Man traits. It cannot be assumed that the presence of a given trait necessarily indicates the absence of its logical counterpart. The results do not support Godelier's model (see tables 4 and 5). None of the language-culture groups shows an absence of characteristics from either societal type, and, as shown in table 5, three of them (Asmat, Kiwai, and Elema) show as many or more "Big Man society" characteristics as they do "Great Man society" characteristics. Further, none of the individual features indicates a consistent pattern of restricted exchange or Great Man leadership across the New Guinea south coast. It would hence be difficult to conclude that the south coast cultures fit the Great Man as opposed to the Big Man political pattern. Indeed, only among the Trans-Fly is there a great majority of the former over the latter. The Purari, whose political system included ranked chiefs, paradoxically shows more Great Man than Big Man traits. Overall, the clusters of traits that should co-vary as part of the logic of Big Man or Great Man societies are in fact mixed together complexly in the various language-culture areas of south coast New Guinea. The Asmat case effectively illustrates the intertwining of equivalent and non-equivalent exchange. Legitimate marriage agreed to by both sides (per se) was of three varieties: exchange marriage, bridewealth marriage, and marriage followed by brideservice (Zegwaard and Boelaars 1955:277-301).9 Sister-exchange and bridewealth marriages were both common, the former being characteristic of unions within the men's club house and the latter prevalent among marriages between different club houses (either within or between villages). If a man's relatives could not raise the requisite bridewealth for inter-club house marriage, the groom could be pressed into brideservice.
Language, subsistence, and political economy
81
Table 4. Big Man society characteristics in south coast New Guinea Homicide compensation +
Bride wealth Asmat Kolopom Marind Trans-fly Kiwai Purari Elema
+ _
_a _
c
-
-
-
+ +
-
+d
Leaders dominate by wealth
Singular leadership
Total "+"
-
+ + + + +/-
3 2 1 1 2 2 3
+b -b + + + +
a
Homicide compensation practiced, but only as part of balanced exchange (Serpenti 1968:125). b Leadership domination pronounced through food exchange competition. c Bridewealth exchanged between agnates to procure "sisters" in marriage, but not transacted between clans. d Holmes (1924:261, 263) states that when battle deaths were not equal, leaders would pressure aggrieved parties to accept material compensation for persons killed or wounded. One cause of quarrels was "damage done to gardens by the pigs of another community and refusal of the latter to compensate the former for their losses." Table 5. Great Man society characteristics in south coast New Guinea
Asmat Kolopom Marind Trans-fly Kiwai Purari Elema a b
Sisterexchange
Blood feuds
+ + (+) + + -
+ + + + + -
Leaders dominate ritually or by coercion + + + + + +
Multiple Total leadership
BM/GMa
Bb
3/3 2/3 1/2 1/4 2/2 2/3 3/2
(-) + (-) + +
3 3 2 4 2 3 2
Ratio of Big Man society characteristics to Great Man society characteristics. Parentheses indicate assessments based on circumstantial or partly conflicting evidence.
The "complex" rather than restricted dimensions of Asmat inter-club house marriage are reflected not only in extensive and obligatory bridewealth/brideservice but in homicide compensation between Asmat villages, particularly those that fought over women and sago areas but did not headhunt each other and might attend each other's feasts (van Kampen 1956:62ff.; see summary in Sowada 1961:53-56). Homicide compensation between such villages could, as in the New Guinea highlands, be standardized, with suggestion made that "the bloodwealth indemnity paid for a murder must not exceed or be less than that amount which is culturally fixed" {ibid. :56; see similarly, Eyde 1967:332).10 Blood-wealth compensation was made directly from the
82
Critique
Asmat killer through a hole in his longhouse enclosure to the kin of the person killed, the payment including sago, spears, shells, dogs' teeth strings, and carved canoe paddles. It could perhaps be reasoned that Asmat exemplify a "bifurcated" exchange logic, with equivalent exchange practiced close to home and nonequivalent exchange practiced farther away. Yet this, too, is belied by Asmat practices. It was just between socially distant and politically equal Asmat men that restricted exchange in wife-lending was practiced, that is, the reciprocal and simultaneous exchange of wives between two men who had chosen to become papisj, bond-friends (Zegwaard and Boelaars 1955:283-87; van Kampen 1956:73-76; see Sowada 1961:91-95). Papisj relations were politically consequential, and leaders could have a halfdozen bond-friends, allowing them to extend their personal connection with important but unrelated men from numerous different longhouses. The exchange linkage was "as binding as a marriage contract" and enjoined the men who exchanged wives to be, among other things, "sworn blood-friends in war" (Sowada 1961:91, 94). Exact reciprocity among yet more distant social relations is highly evident in the blood feuding without compensation that was endemic between Asmat who were not living in adjacent or allied villages (Zegwaard 1959). As the Asmat case illustrates, the analytic assumption that exchange logics are discrete and internally coherent for entire societies is belied by the evident complexities of belief as well as practice. To sustain such an argument in the face of contrary evidence, one would have to artificially polarize differences between different groups of societies or else force cases into an ever-more-cumbersome proliferation of intermediate or mixed-exchange types. In either event, the Maussian tendency to view a given form of prestation as a total logic for a given society or group of societies is severely compromised. More generally, the structuralfunctional legacy in French structuralism and structural Marxism becomes painfully evident. Whereas the logic of the analyst can be pure, consistent, and discrete, cultural orientations may be diverse and internally conflicted - and the details of exchange correspondingly multifarious. Thomas (1991) has recently made parallel criticisms concerning the relationship between exchange logic, material culture, and colonialism in the Pacific generally. It could be objected that the exchange logics at work may not be adequately reflected in the specific traits listed above and in the bald way they are tabulated in tables 4 and 5. Yet if they do not have systematic empirical reflection in these indices or some analogous ones, the existence of discrete underlying exchange logics at the level of "deep structure" is
Language, subsistence, and political economy
83
correspondingly called into question. To argue otherwise is to be left with the conclusion that structural models exist only at the level of mind and are not subject to evaluation at the level of social reality (Levi-Strauss 1960; contrast Maybury-Lewis 1960). Comparative interpretations and ethnographic histories
Given overwhelming evidence to the contrary, how has it been possible for images of low politicoeconomic intensity and lack of competitive exchange to become so entrenched in recent generalizations concerning lowland south New Guinea? Part of the answer is that these generalizations are more apt for south New Guinea areas that are lowland but inland as opposed to those along the coast; the difference derives in part from my taking the coastal language-culture areas as a geographic contour. Even so, the regional comparisons of Feil, Lindenbaum, and others have included coastal groups such as the Kiwai, Kolopom, Marind, and Trans-Fly - groups that represent significant exceptions to their generalizations. Differences in the scale of analysis are also important; Lindenbaum, Feil, and (and to a lesser extent) Godelier configure lowland New Guinea by virtue of its contrast to extremely dense population areas of the core New Guinea highlands. Against this elevated baseline (where else in the world does one find politically unranked horticulturists with population densities of 75 or even 150 persons per sq. km?), almost all other tribal political economies can be seen as "nonintensive" or "lacking Big Manship." If one takes the core highlands as a baseline, other areas are easily defined negatively, without adequately considering the distinctive features of political economy that they in fact exhibit. These problems are naturally exposed as the scale of analysis is reduced and comparisons are built up from within rather than between large regions. Factors of ethnographic history, however, are as critically important as boundary configuration and comparative scale. Notwithstanding the ethnographic evidence presented above, ethnographers did not systematically document the details of politics, exchange, and leadership for south coast New Guinea or highlight them in ways that would have made them more easily recognized by comparative analysts. Much of the available information comes from classic monographs based on fieldwork between 1910 and 1940 that contain rich descriptive detail about many topics but tend to be inadequate for understanding political economy. Williams, for instance, notes that an entire monograph could have been written about the importance of food production and distribution in
84
Critique
Keraki culture but limits himself to the briefest of thin descriptions, ending tersely with "the sound if somewhat platitudinous conclusion that food is sociologically as well as biologically an important thing in Keraki life" (Williams 1936:235). In his Elema monograph, Williams (1940:330) states that in some respects, the enormous and elaborate exchange of gifts among men is: the most serious and important moment in the whole [15-year ceremonial] cycle . . . But the reader need not be wearied with a description of it. Suffice it to say that the gifts were more numerous and the throng of critical spectators far greater than at the morning presentation . . .
At an earlier period, Williams had little notion of the political significance of Purari exchange, reconstructed so vividly more than two decades later by Maher. Williams (1924:200) laments: The inner meaning of this exchange of gifts must be a matter of conjecture. The only explanation ever given me by a native was that this was a suitable occasion for the husband to make a gift to his wife's relatives; he must maintain his good name in their eyes for liberality and wealth.
Van Baal (1966:828) notes for the Marind-anim that though very large feasting exchanges were common, including some at which 50 pigs were killed and sago pallets ten meters long were cooked, There are only a few . . . [descriptions of Marind-anim feasts] which result from systematic observation and even these are incomplete because the marriagerelationships determining the pattern of food-exchange and the technique of the distribution of gifts remained unnoticed or were summarized in empty generalizations plainly indicating that the observer had not the slightest notion of their social relevance . . .
The references to exchange economy and its connection to leadership that are made are often buried deeply in lengthy descriptive monographs that focus primarily on other topics. It is not surprising that the patterns these passages reveal have been overlooked in contemporary analyses of south New Guinea. Comparative analysis accentuates these difficulties when it takes the ethnography of highland and south coastal areas of New Guinea as if they were equivalent to each other. The primary information from each area was collected at different times and with different ethnographic and theoretical objectives. For authors steeped in the recent concerns of comparative highlands ethnography, an uncritical reading of the south coast monographs takes at face value their relative inattention to political
Language, subsistence, and political economy
85
economy and their emphasis on myth, ritual, and totemism. It is easy in this context to embrace the assumption - so embarrassingly erroneous once clearly stated - that an elaborate religious system is somehow an alternative to or functional replacement for an intensive political economy. Compounding the matter, the early monographs tended to portray individual features of politics and economy as separable and isolated from each other (that is, following in the legacy of Haddon and others prior to the rise of functionalism). Such a trend is evident as well in much of the more recent but fragmentary corpus of ethnography on the Asmat. As a result, the few pieces of politicoeconomic puzzle that are presented in the south coast ethnography tend to be widely scattered and disjointed.11 In the absence of a closer reading, it is all too easy to conclude that south coast New Guinea lacked highly developed competitive exchange systems. These biases are the reverse of those that arose among Melanesianists in the 1950s to 1970s. As discussed in chapter 1, this period saw a shift of ethnographic interest to the New Guinea highlands and a shift of theoretical interest to structural functionalism and then to cultural materialism and Marxism. Greatest attention was given to politics, exchange, social structure, ecology, and processes of politicoeconomic development. In all, it is evident that the conceptual contrast between the New Guinea highlands and the south coast - the former having "Big Men," "competitive exchange," "clan-parishes," and "politicoeconomic intensification," and the latter having "Great Men," "restricted exchange," "nonintensive political economy," and "male status autonomy" - is due in part to the juxtaposition of 1970s theoretical and ethnographic emphases against those of the 1920s. The scope of regional similarities and differences is in fact much more complex and interesting than this simplification implies, and I have created my regional contours in part to highlight this fact. This shift does not obliterate comparison but sharpens understanding of the differences and similarities between important cultural regions. Certainly there are real and significant differences between lowland and highland areas of New Guinea (see chapter 10). And certainly divergence of ethnographic interest stems in significant part from the practices and beliefs found in the regions themselves. Nevertheless, the magnitude and polarity of contrast between regions can become artificially magnified. This problem easily arises when generalizations or theories about one region are contrasted to those from another area that was studied largely at a different time and with a different set of topical and theoretical emphases.
Women's status
Recent analyses have made differing assessments of women's status in south New Guinea. Gilbert Herdt (1984a:66) suggests that female status was particularly low where ritualized homosexuality was practiced, and Harriet Whitehead (1986:286f.) suggests that variations in New Guinea fertility cults illustrate different cultural forms of male dominance. Daryl Feil (1987:ch.7), on the other hand, argues that the status of women was quite high in the "homosexual societies" of south New Guinea. Shirley Lindenbaum (1987:226) suggests for these societies that relations of production were roughly egalitarian, with men having a slight edge, but that men were dominant in cultural practice, since "the production and exchange of semen . . . creates status differences between older and younger men and especially between men and women." Moving beyond a logical configuration of gender and exchange, there is a large and interesting range of variation in female status, both within the central portion of south New Guinea where ritualized homosexuality was practiced and more widely along the south coast. Female status is a notoriously difficult concept, but for heuristic purposes in the present context, I follow Herdt (1984a:66) and Feil (1987:170) and consider high female status to be reflected in (a) women's sexual and marital choice; (b) female acquisition of and control over culturally valued property; (c) female participation in public affairs and ritual celebrations - to which one might add recognition of women's role in cosmological fertility; and (d) low incidence of female pollution beliefs and of generally disparaging images of women. To these, drawing on the work of Sanday (1981), I would add (e) low incidence of wife-beating and domestic violence against women. The
Women's status
87
following sections review available information from the seven south coast language-culture areas for each of these dimensions of female status. Aggregate comparative assessments are then made and competing explanations evaluated. Purari
In most dimensions of female status, Purari women rate quite highly. Concerning women's marital and sexual choice, Williams (1924:53) states that it is quite common for the girl herself to take the initiative and send a small messenger to the man she fancies, either taking a piece of tobacco or asking him for one. This is quite regular, and indeed it is regarded as preferable by some that the girl should make the first move; for such a one, having displayed a genuine preference, was more likely to prove a faithful and contented wife.
Sometimes a girl's brother will approach a man "with a proposal on her behalf" (ibid.). If parents disapprove of a romantic liaison, the woman and her partner can persist to good effect: Should the parents, however, have other plans for their daughter, which are distasteful both to her and to her suitor, the two may compromise the matter by making an affair of it. This is followed by revelations [of their sexual relationship] and I am told, the enraged and disappointed parents will acquiesce, (ibid.)
Williams (ibid.) concludes that "whatever the method, it appears that the will of the girl is always considered; and indeed, after marriage a woman will not stay with a husband whom she very much dislikes." Concerning property, Purari women received a substantial dowry at marriage, including a stock of armshells and other valuables that were "strictly her own and which she may keep quite separate from her husband's" (ibid. 123). Women passed these valuables on to their own children at death, daughters as well as sons. Purari women also had rights to valuables gained from ritualized extra-marital heterosexuality, and they exerted strong influence in choosing these sexual partners; they do not appear to have been coerced. If a woman fancies a man other than her husband for the nonce, the matter is arranged between the three, presuming the husband is willing. The husband sleeps in the ravi [men's house] and the wife and her admirer spend the night in her house. She invariably receives some gift, such as an arm-shell . . . Such prostitution and wife exchange may take place at any time. In the amina [sexual
88
Critique
intercourse following the taking of an enemy head] they are carried out with some amount of ceremony. The essential features are, first, that the husband's consent be obtained; and, second, that payment be made. This payment, it should be noted, is actually made to the woman, and not to her husband, though the profits are said to belong to them jointly, (ibid. :56)
Concerning the deployment of valuables, Williams (ibid. :123) observes, "as a rule there is complete confidence between the two [husband and wife], and it is common for the wife to keep in a single hoard all the ornaments they possess." Purari women took a great deal of pride in their capacity to take lovers and obtain wealth, a fact attested begrudgingly by the resident missionary John Holmes (1924:172). Wife-beating among Purari was "deprecated," and domestic violence appears to have been minimal (Williams 1924:60). Further, "a woman who is dissatisfied with her lot in her husband's house will readily desert him for another or else return to her own family, probably to her brother's house." The consequences of abandonment are that if . . . a woman deserted her husband for someone she liked better, he would normally demand payment from the latter, equivalent to the bride-price; and after payment the matter would be allowed to rest, the woman remaining with her new husband, (ibid.57)
On the other hand, women were excluded from most male cult life; there was a general prohibition against their entering the men's house (ravi), where sacred cult paraphernalia were carefully kept. But women were the exclusive singers when Motu traders were hosted (Barton 1910:111), and women of rank or importance were selectively initiated into important cults. Female pollution beliefs appear to have been absent among Purari. Williams (ibid.60) notes that a woman's food-taboos "seem as much in her favour as otherwise." Overall, then, the status of Purari women was very high. This is contrary to what one might expect of gender relations on the basis of other features of Purari society, including strong male status differentiation, exclusion of most women from male cult activities, male prestige dependence on female labor (including polygyny), and emphasis on masculine success in warfare. Despite these propensities, Purari women maintained a great degree of personal control and flexibility in premarital sexuality, in selecting a marriage partner, in
Women's status
89
establishing extra-marital sexual liaisons, in initiating divorce, in remarrying, and in acquiring and controlling property. Kiwai Kiwai women were also generally accorded high status, as documented by Landtman (1927:171-173, 248, 251). Haddon (1927:xvi) emphasizes this point in his introduction to Landtman's volume: Quite a new light is thrown by Landtman on the position of Kiwai women . . . We now learn that they play an essential part in many important ceremonies and that without their aid the men would be helpless; the men recognize this and request their co-operation. The high status of Kiwai women was noted by Hely in the early 1890s (BNG Annual Report 1892-93: 35f.) and has recently been reemphasized by Feil (1987:182). The fertility and magical power of a woman's vagina were central to her high status among the Kiwai. Landtman (1927:248) notes that from a Kiwai perspective: His [a man's] wife, whom he has procured at a very high price, is the source of all his prosperity: 'altogether luck, altogether garden, altogether spear-him-dugong, all he come from woman (through the [vaginal] medicine obtained from her)' . . . A husband was particularly solicitous of his wife to obtain her willing cooperation in a host of ceremonial acts in which her fertility power was used to benefit the couple's pursuits (ibid. :248). A woman's fertility power was allocated in part through sexual intercourse - the mingled sexual secretions being collected and used for diverse growth and strengthening purposes. She could also empower objects simply by passing them near to or touching them with her pubic area. For instance, when a couple planted banana shoots, the woman lies down on her back on the spot where the shoot is to be set, with her knees raised. In Kiwai [Island] she is nude . . . The man, standing astride in front of her, repeatedly passes the shoot underneath her knees and between his own legs, every time taking care that it touches her genitals. This action has a double meaning: passing the shoot under the woman's knees brings fertility to their own garden and also to other people's near by, whereas passing it between the man's legs will "shut" the way to the gardens of others, keeping all the benefit for oneself, (ibid. :90) The importance of female sexuality per se is here underscored by the fact that the man was prohibited from having sexual intercourse with his wife near the garden until it bore fruit (ibid.). In other contexts, by contrast, female sexual fertility power was combined
90
Critique
with that of male semen. In planting yams, for instance, the first shoot was buried using a bull-roarer "smeared with fluid from the woman's vulva after the man has had connection with her, the purpose being that the instrument, when whirling round in the air, should make that medicine fly all over the gardens" (ibid. :76). Alone as well as in combination with semen obtained through heterosexual intercourse, vaginal fluid was variously put in contact with or coated upon (a) the first yams planted; (b) the place where the shoot later sprouted on the root; (c) where the first few shoots sprouted above the ground; (d) on the first pieces of string with which the yams were tied up; and (e) on the first yam harvested (ibid.:77-80). In some cases, the woman simply put the object against her vagina (there being no mention of prior sexual intercourse); in one instance the woman "smears her hands with fluid from her vulva and tugs at one of the shoots, drawing her hand along it from the ground upward; the old man only looks on" (ibid. :78). The cooperative use of women's sexual power virtually saturates Kiwai cosmological belief and ritual practice. That vaginal potency was important in its own right, and not simply a "vessel" for obtaining male semen, is well illustrated in the rites described above and also by men's concern with their own extra-marital sexuality: A man who has had connection [sexual intercourse] with another woman will come to his wife afterwards on the same day in order to "clear that thing." If not he will be prey to conflicting secret powers, just as a canoe is buffeted about by irregular waves coming from different quarters, say the people, (ibid. :248) Property relations were likewise remarkable; women possessed "property of their own like the men" (with the exception of land), and "without the permission of his wife a man cannot appropriate a thing manufactured by her or given her by somebody else; she has the right to do with it whatever she likes without consulting him . . . Even provisions, etc., brought home by the woman should not be taken away by the man without her knowledge" (ibid. :173). The majority of marriages appeared harmonious, and, as a rarity in New Guinea, "expressions of affectionate and even tender relations between husband and wife could often be noted" (ibid. All). Sometimes, "when the pair were sitting together she would frequently caress him, without any apparent motive, at the same time making quite a pretty face." Government officer Beaver (1920:65) notes, "The position of women in the community . . . is by no means as bad as is usually imagined . . . and there undoubtedly exists an amount of affection
Women's status
91
between husband and wife or wives." Landtman (1927:171) suggests that, occasional outbreaks of temper rarely seem to affect seriously the harmony between husband and wife, because sensitiveness in this respect does not seem to be very great on either side. A badly treated woman canfindrefuge with her own people, and in many cases the husband has to come round, if he is not prepared to lose her for good, an alternative often rather serious to himself. Even adultery has some distinctive dimensions: Adultery on the wife's part does not always bring about divorce, but the case is fought out between the two men, and if the husband survives he generally continues living with his wife as before, (ibid. :251) On the less positive side, Kiwai women were excluded as actors from much cult life of the men's longhouse and from many cult and mythic secrets, and they could be threatened with death to ensure their compliance (ibid. :173). In cases of marital disgruntlement, women might be driven to suicide (Beaver 1920:177). As ritual participants, however, they were fully initiated into the madia cult at age ten to twelve in the male cult house. Here, along with their male counterparts, they were forbidden food and water and were subjected to an elaborate series of impersonated spirits, who attacked them in a mock headhunting raid. As part of the initiation, adult men and women danced, the boys and girls were lavishly feasted, and children of both sexes were given valuables such as shell and feather ornaments and strings of dogs' teeth (Landtman 1927:410). Women also had a separate puberty initiation shortly after their first menstruation (ibid. :238). Though this was less elaborate than male initiation into warriorhood, it entailed a great feast and the erection of a fenced enclosure, called a "skirt-house" (wapo-moto), heaped with valuables and especially with large numbers of grass skirts (made by the girl's female relatives), which were hung in rows for subsequent exchange (ibid. :238; cf. A. Weiner 1976). The girl to be initiated was "beautifully ornamented, much in the same way as men on festive occasions, except that they wear petticoats [grass skirts]" (Landtman 1927:239). The initiand was carried by a maternal uncle to the water's edge, where she was bathed by women, adorned with a new grass skirt, and borne back without touching the ground to the skirt-house. During the proceedings female jokesters, dressed as bedraggled or incompetent men, entertained the crowd with bumbling antics, and "for a long time
92
Critique
afterward" they became the recipients of food gifts from the initiated girl. The event concluded with a distribution of gifts, the taking of grass skirts, and a large feast. Shortly before marriage, women became participants in the famed mouguru or "life-giving" rites, which were "the most secret, sacred and awe-inspiring ceremony of the Kiwai people" {ibid. :350; see for eastern Kiwai, Flint 1919; Butcher 1964:ch.2O). The festive quality of the rites escalated, with "the whole occasion . . . calculated to cause sexual excitement" (Landtman 1927:351). People came from near and far to share in the dancing and feasting and participate in the serial and largely promiscuous heterosexual coitus that was the focus of the rites. This sexual celebration appears to have been participated in willingly and avidly by women and men alike (ibid. :352). The ritual purpose of the event was to collect co-mingled sexual secretions, which, as the most powerful "medicine," were used for diverse fertility purposes, including particularly the anointing of sago palms to promote their growth. "Everybody seems to be intent upon contributing as much as possible to the medicine, so that the baru [palm-leaf receptacles] are filled up" (ibid.). Intense sexual activity continued for several nights in succession, and "the longer the orgies last, the looser becomes the general behavior" (ibid.). The initiation of women into the mouguru, however, was more traumatic, with verbal instruction in the sexual ways of the rite followed by sexual intercourse, during which some of the girls would "shriek out and try to resist" (Landtman 1954:185). Kiwai women were supposed to use their vaginal power to benefit rather than jeopardize communal pursuits, since secret adultery or illtimed sexual congress with their husbands could be polluting and deleterious to men's activities and ritual performances. Women were subject to menstrual seclusion (ibid. :238), and menstrual blood was particularly feared as a contaminant to male activities such as fishing, hunting, warmaking, drum-making, and canoe building (ibid.'AS, 114, 122, 209). It was also taboo for men to have intercourse with nonmenstruating women before engaging in most of these pursuits (ibid. :250). Menstrual blood was efficacious in some contexts, however, being smeared on leaves and wrapped around bananas to aid their growth (ibid. :93): The female sexual organs are regarded as in high degree the source of all kinds of witchcraft, beneficent as well as malignant; indeed the people maintained that all "puripuri" medicines are directly or indirectly derived from this origin, just as the fingers branch off from the hand, as one of my informants expressed himself. (ibid. :238)
Women's status
93
The general sense one gains from this is that Kiwai men's dominant concern was to supplicate women to use their vaginal power effectively rather than to disparage them for having the potential to do harm. Kiwai marriage customs were particularly interesting, as strong norms of sister-exchange were cross-cut by frequent romantic unions. On the one hand, reciprocal exchange of women was requisite between totemclans in marriage. If an unreciprocated union had already been established, a girl could be commandeered against her wishes to create a balanced marriage exchange (Landtman 1927:244; Riley 1925:48f.). On the other hand, Landtman (1927:243f.) observes that many sisterexchanges were initiated as "love" matches. Aware of the tension between the requirements of sister-exchange and a significant degree of male and female choice, Landtman (ibid.) states, "submissive as the young folks might wish to be to the wishes of the older generation, yet individual love is a marked feature among them." Wooing and courtship formed an important preliminary to many if not most marriages. When parents were opposed to the match, the couple might continue their secret sexual trysts until the girl left with her lover to go to his house, where they both confronted her angry kin. As Cantrell (n.d.) discusses for Gebusi of the Strickland-Bosavi area, a marriage system based on normative emphasis on sister-exchange can accommodate considerable choice and influence by prospective brides (see also McDowell 1978). Though in some instances Kiwai women could be deployed against their will, romantic unions could forcefully exert themselves as an opening round of sister-exchange, deferring the onus of marital reciprocity onto others at a later time (see Landtman 1927:243f.).1 Even when a woman was obliged to fulfill the demands of marital reciprocity, large numbers of classificatory "brothers-in-law" and the possibility of some delay between one marriage and its "balance" could afford a woman latitude in pursuing a liaison with a man whom she preferred within a range of potential mates. It is thus erroneous to assume that the structural logic of restricted exchange tightly prescribed the actions of individual women. For Kiwai, there was a permeable rather than a rigid line between "prescriptive" and "optional" marriage. Marind-anim
Gender relations among Marind-anim also combined sister-exchange with a significant degree of female marital choice. Marind strongly
94
Critique
favored marriages between age-mates, and van Baal (1966:128) states that: This attitude favours the occurrence of marriages based on mutual love instead of on the pre-arrangements necessitated by sister-exchange. Freedom of choice is favoured, too, by the culturally prescribed form of betrothal: parane. This betrothal occurs at the initiative of the bride-to-be in the context of her peers: It is the girl who takes the initiative by sending her beloved a message that the next night they shall meet to celebrate parane. That night accompanied by a group of girls, she goes to the beach to await the arrival of the boy and his party. . . . Bracing himself, he hands [cassowary quill earrings] to his girl, together with some other simple ornaments. She in turn, gives him apind or pur, a bone implement used for scraping out a coconut . . . In doing so, both pronounce the required formula: "For ever you are my wife (husband)." The formalities having been completed, the bystanders vociferously give vent to their joy and the two groups part company in high spirits, the girls going with the betrothed girl, the boys with the ewati [initiand groom], (ibid. :128f.)
The ensuing marriage takes place upon the approval of the couple's parents, who must reconcile the match with the formal requisites of classificatory sister-exchange.2 If the parents are strongly against the union, a good deal of domestic disagreement may ensue, and the marriage may be precluded (ibid.). On balance, however, van Baal (ibid.'.Yll) suggests that "we should have definite reason to surmise that mutual preference expressed by the young people was more important than having an exchange-partner." He has recently reemphasized this point (1984:139): Their partner is always an age-mate, and usually one of their own choice who and this is even more important - voluntarily agrees to become his wife. Girls are not easily given away without their consent.
None of the early observers of coastal Marind-anim suggested the existence of sister-exchange marriage, but it was stated to be their preferred form of marriage by the Dutch Depopulation Team in the early 1950s (South Pacific Commission 1952-53:62f.).3 This suggestion led van Baal (1966:124f.) to reanalyze the genealogies he had collected in the Marind coastal region, whereupon he found sister-exchange between clans constituted between twenty-four and sixty-two percent of all marriages, depending on the locale in question. When reciprocity at the clan level was deemed impossible, Marind could balance one marriage against another in which the woman was not
Women's status
95
a clan sister of the original groom but was a member of his exogamous moiety. "This latter case, however, becomes very involved" (South Pacific Commission 1952-53:52). Couples who wished to marry but had no possibility of arranging a reciprocating union could give the bride's firstborn child to her natal family in exchange (ibid.). In all, marriage among coastal Marind appears to have combined a great degree of mate choice among young men and women with a tendency toward sister-exchange that was a statistical trend, a cultural predilection, and perhaps also a formal rule. A similar pattern is strongly evident among the Jaquai, to the northwest of the Marind (Boelaars 1981:91-99). Evidence concerning the status of Marind women in marriage is multifaceted (van Baal 1966:166-69, 1984:131). On the one hand, a woman was expected to perform domestic chores for her husband and to serve him food. Wife beating was fairly common, though many women nonetheless exerted significant influence on their husbands. Alder (1922:108, 129), visiting shortly after World War One, stated that Marind women were active participants in public debate, concluding with some hyperbole that "the women literally 'run the ranch.' It behooves the aspirant for leadership to stand well with them . . ."He gives examples of Marind women upbraiding men for lassitude and threatening collectively to withhold sexual intercourse from them until rectifying actions were taken (ibid.:148f., 151). The sexual division of labor - with women doing most of the gardening and sago preparation - appears to have been onerous for women but substantial for men also, particularly before the advent of steel tools (van Baal 1966:167). There are lots of comments made by early observers on the dreadful life of the poor drudge that is the Marind-anim wife, but such conclusions have been refuted by all those who lived long enough in the country to get better acquainted with the daily routine, (ibid. :166)
Concerning the emotional tenor of marital relations, van Baal notes that in many cases, "there is clearly real affection and mutual love between spouses" (ibid. :164). He concludes that "in spite of various reports on wife-beating and harsh treatment of women generally, the relations between spouses are, on the whole, cordial." Like Kiwai, Marind-anim conducted heterosexual rites, called aili or arih, in which substantial numbers of men and women participated in largely promiscuous heterosexual intercourse (ibid. :510, 581f., cf. 558f.,
96
Critique
629-645; see Alder 1922:144).4 Greater emphasis in retrospective accounts, however, has been placed on Marind otiv bombari, in which one or two young women were each serially engaged in coitus by between five and thirteen men - men of their husband's clan or their guests.5 The purpose, as in the aili and arih rites and as among the Kiwai, was to obtain mingled male and female sexual secretions for diverse strengthening and fertility purposes (van Baal 1966:558f., 581). In otiv-bombari, however, there was special emphasis on promoting the childbearing fertility of the woman herself. The fertility contribution of female sexuality to Marind cosmology is reflected in the fact that, despite male homosexuality, it was sexual secretions obtained through heterosexual coitus that were deemed ritually efficacious - as van Baal emphasizes (ibid. :820; 1984:138). But the sexual intercourse of otiv-bombari was traumatic rather than enjoyable for young women, who were sometimes unable to walk the next day as a result of their sexual ordeal. The slim evidence available suggests that women willingly submitted themselves to otiv-bombari in the belief that it was necessary to enhance their personal fertility as well as that of the Marind cosmos (van Baal 1966:815). The importance of female fertility notwithstanding, one cannot deny the intense sexual domination of young women by Marind men. Otiv-bombari was frequent, being a mandatory accompaniment to a large number of Marind ceremonies (ibid. :810; South Pacific Commission 1955:70-77, 99-106). In addition, van Baal notes that a man could sexually lend his wife and receive payment for this use of her services, and he implies that such arrangements were made without much consideration of the woman's inclination (1984:139; see 1966:814). In ceremonial life, Marind women were excluded from some rituals but were privy to many others. In many cases, they participated in or witnessed most of the ritual ceremony but were not informed of its more secret mythic meanings. Women did have their own series of age-grade and ritual distinctions that paralleled those of the men. Though less ornate than those of their male counterparts, these entailed fairly elaborate decorations and feasts. It is important that semen was applied to girls' bodies to make them strong and more beautiful - a feature in common with initiation rites for boys among the Kolopom to the west and the Onabasulu much farther to the north (ibid. :155; see Serpenti 1984; Ernst n.d.). The context of van Baal's (1966:155) remarks, following on those of Wirz (1922:1:90), suggests that semen was rubbed on Marind women to strengthen them
Women's status
97
and was used to anoint their scarification cicatrices to make the ensuing scars more pronounced and beautiful. Among Kolopom, immediately to the west of the Marind, sexual fluids obtained from heterosexual intercourse were analogously rubbed in cicatrices of boy initiate novices when they entered seclusion in the bachelor's house, that is, to help them grow (Serpenti 1977:164). In the case of Marind women, it is not mentioned how "semen" for skin-strengthening was obtained, though it would be highly consistent with Marind practices and with van Baal's terminology if the substance was in fact mingled male and female sexual fluids obtained through heterosexual intercourse. An analyst prone to extrapolation might perhaps suggest that female sexual substance was appropriated (along with male semen) to help "grow" Marind women. Female pollution beliefs appear to have been largely or totally absent among Marind. In summarizing Marind female status, the English translation of the Depopulation Report (South Pacific Commission 1952-53:60) states: The division of labour between the sexes does not indicate a disproportionate burden on the woman. Dr. van Baal [1934] is right when he says that the woman does the most and the man the heaviest work. When we view the subject of social and religious relations, it strikes us that actually the woman is nowhere regarded as an outsider. They are even initiated into the secret ritual of the tribe, although only in a secondary way. The grouping of the women according to age, associated with their own decorations and adornments, runs parallel with that of the men; they take up their own positions at the great dances and participate actively in all festivals. The woman is not treated as a slave.
Van Baal (1984:139f.) concurs with this assessment and finds the status of Marind women "contradictory," that is, with some features indicating high status and some indicating low. Elema
A different constellation of conflicting female status features is found among Elema. Concerning marriage, Williams (1940:53) states, "I do not know of any case of a marriage forced by parents." Courtship was left to the young people's decisions (though premarital sex was discouraged), and "there is no predicting where a boy or girl will find a mate" (ibid.). As a complement to bridewealth, Elema women were provided with dowries that were their own. The dowry included neck ornaments, a few armshells, a dog's tooth necklace, a substantial practical trousseau packed in capacious string bags, and perhaps also a suckling pig and a puppy. Polygyny was extremely rare.
98
Critique
Once established, Elema marriage was highly resistant to dissolution. A woman could be subject to a significant degree of wife-beating, which Williams (1940:50) describes in a manner best left to speak for itself: Marriages are mostly permanent and a man and his wife get on well together provided she is faithful, a good worker, reasonably obedient, and punctual with his meals. 'Wife-beating' is common enough, but we must not imagine a man belabouring his woman into submission. The beating consists of an angry blow or two, or perhaps a kick with the sole of the foot, and the wife does not take it lying down but breaks into shrill abuse, paying him back with her tongue. She may go to the length of absenting herself for a period, taking refuge with her own people; and if there are continued disagreements she can leave her husband permanently and the union is severed by the restitution of ornaments. A good many women, boiling with indignation and displaying a bruise or weal, sometimes severe but sometimes hardly visible to the naked eye, have appeared before me at different times to make complaint against their husbands.
As for spiritual and ritual practice, Elema women were largely segregated from the men's house and "almost wholly debarred" from ceremonial life {ibid. :25f.). Women could, if infrequently, be owners of the spectacular hevehe mask-designs (though they never wore them), and female owners could pass them on as they chose, though they were excluded from the many years of preparation and ritual that accompanied their production. In the hevehe ceremonial, women at one point dressed up in male costume with weapons to invite male dancers from other longhouses to attend. Other than this, they tended to be a passive audience rather than active participants in the elaborate ceremonial spectacle {ibid. :323f.). Williams does not comment directly on female pollution beliefs. He does state that during male initiatory seclusion, even the remotest and most indirect contact of the novices with women was said to cause their hair to fall out and to prevent their attaining full growth (Williams 1939a, 1940:76f.). Initiands maintained rigid gender seclusion for six months to a year. Alone among the south coast groups, Elema customs show no evidence of indigenous ritual heterosexuality or female contribution to cosmological fertility. Overall, the status of Elema women seems multivalent. On the one hand, they were excluded from a ceremonial role, and there were implicit beliefs in female pollution and little or no recognition of women's fertility importance in the major cults. Elema women were subject to domestic violence, and they appear to have been constrained by domestic obligations and threat of force by their husbands. This is
Women's status
99
consistent with an Elema male gerontocracy that was stronger than that of the other south coast language-culture areas. But Elema women appear to have been freer in marital choice than their counterparts among Marind and Kiwai, where sister-exchange norms exerted some constraint. And Elema women's dowries, which were their own, afforded them control over significant material property. The various features of female status thus seem conflicted. In this respect, Elema were similar to the Marind, though the particular features of high and low female status were different in each case. Asmat
Though there is little systematic information concerning the status of Asmat women, those features that can be pieced together are revealing. Asmat women were excluded from the elaborate ceremonial life of the men's longhouse (yeu/jew), though they could be admitted under special circumstances (e.g., Eyde 1967:89; cf. also Schneebaum 1980:73; Kuruwaip 1984:pt. 2:19, 25). Polygyny and control of female labor in sago production were a significant dimension of male status differentiation, and in cases of polygynous marriage, second wives "may be little more than drudges" unless they were sisters to the first wife (Eyde 1967:194; cf. Trenkenschuh 1982a:46). Wife-beating was assessed by Eyde (1967:192) to have been quite common among central Asmat, and he says, "only where a wife-beating becomes near-murder, or actually results in murder, will her brothers intervene." He documents four cases that came to his attention in which men in fact murdered their wives. Unmarried women could be beaten by their fathers or brothers for promiscuity (ibid. :220). Men appear to have also exercised rights of control over wives in allocating their sexual services to male bond-friends in ritual heterosexuality (papisj) (ibid. :191). Zegwaard states: Occasionally the woman refuses to participate in this [sexual] exchange. The husband, in such a case, is very angry and upset. He will often beat her and also will disappear to another village for a short time to put his wife to shame. (Zegwaard and Boelaars 1982:22) Sowada (1961:91f.) puts a milder interpretation on such events, stating that though a woman should consent to the papisj arrangement, by showing enough disapproval she could herself influence the choice of her husband's exchange partner. Part of Eyde's (1967:207) account could be construed as supporting this assessment. It may also be noted
100
Critique
that Asmat widows frequently served as "sexual tutors" to unmarried young men (van Kampen 1956:70, cited by Sowada 1961:82). Evidence concerning Asmat marriage is somewhat conflicted but overall suggests low female marital choice. Women were usually five to ten years younger than their husbands (Eyde 1967:198), and exchange reciprocity is described as prospective male in-laws "selecting" an appropriate girl, though her verbal and ritual acquiescence are also noted (ibid. :34), and indeed it is the groom who is ritually "forced" into marriage (Sowada 1961:85-88). Girls were married at puberty or earlier (Zegwaard 1953:3, cited in Sowada 1961:82). In cases of bridewealth marriage the payment was substantial; in one typical and traditional union of this sort bridewealth included eight to ten stone axes, two dog-teeth necklaces, one large triton shell, four bows, a thousand spears and arrows, five to six bone daggers, two birds-of-paradise, and various other feathers and decorations (Trenkenschuh 1982c:31). All this notwithstanding, Zegwaard and Boelaars (1955) document a significant incidence of romantic marriage (worowous), which begins with an extended series of secret trysts. This pattern dovetails with Eyde's (1967:37) remark that sago areas provide u a traditional area for romance between young men and women." Typically, such partners make their intentions public by sleeping in the club house, after which they take refuge with the man's kin until the woman's angry relatives are confronted and bridewealth payment arranged (Sowada 1961:85f.). Asmat women are described as drawn to aggressive husbands renowned for their fierceness and success in headhunting; they disparaged men who had not taken a head and hence remained politically unimportant (e.g., Zegwaard 1959; Zegwaard and Boelaars 1982). That this male aggression also extended to the procuring of women themselves is evident in marriage by abduction, that is, marriage undertaken by capturing a woman against her will and against the wishes of her relatives but followed eventually by payment of bridewealth to the latter. Such marriages, termed okore, constituted eight percent (8/102) of Zegwaard and Boelaars' (1955) sample. In addition to these, abduction of wives without repayment was described as "rampant" (see Sowada 1961:87). Upon marriage, an Asmat woman changed her kindred-group affiliation to that of her husband (van Arsdale 1975:37). As for property ownership, the sago stands andfishinggrounds that a husband gained by virtue of his marriage became his own and were alienated from his wife. Central Asmat thus
Women's status
101
call the husbands, not the wives, the owners, ar arat ow, of sago orfishingareas to which they have gained a right by marriage. Just as a sister is given to her husband, so are her sago paths andfishingareas. (Eyde 1967:255) Women could inherit rights to important song cycles and were ceremonially given ancestral names that perhaps associated them with their husband's kin group (van Arsdale and van Arsdale 1991:20). An elder woman might sit in on men's political discussions and raise women's objections, and she could also lead women in their ceremonial roles (Sowada 1990:68). Evidence concerning pollution beliefs is sketchy but suggestive. Men slept in the men's house away from their wives when the latter were menstruating, and the house built for women in childbirth was "absolutely taboo to men" (Eyde 1967:89, 147). Sorcery was attributed exclusively to women, and Eyde (ibid. :147) suggests that central Asmat men "generally assume that women are hostile to them." Nevertheless, Sowada (1961:81) cites a report that the wife and daughter of one of the most renowned Asmat leaders were shamans. Asmat women complemented men's participation in at least some ceremonies and joined them in the ritual sexuality of collective spouse-exchange at several major rites and in times of political or perceived cosmological crisis. But they were not as complementary or integral to male cult life as were women to the north among the Kamoro (Pouwer 1991:206ff.) or further south among the Marind. The making and empowerment of elaborate ancestral cult embodiments in the men's house was an exclusive male activity. In all, available evidence suggests that Asmat women were subject to a high rate of marital violence, did not control significant material property, often had little marital choice, were subject to some sexual pollution beliefs, but could be active participants in fertility cult activities and might even be spiritual leaders. Kolopom
Information on the status of Kolopom women is piecemeal, but important facts emerge. Women were betrothed in sister-exchange as young girls and were subjected at about age eight to ten to serial sexual intercourse by adult men. The purpose of this coitus was to procure sexual fluids for rubbing on the girl's groom-to-be, to help him grow. When the adolescent boy moved into the bachelors' house, the young girl betrothed to him moved into his parents' house, after which the boy's father exercised sexual as well as social authority over her
102
Critique
(Serpenti 1984:307). Girls were targeted for serial sexual intercourse especially before headhunts, after selected mortuary feasts, and at the onset of male initiation (ibid. :304, 315). Girls were betrothed as youngsters in part to reduce their opposition to arranged marriage. Once the exchange of girls in betrothal was agreed on, any protests the girl might make were countered by her father's remonstration that the agreement had already been sealed by the drinking of kava (wati) with her prospective parents-in-law (Serpenti 1969:38). As the exchange relationship between the prospective affines deepened, it was increasingly difficult to dissolve the betrothal (ibid. :39). During adolescence but before marriage, a woman might pursue discreet sexual liaisons with a man of her choosing, but these affairs were seldom allowed to compromise her prior betrothal. The options of romantic couples who were going against parents' wishes were few. They could flee in elopement to another village, but this course was dangerous; other villages tended to be hostile, and travelling to them was frequently considered a form of suicide (Serpenti 1968:132). Sometimes a disgruntled woman would indeed take a lethal or sub-lethal dose of poison (Serpenti 1977:182). Alternatively, she might risk a quick elopement with a man visiting from another village, returning with him to his settlement (ibid. :127). Armed protection by her new husband's kin was in this instance crucial, since her relatives were certain to try to take her back by force. If her new husband's kin protected her, the woman might have her first daughter appropriated and given back to her natal settlement in exchange for herself. Beliefs in female sexual pollution appear to have been stronger among Kolopom than anywhere else along the south coast. Men exhibited great fear of menstrual blood, particularly in all gardening pursuits, and numerous precautions were taken to avoid it, including seclusion of women in menstrual huts. Sexual intercourse with adult women was prohibited especially during planting, when men were growing ceremonial crops, before hunting or fighting, during drummaking, when mortuary feasts were being prepared, and during periods of homosexual male cult activity (Serpenti 1977:179). Fear of menstrual contamination may well have underlain the use of prepubescent girls in ritual coitus to obtain sexual secretions for promoting the growth of male initiands (Serpenti 1984:310). Serpenti (ibid.:295) notes that "the fear of heterosexual intercourse in crisis situations sometimes leads to a general avoidance of women." Stringent taboos against even indirect contact with women for everyone connected with male initiation
Women's status
103
epitomized beliefs in the inimicability of women to maleness. This was reinforced in tales of the Kone demon-woman, who tempted men with sex and cut off the penises of enticed victims, taking them home as trophies {ibid. :294). Nonetheless, promiscuous heterosexual intercourse with adult women as well as with girls was an important part of the final feast of the competitive ndambu mortuary ceremonial, when a previous ban on heterosexual activity was lifted, and before and after headhunting expeditions (ibid. :300f.; Serpenti 1977:183). Wives could also be lent as payment for debts between men (ibid. :184). In sum, available information suggests that Kolopom women were subject to (a) little marital choice; (b) sexual domination from a young age; (c) stringent pollution beliefs; and (d) exclusion from male ritual life. Women owned their own subsistence implements but appear to have been excluded from possessing valuables, land, or other significant property, all of which were held by the men of the village ward (kwanda) (ibid.: 120-24). Some wife-beating occurred (ibid.:181), but its relative incidence is difficult to discern. Overall, the status of Kolopom women appears to have been low. Trans-Fly Female status was also low among Trans-Fly peoples, as exemplified by the Keraki studied by Williams (1936). Keraki women were betrothed and transferred when quite young. As among the Kolopom - to whom Trans-Fly peoples appear to have been linguistically and historically related - evidence suggests that Keraki men exercised sexual prerogatives over females before they were pubescent (Williams 1936:146). This is consistent with the Keraki belief that sexual intercourse itself caused the onset of menstruation. Female choice in marriage was virtually nil: The [marital] arrangements, as we have seen, are almost entirely in the hands of the men: it is between them that the pact is made and all that is expected from the prospective wives is acquiescence. At first the latter are for the most part too young to take a very intelligent interest in their future, and certainly too young to make their possibly adverse wishes felt among their elders; though as the affianced bride grows up she may very effectually express her aversion for her husband, either before or after consummation of the marriage, by running away. This indeed occurs frequently enough; but the girl is continually brought back from her parent's village to that of her husband's, (ibid. :137) Williams (ibid. :131f) contrasts the conspicuous absence of courtship and of female assent with the pattern he found among the Purari and Elema
104
Critique
further east. Divorce was also uncommon and difficult for a Keraki woman to bring about. Sister-exchange marriage among Keraki was strongly prescriptive between clans. Men without a true or closely related clan sister used bridewealth to procure a classificatory female sibling from their more distant agnates. This woman was then deployed in marital exchange. This two-step process of internal bridewealth and external marital transfer could significantly reduce a woman's social and negotiating contact with prospective mates. Polygyny and taking young wives was quite common among Keraki, and forty-five percent of married men had more than one wife (ibid. :149). During the long period of marriage itself, a Keraki woman was subject to the domination of her husband and his clan: Under the patrilocal system and the levirate the bride becomes virtually the property of her husband's group and she is usually in fairly complete subjection to him personally, (ibid. :148) The sexual services of wives were lent (apparently without their consent) to visitors at feasts; visiting men reciprocated by lending their wives at a later date. Williams (1936:159) suggests that wife-lending "is essentially an act of hospitality or friendship," and it is noteworthy that "it was never suggested that wundewunde [wife-exchange] implied any ulterior purpose, e.g., the promotion of fertility." Effective marital subordination of women made wife-beating largely unnecessary; Williams (ibid. :148) remarks, "An obstreperous or disobedient wife may receive a cuff on the ear and is quickly reduced thereby to a submissive mood; but wife-beating is very rare and I do not know of any Keraki husband who could be called cruel." Desertion by a wife, however, particularly by a young wife to a lover in her natal village, was severely punished. After being returned by her own kin, such a woman could be communally raped by the men of her husband's clan. Directed by the husband himself, this serial rape was undertaken "to tame her recalcitrant spirit" (ibid. .164). Women owned no significant property apart from subsistence and personal implements (ibid. :148). Men appear to have harbored strong beliefs in female menstrual and sexual pollution. Men observed several food taboos while their wives were menstruating and feared that exposure to female sexuality would contaminate their bullroarer and initiation practices (ibid. :183, 335). In
Women's status
105
the primal myth, highly secret to men, Woman's vagina and her first menstruation were created when the first bullroarer was wrenched out of her pubic area. While rendering this story, Ayres' (1983:74) male informant noted: When a woman has her monthly period, she doesn't work, she doesn't go to the garden. She just sits. She doesn't eat meat either. We still do these things today. Women were considered highly inimical to the rituals of the male initiation cycle, from which they were emphatically barred. Williams (ibid.: 149) notes: A woman has no political power . . . Nor are there any female practitioners in the accredited branches of magic . . . Lastly they have only an insignificant share in public ceremonial, and no share at all in the esoteric rites or in a knowledge of the sacred myths. Writing of mortuary customs in the same area a half-century later, Mary Ayres (1983:300f.) states, the overwhelming dominance of maleness in Morehead culture is manifested in mourning customs. Men are the preeminent cultural beings who know the inner secrets, the esoteric mythology which accounts for the meaning of many customs. Men control the meanings of things, just as they control women. Williams sums up for the Keraki, "The stature of women in marriage is undeniably very low" (1936:148). Comparative assessments
Female status varies greatly among south New Guinea societies along the criteria of female status delineated above, that is, mate choice, low spousal violence, significant female property ownership, valued participation of women in rituals, and absence of pollution beliefs (see table 6). Indeed, given the larger cultural similarities among all these groups, as discussed in chapter 2, this variation is striking. Female status was very high among Kiwai and especially Purari, conflicted but slightly positive among Marind-anim, slightly lower among Elema, low among Asmat, and very low among Kolopom and Keraki. It lends credence to this range of variation that the three groups studied by F. E. Williams happen to encompass the entire spectrum of female status documented, including high (Purari), medium or neutral (Elema), and low (Trans-Fly). That this range of variation was uncovered and reported in separate cases by a single ethnographer with no theoretical reason to gerrymander such variations makes it unlikely that
106
Critique
Table 6. Comparative estimates offemale status in south coast New Guinea mate low marital property ritual value & choice violence owned participation Purari Kiwai Marind Elema Asmat Kolopom Trans-Fly
++ +/+/++ (-) —
++ ++ — ? +/-
++ ++ ? + -
+/++ + + -
no female pollution
overall0
+ + (-) — (-)
7 5 1 0 -4 -5 -5
+ + strongly positive + moderately positive +/- conflicting; evidence of both positive and negative features negative — strongly negative ? unknown a A rough overall comparative index of female status (final column) is assessed by according each " + + " a value of +2, each " + " a value of +1, each "+/-" (some evidence both for and against) a value of 0, each "?" a value of 0, each "-" a value of-1, and each "—" a value of-2. Indices in parentheses indicate assessments based on circumstantial evidence.
they could be accounted for by idiosyncrasies of ethnographer bias or selective reporting.6 Further, the dimensions of female status considered here appear culturally salient within the south New Guinea context; they reflect local differences in the way female status is experienced and perceived by indigenous actors.7 What accounts for variations in female status along the New Guinea south coast? Perhaps female status varies inversely with the presence of ritual homosexuality; the custom was present in the two languageculture areas where female status was lowest, Trans-Fly and Kolopom. But female status was above average among the Marind-anim, where ritual homosexuality was quite evident. Outside the range of coastal cultures but relevant to this question are data from the StricklandBosavi area, further inland. These suggest that the status of women may be relatively high in some south lowland societies where ritual homosexuality was practiced.8 Conversely, the central Asmat, among whom ritual homosexuality was highly doubtful, exhibited low female status. In all, female status was both low and moderate to relatively high in culture areas where ritual homosexuality was practiced, and female status was low, medium, and high in culture areas where the custom was definitely or likely absent. Neither Feil's assessment nor Herdt's concerning the association of ritual homosexuality with female status is
Women's status
107
borne out. It can be concluded that there is no consistent association between ritual homosexuality and low (or high) female status in south New Guinea. Similar noncorrespondence is found between female status and sister-exchange marriage. This is epitomized by the fact that marital decisions could include a significant degree of female choice in culture areas, such as Marind and Kiwai, where sister-exchange was practiced.9 The overall status of women was not low among Marind or Kiwai, and among Kiwai it was quite high. On the other hand, sister-exchange did associate with very low female status among Kolopom and Trans-Fly people. Thus sister-exchange associates with either low or moderate-tohigh female status. For societies in which marital exchange was truly prescriptive and onerous for women - enforced by binding agreements concerning girls when they were quite young - it did betoken lower female status. Where sister-exchange in fact accommodated a significant degree of female marital choice, however, the status of women could be high. These alternatives demand empirical assessment in each case and cannot be deduced structurally from sister-exchange norms alone. There is no relationship between female status and cannibalism. Whole-body cannibalism of headhunt victims was pronounced among Purari, among whom the status of women was high, and also among Asmat, where female status was low (Williams 1924:107-109; Zegwaard 1959; cf. also Serpenti 1968:122 for the Kolopom). Conversely, cannibalism of enemy victims was minimal - ritual eating of small body fragments only - among both the Kiwai, where female status was high, and in the Trans-Fly, where female status was low (Williams 1936:280; Landtman 1927:151). In addition, low female status is not directly related to the importance of warriorhood for male prestige. Warrior prowess was highly emphasized among Purari and Asmat, among whom female status was respectively high and low. Male warriorhood was also important among the Marind, among whom female status was slightly positive; conversely, it was fairly unimportant (relative to gardening prowess in particular) among Kolopom, Trans-Fly, and Elema peoples, among whom female status was low-to-medium. The lack of association between warfare emphasis and low female status appears to undercut the argument of Langness (1967, 1974) and others who have suggested that sexual antagonism and male domination in New Guinea were associated with endemic warfare that placed a functional premium on male solidarity and promoted gender division and sexual hostility. Indeed, if
108
Critique
Table 7. Female status and importance of male warrior prestige Female status
Importance of successful warriorhood to male prestige* High
High Medium Low
Purari Kiwai Marind Asmat
Low
Elema Kolopom Trans-Fly
a
As one index of "high" versus "low" warriorhood emphasis, the Marind, Purari, Asmat, and Kiwai emphasized the importance of taking heads as a prerequisite for a man to marry, to give head-names to children, to rejuvenate cult sacrae, or to obtain significant wealth. None of these characteristics applied to Kolopom, Trans-Fly, or Elema peoples.
the Asmat are excepted, a perfect correlation appears between emphasis on male warriorhood and high rather than low female status (see table 7). This conclusion is corroborated on a much larger scale by Whyte's (1978:129f.) under-appreciated cross-cultural analysis, which considered nine dimensions of female status in pre-state societies and found that warfare did not correlate with low female status. As in the present analysis, he found that important dimensions of female status correlated positively with warfare, including a relative paucity of wife-beating.10 Since male warfare success is largely dependent on men's own activity and effort, this association could be construed as supporting the notion that female status is relatively higher in societies where men can attain prestige through activities that do not depend on the appropriation of female labor. What else associates with female status? Interestingly, groups with low female status relied on root crops for their starch staple (Trans-Fly, Kolopom; see table 2, chapter 4). Conversely, as shown in table 8, those with highest female status relied on sago (Purari, Kiwai), and those with mixed dependence on both sago and root crops had intermediate female status (Marind, Elema). Though Asmat remained a deviant case, it may be significant that though sago production along the south coast entails much higher inputs of female than male labor, this labor is often if not typically undertaken by groups of women. In contrast, root crop gardening takes much higher labor inputs per unit of edible food than does sago, and it almost invariably entails a significant amount of male as well as female work - for instance, in felling trees and building fences as well as digging the soil. In terms of the social organization of production, female labor in cultivating root
Women's status
109
Table 8. Female status and starch staple subsistence
Female status
Starch subsistence staple Sago
High
Tubers
Purari Kiwai Marind Elema
Medium Low
Mixed (Sago/Tubers)
Asmat
Kolopom Trans-Fly
crops tends to be individuated and dovetailed with the labor of a husband or agnate. (Sago processing, in contrast, is frequently undertaken collectively by groups of women, who can work the palm to completion once it has been chopped down.) In political terms, correspondingly, root crop gardening contrasts with sago production in being much more frequently associated both with men's status aspirations in subsistence exchange and with their dependence on female labor in these pursuits. This is well illustrated by Kiwai and Elema, who used root crops in competitive exchanges even though they relied largely on sago as a daily starch staple. The cultural significance of root crops versus sago is reflected in fertility and pollution beliefs. The fertility power of women's sexuality was usually irrelevant if not inimical to root crop cultivation - as exemplified, for instance, in practices and beliefs found among Kolopom, Keraki, and Elema. In contrast, female sexuality was often considered positively related to the growth of sago palms where these were central to subsistence, for instance, among Kiwai, Marind, and Asmat. In short, the association between high female status and male warrior prestige, subsistence emphasis on sago production, and absence of root crops as a starch staple all provide circumstantial support for the notion that female status is higher where male prestige is not defined through activities that depend on the appropriation of female labor. This conclusion dovetails with the suggestions of Ortner and Whitehead (1981) that female status is strongly influenced by women's relationship to the circumstances and activities associated with the attainment of male prestige. Such a relationship helps explain low female status among groups such as Keraki and Asmat, among whom highly polygynous men were
110
Critique
strongly dependent on female labor for exchange and leadership. A closer consideration of other south coast culture areas suggests, however, that this relationship is not as straightforward as it may at first appear. The status of women was particularly high among Purari and Kiwai, but in these societies male competitive exchange was similarly based in significant part on leaders' ability to command female labor through polygyny (see table 3, chapter 4). The Kolopom gender system was particularly revealing in this respect, since female status was low but men's status in competitive exchange was mostly dependent on their own skill and effort in gardening. Indeed, male gardening practices were stringently guarded against female pollution. This protection was especially true for the cultivation of the largest tubers that epitomized competitive food exchange - a pattern reminiscent of the relationship between long-yam raising and gender pollution beliefs in the Sepik (e.g., Tuzin 1972). Polygyny was uncommon among the Kolopom (Serpenti 1977:132). Among Elema as well, gardening was mostly a male pursuit and polygyny rare, yet female status was not particularly high. The conflicting nature of these findings suggest that though female status is likely to be influenced by women's relationship to practices that confer male prestige, the exact nature of this relationship demands further analysis. Several important questions emerge. To what degree was men's prestige in groups such as Kiwai and Purari linked to the magnitude of women's surplus sago production? Were shell ornaments and other valuables that were prestigious in male exchange obtained in (indirect) reciprocity for gifts of female-produced food, or were gifts of sago (or tubers) considered a separate sphere of exchange? Among Purari, a wife's ritual sexual liaisons procured wealth ornaments for the couple jointly, and though subsistence production was generally "not involved in wealth-status rankings" (Maher 1961:80), armshells were nonetheless bought from indigenous Motu trading parties with large quantities of sago (Barton 1910:115). Among Elema, wealth ornaments were procured primarily through gifts of pork. In short, the valuables that conferred male prestige could derive from various sources. To determine the relationship between men's prestige and their reliance on female labor, it is necessary to determine in each culture area what proportion of valuables were obtained through differing means and what the respective roles of women were in each. Further important questions emerge concerning various dimensions of male prestige. What was the relative balance between prestige
Women's status
111
obtained by men in feast-giving as opposed to warrior prowess in societies in which both were important? How did the relative importance of these activities change over the course of the male life cycle? To what extent did ascribed status categories such as rank (Purari) or gerontocracy (Elema) arbitrarily restrict the classes of men vying for prestige through competitive exchange; were all men equally dependent on female labor for their status, or only some? Was this dependence similar for younger men as opposed to middle-aged or older men? Unfortunately, none of these questions can be adequately answered for south coast culture areas, given the information available. We are thus left with the pregnant but partial conclusion that female status, male prestige, and the appropriation of female labor are related in complex ways that demand more refined consideration. The questions raised in reaching this conclusion, however, are potentially valuable; they are empirically answerable in principle and may be useful in further fieldwork and analysis to illuminate the relationship between female status, male prestige, and the appropriation of female labor along the south coast and in other regions. An important analysis that considers these issues among the Etoro of the Strickland-Bosavi area is in process by Kelly (n.d.). Female status and fertility cultism
Gender relations along south coast New Guinea were highly influenced by cosmological beliefs concerning the relationship between women, men, and spiritual and biotic fertility. The most important recent attempt to consider these relationships is Whitehead's (1986) comparative analysis of New Guinea fertility cults. Whitehead suggests that clanship as a fertility idiom was less prominent in lowland than in highland New Guinea, where the "cult of clan" and the connection between clan ancestors and social fertility were strong. For the south lowlands, by contrast, she suggests that "cult of man" and particularly "cult of man-woman" were prominent but that the "cult of clan" was relatively unimportant. It is difficult, however, to classify south coast New Guinea languageculture regions as exemplifying "cult of man," "cult of man-woman," or "cult of clan." These difficulties reveal larger problems of typological analysis and link to difficulties in explaining female status: the great complexity and range of variation in female status along the south coast belies a correspondence with mutually exclusive fertility cult types as structural bases of male domination.
112
Critique
Language-culture areas along the south coast combined cross-cutting currents of patrifiliation, male-exclusive culthood, and incorporation of female fertility. For instance, Elema and Kiwai placed strong emphasis on patrilineal totem-clanship and identified the large male longhouse with a single patrifiliative group, making it similar in significant respects to a clan parish. Williams (1940:40) details how patriclanship formed the dominant idiom of the large longhouse, founded by an original patrilineage, and how this clan identity and corresponding land rights were extended to in-migrants from other kin groups over a period of a generation or more (see also Holmes 1924:ch.ll). The ultimate result was that "the given local group becomes a [patronymic] descent group." As noted by Schwimmer (1977:23), the details of Williams' account suggest great similarity with the cumulative patrifiliation analyzed by Barnes (1962,1967) for the New Guinea highlands. Even among the most decentralized groups of inland south lowland New Guinea, clan parish social organization can be found. For the Yonggom, Kirsch (1991:15) writes, "typically a clan was divided into several segments, each living in a separate hamlet within a radius of several kilometers." Patterns of cumulative patrifiliation were strongly evident; descendants of non-agnates became affiliated with the local clan and could generally acquire clan membership as well as full property rights (ibid.). Gaining and exchanging shell "money" by raising pigs, exchanging pork, transacting bridewealth, and going on trading expeditions were highly important (Schoorl 1976). Among Kiwai, very large men's houses were associated with individual totem-clans. Landtman (1927:8) states, "In former times it seems to have been the rule that every sufficiently larger totem clan in a village occupied a communal house of its own, which bore the same name as the clan . . ." J. Weiner (1988b) has suggested that Purari had features of social organization that on some dimensions of structural-functional reasoning resembled a segmentary lineage system. For the Marind, the South Pacific Commission Report (1952-53:58f.) suggests that the men's house was a kind of small clan-parish unit within a larger community of several clans.11 Among Asmat, the cognatic club house held exclusive territorial rights and could grow through the absorption of unrelated refugees who changed kin-group affiliation and became members of the dominant or "trunk" group of the village (Sowada 1961:57, 60, 67; Bureau for Native Affairs 1957:29). Eyde (p.c. 1992) suggests that Asmat succession to longhouse sections was patrifilial. Worship of clan ancestors and beliefs in their link to the living were
Women's status
113
highly developed and sometimes central to the cult life of several south coast groups. This emphasis is reflected in the fe-pole ceremonies of the central Asmat (Zegwaard 1954; Konrad et al. 1981); the horiomu ancestor cult of the Kiwai (Landtman 1927:ch.23); and the descent of mana-like power from spirit ancestors through chiefs' genealogies among the Purari (Maher 1961:ch.2; 1974). These cult forms did not preclude and indeed underscored the association between diverse patrifiliative groups that Whitehead emphasizes for lowland areas. These affiliations occurred especially through ritual dualism and were elaborate among Kolopom, Marind, Asmat, and Purari. My point, however, is that idioms of large-scale patrifiliative integration could also be important; these are not mutually exclusive alternatives. Just as the ostensible "patrilineal" norms of the highlands have been shown to be idioms allowing diverse cross-clan affiliations (A. Strathern 1972; Feil 1984; Wagner 1967), so, conversely, affiliation between diverse totem clans along the south coast co-existed with important recourse to patrifiliative idioms. As James Weiner (1988b) has recently suggested, this pattern does not suggest a simple opposition between highland and lowland forms of social organization predicated on structural-functional distinctions. Rather, it reveals the complex process whereby diverse cultural idioms creatively elaborate a range of sociopolitical affiliations. This process continues to evolve in the post-colonial era as new idioms of regional and national identity are negotiated along with existing affiliations of kinship and residence. As Lederman (1989) and M. Strathern (1988) have suggested, such broadening of structuralfunctionalist assumptions is also important in refining our understanding of New Guinea gender systems. Concerning female status, it would be correspondingly difficult to argue that a "manhood" or "clanhood" fertility cult presages low female status or that a "male-female" fertility cult presages higher female status.12 Most south coast groups practiced several different fertility cults; among Kiwai, Marind, Purari, and Asmat, some of these strongly emphasized exclusive "manship," but others strongly emphasized malefemale complementarity. The "cult of man" would appear to have been highly developed among the Purari, and yet female status was high (see Williams 1923b; Holmes 1902). Conversely, Marind emphasized a combination of male and female contributions to fertility, but the status of Marind women was quite close to that among the Elema, where female contributions to fertility were virtually nil. Sexual incorporation
114
Critique
of women into fertility cultism was in some respects significant among the Asmat, where the status of women appears to have been low. The status of women was high among Kiwai, who had significant dimensions of "cult of clan" and "cult of man" as well as "cult of man-woman." The point, then, is that the range of south coast ethnographic variation belies easy categorization into Whitehead's fertility cult types, and those classifications that might be posited do not correlate as one might have hoped with variations in female status. Conclusions
South coast New Guinea encompassed striking variations in female status: very high, medium/neutral, low, and very low. These variants did not correlate with the presence or absence of: -ritual homosexuality -sister-exchange -cannibalism -fertility cult emphasis on manhood, clanhood, or male-female complementarity A partial correlation exists between high female status and prestige importance or prominence of male warriorhood, between high female status and primary subsistence staple reliance on sago, and, correspondingly, between low female status and primary subsistence staple reliance on cultivated tubers. The relationship between female status and male prestige reliance on female labor is equivocal and demands greater scrutiny, suggesting that a more refined consideration is needed of the relationship between male status, prestige-related activities, and the sexual division of labor than is possible here. The importance of prestige-related labor (and not simply labor contributions overall) is underscored by the cross-cultural findings of Whyte (1978:146) that there is little connection between female status and either female subsistence contributions in the aggregate or female subsistence organization. Overall, our evidence highlights the difficulty of accounting for female status on the basis of factors usually deemed significant in the analysis of New Guinea cultures despite significant ranges of variation in all of the would-be predictors along the south coast. This conclusion is itself compromised by the small number of cases (only seven) but is buttressed qualitatively by the high face value of the data considered, which make clear the weaknesses of the hypothesized associations. These findings support Whyte's (1978:ch.5) general conclusion that
Women's status
115
dimensions of female status are not easily collapsed into a unitary factor and are not easily explained by prime-mover determinants or correlates. The postmodern feminist implications of his conclusion, however, remain to be drawn: not only does female status, like sexuality, not cohere internally as a single entity, but the very attempt to consider it in these terms can impose an analytic strait jacket on the analysis. The kind of analysis pursued in this chapter, though it is valuable for evaluating existing generalizations, needs to be transformed when it comes to positing a better alternative. This conclusion suggests that a more dynamic and processual consideration of female status is necessary. In particular, female status needs to be viewed alongside constellations of inequality that play out among status groups of men and between ethnic groups; inequality between genders is deeply interrelated with the development of other forms of inequality. Since the criteria of worth and status may differ importantly in different culture areas, this relationship needs to be considered at least initially on a case by case basis. This last point may be elaborated. Standardized indexing and typological sorting have inherent limitations in the study of gender inequality; if gender inequality is in important respects a cultural attribution - a differential moral worth attributed to men and women - then the axes of this valuation may differ from case to case.13 For instance, a factor such as presence of menstrual pollution beliefs may not correspond with an equally high degree of female disparagement in all instances; the link between pollution and female disparagement was strong among Kolopom but weak among Kiwai, for whom female sexual pollution simultaneously betokened women's positive sexual value and power. Social indices of female status must stay constant to be useful for comparative analysis, but those particular features that encode prestige and moral worth may be highly variable from culture to culture. Both of these dimensions of female status are important. Neglecting cultural valuations sets up etic discriminators that may not adequately reflect inequality as it is culturally promulgated. But limiting the analysis to cultural evaluation is to risk adopting an ideology that may be compromised if not belied in practice by power relations and behavior. Both of these alternatives are one-sided: it is the relationship between cultural perception and practical result that is central in gender equality and inequality - both for defining these relations and for maintaining or changing them over time. These considerations suggest that cultural and cosmological dimensions of south New Guinea groups need to be analyzed in conjunction
116
Critique
with the historical patterns of power and practice through which they were actualized. Notwithstanding the difficulty of applying Whitehead's categories to the specifics of south coast ethnography, she has taken a very important first step in initiating this kind of integrated analysis in the New Guinea context. In a sense, the problem of applying her model is one of comparative scale as discussed in chapters 3 and 4; features that seem germane as broad-brush contrasts between large ethnographic regions (such as the New Guinea lowlands versus highlands) appear less satisfactory as the complex range of variation within regions is considered. In each of the constituent culture areas of south coast New Guinea, gender relationship, cosmology, cult organization, and sociopolitical organization were intertwined in a distinctive gestalt-like configuration of internal reinforcement and development. To analyze this interaction with respect to gender inequality, we can draw on an important recent statement by Ortner (1990a). She suggests that the extent and configuration of male dominance versus male-female equality is variable depending on the distinctive interface between cultural valuation of prestige and the political economy of power in each case. The goal is not to assess universals in either the symbolism or behavior of gender, but to illuminate patterns of equality/inequality that link culture and action - to consider dominant patterns of connection between gender prestige and male-female socioeconomic and political inequality in individual cases. Ortner suggests that sociocultural formations do tend towards identifiable patterns of gender hegemony, but that these are empirically variable and cannot be ascertained on the basis of a priori structural assumptions. She further suggests that in any given case, one is likely to find subordinate tendencies that cross-cut dominant ones - minor themes that provide potentially transformatory "counterhegemonies" for the society in question {ibid. :46). In this way, sociocultural formations mediate diverse and even strongly opposed potentials for the development of gender relationships. It is crucial to identify the processes that inform this mediation. Ortner's perspective fits well with the range and diversity of female status both between and within the language-culture areas of south coast New Guinea. It also provides a theoretical impetus beyond the tabulation of female status as an inductive composite of isolated traits, on the one hand, and the establishment of static typologies, on the other. It is at this point that gender links to the theoretical issues raised in chapter 1, that is, the dialectic between cultural impetus and politicoeconomic actualization. These issues will be reengaged in part 3 of the present work.
Trends in comparative analysis
Chapters 3-5 above illustrate several tendencies in the comparative analysis of ethnographic regions: 1 Particularly on initial analysis, the features considered "characteristic" of a culture area tend to emerge through explicit or implicit contrast with other areas.
Every "figure" requires a "ground." For instance, Melanesia emerged as the region of "Big Man" societies particularly when configured against the "chiefdoms" of Polynesia (Sahlins 1963); interior areas of New Guinea were seen as "secular" in comparison with the "religious" bent of the coastal seaboard (Lawrence and Meggitt 1965). More recently, the New Guinea south lowlands have been asserted to have "low politicoeconomic intensity" and to be "homosexual" and "manhood emphasizing" when configured against the "high politicoeconomic intensity," "heterosexuality," and "clanship" of the highlands. To a significant extent these assessments stem from the terms of contrast themselves. How different south New Guinea fertility cult and sexual practices would seem if configured by regional contrast to northern Australia, native America, or lowland Amazonia, as opposed to the New Guinea highlands. How different the characterizations of highland New Guinea political or religious systems would be if configured as variants of the power-dominant or "open" status systems of Polynesia, rather than as a polar contrast between "Big Men" or "Great Men" and "chiefs" (cf. Goldman 1970).
118
Critique
2 The features deemed "characteristic" of a culture area vary depending on the geographic contours of the area, and the contours chosen reflect much about analytic agendas as well as ethnographic differences.
Whether south lowland New Guinea can be considered "heterosexual" or "homosexual" depends in part on whether priority is given to the more populous coastal regions, along an extensive east-west axis, or to areas that extend from a narrow coastal section inland to less populated areas. On a larger scale, if Melanesia is perceived to be an area where competitive Big Man or Great Man leadership is paramount but rank and chiefly authority are absent (Sahlins 1963; Godelier 1986), "Melanesia" may be tacitly configured to exclude Fiji and to conceptually marginalize areas such as New Caledonia, the Trobriand Islands, and the Mekeo, which become the cultural equivalent of "Polynesian outliers" (see critique by Douglas 1979; Chowning 1979). If, by contrast, the insular South Pacific is taken as a more inclusive general region, Melanesian "exceptions" become linkages to other areas in the Pacific, minimizing the distinction between Melanesia and Polynesia, as Thomas (1989a) has recently proposed. 3a Large-scale comparisons between ethnographic areas or conceptual types are almost invariably compromised by considering smaller-scale ranges of variation within each individual area or type. 3b Disagreements about appropriate comparative features frequently result from differences in the scale of analysis.
Comparative analysis progresses by positing typologies of large-scale areal or conceptual variation and then critically confronting these with ranges of variation within smaller areas or with exceptional cases. It is almost axiomatic that large-scale types will be modified if not refuted as the complexities of local-level processes and variations are taken into account. It can thus be expected that Big Manship as a coherent leadership type is exploded once the varieties and complexities of indigenous leadership within Melanesia are considered; indeed, the longevity of the Big Man model is striking given the number of critiques it has been subjected to. 1 Analogously, the secular nature of highland New Guinea becomes questionable once its cultural impetus is more carefully considered (e.g., J. Weiner 1982; Wagner 1972; M. Strathern 1988; LiPuma 1988). Conversely, the elaborate politicoeconomic (as well as religious) dimensions of insular Melanesia emerge as the region is more richly documented (e.g., Young 1971; Leach and Leach 1983; Clay
Trends in comparative analysis
119
1986; Brunton 1975; Salisbury 1970; A. Carrier and J. Carrier 1989). In a similar vein, chapters 3-5 illustrate, among other things, that as south coast New Guinea is more closely scrutinized, it becomes highly questionable whether the region was characterized by low intensity political economy, ritual homosexuality, or distinct "cults of man" and "cults of man-woman." The point is not that areal contrasts do not exist but that the process of inferring contrasts tacitly presumes an ideal type - typically in polar contrast to another region - that tends on closer scrutiny to be found unsatisfactory. When assessments propose inter-regional differences, they tend to assume uniformity within each of the regions compared. This uniformity is dispelled once the scale of comparison is reduced and a range of ethnographic variation is considered within each region. The same process occurs conceptually as ideal types not rigidly tied to regional boundaries are proposed and subsequently refuted. For instance, the global contrast drawn by Collier (1988; Collier and Rosaldo 1981) between various types of "brideservice" and "bridewealth" societies practically begs for ethnographic refutation and theoretical recontextualization in Melanesia (e.g., Wood 1987; Kelly n.d.). And within New Guinea, typologies of "cult of clan" versus "cult of man" or "cult of man-woman" (Whitehead 1986) become difficult to apply unambiguously once a range of cases is considered. An extended illustration of these points emerges in recent discussions of Melanesian "Great Men" and "Big Men." Godelier (1982, 1986) suggested that Sahlins' Big Man leadership type was limited largely to core areas of the New Guinea highlands and that his own category of "Great Man" - grounded in his analysis of leadership among the Baruya of the Anga region - applied to many other parts of New Guinea. In important ways, Godelier replaced a Melanesia versus Polynesia leadership typology (Big Man versus chief) with one within Melanesia (Big Man versus Great Man). The larger typology was refuted and replaced by one at a smaller scale of analysis. However, the smaller-scale typology replicates the same structural tendencies as the larger one and is likely itself to be inadequate once the range of variation among "Great Man societies" is considered. This trend is evident in Godelier and Strathern's edited collection Big Men and Great Men in Melanesia (1991). The book's contributors make the Great Man versus Big Man dichotomy squirm if not dissolve by confronting it with a plethora of intermediate cases, counterexamples,
120
Critique
and intra-societal diversity. It is a measure of the volume's strength that neither Godelier nor his contributors talk past each other; the dialectic between high-level generalization and lower-level refutation is self-consciously maintained as cross-fertilization rather than polarizing into mutually exclusive levels of analysis. To maintain this tension, however, Godelier's Great Man category expands and proliferates while the once-hegemonic notion of Big Man becomes so small and restrictive that it threatens to disappear as an indigenous form. The contributors to Big Men and Great Men consistently suggest that the classic Big Man emphasis on complex and competitive material exchange was intensified if not enabled by Western influence in the course of colonial pacification.2 Even Godelier is surprised to find how rare indigenous Big Men seem to have been (1991:296), and Marilyn Strathern's (1991) introduction and Roy Wagner's (1991) contribution emphasize the ethnographic relativity of Great Man versus Big Man characterizations. That many Melanesianists could now consider "Big Manship" to be (in significant part) a chimerical rendering of indigenous leadership is rather jarring given the concept's previous preeminence in analyses of New Guinea political systems. It is perhaps but a short step from colonial facilitation of Big Manship to seeing it partly (but by no means wholly) as a project of Western post-World War Two cultural attitudes, that is, reflecting back to us our own emphasis on competitive individualism and aggressive materialism. One recalls Sahlins' (1963:289) classic assessment: The Melanesian big-man seems so thoroughly bourgeois, so reminiscent of the free enterprising rugged individual of our own heritage. In contrast, Marilyn Strathern (1988) and others have strongly questioned the tendency of Western ethnographers to assume the selfinterested individual as our basic unit of analysis, particularly when we study people who may have a much stronger notion of collective identity than we do. In recognizing this, we need to welcome critical self-awareness while at the same time not giving up the drive to document and analyze ethnographic diversity as fully, systematically, and with as much nuance as possible. With the de-throning of the Big Man as the typical indigenous Melanesian leader, the bulk of the region's non-rank leadership variation is easily left to reside in the remaining Great Man category,
Trends in comparative analysis
121
which is suddenly uncomfortably large and unwieldy. It is thus not surprising that Godelier (1991) in his most recent formulation finds recourse in a subdivision of Great Man types. One can minimize problems of typological reification by explicitly assessing the range of variation within as well as between comparative units and by honestly addressing the problems and potentials of assuming particular conceptual or regional boundaries. It has yet to be demonstrated that the division between discrete exchange logics in the French structural tradition is paralleled by discrete contrasts between sociocultural groups on the ground. As Wolf (1988) has recently suggested, neither "societies" nor "cultures," much less larger ethnographic regions, have simple boundaries; they are often merely analytic artifacts. This fact places greater responsibility on the analyst to make clear his or her own motivations for marking boundaries, units, and contrasts in a given manner, both over space and over historical time. 4 The features considered "characteristic" of a culture area tend to be configured as a heuristic device to support an analytic agenda.
Max Weber, the father of ideal types in social science,3 realized this explicitly. Indeed, he held that there is apt to be no empirical case that truly conforms to the abstract purity of the type-characterization within its designated region (Weber 1978:ch.l). In addition, Weber clearly realized the intrinsically contrastive nature of ideal types; their value is not only heuristic, but an oppositional form of heurism. (Thus, for example, the Weberian value of characterizing Hindu asceticism as "other-worldly" is precisely the figure/ground relationship it provides with "this-worldly" asceticism in capitalist Protestantism [Weber 1958, 1978].) The admission that ideal types are, after all, only ideal, allowed Weber to complement his typologies with detailed historical analyses of empirical complexities and cross-currents. Anthropology, however, has often neglected this lead, preferring with Radcliffe-Brown to assume that discrete conceptual features exist as real things that are archetypal of broad patterns of life, not only within individual societies, but among groups of them. This turns the finding of areal designators into a mistaken end-in-itself - the "butterfly collecting" of typologies so effectively critiqued three decades ago by Leach (1961). This is a problem that Weber's analysis itself does not fully escape from; in admitting conceptual reification, he embraces it too strongly,
122
Critique
resulting in a plethora of static types, categories, and definitions that proliferate at times for their own sake. The heuristic purpose of regional characterization and inter-regional comparison requires clear analytic specification. For what purpose is regional characterization/contrast undertaken? In the present case, language-culture areas of south coast New Guinea are configured in order to compare them to existing regional generalizations. The hope has been, on the one hand, to recontextualize existing generalities at a finer level of ethnographic specificity and, on the other, to elucidate meta-tendencies of comparative analysis itself. In part 3 of the present work, a more substantive answer to this question is developed, that is, that two complementary purposes of regional analysis are particularly defensible in the anthropological endeavor. The first of these is to document areal patterns of distinctive cultural richness; the second is to expose patterns of social inequality. 5 Insofar as they become influential, conceptual contrasts between regions tend to become working assumptions. The issue here is reification. Once parameters of contrast are established, boundaries between ethnographic regions or conceptual types tend to be gerrymandered to fit them. Five variations on now-familiar themes can illustrate: (a) If Melanesia has Big Men or Great Men and yet Fiji has had chiefs, then Fiji becomes somehow not quite so "Melanesian." The same is true of New Caledonia, and the Trobriands become anomalous, needing special explanation (Brunton 1975). (b) In the 1950s, African segmentary lineage systems were sought in the New Guinea highlands; one was found among the Mae Enga (Meggitt 1965). But by the late 1960s and 1970s, the New Guinea highlands seemed to be "loosely" structured, a designation that was easily attributed to the highlands as a whole (e.g., de Lepervanche 1967). By the late 1980s, the degree of patrilineal corporate boundedness became an areal contrast between the eastern Papua New Guinea highlands, where it was asserted to be high, and the western Papua New Guinea highlands, where it was asserted to be low (Feil 1987:ch.6). An ironically reified model of kin group flexibility in the latter region was used to call into question the existence of patriclanship even as a dominant sociocultural ideology among groups like the Mae Enga.4
Trends in comparative analysis
123
(c) The political division between Papua New Guinea and Irian Jaya developed as an artifact of Western history, conceived along the 141st meridian in 1828 by the Dutch. Yet it is easily reified as a boundary for considering the prehistoric evolution of Papua New Guinea highland societies, eliminating west New Guinea from consideration a priori (Feil 1987; contrast A. Strathern 1990; Ploeg 1988). (d) For south New Guinea, recent work tends to configure the region according to the extent of ritualized homosexuality. This leads to the finding of further presumed structural correlates of homosexuality, such as male domination, restricted exchange, and low intensity politicoeconomic development. Many of these characterizations are questionable when evaluated against the ethnographic evidence available. (e) The reification of "Great Men societies," "Big Men societies," and "chiefly societies" divides areas of Melanesia into a sequence of implicitly unilinear political evolution. As critiqued by Liep (1991), the particular characteristics of these categories make it quite improbable that they could have formed a developmental sequence in any one area, much less be stages lingering differentially in different areas of Melanesia (see also Allen 1984; Lindstrom 1984; Sahlins 1983). In all these cases, terms of ethnographic contrast become reified, themselves determining subsidiary concepts and even the boundaries of ethnographic regions. This can retard adequate consideration of ethnographic variations and historical developments. As Bourdieu (1991a: 223, emphasis original) states, Regionalist discourse is a performative discourse which aims to impose as legitimate a new definition of the frontiers and to get people to know and recognize the region that is thus delimited in opposition to the dominant definition . . . The act of categorization, when it manages to achieve recognition or when it is exercised by a recognized authority, exercises by itself a certain power.
To raise this criticism is far from arguing that regional comparison should be avoided or that it cannot have ethnographic grounding. And as for reification, anthropologists are renowned for exercising their Popperian function, that is, by using ethnographic counterexample to dispel overgeneralization. The point is rather that the boundaries of an ethnographic region vary depending on the key features chosen to characterize it. As importantly, no natural coherence or isomorphism of multifarious secondary features within a region can be "logically"
124
Critique
presumed. We need to be up front about this in our analyses, more open about the reason our comparisons take the shape that they do, and more careful about delineating the ranges of internal variation that they easily subsume. 6Areal ethnographic characterizations are easily influenced by ethnographic history andparticularly by the theoretical and topical concerns dominant during the primary period(s) offieldwork in a region.
What are the key features of culture area contrast? Bow and arrow culture versus spear culture? Guilt culture versus shame culture? Patrilineal versus matrilineal? Tribal versus chiefly? Perhaps not so obviously bound to history are current Melanesian concerns such as "high versus low politicoeconomic intensity," "homosexual versus heterosexual," or "high versus low female status." Yet in historical hindsight these, too, will likely seem quaint points of societal and regional comparison. To state this is more a truism than a critique, except that the concerns of the day put a deep stamp on the primary ethnographic data collected during that period. Certain areas become "hot spots" of fieldwork and become known through subsequent ethnography as exemplars of certain characteristics. Researchers especially interested in these specialties are steered toward fieldwork in those particular places. To various degrees, this hermeneutic link can make ethnographic characterizations of a region a self-fulfilled prophecy. The Nuer are a grounding bed for the segmentary lineage system; !Kung are the locus of primitive hunter-gatherers; India epitomizes purity and caste hierarchy; Bali features heightened aestheticism; south New Guinea has given us homosexuality. Such crude assessments exert a subtle influence well beyond introductory anthropology courses; as Appadurai (1986, 1988) has suggested, the mapping of "concept" and "place" has a strong if idiosyncratic history in anthropology. Given this, it becomes a very open question whether ethnographic history is itself being adequately controlled for in an ostensibly "controlled comparison" between ethnographic regions (Eggan 1954; cf. LomnitzAdler 1991; Buckley 1989). To answer this question we must pay attention to the comparative historical and theoretical context of ethnography without relinquishing rigorous attention to the ethnographic details themselves. Practically speaking, is there any way out of the seemingly intrinsic problems of comparativism? On the one hand stands the large-scale comparison, approaching the Weberian model both in ideal sweep and in disconnection from fine-grained empirics. Comparative reification
Trends in comparative analysis
125
increases with scale, being most extreme in world-region and worldhistorical models. Analysis in this mode has the strength of synthesis and can serve as a valuable target, stimulating more tightly focused scholarship that refines and refutes its generalities. I have myself adopted a grand-scale comparative perspective on other occasions, for instance, delineating the large-scale trajectory of violence and sociality over the course of human evolution (1987c, 1991) or the divergence between cultural and demographic success in preindustrial cities (1987d). In opposition to this is the Boasian response, which reduces the scale of comparison, refutes higher-order generalities, and spawns relativism. If carried to an extreme, this reaction makes each case totally atomized and incomparable to others. Standing in implicit opposition to both of these strategies is the statistical or "holographic" comparison epitomized by research that relies on the Human Relations Area Files. In this comparative strategy, elaborately typologized places and concepts grid-lock the entire globe and easily proliferate upon their own categorical reifications. The tension between the large-scale, the small-scale, and the statistical comparison is to some extent intrinsic to comparative analysis in anthropology. The tension between these, however, can be made more productive by forwarding premises that link larger-scale trends with smaller-scale diversity. For instance, one may adduce themes that are general to a region but admit important sub-regional variants (Goldman's solution in Ancient Polynesian Societies [1970]; cf. Thomas 1989c). Or, one may adduce polar tensions or forces that seem widespread but resolve differentially in individual cases, for instance, tending toward one or another pole of a continuum (e.g., A. Strathern's [1969] influential analysis of "finance" versus "production" in New Guinea highlands exchange systems). In both cases, admitting intermediate ranges of variation and linking different levels of analysis make ethnographic comparison more dynamic and flexible than static and typological. In general, one helps guard against uniformitarian assumptions by openly exploring the range of variation within a region and coming to conclusions about its characteristics a posteriori rather than a priori. Comparisons between regions can in principle be "built-up" in the same manner, looking critically for similarities as well as differences between the areas compared. This framework, I believe, must include fundamentally the dimension most frequently left out of comparative analyses, including the present critique: the influence of symbolic orientation on social action.5 It is extremely difficult to reconstitute distinctive subjective orientations
126
Critique
ex postfacto. The necessity of doing so arises quite quickly, however, if one adopts a reductive orientation in which symbolic formations are an epiphenomenon of politicoeconomic, material, structuralist, or social structural causation. In the case of south coast New Guinea, fortunately, there is rich ethnographic documentation of indigenous spiritual beliefs and ritual enactments, and this information can be articulated with what has been uncovered in preceding chapters concerning political economy and gender. As discussed in chapter 1, cultural dynamics can exert crucial influence on patterns of political economy, social organization, and gender relations. In this regard, as Weber suggested in his final programmatic statement on interpretive sociology (1978:ch.l), subjective orientations must be considered in relation to practical outcomes in social action. Taking in hand the insights of Marxist and post-Marxist analysis, such a focus demands dialectical engagement of otherwise static cultural types with social practice, comprehending in the process differentiation and/or domination among genders, male status categories, and ethnic groups. In the process, drawing on structuralism, the developmental generation of cultural permutations can be analyzed to transcend the constraints of extreme relativism without resorting to rigid typological reification. Part 3 of this work attempts such an analysis for indigenous south coast New Guinea.
PART 3 RECONFIGURATION
7 Theoretical reconfiguration
What are the goals of comparative analysis, indeed, of ethnographic analysis in general? What is its purpose and justification? Anthropologists are increasingly cognizant that they are unlikely to predict future sociocultural developments with precision or exert great impact upon their general course of future development. Our role, rather, is as rigorous commentators on the past and present. In this regard, our goal should be to use the tools of social science to further a humanistic perspective as much as the other way around. This agenda does not mean that anthropology is unscientific. Rather, it suggests that we embrace science in the wider sense of rigorous and systematic knowledge - in some ways reflected in the notion of science as wissenschaft and that we take the type and end of knowledge, its human and pragmatic justification, to be important. In studying social life, objectivism should be a tool rather than an end in itself. Indeed, it is just when objectivism is assumed to be a neutral or transparent window upon social reality that its assumptions go most unquestioned and are most in danger of being fulfilled as tautologies. Analysis can take on the guise of an unbiased if not arbitrary search for knowledge while in fact being subservient to unexamined cultural biases that are actualized through the status competition of Western scholarly discourse (Bourdieu 1988a, 1990c; see anthropological case examples in Kuper 1988; Stocking 1987). To minimize such pitfalls, the strengths of detailed scholarship and conceptual sophistication that academic discourse affords and by rights demands need to be trained on clearly specified goals that are not justified by objectivist assumptions alone. In this regard, two complementary goals of ethnographic analysis may be held as particularly meaningful and defensible: (1) to document the
130
Reconfiguration
richness and diversity of alternative cultural formations, and (2) to expose the operation of social inequality and domination. The first goal arises from a hermeneutic concern with actors' subjectivity that can be traced back at least as far as Dilthey. Anthropology draws important passion and rigor from the desire to penetrate the richness of foreign ways of thinking and acting. In American anthropology, this concern has a long tradition in the Boasian legacy as well as from Weber in the Geertzian emphasis on cultural interpretation. Using a higher power of relativism and self-criticism, postmodern approaches in anthropology also draw selectively on this desire to penetrate the Other on his or her own terms. The goal here should be to consider otherness, not just in abstraction, but in living peoples whose knowledge, imagery, and experience enrich and critique our own. Such an interest has had from its beginnings in professional anthropology - and should continue to have in my opinion - a liberal cast of empathic understanding. This implies not so much an Enlightenment desire to expose a single path through ethnographic diversity to human improvement, but the late Foucauldian desire to illuminate a diversity of potential alternatives to choose from. The second, complementary, objective arises from the Marxist legacy in anthropology, whereby analysis of social and material relationships exposes patterns of social inequality and domination. These inequities tend to be legitimated and to varying degrees obfuscated by symbolic formations serving as ideologies. Each of these goals arguably needs the other as a balancing complement. Exploring cultural richness by itself leads to endless relativity. It can also lead to blind empathy or uncritical sympathy, particularly when romanticism in fieldwork makes us excuse forms of domination or suppression we would vehemently oppose in our own society. By contrast, exposing inequalities of gender, race, ethnicity, and socioeconomic status can sensitize us to analogous or cross-cutting patterns of inequality closer to home, defamiliarizing and deromanticizing the taken-for-granted in an important way. To read anthropology as merely the penetration of people's dissimulations, however, reduces culture to ideology and has the unwitting effect of dehumanizing our subjects of study, including ourselves. It cannot be assumed that all social action is driven by the pursuit of interest at others' expense. Domination and inequality demand consideration because they are common and socially important, not because they are universal or intrinsic to social interaction.
Theoretical reconfiguration
131
Both these objectives - the exploration of cultural richness and the exposition of social inequality - are strongly consistent with the humanist tradition of anthropology that is in my opinion one of its strongest assets. These goals, however, are intrinsically competing: are symbolic formations "genuine," rich, and deserving of empathetic analysis from the inside, or are they ideological masks, justifying social and material inequalities that can never be fully exposed from within the reasoning of indigenous cultural logic? Neither of the above two goals can be effectively negated by or, alternatively, made consistent with the other: they are in a formal sense mutually exclusive. As a result, neither the delineation of cultural richness nor the exposure of social inequality can be justified on objective grounds; they work from divergent points of prior assumption. To turn this conundrum into a benefit, however, each goal can be adopted as a check and balance on the other in alternative moments of analysis. They can be used not in attempted fusion, but as parts of a dialectic that drives forward a humanistic anthropology. As two moments of analysis, each invigorates and challenges the other to new levels of sophistication and understanding. It bears emphasis that the goals of documenting cultural richness and critically exposing social inequality are a priori valuations of what is important in anthropological research. As Weber would put it, these emphases are judgments of value. Other anthropologies could have other moral orientations or make alternative point-of-departure assumptions. Within our current discipline of anthropology, however, these twin goals are especially defensible on moral grounds as well as having a substantial intellectual and ethnographic tradition. In contrast to both staunch objectivism and extreme postmodernism, I do not try to avoid explicit value judgments or wriggle out of an authorial mantle. Given that these sticky issues are an inescapable part of authorship, it is best to admit and take responsibility for one's predispositions. From the present perspective, a third dimension of ethnographic analysis - the objectivist "explanation" of sociocultural forms - should be strongly mediated by the above two goals. Though the attempt to explain or account for ethnographic data by using higher-order generalizations is a useful and indeed indispensable analytic tool, this is best combined with a desire to document cultural richness and distinctiveness, on the one hand, and to expose patterns of social inequality, on the other. Without periodic assessment with respect to these or similar pragmatic groundings, authors are increasingly licensed to spin
132
Reconfiguration
rarified personal aesthetics, on the one hand, or to proliferate "facts" and test "hypotheses" that contain unexamined biases, on the other. By itself, objectivism or aestheticism can weave its own justification simply as a token of scholarly capital in academic discourse - to what larger end? The theoretical underpinning for a dialectical analysis of cultural richness and social inequality was discussed in chapter 1 and can be reengaged here, if too briefly, in an historical perspective. Among early social science theorists, it was particularly Weber and the early Marx who attempted to articulate an appreciation of meaning and consciousness with an analysis of social inequality and domination. In more recent anthropological history, symbolic perspectives can be seen (among many other things) to emphasize the subjective and hermeneutic side of this dialectic. They attempt to delineate cultural richness, whether it be through the Geertzian search for local knowledge or the postmodern exposure of irreducible pastiche in polyphonic voices. Symbolic perspectives in anthropology can be a strong impetus to explore alternative subjectivities in all their distinctiveness. In complementary fashion, a material determinist legacy stemming from Morgan and the late Marx and Engels informs approaches as diverse as the cultural materialism of Harris (1979), structural Marxism, and, in an importantly historicized perspective, the anthropological study of political economy and geopolitical domination (e.g., Wolf 1982; Wallerstein 1991). In these perspectives (notwithstanding their huge differences), technoenvironmental and politicoeconomic factors constitute infrastructural determinants that maintain and perpetuate, among other things, large-scale social inequality. This causation occurs regardless of, in spite of, or in concert with, cultural legitimations. On the current theoretical scene, theories of structure and practice developed by Bourdieu, Giddens, Sahlins, and Ortner, among others, bridge and attempt to transcend the longstanding and sometimes pernicious opposition between the above approaches, that is, between cultural interpretation and materialism, or, more broadly, between subjective and objective determinants of social action (see Ortner 1984; cf. Sahlins 1976). One of the strengths of practice theories in anthropology is to incorporate the insights of interpretive and materialist perspectives dialectically, for instance, as dimensions of agency and power that simultaneously inform practice. In so doing, practice theories can treat nuances of cultural richness and sociomaterial dimensions of inequality as complementary rather than as competing foci of analysis. In some prominent theories of practice, however (and particularly in
Theoretical reconfiguration
133
Bourdieu's), empathic appreciation of symbolic impetus is undercut by assuming that social inequality drives rather than reflects transformatory cultural change; the Weber of the Protestant Ethic is unduly neglected.1 In the present perspective, politicoeconomic motivation is taken as one important dimension of analysis, but one that must be complemented by considering cultural richness in its own right. On the other hand, the structural(ist) theories of Sahlins (1981, 1985) and the more phenomenological ones of Munn (1986) tend to give too much weight to the staying power of subjective logics already in place. Subjective orientations are viewed as staying basically the same over time; concrete change is explained for the most part by the stasis of subjective orientations as they engage external instigations. Change does not tend to be seen as intrinsic to symbolic formations through their own sociomaterial actualizations. On the present analysis, it is just this dialectic that drives the development of sociocultural formations from the inside. Symbolic orientations do exert crucial influence over what people do; culturally constituted values and orientations motivate action. But cultural determinism is never total, is sometimes systematically compromised, and is regularly confronted by the unforeseen legacy of its own hard-world actualization. This actualization reflects the limits and forces of ecology, technology, demography, trade, the military force of intruding sociocultural formations, and so on. The effects of these limits and forces on action, reciprocally, are mediated by very active and very subjective responses. As Kelly (1985:ch.6) so effectively discusses for the Nuer and the Dinka, sociocultural development and change are driven by the self-destabilizing results that cultural valuations have as they engage their own material repercussions. As he emphasizes, the complex and often unintended sociomaterial consequences of cultural orientation are themselves exacerbated, minimized, or otherwise responded to by symbolic formations themselves. This sociocultural interaction entails a dialectic relationship and not simply the stochastic progression portrayed in cybernetic or variable feedback models. Symbolisms proliferate and change qualitatively in response to their hard-world actualizations; it is not simply the "magnitude" of symbolic categories or cultural emphases that change. In contrast to stochastic change, then, dialectical change entails mutual causality in which symbolic categories are qualitatively revalued through interaction with the tangible properties of their material world (see Sahlins 1981). The outlines and content of data categories cannot be
134
Reconfiguration
taken as constants. And yet, as the Marxist notion of dialectic progression implies, change is not thereby unordered and random; it is progressive and directional. In the present perspective, this systematicity is explained both by the fact that symbolic formations actualize themselves recursively and by the fact that repeated engagement with existential conditions produces regular hard-world repercussions. In terms of method, I start with the distinctive features of symbolic formations in place. Though the degree to which cultural formations are systemic has been much debated in recent years, culture as a diffusely shared set of meanings and values remains an important heuristic concept. As Shore (1988) has suggested, there need be no assumption that cultural meanings uniformly influence or motivate all individuals; taking culture seriously need not deny the polyphony or cacophony of voices that constitute cultural formations. Cultural orientations should be considered first from the inside - from the viewpoint of indigenous actors. They cannot be adequately reconstituted ex post-facto, that is, after universalist assumptions of material determinism or politicoeconomic motivation have already been made. The reverse it not the case, however: internalist analysis of symbolic formations can be supplemented by a subsequent consideration of technoenvironmental constraints and sociomaterial opportunities. Cultural orientations juxtapose in constant relationship with nonsymbolic ecological, material, and demographic processes. Cultural impetus takes on existential dimensions as it is actualized; practice both manifests culture and alters it. This alteration, in turn, rebounds upon and further stimulates the elaboration of endogenous symbolic gestalts. Viewed in spatial or comparative terms, one frequently finds broad sociocultural features shared in common across regions but cross-cut by specific divergences if not polarizations between constituent cultural groups. These divergences are not simply random permutations of cultural form, as Levi-Strauss might have it, but symbolic formations elaborating distinctively in response to the hard-world legacies of their specific prior history. This historical legacy poses realities at once both symbolic and nonsymbolic to which symbolic orientations react and respond. In the south coast New Guinea context, one finds great overall similarity among the seven major language-culture areas (see the conclusion of chapter 2 above and chapters 9 and 10 below). This similarity is cross-cut by symbolic and sociopolitical differences and polarizations, including what Ted Schwartz (1975, cf. 1963) has for
Theoretical reconfiguration
135
north Melanesia called "ethnic totemism" - the encoding of cultural identity through strong if not diametric opposition between adjacent ethnic groups on the basis of selective divergences of custom and belief. These markers of cultural differentiation are frequently complemented by differences in residential, sociopolitical, and economic organization. These variations cannot be accounted for on the basis of ecology or material factors alone but stem from the spiralling elaboration of local cultural geists in interaction with the legacy of their own hard-world actualizations. These actualizations, in turn, both reflect and reinforce distinctive differences in the organization of social inequality and domination between genders, between status groups of men, and between ethnic groups. Along the methodological lines sketched above, the seven languageculture areas of south coast New Guinea will be considered as internally configured cultural formations that engage with sociodemographic, environmental, and political constraints and opportunities. Though it might be possible to separate and then cross-tabulate individual factors, such a procedure would compromise a developmental understanding of the sociocultural formation in each case. General features of areal development, however, may be compared and contrasted. I pursue a relatively detailed analysis of the Marind-anim in chapter 8, as their ethnographic material is especially rich and illustrative of developmental dynamics. In chapter 9, I analyze the interface between culture and practice among the remaining six south coast languageculture areas; in the process, I compare them to the Marind-anim and to each other. In chapter 10, regional comparisons are built up, for instance, between the south coast and the New Guinea highlands. For this broader scale of comparison, I identify general commonalities of south coast cultural orientation and their existential results.
8 Marind-anim
Marind-anim provide a convenient point of departure for reconfiguring the comparative analysis of south coast New Guinea. Marind customs and beliefs emphasized themes found in different permutations elsewhere along the south coast, and their sociopolitical and mythic features were both dramatic and distinctive during the early colonial period. Available information is ripe for reconsideration, since the relevant details are meticulously documented but deeply ensconced in van Baal's (1966) huge and wonderful but digressive and complicated compendium of Marind ethnography.l Dema
To comprehend Marind-anim, as van Baal emphasizes, we must start with dema. Dema were at once primordial ancestors, living spirits, clan totems, timeless originators of the universe, and continuing forces of power, awe, and change within the cosmos. The relationship of dema to Marind was not only one of descent but transcended boundaries of linear chronology and social space. Dema created the places of the known world. The stories of their travels, adventures, and torments were a continuing myth-space that engaged all four Marind phratries and moved across the territory in ritual enactment. Girls and particularly boys were indoctrinated and socialized into the dema's way of life; in addition to being initiated into the world of dema-stories and ritual embodiments, they re-learned how to drink water, eat food, gather coconuts, clothe themselves, and obtain enemy heads as taught by the dema. Dema did not exist in distant time; one's grandfather was apt to have lived just after the period of their initial actions. As Verschueren wrote to van Baal (ibid.: 182),
Marind-anim
137
It is the raconteur's method to present all [mythical] events as actual, as events of the day. Often when listening to a myth being told, I had the impression that it all happened only a few months ago. Dema continued to inform the strange, awesome, and cataclysmic aspects of life, and they could be conjured. Moreover, they were continually brought back into being through human embodiment. The major cults did more than reenact the activities of dema in a panoptic profusion of spectacularly costumed deraa-performers; actors were transformed into dema themselves. Thus, when Wirz saw a demaperformer fall and be strangled senseless by the cords holding his enormous costume edifice, the group silently gathered and performed a ritual to facilitate the dema's departure before the cords could be loosened and the man allowed to struggle back to consciousness. During the promiscuous heterosexual intercourse of the myth-enacting rituals, the serial sexuality of the Marind was that of the dema themselves, and children born to unmarried women as a result of such sexuality were killed: they were not human but were dema-children. After the rituals, raids of headhunting and kidnapping that stretched far outside Marind territory incarnated the head-taking that allowed dema to proliferate and spring forth anew. The universe of dema was multifarious and encompassing. Van Baal {ibid. :180) suggests, we are confronted with . . . a bewildering multitude of dema, each associated with one or more different things, species, or customs, so variegated and numerous as to suggest that everything comes from the dema. That, indeed, is the way the Marind see it when they refer to the dema as the originators of all things. These associations were at one level totemic; dema-affiliations signified various forms of individual, clan, and local identity that were strongly embraced. The pervasiveness of dema in Marind social life suggests similarities with the Dreamtime ancestors of Australian aboriginal populations southward across the shallow Arafura Sea (Stanner 1979:ch.2). Yet there were important differences. The world of the dema was not only primordial but temporal or "in time." Correspondingly, the deep-seated transformation of subjects into totemic objects in Australian ritual, as penetrated by Munn (1969, 1973) comes to a fuller circle among Marind-anim. Dema were subjectified as present beings and Marind
138
Reconfiguration
objectified themselves as creative embodiments who continued the dema's restless wanderings and vital energy. Dema provided not just the authority of age-old sanctity but a license to elaborate their spirit in the present. Although Marind retained a deep sense of personal dignity and self-contained superiority in their ethnic embodiment as dema, they were highly expansionist, melding foreign peoples on all of their borders into their proliferating ritual cults. Being more than vessels of a timeless past, Marind were as active dema-hevoes in the present. Social and mythic complementarity
The relationship between social and mythic organization engages the rich specifics of Marind agency. The atom of Marind residential affiliation was the exogamous boan, a patri-descent construct that flexibly bridged and subsumed what might otherwise be called lineage, clan, and clan-affiliate or phratry levels of social organization (van Baal 1966:87). On a small scale, boan appear to have been basic residential and land-holding units, a small men's house community of about twenty persons on average. Several of these and associated women's houses clustered to form a hamlet (South Pacific Commission 1952-1953:58f.; cf. van Baal 1966:39). The nine major boan names found across Marind territory were classed in a four-phratry system, with boan from all four phratries grouped into moieties within each village. Named villages were extended territorial units of some 100-450 persons dispersed in several hamlets. Villages combined members of all four phratries in quadripartite social organization. This arrangement structured marriage as well as cult life; the boan of the exogamous phratries tended to marry within the village, which was hence largely endogamous (van Baal 1966:45). Major cults, feasts, and accompanying myth-performances required deraa-personae from all four phratries so they could play their respective roles in dramas of collective cosmological rejuvenation. The four phratries were represented in roughly equal demographic proportions across Marind territory (e.g. ibid.:80, annex 3). Van Baal (ibid. :428) notes that "the present system of phratries and clans is a superstructure which, through a long process of adaptation and integration, has superseded and absorbed a multitude of older local clan-organizations, the constituents of which live on in the numerous subclans." Diverse patri-groups could be incorporated into the major totem-affiliations of existing boan, finding their place flexibly at unmarked "lineage," "clan," or "phratry" levels without compromising
Marind-anim
139
the larger integrity of boan mythic and totemic associations. The boan and their phratries had primary mythic-totemic affiliation with particular dema, but mythic association defined boan identity as much as the reverse {ibid. :93, 96). The attractions of Marind ethnicity combined with the threat of headhunting against outsiders to gradually subsume border groups into Marind social and mythic organization. "There is every reason to reconsider the Marind-anim clan-system from the point of view of actual reality . . . everywhere inducing peoples to adapt their clan-systems to that of the Marind-anim by fitting their clans into one of the categories represented by the nine big names" {ibid. :96f.). Further, "the tendency to assimilate local clan-systems into a kind of overall system is so general that it cannot be new. It must be a very old trend." 2 Through elaborate dual organization, Marind myth and ritual facilitated widespread social as well as cosmological integration. Marind perceived the distinctive myth and ritual variations found elsewhere in their territory as providing important complements and permutations of overarching cosmological motifs. For this reason, visitors from distant Marind villages were welcomed to perform their distinctive demaenactments {ibid.:829-862). This sharing of ritual display dovetailed with the Marind tendency to classify the human and material world according to its similarity or association with known totemic objects, properties, and species {ibid. :196). Grounded in widespread mythico-religious affiliation, Marind were remarkable in their cooperation and alliance. Distant villages, including from the far eastern and western portions of Marind territory, allied in headhunting against non-Marind {ibid. :95). Intra-Marind relations were amazingly non-violent among a population of 8,500 to 10,000 coastal Marind and an additional 6,000 or so Marind in the interior. As van Baal (ibid.:24) puts it, "most remarkable of all is that, in spite of the absence of intervillage authority and organization, they managed to maintain relatively peaceful conditions among themselves." In those episodes of intra-Marind killing that did occur - only two known - the few victims were not beheaded and the parties made peace within a few years (ibid.:6S5, 689, 691). Marind disputes were often dealt with through recourse to sorcery and countersorcery, but accusations were vague and rarely resulted in killing; inter-village sorcery was much less feared among Marind than in neighboring language-culture areas (ibid. :688, 936f.). Violent conflict was infrequent within the village as well. Van de Kolk (quoted ibid. :692) states that "very rarely do men
140
Reconfiguration
of . . . the same village fight each other, which we have always found amazing." These patterns contrast dramatically with the relentless headhunting that Marind directed against foreign ethnic groups. The operation of this unusually cohesive dynamic is revealed through the Marind linkage among moieties, cults, and ethnic sub-groups. Internal dynamics: moieties, cults, and ethnic sub-groups
The symbolically dominant Marind moiety was Geb-ze, associated with the coast, the southeast, fire, sunrise, and the origin of man. In contrast, the Sami-rek moiety was associated with inland areas, swamp, the origin of killing and death, women, and night (ibid. :215-219). In addition to its classificatory function within villages, the binary division between Geb-ze and Sami-rek was overlain with areal ethnic polarities. Sami-rek dema were emphasized in the cult enactments of the Imo Marind, a fierce Marind ethnic group with historical as well as cultural and mythic ties to swampy inland areas. Van Baal presents strong evidence that the Imo Marind originated as a separate inland group with its own tribal cult, subsequently expanding and migrating south toward the coast, where they eventually established a few major coastal villages (ibid. :607, 666). Imo intrusion thus split the pre-existing Marind coastal population geographically in two, and there remained important language dialect differences between the two groups. Cult affiliation reflected this division; intrusive Imo villages resolutely practiced their imo cult, whereas most other coastal Marind followed the mayo cult.3 The myths of the Imo Marind encode a history of antagonism between their preeminent Sami-rek moiety and Geb-ze. For instance, of the five Geb-ze dema in the imo cult enactment, one is raped, killed, and eaten, a second is captured and imprisoned, a third is killed by sorcery and his head cut off (becoming a coconut), and the remaining two themselves facilitate the capture of other Geb-ze dema by the imo (ibid. :435). By the early colonial period, the ethnic and cult relationship between Imo and Mayo Marind had become one of cooperation within a common system of cosmological and social organization. Over time, imo and mayo cults incorporated key dimensions of each other, with Geb-ze themes in particular informing the imo cult as the hidden or secret meaning of the traumatic rites (ibid.:649, 669). Ethnic polarization was subsumed in the same way that polarity between moieties or phratries
Marind-anim
141
was subsumed within the village: "the tendency to associate every phratry with certain aspects of nature is balanced by a trend to express relations with the favourite characteristics of the opposite moiety" {ibid. :426). As well as entailing mythic performance by actors from both moieties and all four phratries, this trend toward complementarity predisposed affiliation with dema enactments performed in other villages and other Marind ethnic groups. It was on the basis of such affiliation that cooperation between Imo and Mayo Marind was secured for activities such as cooperative headhunting against non-Marind and joint celebration of large head-feasts. Cultic and ethnic cooperation was both a cause and a result of expanding quadripartition across Marind territory. Structuralist logic and ethnic history were here combined. Historically, ethnic myth and ritual affiliations diffused, integrating constituent groups through beliefs and ritual themes subsequently held in common. Structurally, a classificatory propensity for complementary dualism throughout the region provided a framework for recognizing and appreciating alternative mythic and ritual emphases - that is, for seeing them as variants of one's own practices and beliefs. Within these permutations, mayo cultic and associated Geb myth emphases were dominant in historical priority and in recognized classificatory eminence; they stressed life, dry season plenty, birth, man, fire, and beach (ibid. :212-214). This classificatory superiority was not also social, however; it betokened no social dominance of Mayo group "first-comers" versus Imo group "latecomers," in contrast to patterns found in many African and Polynesian societies (see ibid. :98). This fact helps explain the process of ethnic and cultural accretion to Marind ethno-mythic formations. The elaborating dualisms of Marind cosmology integrated diverse mythic and ritual permutations, and in the process, they amalgamated people with different social affiliations and even different ethnic histories. To the north, Upper Bian Marind were amalgamating both their ritual and their political alliance system to the Marind imo, just as the Imo had combined theirs with the mayo (ibid. :606). The Sosom cult among eastern coastal Marind, discussed further below, likely originated as a cultural if not ethnic infusion. And in the far eastern coastal Marind village of Kondo, the rapa cult was being incorporated, combining basic features of mayo cult mythology with a distinctive emphasis on fire (ibid. :563). Myth The dema themes illustrated in myths of human origin had pragmatic as well as aesthetic significance. These themes came to be shared by all Marind, and
142
Reconfiguration
their enactment figured prominently in practices of ritual sexuality, warfare, and sociopolitical organization, as well as in cult performances. Mythic themes were also palpable to Marind in and of themselves; their cycle of associations needs to be sketched before their social influence can be traced (van Baal 1966:pt. II). The multitudinous aspects of Marind mythology gradually reveal a structure of permutation on basic dominant themes. Rather than pre-assess these themes, however, I begin by letting the main stories of the four Marind phratries speak for themselves. Prior to the origin of men, dema were already holding cult-feasts. Traveling underground eastward in two boats (one for each moiety), they were accompanied above ground by a dema-dog. As the dog heard the growing noise of dema tunnelling underground, he dug furiously. Out of two holes, along with gushing water, came the first humans, emerging in two moieties, unformed and looking like fish. 4 The dema Aramemb (founder of Aramemb phratry of the Geb-ze moiety) rescued the first emerging humans from a predatory stork and lit a fire to warm and dry them; the popping bamboo from the fire formed their eyes and ears. Of a common moiety, Geb and Aramemb claimed and took their respective phratry people. The rest were taken by Mahu and Bragai the dema phratry-founders of the Sami-rek moiety. Following their founders, Marind were settled westward as far as the Princess Marianne Strait. Geb in his primary and secondary dema forms is the central figure of Geb-ze moiety and phratry myths. He is initially satisfied with a bamboo instead of a wife but is eventually given a woman by Mahu. He is also a boy or man who lives in a hole on an eastern beach and captures and kills boys. He is found out and cleaned and rubbed with semen by women, and the first banana thus sprouts from his neck. He is sodomized, whereafter he escapes and climbs a vine to the sky to become the moon. In another variant, Geb as a killer of boys is himself beheaded and his glowing head rises in the east to become the sun. Geb is also a giant snake whose snake-son is stolen. Aramemb steals Geb's son back, but the son proceeds to seduce Aramemb's wife. In revenge, Aramemb has the son killed through sorcery; his head is planted and becomes the first coconut tree. Geb mythology establishes the basic Marind mythological connection between heads, killing, coconuts, and heterosexual regeneration. The most important snake-son of Geb is Uaba, who brings his wife
Marind-anim
143
Ualiwamb, mother of stork and initiation, to a dema feast. Resisting the ritual requirement of serial sexual intercourse (otiv-bombari), Ualiwamb flees to the west, where Uaba trails and finally engages her. They are found trapped in sexual intercourse the next morning by dema who had followed them. Fused in the sexual act, the couple are covered with mats and brought east where they are found by Aramemb, who wrenches Uaba free. Flame shoots from Ualiwamb's vulva (the origin of fire), from whence also emerges the first cassowary and the stork (symbol of the initiate). The fire from the culture-heroes' prolonged coitus spreads westward through the entire country and creates the Marind beach and savannah. The cassowary dema, Dawi (of the Sami-rek moiety), tries to put out the fire by beating it with his wagane (penis/head-hunting club), but merely manages to sever from the mainland a head-shaped island covered with coconuts; it floats west. The headhunting club originates from events following a cult-celebration by the dema. After holding their celebration, the dema travel through headhunting country accompanied by Sok, the beheading-knife dema. The dema Diwa parallels this journey and carries his huge penis over his shoulder like a club, but it violates a young woman, whose mother cuts the phallus off. (Among the Marind themselves, by association, the pahui headhunting club has a female disk through which the phallic male shaft slides. In symbolic castration, the top fretwork of the shaft is smashed over the victim's head and broken off prior to beheading.) Similar to Diwa is Uaba's brother, the violent giant Sosom of the Aramemb phratry, who wears a string of enemy heads. He is beheaded in the west but goes east, enters the vagina of a woman, and is reborn. Growing up, he is loud and obstreperous, and he beats the boys and has sex with the girls until people lose patience and castrate him; in one variant, his penis becomes vaginally locked in sexual intercourse and is cut off by the girl's mother {ibid. :268). Sosom goes off growling loudly, masturbates [his penile stump], and eventually drives off the women and teaches Marind men the homosexual rites of the Sosom male initiation cult, including the use of the bullroarer - simultaneously Sosom's castrated phallus and his loud voice - and the practice of anally inseminating cult novices. In the Sosom rituals, which included promiscuous homosexual intercourse, Marind set up a huge red phallus of Sosom and danced around it, while the deraa-impersonator of Sosom was revealed to the male initiate novices as a real man/inseminator. Sosom was nick-named "anus-man."
144
Reconfiguration
A relinkage of parallel themes is found in the core mythology of the opposite (Sami-rek) moiety. One of the moieties' principal myths, from its Mahu-ze phratry, recounts the travels of the Diwa canoe, which carries dema from a mayo ceremony to a large feast (ibid. :311-314). A dema called Yugil, associated with Diwa, has a similarly huge penis that he carries over his shoulder. While crossing a river, the penis molests a young girl and is cut off by her mother, after which it falls into the water and sticks to the bow of the Diwa canoe. The canoe is overladen with dema and food from the preceding feast; its occupants float downstream and are jettisoned along with food and material items at various locations, with which they are subsequently associated. A sea-snake attacks and capsizes the canoe, whereupon various dema are marooned, including Yugil, the "dema of the penis stump." The canoe continues its journey to the sea and is washed back inland with the tide; the penis ends up in a swamp. Mahu is the dema-ioxm&tr of the Mahu-ze phratry of Sami-rek. He has exceedingly large genitals and copulates frequently with his wife, whereupon she bears him a litter of dogs (which the Marind associate with large genitals, incessant copulation, and excrement). One of these dogs copulates with Mahu's wife, by consequence of which Mahu kills and eats him. But each of the dog's bones comes back to life as a new dog to sniff the excrement of Mahu after he inadvertently defecates near the dog's skeleton. Mahu also has other wives, who, along with his first wife, give birth to sons who become the ancestors of Mahu-ze subclans. Mahu finds one of his wives stealing food, so he ties her up and later gives her to Geb as a wife. Mahu's sons become enraged at the marital gift of their mother; they defecate into coconut bowls and fling the contents at their father. To the Sami-rek moiety also belongs the pig-dema Nazr of the Bragai-ze phratry, the leader of headhunts. Nazr changes back and forth from pig to man; in his pig form he devours sago pith at night (ibid.:409-424). The local people dig a pit-trap, catch Nazr as a pig, and kill and eat him. The bones complain of the cooking heat, leave to bathe, and attack the people of the village. The people in turn shriek like pigs and indeed turn into pigs, and their village becomes forest. Afterwards, Nazr develops a passion for shooting with his bow, and he travels and kills many people and even dema (ibid.:395-403). When he finds a dema he cannot kill, he shoots a pair of copulating snakes and uses them to tie the dema up. Nazr meets his friend Mahu and shows him how to go headhunting and take and process heads; Nazr's many
Marind-anim
145
children help to make the attack an easy victory. Nazr then steals the heads Mahu has taken; Mahu has to turn himself into a dog to recover them. Mahu is also the possessor of self-processed sago (associated with women) and splits the skull of the dema Wakabu when the latter attempts to steal sago from him. Wakabu washes his split head in a swamp, whereupon grows the first true sago-palm. Bringing the mythology full circle is Opeko-anem, the main dema of the Sami-rek's Bragai-ze phratry. Opeko-anem is the mythical complement to Uaba of the Geb-ze moiety. Opeko-anem and Uaba marry each other's sisters and bring their wives for exchange at the heterosexual
Figure 3 Marind-anim gari sunburst ornament. Made of very light kernel of sago-leaf ribs. Thin, long strips, radially arranged, are lashed and painted in various colors, particularly white, punctuated by darker stars and border. Total diameter 3-4 m. (Illustration after Wirz 1928:plate 100, see also his plates 35, 95 and van Baal 1966:356ff., plate 9.)
146
Reconfiguration
rites of the mayo cult ceremony; from then on, friendship is established between Uaba's boan and the Bragai-ze phratry. Uaba asks Opekoanem to fetch an additional woman for the heterosexual rites and a gari, which in actual cult performances were large sun-burst body ornaments up to four meters in diameter (see figure 3). When Opeko-anem returns with the gari and the young woman attached to him by a spear, the woman resists and stabs him with the weapon that joins them. She carries him off along with the sunburst and begins a long journey, like the sun, from the east to the far west, returning to leave the sunburst near the coast and Opeko-anem upstream. Dema-women who are angry at Opeko-anem for having coerced women into sexual rites tie him upside-down to ironwood pillars in the middle of the river. They also fasten a big woman's apron between his legs to prevent him from copulating. Singing the headhunters song, the dema-women settle nearby to keep watch on their prisoner, remaining there to the present day. Sami-rek myths engage themes of hypersexuality, castration, and the re-birth of heads parallel to those of the Geb-ze, and, like them, they link back to the primordial mayo ceremonies. Nevertheless, they complement Geb-ze emphases with an accent on death, destruction, darkness, night, swamp, and womanhood. Marind myths are clearly amenable to structuralist or Freudian analysis, and the themes presented above are but a small part of an enormous and enormously complex mythological corpus. Associations abound in mind-boggling variants and transformations. Nevertheless, certain basic themes repeat: prolific sexual intercourse, castration, decapitation, rejuvenation, and rebirth. These themes are linked in a distinctive fertility cycle, and they are the means by which dema regenerate in their various incarnations. The resonating permutations of these themes also link the mythic cycles of the four phratries. Through these themes and specific dema-forms, origin and meaning are given to the sun, moon, fire, water, dogs, pigs, snakes, bamboo, coconuts, sago, headhunting clubs, canoes, phalli, women, heterosexuality, homosexuality - indeed, to virtually all objects and features or forces of importance to Marind. Given this scope of reference, it is not difficult to see how new variants, drawing on alternative ethnic topical emphases, were melded with and subsumed by the Marind mythological cycle. Within this mosaic, strong emphasis is placed on the transformatory
Marind-anim
147
opposition between life-death, coast-inland, east-west, dry-wet, firewater, copulation-killing, male-female, and so on. Marind mythology can clearly be analyzed as a proliferating structuralist logic of antinomy, mediated opposition, and transformation. In addition, however, Marind mythological spirit is highly experiential and social; enacting mythic themes in social behavior and politics was central, not epiphenomenal. Marind emphasized the performative dimension of their cosmology rather than rarifying it as a timeless system of knowledge. They appear to have been untroubled by the inconsistencies, additions, and divergent proliferations of their mythical corpus in different forms. Indeed, they continually embellished their own ritual enactments to creatively elaborate, complement, or disguise various mythic themes. Though a prolonged structuralist analysis of dema myths could be undertaken, the present goal is to consider Marind mythology not so much as a formal system but, as Marind themselves did, in relation to social practice. It is hence the basic themes and their pragmatic interconnection as parts of an enacted fertility cycle that will be stressed. Enacting myth: cults and social action To actualize mythic meanings and imbue these meanings in the young, Marind enacted elaborate cult performances. Dema in spectacular costume were embodied by the coordinated boan of the four phratries, each enacting the dema associated with its particular sub-group. Van Baal's (ibid.:856f.) description of the Sosom dema illustrates the lavish costuming: The demfl-performer is bedecked with an extraordinary variety of ornaments. His face is concealed by a brightly coloured yellow shield representing a bower bird (batend). His head is adorned with birds of paradise plumes, in his ears he wears special ornaments, another ornament keeps his lips sealed, indicating that he is not allowed to speak. All kinds of finery cover his breast and back, and round his waist he has a skirt made of hibiscus-fibres. At the back of his head he proudly wears the humum [sky-cloud] ornament, often of an enormous size. Moreover, each dema-performer has his particular face-painting and also the ornaments which refer to his mythical past. The sequence of dema-enactments was correspondingly elaborate, as illustrated in the humum-angai dance (ibid. :855): The procession of dancers is opened by a number of dem
148
Reconfiguration
performer wears a big, butterfly-shaped ornament representing the clouds, while yet another holds two oblong fences which represent the waves of the sea. Then follow the humum-angai performers proper. Perched on the top of his head, each wears an animal figure, fastened by means of a long rod which passes right through the hairdo and the body of the animal and ends in a long plume . . . The animal's figure is set off against a kind of nimbus, a construction of ribs of palm-leaflets dotted with down. The nimbus is called humum, literally cloud, clouded sky, and this name came to be applied to the whole show. A series of such performers in the dema-wir actualize specific myths And so it goes on and on, the myth of konaim-anem, episodes from the myth of Yorma, from the myths of the crab dema Hoyom, the Diwai-canoe, the bamboo dema and the bow dema, from the myth of the stork and the eagle, the myth of Ganguta, scenes from the life of Aramemb, they succeed each other in an endless variety of . . . highly interesting theatre. Each performer had primary affiliation with the dema he or she enacted and with its respective totem-group boan. The enactments as a whole thus actualized social as well as cosmological integration of totemic affiliations {ibid. :858, 861). The mayo cult Each of the major cults presented a different permutation of shared Marind themes. Older boys and girls were initiated into the mayo cult through elaborate ceremonies lasting five to six months {ibid. :559). Through dema enactment, novices were trained and shown the mythic significance of basic Marind living practices. 5 Sexual activity was also learned and carried out to actualize the excesses of the dema. This included promiscuous heterosexual intercourse following wildly celebratory dancing (iWd.:510, 512f., 528). Wirz (quoted in van Baal 1966:510) states: 6 Every night [heterosexual] orgies take place in the bush, to which people of other villages have free access. The neophytes were not on any account allowed to join in, except toward the end of their seclusion. Then the rules of continence incumbent upon them were abrogated and the character of the celebration became even more obscene. As discussed further below, sexual secretions obtained from intercourse were used for a wide range of ritual strengthening rejuvenation purposes (/6w/.:544, 548). Of homosexuality there little if any in the mayo, though male novices were re-taught social
this and was and
Marind-anim
149
exchange obligations to their maternal uncles (binahor-fathers), who had previously been their anal inseminators in the Sosom cult. For boys, the mayo climaxed a period of semi-seclusion and homosexuality in bachelor residences that had lasted several years. During the mayo ceremonies, the dema themselves taught numerous activities and meanings - as many as fifty performers enacting them on some occasions (ibid. :545). The story of Uaba and Ualiwamb referred to further above was among the primary myths enacted (ibid. :553). Performative references to sacred myth were frequently oblique, however, being elaborated creatively in suggestive but metaphoric ritual imagery (ibid. :549). Enactments were carried out with "the solemnity and the awe which are prevalent during a deraa-performance. Acting a dema is not a play, but a serious rite" (ibid. .562). Uninitiated boys and girls had to keep away lest they die from seeing the dema (ibid. :517). In contrast, the initiand boys and girls learned names, meanings, and episodes of the dema, and boys also learned the secret knowledge associated with their particular boan and phratry (ibid. :546). The long mayo initiation subjected initiands to various food taboos and required them to wear shapeless garments in daily seclusion, but no particular emphasis was placed on frightening or harrying the novices (ibid. :547). Major feasts took place in appreciation of novices' sponsors, primarily their mothers' brothers (MB) and mothers' brothers' sisters (MBZ) (ifeid. :527). As the climax of the cult and of the demas action, the performing village undertook long-distance headhunting expeditions. Widely dispersed Marind villages were invited to attend the large head-feasts that celebrated the cult's culmination in military and spiritual success. In all, the mayo was not just a cult initiation but a celebration and re-creation of the Marind cosmos. When cult activity was forcefully suppressed by the Dutch, Marind expressed an irrevocable sorrow: the Marind cosmos was ceasing; the uninitiated could never regain their heritage (ibid. :544; see South Pacific Commission 1952-1953). The mayo exhibited two particularly important social features. First, the cult was conducted simultaneously each year among roughly onefourth of the mayo villages, passing eastward across the quarters of Mayo Marind territory on a four-year cycle and then recommencing in the far west (van Baal 1966:498). It thus required a substantial degree of performative coordination both within and, sequentially, between various Mayo Marind groups. Second, the headhunting that concluded the cult supplied not only heads and "head names" for Marind children but
150
Reconfiguration
live children as well; the progeny of foreigners were systematically kidnapped, brought back, and re-socialized as full Marind-anim (ibid. :532). In effect, the mythic cycle of hypersexuality, headhunting, and rebirth was made demographically as well as cosmologically real. Mayo was the most widespread, elaborate, and synthetic of the Marind cults, and its adherents included the bulk of the coastal villages, who were in all likelihood also the original Marind ethnic group. The mayo was primordial in mythic terms as well, with the other cults presented as subsequent to or emanating from it (ibid. :495). All the other Marind cults were associated with a permutation or phase of basic Geb mythology, which was most elaborately enacted in the mayo. The into cult Imo cultism drew upon Geb mythology themes, but in their dialectical Sam-rek moiety aspect. Consistent with this, imo placed strong emphasis on darkness, dissimulation, and death. The imo was shorter in duration and more geographically focused than the mayo, particularly in its most secret initiation ceremonies. These apparently had to be undertaken at the imo dema-center at Sangase near the coast, to which a kind of pilgrimage was made (ibid. :610). The leader of the imo had to give permission and even set the date for subsidiary imo ceremonies held at other times elsewhere (ibid. :609). The imo cult thus exhibited a significant degree of centralization (ibid. :607-611). Emphasizing danger and violence, imo rites were far more traumatic for novices than those of the mayo, and women were excluded from formal initiation. Ordeals included beating novices and submitting them to an ostensible headhunt attack so realistic that most of them fainted from fright (ibid. :648). Novices had their mouths, noses, and eyes smeared with excrement that had been mixed with semen, associating them with the fecal and sexual imagery of the Sami-rek moiety. They were then forced to lie in seclusion until maggots appeared on their befouled faces (ibid. :651). Much greater secrecy attended the imo cult than the mayo (making its ethnography correspondingly meager), and depictions of specific dema episodes were more veiled and cryptic. The rites' enactment of Geb-ze mythology is evident in allusions to its important Uaba myth in the climactic imo rite staged on a moonless night (ibid. :616-629, 657-665). Conducted by an old woman, the older men sang, after which a male and a female dema emerged carrying canoes on their heads, proceeding to dance together in the bottom of a large pit. As they danced,
Marind-anim
151
promiscuous heterosexual intercourse took place between imo men and women in attendance. Simultaneously and secretly in the night, arrowheads were inserted into the blank eye-holes of large shields, mysteriously called pahui (headhunting clubs), that had previously been set up around the pit {ibid. :663). Toward daybreak, those present gathered tumultuously around the pit while men climbed surrounding coconut trees and threw down a number of young coconuts. The dera^-performers cast off their costumes and leaped out of the pit; simultaneously, the "pahui" shields were thrown in. The "pahuF and costumes were then frantically buried as the pit was filled up and the earth stamped down. The meat from the coconuts was then mixed with mingled semen and vaginal fluids (collected during the promiscuous sexual intercourse of the preceding night) and eaten in a feast. As van Baal recounts, the rite enacted the myth of Uaba and Ualiwamb, who became locked in intercourse and were covered up to protect them from public view (ibid. :657-665). This primordial event was embodied not only in the dance of male and female dema in the pit and the corresponding sexual intercourse of the audience but in the secret insertion of phallic male arrow points into the concentric eye holes of the large and engulfing female pahui - the female aspect being dominant in imo and Sami-rek affiliations. Once these projectiles were pushed irretrievably into the receiving shield, they became the embodiment of Uaba and Ualiwamb, whom they replaced as dema when the performers leaped from the pit and left their costumes behind. Locked in copulation, the sexually engaged pahui were covered up along with the costumes that revealed their secret identity. The imo culminated in a fervent headhunting raid that enacted the rejuvenation of death into life through the taking of heads with re-masculinized pahui, that is, as presaged by the taking and eating of "coconut" heads mixed with sexual secretions in the final imo rite. Imo and mayo shared basic mythic themes but enacted them with complementary emphasis. In the imo, the sexually resistant demawoman was dominant in images of evil and decay - the Excrement Woman. This was counterbalanced by the imo casting of living women in "the main roles in the promiscuous aili sexual rites" (ibid.:651). In both the imo and mayo, Marind women participated as important actors, and though they were excluded from awareness of key cult secrets, particularly in the imo, women nonetheless "played a substantial part in the celebration of every secret rite" (ibid. :654). In both cults,
152
Reconfiguration
homosexuality appears to have been absent in the climactic cult performances and in their corresponding myths. Yet both cults culminated a four-to-six-year period of seclusion and indoctrination of young adolescent boys in bachelor houses during which homosexual insemination took place at the prerogative of the "MB" as binahor-father (ibid. :669-674). Both cults ideally culminated in large-scale headhunts and subsequent head-feasts. In other respects, imo and mayo were complements; the former strongly emphasized femininity, death, darkness, and destruction, and the latter emphasized maleness, light, life, and creation. In this sense van Baal (1966:665) is correct that the two cults are cosmological opposites though they present permutations of the same mythic themes. This complementarity informs the myths' social organization as well, since the mayo Woman comes from imo and the imo Woman from mayo. "The relationship between the two cults is modelled on that between the two moieties; they exchange their women" (ibid. :436). Though initiation into imo was mutually exclusive with the mayo and reflected a historically independent ethnic identity, the two cults developed intertwined mythical imagery and became complementary parts of a single mythic cycle. The Sosom cult
Another complement to mayo and imo is the cult of Sosom, the great phallic warrior hero, whose name was also that of the bullroarer. The Sosom cult had adherents in the eastern Marind coastal area, where most of its initiates were subsequently also initiated into the mayo. Sosom is a giant closely associated with Uaba, and van Baal (1966:664) suggests they "are one and the same power under different aspects." Both dema are trapped in heterosexual intercourse, but whereas Uaba is wrenched free, Sosom loses his penis and is castrated in the encounter, whereafter he gives men the bullroarer and indoctrinates them into the practice of homosexuality. Sosom cult celebrations emphasized mythic themes of castration, devouring of novices, revelation of bullroarers, and secrecy from women, as well as homosexuality. In the cult as in the myth, the giant Sosom travelled annually from the far east of Marind territory westward to the Kumbe River, staying in each village along the way for one to five nights. His impending presence was forewarned to the public by huge footprints and large piles of excrement produced by men but said to be from Sosom, the "anus-man." The rites were transmitted sequentially
Marind-anim
153
from village to village: upon completing the rites, each boan of the performing village brought a semen-coated bullroarer westward and touched a bullroarer that had been brought to meet it from a village where the cult had not yet been practiced that year {ibid. :472f.). Though Sosom visited each village yearly, his fullest visit came when a new group of boys was ready to be initiated into the cult. For this, Sosom's ritual ground in the village was enclosed by a fence some four meters high; within it, a large platform approximately eight meters high was built. Women were strongly debarred from the cult ground and from seeing the bullroarers. After nightfall, the novices were brought to the cult ground. Following on his footprints and excrement, Sosom's eminent approach was broadcast by his huge voice - which emanated from bullroarers and from a long and shrill bamboo pipe that Marind adopted from Trans-Fly peoples to the east {ibid. :476; Williams 1936:186). As the boys waited inside the fence, they were told that Sosom would devour and then vomit or disgorge them through defecation. An opening was ripped in the fence and Sosom entered, whereupon the men accompanying Sosom beat the novices with burning torches and wooden clubs (van Baal 1966:479). The huge platform swayed as the giant Sosom ostensibly sat on it; his huge "tail" descended and touched the novices. The boys were then dragged by their binahor-fathers to meet the dema. A large pole carved in the shape of a phallus and painted red was rapidly set up to represent Sosom's castrated phallus. To the loud accompaniment of bullroarers and pipes, the elaborately costumed Sosom danced around the pole with his retinue, followed by the initiate sponsors and their novices dragged along. Then, Sosom knelt down in front of the boys and his decorations were taken off him; the dema was revealed as a man. The boys were sworn to keep the cult's revelation secret from women, and each was given a clan bullroarer, which he had thereafter to store in the men's house under the supervision of his binahor-father inseminator. Dancing continued and the boys were allocated places outside the enclosure. During the remainder of the night, they were the targets of promiscuous anal intercourse by the initiated men, who continued to sing and dance around Sosom's red phallus (i'6id.:479,481). In the morning, a large cast of dema-performers, including women, enacted mythic scenes from Sosom's nonhomosexual adventures {ibid.:483). The rites concluded with a large feast, whereupon the bullroarers were secretly coated with semen to transmit the cult westward.
154
Reconfiguration
The Sosom cult was in several ways equivalent to afirst-stageinitiation for boys, and it likely marked their introduction to the bachelors' house and the period of anal insemination, thereafter performed exclusively by their binahor-fathers. This period lasted until the climactic mayo ceremonies, at which women were also initiated and indoctrinated in ritual sexual customs. The Sosom cult was strongly associated with eastern origins. Both Wirz and van Baal believed it to have originated as a foreign cult incorporated by eastern Marind with Geb-ze mythology as a first-stage precursor to their own mayo ceremonies (ibid. :267f., 472ff., 489). Trans-Fly myth and ritual highlighted themes that were most central to the Sosom cult: male homosexuality, exclusion of women, and revelation of bullroarers (van Baal 1982:chs.4-5; Williams 1936:chs.ll, 16). This view is also consistent with the annual origin of Sosom in the far east, his westward migration, and cult specifics such as bullroarers and distinctive flutes that originated among the Yei and other Trans-Fly peoples. By the early twentieth century, the Sosom cult had diffused further west and north and was said to make a secret annual journey to inland imo areas, where it likely combined with imo rites inaugurating boys' homosexual insemination (van Baal 1966:664). However, van Baal (ibid. :489) also notes that the Sosom cult is so fully integrated in Marind-anim life that we simply have to accept it as genuinely Marindinese, whatever its origin. In our concept of the origin of Marind-anim culture as the result of multilateral contacts between neighboring and mutually related groups, the question whether a certain ritual is foreign or native is hardly relevant.7
This reasoning may be extended to incorporate rather than suppress the strong connection between Sosom and cult practices diffusing from the east. Through cultic amalgamation, Marind borrowed elements from and even incorporated ethnic groups within the framework of their own elaborating cosmology. In the process, significant and sometimes elaborate differences among sub-groups could be encompassed without causing political polarization or enmity; indeed, such differences could become the basis for mythic complementarity and social alliance. Marind identity was expanded rather than diminished by its diverse cult affiliations. Headhunting
As their social and cosmological validation, major cult enactments such as imo and mayo culminated in long-distance headhunting raids outside
Marind-anim
155
Marind territory {ibid. :716, 743). These raids were collective ventures, and co-participating groups sometimes included six or more large villages {ibid. :710). These villages were typically of the same major cult affiliation, though affiliation across cult lines also took place In contrast to many other New Guinea groups, Marind villages not participating in a raid consistently let the attacking party pass unmolested through their territory to reach foreign areas. Just as important, the houses, gardens, and other property of those departing were vouched safe from destruction or theft by other Marind. As a result, headhunting expeditions often lasted for weeks at a time and covered hundreds of kilometers. They also occurred quite frequently. Nonparticipating Marind settlements joined as honored guests in the large head-feasts that concluded the expedition. Marind greatly enjoyed traveling beyond the perimeters of their territory. These foreign areas were first and foremost "headhunting grounds" (kui-mirav) {ibid.'.lll). As one Marind put it to a colonial officer, "Let us go and take their heads. That is what they are made for!" (quoted in van Baal 1966:696). Before pacification, "an [headhunting] expedition was really a treat. Once the men had decided to mount one, everybody, the young people in particular, wished to go" {ibid.713). Even after headhunting was suppressed, Marind wanted to continue their expeditions, being desirous of long-distance travel, visiting, and trading {ibid.'.lll). If subsistence resources in the targeted area were sufficient to sustain them, the general populace of a village would accompany the warriors. Men, women, children, and the elderly would go, leaving behind only the sick, the very old, and a contingent of young women to process sago for the head-feast to follow {ibid.:113). Given this collective exodus, a whole string of Marind villages might be left largely deserted during the headhunting season. Visiting with friendly villages along the way and trading with those further afield, the expedition proceeded along special "headhunting roads" - specially cleared tracks in forest. These combined with inland waterway travel in long canoes and led to the edges of Marind territory {ibid. :705, 717). As they approached the Marind periphery, expeditions that planned an overland traverse established special hiding places for canoes and enjoined local guides to help them. When waterways were reencountered, further canoes were solicited or extorted from peoples residing nearby. Food was stored in long canoes, obtained from
156
Reconfiguration
friendly villages along the way, and pillaged from areas outside Marind territory (ibid.:7U). Marind war parties were large. In 1884, an estimated 1,200 Marind in thirty to forty war canoes were discovered by Captain John Strachan across the international border some 280 km east of the main Marind settlements. (In the ensuing engagement, Strachan's ship was lost and Strachan himself barely escaped with his life [Strachan 1888:46, 49, 51-69]). A dozen years later, a punitive expedition in British New Guinea lead by Lieutenant-Governor William MacGregor encountered about seventy-five manned Marind war canoes and managed to capture forty-eight of the craft (BNG 1896:30f.). "In most of the canoes were twenty or thirty bundles of sago, each bundle weighing ten or twelve pounds" (ibid. :55, cited in van Baal 1966:713). The headhunting expedition could have totalled 1,500 or more persons despite being over 250 km from the main Marind settlements. Going yet further to the east, Marind war parties from Kaiburse traveled as far as the Fly River, a straight-line air distance of about 325 km, and during the round trip journey they may have traveled 1,000 km or more (ibid.:697-8). Imo villagers in the central Marind area were particularly avid headhunters, mounting expeditions well beyond both the eastern and northwestern Marind borders. Especially when attacking groups to the east, Marind expeditions so outnumbered their opponents that they faced little resistance or reprisal. War parties would often split into constituent village groups to maximize their take of enemy heads from different settlements (ibid.'JIO). The basic attack plan was to surround the targeted settlement in the middle of the night and attack at first light. Unless a counterattack was expected, Marind women and children stayed nearby in camp (ibid. :716). In the attack, enemy adults were hit or shot, held, and beheaded. Children and young women were captured. Before decapitating a victim, Marind ideally broke a fretted headhunting club (pahui) over his or her head. The most elaborate pahui had a female vulval disk that slid up over the male shaft as the club was wielded. When the victim was struck, the male phallus portion of the club would break off during this movement, that is, in symbolization of castration from copulation (ibid. :730-741, 758). The final exclamation of the victim prior to beheading was taken to be his or her "head name" and was bestowed as such upon a Marind child or relative. Obtaining head names for children was one of the main stated reasons for Marind headhunting, and in some of the larger central
Marind-anim
157
villages, it was boasted that all the children, both girls and boys, had true individual head-names (ibid.:709, 111). Many heads were indeed taken - van Baal gives a conservative estimate of perhaps 150 per year and colonial officers confiscated up to 90 fresh heads after a successful headhunting expedition {ibid. :709f.). Marind considered the symbolic appropriation of the head to be more important than its subsequent possession. Though heads were kept as war trophies, they were not particularly revered as ritual or decorative sacrae (ibid. :718, 751). Likewise, though cannibalism was sometimes practiced - of both the head and the body generally - there appears to have been little spiritual significance given to this act. Available evidence suggests that cannibalism of victims was not invariable or general and may have been undertaken in significant part as a supplementary food source during long expeditions when supplies were low, for instance, "in case the assailants had not had any meat for a long time, all the members of the party might feast on parts of the bodies of their victims" (ibid. :746). Coastal Marind areas were effectively immune from headhunting reprisal, though in the longest raids, they could be subject to harassment and resistance, particularly in the northwest across the Digul (ibid. :709). However, "no enemy war-party, however passionate the desire for revenge, ever ventured into Marind territory, the Marindanim being wise enough to keep up friendly relations with their immediate neighbours" (ibid. :24). Marind headhunted across all of their borders. Though for reasons of colonial history their raids are most well known eastward across the international border, expeditions were also carried out avidly in the north and west. Headhunting roads led to the Yelmek peoples and across the Digul River in the west, including where it was so wide that the far bank could barely be seen (ibid. :707). Even groups in the eastern third of Marind territory, such as the Kumbe, made the 150 km trip to the Digul area for headhunting (ibid.:705). Indeed, the Digul was the area most strongly associated with headhunting mythologically. More pragmatically, it also harbored rich stands of sago that provided a plentiful food source for large war parties. To the northwest, Marind predated the Meklew; further north, they raided upstream across the Digul; to the northeast, they attacked the northern Yei and along the middle Maro River (ibid. :702f., 707). The threat of long-distance raiding provided an impetus for foreigners in border areas to make peace with adjacent Marind groups. This
158
Reconfiguration
gradually mitigated the raiding threat posed by more distant Marind as well, who would then be allowed to pass peacefully (or be actively escorted) through the outsiders' territory to raid areas yet more distant. Headhunting was in the process redirected and intensified with the help of erstwhile enemies against groups further afield. Through progressive alliance, the border group could eventually become affiliated with and amalgamated to the parent Marind system. This trend can be documented in various forms along eastern, northeastern, northwestern, and western Marind borders. Along the eastern border, Nevermann (1939:32) notes that the neighboring Kanum-anim were never raided by the Marind-anim who lived in the neighbourhood, but they suffered from attacks by the Sangase [ImoMarind] people . . . and probably also by other Kumbe valley villages. Apparently the Kanum people themselves never attacked . . . the Marind-anim . . . but directed their raids against the Gambadi, Semariji and Keraki [further east and northeast]." (quoted in van Baal 1966:700) In one specific example of border politics, three young Marind men travelling far from home were refused water by Kanum-anim near the Marind's eastern border. In retribution, a war party of Marind men went beyond the offending village and intercepted groups of Kanum travelling to a nearby feast. After inviting them to sit down and chew betel, the Marind killed and beheaded the Kanum, whose bodies were concealed in the thicket nearby so as not to alert the next group of approaching Kanum. This group, too, was similarly dispatched (ibid. :690). It is easy to see how such events could encourage the remaining Kanum to be more hospitable to Marind in the future as the latter arrived from distant areas to traverse Kanum territory. Further east along the coast, Marind confronted the Markai-anim, "whom they sometimes fought and sometimes befriended. In the latter case they went inland together with the Markai-anim to fight the Batu-anim in the interior" (ibid. :697). Similarly, Marind appear to have raided and then befriended the southern Yei-anim, enlisting their support in headhunting against more distant groups among the northern Yei (ibid. :703f.). The southern Yei had by the time of contact "adopted several traits of Marind-anim culture" (ibid.:704). Again, Marind settlements close by did not attack, but they could "show the way" to Marind headhunting expeditions emanating from further south. Though the Yei were respected by Marind for their headhunting skills, their own raids were directed
Marind-anim
159
further north against the Boazi and against some of the fringe-Marind settlements of the upper Bian; they never travelled south to reciprocate Marind attacks {ibid. :706). The next step in the process of amalgamation can be seen among the Upper Bian people, who, as they became assimilated into Marind culture, attacked each other much less frequently and even befriended the Boazi further northeast for purposes of excursions to distant Lake Murray areas (ibid. :706).8 Likewise in the northwest, Meklew-anim villages were befriended by nearby Marind and attacked by those further away; the Meklew themselves redirected their aggression further north and east, along the Buraka and Eli Rivers (ibid. :707). In the far west, Marind attacked the Komolom and drove a portion of them out. These refugees resettled further away as the Yelmek ethnic group, upon whom Marind later re-encroached (ibid. :14). Not coincidentally, Marind alternated attacks with friendly relations towards the remaining Komolom peoples, the village of Mombum indeed being assimilated and participating in the Marind mayo cult despite having a non-Marind language (ibid. :16). In the process, the area became a vantage point for raids further west on Frederik Hendrik Island (Kolopom), whose eastern population alternately was raided by the Marind and cooperated with them in attacking more distant Kolopom groups (ibid. :708; Serpenti 1968:129). The general pattern was one of border groups being alternately befriended, particularly by Marind nearby, and raided, particularly by Marind groups more distant. In the process, border groups were coopted, first as guides and conduits, and later as active allies, against enemies further afield. The survivors of border groups were gradually amalgamated with the Marind parent system in cultic affiliation and sociopolitical alliance. External domination and internal equality?
Marind established an alliance system that kept relative peace among some 15,000 persons and directed hostility against outsiders. Yet more remarkably, this system operated without the barest outlines of political hierarchy or centralization; there was surprisingly little internal domination of some Marind groups or status categories by others. Though feasts were large, competitive feast-giving was undeveloped and investment of gift-valuables was virtually nil. Leadership rivalry was less developed than in most other south coast language-culture areas (see chapter 4). Gerontocracy was undeveloped relative to Australian aboriginal groups
160
Reconfiguration
as well as to many New Guinea societies, including south coast groups such as the Elema. Inter-group rivalry was subordinated to or amalgamated within mythic and cultic complementarity, and religious diversity was if anything sought rather than suppressed. Marind subsistence and residence were likewise highly decentralized, lacking even the large longhouses and sizable settlements found in many other south coast New Guinea groups. These trends throw into relief the importance of mythico-ritual affiliation and the requisite union of wide-spread complements in cult performance, headhunting, and feasting. Despite a hypermasculine warrior ethic, gender inequalities were muted relative to some of the other south coast New Guinea languageculture areas. Notwithstanding the emphasis on male headhunting and the unmistakable sexual trauma of otiv-bombari, the status of Marind women was positive in several respects, as discussed in chapter 5. Female status was probably yet higher in those locales and time periods in which mutualistic rather than asymmetrical ritual heterosexuality was emphasized. Marind women had a high degree of marital choice and were actively involved in cults and feasts as social participants and costumed deraa-performers. The reduction of gender antagonism in the service of larger gender complementarity mirrors the sociopolitical drive to limit divisive polarization. The opposition between men and women, as between maleness and femaleness as categories, was not one of acrimony or constant domination. As van Baal implies, inequalities were ameliorated in the service of a political union that was larger and more celebratory when women were actively included. Oppositions were submerged as dualistic complements within larger cosmological integration. More inclusively, of course, the egalitarianism that furthered alliances informed the huge and hugely successful mequality between Marind as a whole and the foreigners of their headhunting grounds. Cultural richness and egalitarianism pushed against gender inequity within. Domination and inhumanity were projected without. Marind expansion and incorporation of outsiders
To what degree were outsiders decimated as opposed to incorporated into Marind society and culture? Those areas easiest to attack, to the east, were also those most sparsely populated, and as the number of defenders was further reduced through headhunting, they became ever easier to attack. Hence the "steady decrease in population eroding these small tribes" (ibid.:702; see also Wirz 1933; Haddon 1891; Vertenten
Marind-anim
161
1923). Ernst (1979) has suggested that by the time of colonial contact, the eastward expansion of the Marind was nearing its maximum possible extent; the size of the populations residing there was getting small and their distance from the Marind was getting great. These difficulties were to some extent mitigated by Marind reduction of hostility and amalgamation of groups in eastern border areas. It is hard to determine at what point cultural incompatibility would have prevented remnant Kanum and western Trans-Fly groups such as the Yei from themselves becoming Marind variants. To their north and northwest, Marind encountered populations that were more plentiful and closer at hand; they provided both greater resistance to and greater potential for Marind cultural expansion. Evidence suggests that northern Bian Marind were becoming adherents to the imo and Sosom cults, which fit with their pre-existing religious emphasis on coconut-as-head imagery, ritual hetero- and homosexuality, and revelation of bullroarers to male initiates (van Baal 1966:586, 588, 606). Though disputes over cult organization and over revelation of cult secrets had caused great conflict among Upper Bian villages - reminiscent of Sepik River disputes {ibid. :574; cf. Harrison 1990) - this pattern changed as they affiliated with Marind to the south. By virtue of this association, "the upper Bian villages did not fight each other, and when occasionally they did have a fight, they would not cut off the heads of their victims" (van Baal 1966:706). In the early twentieth century, Bian Marind were fervently expanding Marind influence through alliance and extensive raiding: west across the Digul, east among the Yei, and north toward Lake Murray {ibid. :578, 706). As van Baal (1984:129) recently summarizes, "Marind-anim culture was an expanding culture, spreading from the coast to the interior, and along the coast from east to west. This expansion was particularly evident in the case of the subtribes on the upper Bian River." Demography and fertility
Marind kidnapping of children and young women during headhunting raids had special sociodemographic importance. Young captives were brought back to Marind territory and, in the case of children, raised as Marind-anim; they "were adopted and received into the tribe as members with the same rights as own children" (van Baal 1966:24). Indeed, their identity as foreigners was hidden as much as possible. The prolonged training that culminated with initiation into the mayo or imo cult undoubtedly provided a fertile context for ethnic resocialization.
162
Reconfiguration
The number of children adopted from foreign groups was substantial. In the village for which the best data are available, there were at least twenty-two adoptees out of a population of 268, that is, 8.2 percent, who had been captured in the course of headhunting expeditions and raised as Marind-anim. This is a low estimate, as these data on child capture were collected only for persons in the ten to thirty-five year age group. If this age group constituted half of the population, the actual percentage of persons abducted might be twice as high, that is, sixteen percent. The figures are further underrepresented since, as van Baal notes, Marind concealed a person's foreign origin. It was bad form among the Marind to allude to somebody's being of foreign extraction . . . Kidnapped children were raised in precisely the same way as own children and their real descent was kept a secret from them as long and as completely as possible. It follows that the number of own children was in reality low. (ibid.29)
The demographic importance of abducted persons is reflected in the post-pacification Marind practice of buying children from other groups, particularly those across the Digul River. In five northern Marind villages for which data are available, the percentage of village children who had been obtained by purchase was 25 percent, 24 percent, 20 percent, 13 percent, and 11 percent (ibid. :32). Before pacification, the incidence of child-acquisition by force is likely to have been similar, supplying perhaps ten percent to twenty percent of the Marind population. The importance of child capture to Marind is underscored by evidence of a negative internal growth rate during the earliest colonial period. Missionaries and government officials quickly noted the relative absence of infants and found an abnormally low Marind birth rate. During one early annual period prior to the introduction of Western diseases, only three births as opposed to nine deaths were recorded for 389 people in two villages.9 Western documentation of Marind fertility was spurred by the outbreak of introduced venereal granuloma (donavanosis). Donavanosis spread rapidly given Marind sexual practices and was brought under control through widespread and highly intrusive medical and public health measures enforced by Dutch officers in the 1920s and 1930s (South Pacific Commission 1952-53:111-122; Vogel and Richens 1989).10 In a 1920 medical study of the Marind, Cnopius, the chief doctor, found an "abnormally high incidence of sterility, not only among
Marind-anim
163
women who had suffered or were suffering from venereal granuloma, but among non-infected women as well" (van Baal 1966:26). These findings were reconfirmed in a comprehensive report by a research team sponsored in 1952 by the South Pacific Commission to investigate the causes and consequences of Marind depopulation (South Pacific Commission 1955).n Jan Verschueren, who was fluent in Marind and probably the most sensitive of any who have made intensive first-hand enquiries concerning Marind custom and belief,12 paid close attention to privacy and social context in collecting the report's survey data. Because the study casts important light on Marind demography prior to the onset of introduced venereal disease, itsfindingsbear scrutiny.13 A reasonably complete reproductive history of 2,408 Marind women revealed that of those born before 1908, thirty-three percent had never been pregnant; of those born between 1909 and 1913, twenty-nine percent had never been pregnant. Among women born between 1914 and 1928, however, only six percent had never been pregnant (McArthur 1955:9, Table 8; see also van Baal 1966:26). This diminution of primary sterility closely paralleled reduction of ritual sexuality, particularly otiv-bombari, which was effectively eradicated when the last-mentioned female cohort was reaching its childbearing years (South Pacific Commission 1955:184). The numbers revealed a similar pattern spatially, with high primary sterility persisting longer in areas where the sexual rites persisted and declining sooner in areas where they were more quickly halted (McArthur 1955:9f.). The team considered a wide array of blood-sample, nutritional, and biometric data across regions and age-cohorts of differing degrees of acculturation in conjunction with qualitative ethnographic queries by Verschueren. They attempted to discern alternative possible causes of precolonial primary sterility besides those related to Marind sexual practices; they found none. The depopulation team was aware of potential bias in their survey data, and they considered the possibility that older women with no surviving children might be more prone than younger women to state that they had never been pregnant (South Pacific Commission 1955:178). If such a differential bias between age groups had been present, one would have expected older women to similarly underreport the incidence of stillbirths and miscarriages and, among those who had borne children, the total number of pregnancies relative to younger women. Yet the data showed similar rates of stillbirths and miscarriages for older and younger women and similar rates of pregnancy once primary sterility was controlled for. As the team's demographer, Norma
164
Reconfiguration
McArthur (1955:10) put it, "the women of these older cohorts who were capable of reproduction had just as many pregnancies on the average as the women in the reproductive period now."14 The bulk of the variance was explained by differential patterns of primary sterility alone. As a result, the early demographic deficit had not been caused by factors that might have minimized the rate of offspring survival or the number of pregnancies for women who could bear children. Given this unusual patterning of compromised fertility, the depopulation team looked to the impact of Marind sexual practices. Verschueren documented that ritual heterosexuality, and otiv-bombari in particular, was a necessary accompaniment to the following Marind ceremonies and rites: marriage; first post-parturition menstruation; to commemorate an infant's first sitting up; to reward masters of feasts or ceremonies for their services; pig feasts, mortuary ceremonies and feasts on the grave; new garden preparation; to induce the ripening of sugar cane and yams; to ensure successful fishing or hunting expeditions; to promote the coming of rains; to celebrate completed gardens; to dispel and to cure sickness; and to accompany/celebrate a range of different dances and cult enactments, including those of the mayo and imo. Ritual heterosexuality was also necessary to collect mingled sexual secretions as a crucial life-giving elixir to treat wounds, blacken teeth (a decorative custom), mix with food and promote children's growth, coat ritual objects and garden plants, and as a medicine for sickness (South Pacific Commission 1955:70-79; van Baal 1966:810-813). Based on the frequency of these uses and occasions, the depopulation team estimated that an average married woman might be subject to serial copulation in otiv-bombari twenty-three times per year (South Pacific Commission 1955:74). As van Baal (1966:814f.) notes, however, some of the above occasions coincide or may be celebrated simultaneously. Even so, the incidence of serial sexual intercourse was high, and van Baal (ibid.:807f.) concurs that otiv-bombari was "a concomitant of nearly every feast, dance, and ceremony, and the high frequency of these opportunities for sexual license lent substance to the reputation for hypertrophic sexuality which the Marind-anim established for themselves at an early stage of contact." Otiv-bombari marks an extension of beliefs common in New Guinea that several acts of sexual intercourse are necessary to induce conception (Knauft 1989a:208-211); in the Marind case, serial intercourse was targeted by a number of men particularly at newly married women to help them conceive. But Marind ritual heterosexuality was caught in a
Marind-anim
165
vicious circle with the very feature it was most explicitly designed to cure, that is, infertility. Ritual sexuality intensified as the rate of infertility mounted, and it was targeted particularly at those young women who had difficulty conceiving. This activity grew yet more pronounced as Western venereal disease was introduced and the rate of infertility climbed yet higher. In the process, the interspersing of otiv-bombari with more general and less traumatic sexual intercourse in which larger numbers of women participated and each copulated but once or twice - shifted to a more exclusive focus on otiv-bombari {ibid. :819). On each of these occasions, one or two young women were copulated by many men in succession, each typically thrusting for several minutes until coming to orgasm (South Pacific Commission 1955:75; see van Baal 1966:807-821). Being thought necessary to induce fertility, otiv-bombari was repeated quite frequently when a young woman was newly married. What were the women's attitudes toward this sexual trauma? Several female informants confessed that they participated, not primarily because it was their husbands' wish, but because they felt it a necessity . . . Either the women believed that unless they submitted to the rite they were not to have children, or they feared that if they abstained from it, they would fall ill, be stricken by the demay as some of them said. (ibid. :815f.)
Spiritual belief notwithstanding, otiv-bombari was physiologically traumatic, and the day after the rite, women could hardly walk, sometimes being able to move "only crawling on all fours" (South Pacific Commission 1955:75; van Baal 1966:815). The effect of soft tissue irritation and infection in lowland tropical climates is great. As anyone who has lived in the south New Guinea lowlands can attest, a slight skin wound can fester with surprising ease and turn into a tropical ulcer. These problems are heightened in abrasion of women's genital tissue, which is blood-rich, retracted, and unexposed to light - that is, providing an ideal environment for bacterial growth. Though not generally known at the time of the depopulation team's survey, it has since been documented that severe or chronic vaginal infection can indeed induce sterility through the syndrome of symptoms collectively called pelvic inflammatory disease (PID). As summarized by Eschenbach (1980:143) and McFalls and McFalls (1984:289), PID can be predisposed by sexual activity that causes nonspecific anaerobic vaginitis and a resulting proliferation of bowel organisms in the vagina. Akerlund et al. (1975:170) have suggested that
166
Reconfiguration
coitus entailing trauma to the vulva, urethra, and vagina increases the risk of such infection. As McFalls and McFalls (1984:289) state, "Some type of mechanism associated with sexual activity is always sought in PID cases because pelvic infections are rarely seen in premenstrual and postmenopausal women and women who are not sexually active, such as nuns." Once begun, a train of infection is easily reengaged. This is reflected in the medical finding that pelvic infections with "endogenous aerobic and anaerobic organisms are more frequent in women who have had a prior episode of PID," suggesting that "resulting tubal damage renders the genital tract more vulnerable to infection with the endogenous flora" (ibid.). In short, there is medical evidence for a recurring chain of worsening endogenous infection that could be begun by especially traumatic coitus and culminate in permanent sterility as a result of pelvic inflammatory disease. Though these findings were unknown to the Marind depopulation team, they are highly consistent with their reasoning and conclusions. The repetition of sexual trauma entailed by repeated bouts of otiv-bombari among young women, especially in a humid tropical environment, would appear highly predisposed to initiate and quickly intensify inflammatory pelvic infection, causing a high rate of sterility. In 1955, the depopulation team concluded that prior to the onset of venereal disease, "the absence of pregnancies was probably due to chronic inflammation of the cervix uteri and chronic irritation of the female genital organs in consequence of excessive copulation" (Kooijman 1959:25; cf. van Baal 1966:27). In addition, those children born to never-married women from their sexual initiation into mayo and imo cult enactments were uniformly killed; they were believed to be dema children. The same was true for all children born to women who had not yet married (ibid. :155).15 In this respect, cultural practices that threatened a woman's fertility as soon as she was married were complemented by others that reduced the survival of offspring born prior to marriage to almost zero. Regardless of the exact history of pathogenic agents involved in Marind depopulation,16 it appears that their hypertrophic sexual customs compromised female fertility and greatly facilitated the spread of sterility-causing infection and disease. By providing an easy means of intrusion for pathogenic agents, both indigenous and introduced, Marind sexual practices were strongly "preadapted" to incurring great reproductive cost in both the precolonial and colonial periods. These trends were complemented by infanticide of children that might be born
Marind-anim
167
prior to the onset of acute infection and inflammation, that is, prior to marriage. The exact magnitude of Marind childlessness prior to introduced Western disease may never be known, but it is evident that the deficit was great enough precolonially to make Marind demographically nonviable and highly dependent upon child-capture to replenish their population. This demographic problem was merely intensified by the introduction of venereal pathogens during the colonial era. Marind myth and ritual contain deeply-embraced and almost obsessively elaborated themes of excessive copulation, castration, and violent reproduction. That these concerns were so emphatically accentuated at the core of Marind myth and ritual strongly support the notion that Marind infertility was not an artifact of the colonial encounter but was a long-standing problem. Van Baal (1966:31f.) concludes, I think correctly, that "the rate of reproduction was insufficient to keep numbers constant and that, consequently, the kidnapping of children and their adoption as full-fledged members of the tribe was not a matter of indulgence, but a dire necessity." General patterns
In ethnographic abstract, Marind society and culture developed in a reinforcing cycle of: (a) mythic linkages between hypersexuality, head-taking, and rebirth (b) avid fertility cultism that enacted mythic themes through ritual hetero- and homosexuality, deratf-performances, and the taking of heads (c) high Marind female infertility from vaginal infection caused to a significant extent by ritual coitus (d) replenishment of the Marind parent population through the capture and adoption of youths from enemy societies during Marind headhunting raids (e) radical gender socialization of outsiders (and all youths) through prolonged mythico-ritual indoctrination, initiation, and sexual subordination; and (f) additional incorporation of ethnic sub-groups by amalgamating their myth and cult systems to the elaborate dualisms and complements of Marind cosmology As a result of this reinforcing cycle, Marind were expanding territorially and demographically on all of their borders in the late nineteenth century despite a negative internal growth rate. Due to elaborate
168
Reconfiguration
cross-cutting mythic and cultic connections, the 14,500 to 16,000 Marind were both internally peaceful and remarkably successful in dominating adjacent ethnic groups. The spreading Marind cycle of demographic crisis and cultural intensification can be clearly seen in the upper Bian Marind. Upper Bian Marind had particularly intensive and persistent heterosexual rites and a particularly high and persistent rate of primary sterility {ibid. :583; McArthur 1955:table 8). They also had a particularly strong "die in copulation" theme in their initiation cult; indeed, the enacted notion that a human novice and a woman locked in intercourse were killed during their rites was so vivid that Wirz (1928:283f.) erroneously believed the act to have occurred in fact rather than as a ritual trick on the novices (cf. van Baal 1966:571). The mythical connection between copulation and headhunting was also particularly strong among Bian Marind (van Baal 1966:584-586), and they were correspondingly avid in capturing children and in buying them following pacification. Finally, the upper Bian was the most active site of Marind ethnic expansion in the early twentieth century (van Baal 1984:129). In short, crucial features in the cycle of internal demographic deficit and expansive response were intensified in the very Marind area that was expanding most rapidly and effectively at the time of colonial pacification. Among Marind more generally, there is a clear pattern of dialectical reinforcement between cultural expansion and its existential effect, that is, internal depopulation. Cultural orientations are importantly causative here rather than derivative; available evidence suggests that the precolonial Marind demographic crisis arose as a direct result of sexual practices motivated by their driving cosmological and ritual orientation. Correspondingly, however, outcomes such as high infertility and demographic nonviability presented the symbolic formation with threats that could not be contained or controlled through spiritual mediation alone. Marind elaborated ever-intensifying beliefs and practices linking hypersexuality with headhunting and culturally-engendered reproduction. Injurious hypersexuality was the virtual origin of fire, of animals, fish, and of the first initiate. The violent resentment of sexual impotence was effectively symbolized by the phallic headhunting club breaking off in castrated sexual intercourse over the headhunting victim's head. But reproductive shortcomings were appeased to good demographic as well as cultural and psychological effect in the appropriation of life - not only the spiritual life of decapitated enemies but the ongoing life of their surviving children.
Marind-anim
169
Analogous processes occurred in the individual as well as the collective psyche. Establishing an identity for Marind children by giving them a true foreign head name complemented the fact that a significant number of them were in fact foreigners. For a foreign child, the beheading of one's parents and being captured by Marind warriors must have been deeply traumatic. This poignant experience was amply drawn upon in the deep resocialization children were subsequently subjected to as Marind-anim neophytes. This cosmological resocialization linked vitality, growth, and reproduction directly to headhunting and primordial death. This poses a fitting psychodynamic recapitulation of identity for children who have themselves been adopted through the killing of their parents and for a culture that impedes its own reproduction by excessive sexuality. Both as foreigners and as natives, adult Marind linked reproductive impediment with military copulation, reproducing their own identity through the foreign Other. Causation and dialectic
What causal process does the Marind system illustrate? Clearly, as Ernst (1979) has cogently pointed out, there was a reinforcing spiral among cultural, sociological, and demographic processes - what Maruyama (1963) calls a positive feedback cycle of deviation-amplification. Within this cycle, the intensity of Marind sexual activity, social alliance, and external headhunting - all so pronounced even within the New Guinea context - were mandated first and foremost by cultural orientation and spiritual belief. The importance of symbolic formations is thrown into relief by the fact that Marind were culturally expanding while they were biogenetically deficient. As a cultural group, Marind were growing on virtually all borders; their beliefs and customs were at the forefront of an advancing cultural boundary. Yet in demographic terms, they were internally nonviable; they could not reproduce themselves from within. Though at a cultural and symbolic level Marind sociocultural formations were highly adaptive and successful, at a biological level they were highly maladaptive: their biogenetic propagation as individuals was severely compromised. Put differently, there was an inverse rather than a direct relationship between Marind cultural success - its success as a symbolic system - and the biogenetic success of its constituent individuals (see Knauft 1987c,d).17 This relationship was mutually reinforcing and not simply coincidental: the fervency of Marind cultural reproduction, encoded so aptly
170
Reconfiguration
in excessive ritual coitus, itself prevented maximal production of offspring at home. Conversely, the relative lack of Marind biogenetic propagation itself fueled the expansionist dissemination of Marind culture and the need to incorporate outsiders. Analogous examples in which cultural success is inversely related to biogenetic propagation are evident on a much larger scale in the rise of large preindustrial cities, such as seventeenth-century London and ancient Rome (see Knauft 1987d). By all accounts, these centers were culturally successful and growing prolifically in size. Nevertheless, they were internally nonviable; they were demographic sink-holes that could not reproduce their population and were highly reliant on immigration. The enormous success of these urban areas as sites of preindustrial symbolic and cultural production is hence in opposition to their constituents' lack of reproductive success, including the most wealthy of them (ibid.: 100-103). Though the similarity could be pushed too far, a somewhat analogous inverse relationship between cultural and reproductive success has arguably occurred in the modern demographic transition (see detailed discussion in Vining 1986). This entailed a reduction in fertility and diminution of reproductive success (relative to that possible) in tandem with increasing economic development and international cultural influence in industrializing countries. Though the dynamics are complex, this pattern contrasts in overall terms with the reproductive success of exploding population in the Third World, which, however dubious it may be from a quality-of-life perspective, is much more adaptive in neoDarwinian terms than patterns in developed countries, that is, it more fully maximizes individuals' biogenetic propagation. In general, cultural success - the widespread dissemination of symbolic formations - is frequently bought at the expense of having relatively fewer children. Given the costs and potentials of cultural transmission, maximal propagation of ideas easily works at cross-purposes to maximal propagation of genes, in contrast to the reasoning of Durham (1991). The frequently inverse relationship between relative cultural and relative biogenetic success illustrates the limits of materialist or genetic determinism, which generally fails to take cultural causation adequately into account. Conversely, it also illustrates the difficulties of an exclusive emphasis on cultural causation. Symbolic formations do not elaborate in an aesthetic void. Marind patterns of development are difficult to comprehend outside of the reciprocal impact that hard-world realities such as demographic deficit have in driving the existing symbolic gestalt
Marind-anim
171
to further intensity and elaboration. Marind illustrate a dialectic spiral between the enactment of culture in the material world and cultural responses to its own actualization. Patterns of reinforcement between the subjective and the existential are not only crucial, they are irreducible. Their relationship is the ultimate determinant of social development.
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
How do Marind-anim compare with the other language-culture areas of south coast New Guinea? To answer this question, we can re-apply the theoretical perspective of chapters 1 and 7 to the other south coast groups. Ethnographically, we can expect to find local permutations on region-wide themes. In a structuralist sense, these permutations are synchronic transformations within a regional cultural structure. But in time, these differences engaged the social and material world to produce surprisingly different results. Structural proliferation is not reversible in practice (Bourdieu 1977, 1990a). The dialectics of practice confront symbolic form with existential result; across space, they actualize social universes that both diverge widely and share much in common. The Marind-anim ethnography exemplifies a strong relationship between fertility cultism and the patterned spread of ethnic and sociopolitical organization. As other south coast language-culture areas are considered, however, it becomes quickly evident that there was wide variation in the integration versus fragmentation of political units, including their degree of centralization, their practical success in warfare, and their geographic expansion. These intra-regional differences do not correspond in direct fashion to basic contrasts in ecology, subsistence strategy, or social organization. Mythic and ancestral beliefs exerted decisive influence on subjective experience and on both political and ritual action. Nevertheless, the actualization of symbolic impetus through local ecology, demography, and inter-ethnic opposition did pose major constraints and opportunities against which cultural motivations elaborated. A distinctive pattern of symbolicexistential interface resulted in each of the seven south coast languageculture areas.
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
173
As a point of departure, we can delineate region-wide themes that provided the grist for local cultural emphases. These included: (i) a cosmological cycle of growth and fertility that included the taking and incorporation of life-force, especially through headhunting (ii) the creation, exchange, and transmission of life-force in ritual heterosexual and (sometimes) homosexual activity (iii)the coalescence of spiritual force in sacred costumes, carvings, trophies, or relics and (iv) the enactment of cosmological growth cycles through elaborate spirit cult performances1 These linked nodes of symbolic impetus cycled life-force through sexuality, reproduction, growth, death, and rebirth. They thus provide a distinctive permutation on symbolic ecologies found elsewhere in Melanesia that linked life, growth, and death through a myriad of culturally constituted exchanges that transacted bodily substance, productive labor, food, material wealth, and sickness or death from sorcery or warfare.2 Along the New Guinea south coast, specific features of fertility emphasized in one language-culture area were often present but less stressed or minimized elsewhere in the region. The "presence" or "absence" of fertility cult elements as signs in a cultural logic is hence less important than their overall configuration and practical influence on social experience in each case. The pragmatics of fertility cultism illuminate its distinctive permutations across the region. Purari
Purari delta peoples were similar to the Marind-anim in believing that life-power of enemies obtained through headhunting rejuvenated the spiritual force of one's group. For Purari, however, this life-force was physically concretized and fervently protected by each settlement in violent competition with its neighbors. Purari were polarized into a small number of large warring villages (Williams 1924; Maher 1961, 1967). Whereas Marind villages were small and internally dispersed in a loose aggregation of boan hamlets, Purari lived in fortress settlements of up to 2,000 persons surrounded by largely uninhabited land. This land was exploited furtively for rudimentary horticulture in hidden gardens and especially for felling sago logs. Armed groups of men typically cut the sago and floated it back to the village for processing by women (Williams 1924:10, 22).
174
Reconfiguration
As among Marind, Purari had an elaborate system of dual organization, but they internalized this complementarity in cross-cutting ties within the fortress-village as a coherent (and solitary) political unit. In contrast to Marind expansion, the fissioning and multiplication of Purari villages was discrete rather than amalgamatory, with highly similar structure within each village but few ties between them (with the exception of individual river clan affiliations [Williams 1924:86; see discussion in Weiner 1988b: 569f. ]). Contact and travelling across Purari community boundaries was dangerous and generally avoided (Holmes 1924:266-268). Purari headhunting focused on the taking of life-force from other Purari villages and adding it to one's clan spirit incarnations (Williams 1923b, 1924:ch.l2; Haddon 1919). These took the form, among other things, of large wicker monster embodiments (kaiemunu) made by each of the village's river clans and kept communally in the sacred rear section of the community's enormous central longhouse (see figure 4). When an enemy head was taken, it was fed to the kaiemunu, being put in the mouth of each clan's kaiemunu in turn to rejuvenate them all (Williams 1923b:387). The kaiemunu became immediately energized, and they jumped and capered about the longhouse, "pulling" the men who held them. After being used to empower the kaiemunu, the victim's remains were eaten by the community at large. Spiritual dedication of heads and subsequent absorption of life-force through whole-body cannibalism was apparently the central cultural motive for Purari headhunting {ibid.: 385).
Figure 4 Purari kaiemunu. Lashed and woven cane. 3.5 m long x 2 m high. (Illustration after Williams 1923b:376, see also his figure 1 and plate 21.)
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
175
The construction of new kaiemunu was closely associated with the dedication of a new longhouse and with the fast growth of young male initiate novices, who helped produce the wicker monsters during their seclusion in the large new edifice (Williams 1923b). The capture and offering of an enemy head at the culmination of the rites spiritually energized the initiates and the new longhouse as well as empowering the completed kaiemunu. Life-force incorporation through headhunting was associated with growth and well-being that was at once physical, residential, political, and spiritual. Purari cultural regeneration also had a strong sexual dimension, reflected in ritual heterosexual intercourse following the headhunt. This coitus occurred between the warriors and the women of the village and especially between some of the men and the wife of the man who had brought down the headhunt victim (Holmes 1924:175; Williams 1924:212-214). Ritual heterosexuality also occurred as an ad hoc accompaniment to other rites and celebrations. In all instances, men who participated were required to give a valuable such as an armshell to their female sexual partners, who were wives of other men (Williams 1924:210-212; Holmes 1924:172f.). The high status of Purari women is consistent with the prestige demands of male headhunting, which were satisfied for the community at large by obtaining a single victim. Masculine aggressiveness was not generalized as a social element of individual status accession and appears if anything to have been negatively valued in marital and domestic contexts. Conversely, since large communities needed but an occasional headhunting victim, the existential risks posed by headhunting attack were not great for the individual as long as he or she kept with groups of kin and did not stray too far from the community. Near the village, men did not need to maintain a hair-trigger readiness for violence and aggression, and their domestic relations appear to reflect this fact. Purari acquired spiritual force in large part through an elaborate political hierarchy of sacred power. Men of high political rank, particularly the hereditary chiefs, were repositories of collective life-power from ancestral imunu spirits in a long genealogical line (Maher 1974). In sanctity, rank, and spirituality, the supreme chief {man) was like a human kaiemunu. Metonymically, he was the "chief of the oru" that is, chief of the sacred chamber where the kaiemunu were kept, and he was strongly identified with the spiritual power of the longhouse - which in turn was conceptually coextensive with the
176
Reconfiguration
community (Holmes 1924:172f.; Williams 1924:76). Given their association with this centralized force, spiritual chiefs seldom absented themselves on expeditions outside the village (Williams 1924:110). In the precolonial era, men of high rank held preeminent decisionmaking and political power within the village, organized feasts and rituals, and commanded a significant amount of obedience. The supreme chief was described as the paidi amua or political as well as spiritual chief of the entire community (ibid. :115). High ranking men and especially the supreme chief had many wives and possessed the wealth items necessary to participate in frequent ceremonial heterosexual intercourse. They also participated most liberally in food exchanges, which in the longhouses were often first offered ceremonially to the kaiemunu. "Food for the men of the ravi [longhouse] is food for the kaiemunu, while to neglect one's friends is to neglect the kaiemunu and incur its displeasure" (Williams 1923b:381). Within the south New Guinea context, village size, political rank, and material localization of spiritual power were highly developed among Purari. The geographic separation, autonomy, and political centralization of Purari fortress-villages contrasts maximally with the dispersed residence, decentralization, and elaborate alliance system of the Marind. Perhaps correspondingly, the Purari language family was a relatively small and geographically circumscribed linguistic isolate (Wurm and Hattori 1981), whereas the Marind language family was expanding along all its borders. As Maher (1961 :ch.2) notes, the point is not that cosmological beliefs rigidly determined Purari warfare, settlement, and political patterns but that they exercised an undeniable and distinctive influence on them. Certainly, abundant sago stands and ease of canoe transport facilitated the growth of large Purari villages, but Marind also availed themselves of plentiful sago resources and extensive canoe travel. Even within the Purari's particular micro-environment, alternative organizational means of exploiting their resource base would have been possible, including decentralized residence and a network of alliances, either with or without the addition of central village shrines. The ecological ramifications of cosmological belief are crucial in understanding divergent systems of sociopolitical organization and development. If reduced to synoptic Durkheimian terms, Purari fertility emphasized coalescence of spiritual force in clan spirit incarnations {kaiemunu), in persons of rank, and in large men's houses. The political
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
111
correlate of this fertility emphasis was centralized competition in warfare between extremely large but widely dispersed Purari villages. The process of concretizing life-force within large fortress villages had important existential results. As communities aggregated more people, inter-village distances increased and villages polarized in stable opposition to each other. Despite what Williams (ibid.:6) describes as remarkable homogeneity of structure between villages, Purari lacked a term for the language they all shared in common, and they had no common ethnonym (ibid. :3-4). Each village was not only a self-sufficient marital, political, and economic unit, it was cosmologically autonomous. Outside communities were a cultural Other. (The Marind, in contrast, might be cosmologically portrayed as emphasizing union of proliferating complements, with a sociopolitical complement of expansive political incorporation both of diverse but decentralized Marind groups and of outsiders.) The social, political, and geographic distance between Purari villages provided selective reinforcement to cultural motivations. As villages became larger, better defended, and more dispersed, it was more difficult to procure headhunting victims; conversely, the spiritual centralization of villages around hereditary chiefs meant that the life-force of a single victim, sacrificed to the kaiemunu and embodied in the supreme chief, rejuvenated the community as a whole. As Williams (1923b:385; 1924:107f.) notes, Purari headhunting was undertaken largely for ceremonial purposes, and war parties were satisfied with whatever straggling man, women, or child they could victimize on the periphery of their enemies' territory. For defenders, this reduced the threat of a frontal village assault and also the threat to them personally, particularly when they were close to home and in the company of coresidents. Correspondingly, minimal loss of life-force from enemy headhunters meant little need to avenge loss and further reduced the impetus to risk large-scale assaults against well-defended villages over long distances in order to procure a large number of heads. As the collective size of the village and its stability increased, the marginal increment provided by an additional victim to its long-amalgamated life-force also decreased. Given Purari spiritual beliefs, what resulted was a strong dedication to headhunting, but to headhunting of a distinctive variety: as an accompaniment to the largest ceremonies, a large war party could kill a lone victim to rejuvenate all the community's clans. Purari symbolic formations were locked in a reinforcing cycle with their own social and material entailments, that is, demographic centralization
178
Reconfiguration
within communities and geocultural separation between them. As these increased, the drive to centralize and maintain accumulated life-force intensified yet further. Kolopom
Among Kolopom, west of the Marind-anim, elaborate dualism resulted neither in large-scale residential cohesion, as among Purari, nor ethnic expansion, as among Marind. Rather, dual organization became strongly competitive and politically divisive, producing invidious competition and acrimonious oppositions at the village, half-village, village ward, and intra-ward levels (Serpenti 1977:chs.3,6). This tendency toward inward-looking division and opposition drew upon the unique swamp ecology of the Kolopom region. Subsistence developed through great individual effort, particularly through intensive horticulture of man-made garden-islands. These were paralleled by small separate islands made for human habitation (ibid. :ch.2). The Kolopom population was dispersed across an expansive reed marsh and inhabited areas comprised of dozens of tiny dwelling islands connected in a mazeway of narrow canoe channels. The reed marsh ecology of the territory made interior areas difficult to traverse and relatively resistant to the headhunting predation that was targeted against coastal Kolopom areas by the Marind to the east and the Digul River groups to the north (Serpenti 1968:126f.). The opposition of Kolopom to foreigners as well as to each other fueled the conclusion by outsiders that the interior of their swampy island was largely impenetrable (Serpenti 1977:ch.l). Like Marind and Purari, Kolopom fertility cult practices linked warfare and ritual heterosexuality to the rebirth of the community through death. Among Kolopom, however, this death occurred importantly within the community: rebirth through headhunting was a concomitant of the gardening success and competitive food-giving that climaxed an elaborate cycle of mortuary feasts held for persons recently deceased in the village. Though admitting various permutations in practice, the following scenario illustrates the ideal Kolopom pattern. Following a death from sickness, the gardens of the deceased were closed and a mounting series of mortuary food-exchanges were held. These exchanges culminated in large competitive gifts of food between village halves. The village half of the deceased accused someone in the opposed village half of having caused the death by contracting the victim's demise with a renowned sorcerer from some other village. This accusation was publicly made by the deceased's kin within their village and was hotly
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
179
disputed by their opposed village half (Serpenti 1968:132-135; 1977:210).3 As a display of their innocence or repentance, the accused village half was supposed to lead a headhunting attack against the outside village that they claimed had sorcerized the deceased. Unlike other south coast groups, Kolopom stated that sorcery revenge was their most important motive for headhunting. Perhaps relatedly, they were not avid headhunters; in the great majority of cases, headhunting attacks to avenge sickness deaths were never arranged (Serpenti 1968:125,127,133). In those headhunting raids that did occur, expedition leaders were paired with novice males from the deceased's village half who were to be initiated into headhunting. The older men proceeded to have promiscuous sexual intercourse with their novices' betrothed wives, who were typically prepubescent. The sexualfluidscollected from this ritual intercourse were rubbed on the male novices to make them strong and protect them in the raid. The mentor and his protege went together in the raid; when the former brought down a victim, he instructed his protege on how to cut off the head, ordered him to drink its dripping blood (to make the novice strong), and gave him the head as a trophy. In contrast to what is known of most other south coast groups, prisoners were often cruelly tormented before they were killed (Serpenti 1968:120).4 Captured heads were taken immediately and planted on the grave of the person who had died from sorcery within the village. This act signified an end to the mourning period; the grave was ritually opened and the deceased's bones anointed with coconut oil. It also lifted the taboo on eating from the deceased's gardens and permitted the competitive food-giving between the village halves that would conclude the mortuary cycle. The deceased's grave was thenfilledin and the head-adorned pole left in place to become the center of an all-night dance, that is, on top of the grave. The dance climaxed with further promiscuous sexual intercourse, especially between the more experienced headhunters and the young betrothed of the male youths, who were now credited as the owners of the heads. In short, taking life through headhunting was used as the reproductive counterbalance against the loss of life within the village. As part of this process, novices from the deceased's village-half were spiritually and sexually reproduced, that is, as an intergenerational replacement for the deceased. At daybreak, a mortuary feast was held and large food piles were acrimoniously exchanged between the two village halves. Thefleshof the
180
Reconfiguration
victim (excepting the brains, which were discarded) was also distributed and consumed by men and boys. The skull of the headhunt victim was then coated with some of the sexualfluidscollected during the preceding night and decorated with the distinctive face-painting and hair style reserved for the dead (Serpenti 1968:123). Initiate novices, who were probably also coated with sexual fluids (Serpenti 1984:315), were adorned in a similar fashion - that is, like the enemy head - and were mourned as "dead." After this they were sequestered in the bachelor's house and secluded from women (Serpenti 1984:301f.).5 During their seclusion, boys were subject to ritual rebirth into manhood through regular homosexual insemination as well as through repeated anointment with sexual fluids obtained from men's intercourse with girls as described above. Seclusionary strictures were also extended in part to the novices' fathers and mentors, who avoided social or sexual contact with their wives during this period (Serpenti 1984:303). In all, then - and here but densely sketched - an elaborate set of antinomies and mediations articulated natural death, head-taking, heterosexual and homosexual fertility, initiatory rebirth, and prodigious food exchange. In structuralist terms, these can be seen as a series of linked oppositions and successive mediations that transform but cannot ultimately resolve the basic opposition between life and death: (a) the opposition between the deceased and his living kinsmen is mediated by and displaced onto the other village half, who become a target of sorcery accusation; (b) the opposition between village halves is mediated and replaced by the opposition against an external village as the target of headhunting; (c) the killing of an enemy mediates and temporarily reduces opposition against the enemy village; (d) the placing of an enemy head on the grave provides a human (if lifeless) replacement for the deceased; (e) the reproductive sexuality of promiscuous intercourse replaces the lifelessness of the head with the assertion of life; the coating of the head with sexual fluids empowers it as an object of ritual power and transformation; (f) the coating of the initiate novice with sexual fluids and dressing him as "dead" simultaneously animates him and associates him with both the enemy head and the deceased. In the process, his life mediates the opposition between their respective deaths; as a
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
181
culturally constituted initiate, he will be a living replacement for the deceased within the village; (g) the exact reciprocity of large food gifts between village sides in the final mortuary exchange mediates their opposition; in the process, each side also tacitly asserts its material self-sufficiency; (h) invidious comparison of small differences in the quality or quantity of foods exchanged between village halves in the final mortuary feast reengages their opposition, making them ripe for sorcery accusation at the next natural death; (i) the cycle begins anew with the next sickness-death in the village. Through its regenerating logic, Kolopom fertility practices transduced fasting into feasting, flesh into food, prohibition into promiscuity, boyhood into manhood, and death into life. The headhunt victim was central to this process through his or her metaphoric association with the deceased-from-sickness, on the one hand, and the initiate novice, on the other. These associations were energized by ritual sexuality, which animated both the head and the novices and fueled the transformation from mournful taboo to life-giving gratification. Apart from its patent structural form, this ideal process also had distinctive and problematic practical results. By itself, the above scenario suggests a binding of village halves as mentor/protege and reciprocal food-givers. Within the village half (but not so frequently between them), wards were bound in addition by sister-exchange and reciprocal homosexual insemination. The village sectors thus appear to submerge their fear of sorcery from each other in alliance against a common Other, that is, against an external village from which they appropriate heads to effect their own cosmological reproduction. In fact, however, the balance between intra-village sectors swung much more toward antagonism than cooperation. Village halves seldom united and outsiders were seldom raided; the suspicion of sorcery was not expunged, but remained within the village. The feasting competition between village quarters and halves was truly divisive - events likened by Serpenti to potlatches (1972-73, 1977:ch.6). Not only was sorcery attributed primarily to the other village half but killings between them appear to have been common, leading in some cases to "mutual slaughter" within the so-called village (Serpenti 1968:130). It was quite dangerous to remain in the other half of a village after dusk, since "one ran the risk of being killed in revenge for a life taken before" (ibid. :130). The favored method of intra-village killing was to
182
Reconfiguration
await the victim in one of the narrow, meandering channels between the little islands grown with palms. The attackers hid under water, breathing through a cane. When the dug-out of the victim passed by, it was overturned and the head of the victim was held under water until he was drowned. (Serpenti 1968:130) Even in the 1960s, people rarely ventured into the other village half and in some villages they did not even know where the garden islands of the other village half were situated. Competitive feasts between village halves always ended at nightfall "as the guests, for fear of sorcery, consider it wiser to return to their own area" (ibid.). Though headhunting per se did not take place between village halves, their relationship is revealed in the origin myth of headhunting. When the culture hero leaves on a headhunting trip, his wife is ravaged by a village counterpart. The hero returns, cuts off the culprit's head, and tells his people to henceforth treat their enemies in the same way. The hero's initial intention of hunting outside the community is hence redirected within it (Serpenti 1968:116ff.). Among Kolopom themselves, even the promiscuous celebration dance that followed the headhunt (watjip) was a focus of competitive dispute: The dancing is always patterned on two parties, which each sing their own songs [disparaging the other side] and thereby try to drown one another. The party which gets into the minority disappears shamefacedly from the dance floor, while the winning party continues to dance till sunrise. This competition often leads to fights. (Serpenti 1969:41) More specifically, The division [between the two parties] is marked by a bamboo strip, for if one were to set foot, during the dance, on the other group's territory, whether accidentally or not, this trespassing would straight-away result in a fight. Even without such an excuse, dances would formerly often end in fights in which men were killed or wounded. (Serpenti 1977:97) Intra-village animosity also appears to have influenced gender beliefs. Women were almost invariably in-married from other village sections; as such, they were almost intrinsically threatening, and men viewed them as highly debilitating both to local male cult activities and to men's cultivation of prestigious root crops. Because food competition paralleled patterns of intermarriage between village sectors, women who polluted male crops effectively increased the standing of their natal relatives in competitive food-exchange relative to that of their own husbands. Intra-village animosity thus helps to explain sexual hostility, strong pollution beliefs, and the low status of Kolopom women despite lack of male prestige
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
183
dependence on female labor and the general lack of a hypermasculine warrior ethic. Prized tubers and women were both given to and received from other village sectors in restricted exchange. There was no possibility of delayed payment or nonequivalent exchange in either case. For precolonial Kolopom, suspicion and antagonism penetrated not j ust the relation between village-halves but lower stages of the dualistic hierarchy, including village quarter-sections (kwanda) and opposed dwelling islands (patha). This nested hierarchy of dualistic residential organization was not necessary for survival. Competitive giving entailed simultaneous reciprocity rather than delayed or asymmetrical giving, and the most important gifts were ceremonial tubers in any event; the exchange did not function as a welfare system to counteract subsistence shortage or facilitate other kinds of trade (contrast Harris 1974). The defense and alliance functions of dualism were also equivocal, since murder as well as wife-stealing, sorcery, and theft frequently took place within the village.6 It has often been suggested that dual organization can foster social integration and residential affiliation in pre-state societies. This outcome was amply evident along the south coast among the Pur ari and, in the Sepik regions of northern New Guinea, among groups such as the Iatmul and Ilahita Arapesh (Bateson 1936; Tuzin 1976; see more generally MayberryLewis and Almagor 1989). But complementary sides in dual organization have the capacity for opposition as well as alliance - for exchanging blows as well as gifts (cf. D. Brown 1979; Schwimmer 1973). The political outcome of dual organization is hence empirically variable. Among Kolopom, the result appears much more contentious and less unifying than in the other south coast culture areas. Kolopom divisiveness does not imply that ritual affiliations between village sections were absent nor that their fertility logic was mere ideology. But these affiliations were strongly cross-cut by political animosity, "fighting with food," and murder as well as sorcery (Serpenti 1968, 1977:ch.3; cf. Young 1971, 1983). The overlaying of restricted exchange and alliance relations with deep-seated conflict and violence is not an empirical anomaly; a version of this same pattern is strongly evident in the south lowlands further inland among the Gebusi (Knauft 1985a, see more general analysis by A. Strathern 1982b). In summary, Kolopom fertility emphasized antagonistic polarization in nested dual organization, restrictively controlled sexual exchange, sexual antagonism, and food-giving competition. Head-taking was the uncommon but structurally key apotheosis of this polarization, that is, opposition escalated to the inter-village level. As a political and economic corollary,
184
Reconfiguration
one finds invidious intra-village opposition in Kolopom residential structure, prestations, sorcery, and killing. Between villages, enmity was punctuated by sporadic headhunting. Kolopom cultural emphasis had the existential effect of political involution . Dualism competed against itself at ever-lower levels, fueling the drive to find security in the smallest kin and residential units. Rather than organizing extensive communal labor, Kolopom separated themselves into tiny islands and maintained themselves in atomized subsistence through a horticultural system that was almost as precarious as it was intensive. As actualized, cultural orientations entailed residential and economic patterns that intensified social insularity, suspicion, and divisiveness. Cultural impetus and its material result reciprocally reinforced Kolopom's involuted oppositions. Trans-Fly
The Keraki of the Trans-Fly area echo Kolopom linkages between root crop production, competitive feasting, and dual organization based on sister-exchange. And in both areas the status of women was low and male prestige was based more on domestic root crop production than on warfare success. Whereas Kolopom horticulture was preeminently a male pursuit, however, Keraki male prestige was highly dependent upon women's garden labor, and polygyny was frequent. Further, Trans-Fly geography posed little impediment to long-distance headhunting. Trans-Fly groups raided each other substantially and sometimes unpredictably (e.g., Beaver 1920:107ff.; cf. Williams 1936:ch.l5). More importantly, they were attacked from all sides in long-distance raids by neighboring language family groups, especially by the Marind to their west, but also by the Kiwai to their southeast, by the Zimikani and "Suki" to their north, and (more sporadically) by the Torres Straits Islanders to their south.7 Because Trans-Fly settlements were small and vulnerable to large contingents of attacking warriors, local groups could lose many members from a single raid. In 1927, Williams (ibid.:288) witnessed the gruesome after-effects of one raid in which thirty-nine victims were killed; not one of the attackers was killed or even, he thought, wounded. By virtue of such attacks, a number of Trans-Fly groups were decimated and forced to flee (see evidence in Haddon 1901; Williams 1936:ch.l5; Strachan 1888:ch.9; Wirz 1933; Beaver 1920:ch.9).8 Combined with the tendency of Trans-Fly peoples to attack each other, foreign predation could well have extinguished major groups in the area within a decade or two had not European pacification intervened. Williams
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
185
(1936:vi, vii) notes that "although the Tugeri [Marind] raids have ceased, they have left their effect in disorganization and social depression," and he assesses the Keraki to be "socially or collectively in rather low spirits." Trans-Fly patterns of fertility cultism were closely tied to a timeless ancestral past and were strongly embodied in mythic and residential association of totemic groups with specific tracts of land. As Ayres' (1983) re-study of the area makes clear, there is strong similarity between Trans-Fly patterns of myth and cosmology and those of Australian aborigines. Indeed, links to the Australian Dream time are stronger here than among any of the other south coast language-culture areas (see ibid. :38ff.). Though the point could be pushed too far, Williams (1936:5, 49) and Beaver (1920:127) both note similarities between the Trans-Fly and northern Australia in geography and in indigenes' physical type. It has sometimes been suspected that the Trans-Fly region is culturally "old" in the New Guinea context, and some eastern Trans-Fly groups do have linguistic affiliation with language families in the Torres Straits (Wurm and Hattoril981). An illuminating comparison can be made here between Trans-Fly peoples and Marind-anim. Whereas Marind dema embodied a primordial past, their presence was continuously creative in the present. Marind liked to travel long distances, wreak the vengeance of the dema on foreign peoples, proliferate their cults in new incarnations, and transform the social and cultural landscape as the dema had done. Trans-Fly peoples, in contrast, were conservatively bound to specific ancestral locations. Lacking specific mythological knowledge of neighboring clans, local groups feared to travel on others' land, worried lest they violate its story-places and court sorcery from its human inhabitants (Ayres 1983:174). Even if a neighboring language dialect was known, it was inappropriate to speak it, since one lacked ancestral connection with the knowledge it presumed (ibid.:108, 137f.). In contrast to the Marind's ubiquitous cross-cutting ritual linkages, Morehead peoples emphasized the "highly autonomous nature of local section groups" (ibid. :171). The Trans-Fly mythical age was collapsed andfixedin the physical world of the present. Just as "mythical beings are no longer active, mobile beings, but are in fixed association with sacred places and things," so too, "true people arefixed,stationary and stable . . ."and "there is a strong positive cultural valuing offixednessas a central notion in beliefs about the meaning of land, place and locality" (ibid. :124f., 106). There was little impetus to introduce social or cultural change. This stasis was reflected metaphorically in the contrast between mythical time, when land was small and
186
Reconfiguration
beings big, and the present, in which the land is big but beings small (ibid. :117). Unlike most other south coast peoples, including the Marind, Trans-Fly material culture was unelaborated both in ritual sacrae and in body decoration. Even their sacred sites were but a dim reflection of their imposing existence in myth (ibid.:312-327; Williams 1936:104). The major sacrae were standard bullroarers and revered but small and unadorned spiritual stones (seefigure5 a,b). By contrast, the Trans-Fly system of myth and place identifications was "staggering in its elaboration" (Ayres 1983:38, 48). Mythical knowledge was highlighted, treated with reverence, and highly secret from women (Williams 1936:292f.). The cultural stasis of this system is reflected in the fact that the myth sequences reported by Williams (1936) remained almost totally unchanged when elicited a half-century later by Ayres (1983:64).
Figure 5 (a) Trans-Fly sacred hawk stone. Flat crescent stone, ground and polished. 5 cm. long. (Illustration after Williams 1936:104.) (b) Bullroarer. Incised wood. 25 cm. long. (Illustration after van Baal 1966:plate 11; Williams 1936:181.)
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
187
In the precolonial era, Trans-Fly cultural predispositions minimized their ability to improvise military affiliations between settlements or pursue long-distance attackers during their lengthy return to home territories. Indeed, foreigners' headhunting raids easily intensified a Trans-Fly sense of identity that was self-sufficient in its mythological component and not dependent upon elaborate material enactment or social development, much less military success. External threats to male status also dovetailed with internal Trans-Fly social inequalities; men's military impotence against outsiders and their insecurity vis-a-vis males from other communities may have increased their impetus to dominate women and youths within their own community. This political environment helps contextualize the details of Keraki spiritual belief and sociopolitical organization as reported by Williams (1936). Keraki fertility cultism centered on safe-guarding and protecting the transmission of male fertility in highly secret initiation rituals of bullroarer revelation and anal homosexual insemination. Totem clanship strongly emphasized mythic ties to patrilocal place affiliations. As in central Australia, knowledge of myth was central to male status and was under the exclusive control of men, who took their wives from groups with alternative place affiliations.9 Gerontocracy was important; elder men had the greatest social authority as well as the greatest mythological knowledge. "Insofar as the local group remains a closeknit patrilineal kin it is normally the eldest among them, provided he is able-bodied and has the requisite strength of personality, who will be the headman" (ibid. :243). In contrast to those of the Marind to the west and the Kiwai to the east, Trans-Fly cult initiations rigorously precluded rather than invited the presence of women. In contrast even to the Kolopom, lending of women for sexual purposes is said by Williams (1936:159) to have been for hospitality only and not for promotion of fertility. Marital exchange between groups was protected and internalized by payment of bridewealth within rather than between clans, that is, "sisters" were purchased as needed from distant agnates and then used in sisterexchange to procure a wife (ibid.: 139f.).10 In general, Trans-Fly masculine ideals stressed subordination both within the male age hierarchy and of women to men within the domestic group. A palpable emphasis was placed on conformity, reserve, and retentive conservatism (Williams 1936:248-261). Trans-Fly socioeconomic organization was not driven narrowly by ecological parameters; in at least the southeast part of the region,
188
Reconfiguration
excavation of deep and extensive drainage ditches indicates a highproduction prehistoric subsistence regime that would have supported intensive socioeconomic and political organization, including higher population density (Harris and Laba 1982). This possibility is complemented by ethnographic evidence that even highly dispersed Trans-Fly populations were able to amass huge root crop surpluses for use in competitive exchanges (see chapter 4). Viewed in synoptic formation, Keraki cosmology emphasized localized interiorization of male fertility and mythical knowledge. This was reflected in ancestral totemic affiliations tied closely to local places, in emphasis on anal homosexual intercourse between senior and junior males, and in rigid exclusion of women from myth and rite. Socially concomitant was politically localized authoritarianism!submission. This was evident externally in military inferiority and despair vis-a-vis outsiders, and internally in emphasis on restrictive patri-clan affiliations, assiduous male control of female labor, male age seniority, and an ethos of conformity and conservatism. The existential effects of Trans-Fly cosmological orientation put them in a pronounced if unintended spiral with predation by foreign ethnic groups. Trans-Fly groups failed to develop a strong fighting ethic or alliance structure, preferring to derive their social prestige from thousands of small yams. Trans-Fly people's inability to defend themselves or stage a counterattack was linked to a retentive cultural conservatism that was if anything intensified by external duress. Reciprocally, their huge yam store houses must have been a great attraction to foreign raiding parties, for whom long-distance warfare entailed ecological as well as spiritual foraging. Keraki even conveniently localized their heads with their yams, as they traditionally slept at the front end of the yam houses (Ayres 1983:156; Williams 1936:13). The enemy systems reinforced each other. Though Trans-Fly peoples struggled culturally and socially to retain land, food, women, and male fertility, their actions unwittingly fueled alternative cosmological appetites. Asmat
In contrast to Trans-Fly peoples, Asmat strongly emphasized success in headhunting as the epitome of male worth and self-image. In several respects, headhunting was necessary to truly identify oneself as an Asmat, a "real man" (Sowada 1961:1). Great renown accrued to the most successful head-takers, and they frequently trumpeted this status in elaborate personal boasting (Zegwaard 1959:1030f.: Sowada 1961:10f.).
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
189
Asmat were remarkable to Western observers for their interpersonal aggressiveness, self-aggrandizement, and hair-trigger violence, and they were probably the most difficult of the south coast groups for outsiders to associate with during the early colonial era. It was culturally important for an Asmat man to galvanize his anger and target his rage immediately and effectively against those who threatened his reputation, his kin, or his supporters. As a result, almost any confrontation risked the provocation of violence. Spiritual, military, and politicoeconomic force were strongly aligned in Asmat cosmology. Headhunting was endemic, being undertaken simultaneously to revenge previous killings, to silence taunts or threats, to encroach on others' sago andfishinggrounds, to appease deep fear of ancestral spirits, and to obtain life-energy from enemy heads in order to empower ritual objects, initiate boys, and rejuvenate the spiritual force of the community (Zegwaard 1959; Eyde 1967). Conversely, spiritual force was perceived to be continually threatened and depleted by frequent attacks of neighboring Asmat contingents upon one's own community. Given the constant Asmat struggle to defend and augment life-power, male status was not achieved once and for all by taking just one head; repeated courage and success in headhunting was necessary, both as a fighter and as an organizer of ceremonies and feasts that culminated in successful raids. One renowned Asmat leader or "chief" whose history is known had personally killed persons from ten different villages (Mraz 1978:85), and it appears that a warrior had to personally take six heads in order to sponsor a bis ceremonial feast (see Kuruwaip 1984:19). As discussed in chapter 5, success in headhunting articulated with Asmat leaders' sexual, economic, and political success. Men who had not taken a head were disparaged by women as well as men, and they could have difficulty finding a wife. For reasons of cultural value as well as those of realpolitik and military success, men who had taken the most heads generally obtained the most wives. Headhunting also facilitated social and sexual alliance through dispersed wife-exchange relations and bond-friendships (papisj) with men from other villages. The link between successful headhunting and sexuality was exhibited more formally on a collective scale with the celebration of generalized papisj collective ritual heterosexuality - following a successful headhunt (Sowada 1961:95, following van Kampen 1956:73-76). Just as a successful headhunter attracted wives, he also attracted male supporters willing to give women and/or to coreside within the military
190
Reconfiguration
umbrella of his settlement. Kinship facilitated residential affiliation through a diffuse range of cognatic ties that informed the flexible dualism of the Asmat longhouse (Eyde 1967). Unrelated persons could be assimilated and change their group name (Bureau for Native Affairs 1957:29, cited in Sowada 1961:67). The founding group claimed the prestigious down-stream end of the settlement; it was the "trunk" onto which subsequent village "branches" accreted (Zegwaard and Boelaars 1955:252; see Sowada 1961:57f.). As a dimension of their prowess, precolonial Asmat leaders exuded tes, glossed as "charisma," which reflected generosity to followers as well as success in warfare (see van Arsdale and van Arsdale 1991:20). Cultural virility in headhunting, sex, and marriage combined economically with a husband's garnering of prized sago stands inherited from his wives by virtue of marriage (Eyde 1967:227, 255). Sago was worked by wives and, especially for large feasts, by the wives of other male supporters. Asmat ceremonies formed a large cycle that was punctuated by the dedication of elaborately carved ancestor poles, canoes, and hardwood shields. These artifacts embodied and commemorated the feast-givers' deceased agnates, especially those who had been headhunt victims. Amelsvoort (cited in Konrad et al. 1981:32) suggests that the ceremonial cycle among central Asmat entailed (a) a feast for the opening of a new men's house (yen polmbu); (b) an ancestor pole dedication feast (mbis mbu); (c) a feast for which twenty or more war canoes were made and dedicated (tsji mbu); (d) a mask feast (jipai or mbipokmbu); and (e) a shield feast (jamasj pokmbu).11 Eyde's (1967:334) description suggests that feasts occurred in pairs and celebrated the completion of different parts of the longhouse and various ancestor-embellished carvings, including canoes, shields, drums, spears, paddles, spirit masks, and body ornaments. Carved artifacts and decorated implements were generally considered to be ancestral embodiments. Viewed as objects of spiritual force, there was an emotionally cathectic identification with them by the living descendants who had commissioned their construction (Schneebaum 1990). Since the spirits of ancestral headhunt victims constantly demanded vengeance and appeasement, their embodiments served as a constant reminder and impetus for further headhunting revenge. In the meantime, they also helped keep the angry spirits of the deceased at bay (Zegwaard 1959:1029). The most renowned headhunters commissioned great carvings to
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
191
commemorate their ancestors and dead relatives at pivotal points in the ceremonial feasting cycle. These embodiments were infused with the nammu or "mana" of the headhunter and were considered sacred (Sowada 1961:38, citing van Renselaar and Mellema 1956). The largest and most elaborate carvings were Ws-poles (see figure 2, chapter 4). These were fashioned from trees procured in the forest by men as if in battle, that is, by warriors who stalked and attacked the tree as if it were an enemy. As a huge head, the tree was cut off and carried back to the men's house for preparation amidst the war-leader's boastful enumeration of the many heads he had personally taken (Kuruwaip 1984:20).12 As the carving neared completion, a headhunt was conducted so that the blood from fresh heads could be used to rub onto and sanctify the pole {ibid.). Eyde (1967:347) describes the transmission of lifesubstance to appease the ancestors: This Mis [bis] ceremonial cycle was an occasion for intensive headhunting. When an enemy had been killed on a headhunting expedition, the head was carried to the small wooden "canoe," jifoj, at the base of the mis pole before it was taken to the central fireplace to be pinned down with a bone dagger. One of the loins, or sometimes the entire body, was placed in the canoe. Then it was cut up and distributed. The blood from the body was rubbed into the canoe, and fat from the chest was dripped into it. This fat was also collected in small bags which hung from the rafters of the men's house and was applied to the [bis] poles daily. The spirits of the Mis ceremonial cycle are believed to load the "essence," jisimuj, of all the food offered to them into the canoe and sail off to the spirit world.
The bis-po\e was subsequently erected and celebrated with a rite of generalized ritual heterosexuality (Kuruwaip 1984:14). Thereafter, it was planted in the sago forest, where its spiritual force infused the sago and was transferred as strength and fearlessness to those who ate it (ibid.; van Renselaar and Mellema 1956). The same was true of captured heads, which could be hung in gardens to improve their fertility and help make children strong, brave, and healthy (Zegwaard 1959:1039). In essence, sago used in feasting both facilitated the organization of large-scale headhunting and was itself re-empowered by the fertility strength of the heads captured. Not surprisingly, enmities within and between villages were often fueled by disputes over sago territories. The association between life-force and the individual head was highly pronounced both for the head-taker and the person upon whom he bestowed it. In order to facilitate quick masculine growth, an initiate
192
Reconfiguration
novice would squat in seclusion for a considerable time with his genitals virtually touching the head given him. He then underwent a dramatic ritual transformation from symbolic death to rebirth (Zegwaard 1959:1024, 1039; cf. Sowada 1980b:85). From this he emerged with a new social identity: that of the head-hunting victim. The name of this person became his own, and he was considered the decapitated person's incarnation even by the latter's relatives, who welcomed him as "their kin."13 The primal headhunting myth, in which an elder brother convinces his younger sibling to cut off his (the elder's) head, effectively illustrates Asmat identification with the victim as well as with the perpetrator of headhunting. The severed head switches from object to authorial subject of headhunting, transferring his name to his younger brother and instructing him how to go headhunting, how to process the head, and how to use it in initiation rites to empower a novice (Zegwaard 1959). Among Asmat themselves, bestowal of captured heads to empower the recipient was so important that serious fights over their possession frequently erupted within the victorious village. Hostilities escalated as the corpse was fought over, taken, and retaken by various factions and individuals; in some cases, "village unity has been permanently damaged by such fights" (ibid. :1026). In all, then, the life-force of headhunting was transmitted in a highly competitive cycle of interpersonal rivalry, head-taking, heterosexuality, sago production, human growth, ancestral commemoration, and male initiation. Within this cycle, Asmat spiritual force was closely associated with fighting accomplishment and, as a corollary, with sexual success, feasting, renown, and leadership. Not only were the greatest headhunters magnets attracting cognatic kin to themselves within the elaborate warfare-canoe idioms of longhouse organization but ceremonies, like the longhouses or canoes they dedicated, culminated in headhunting. Indeed "almost every larger festivity or public ritual presupposes a headhunting raid" (Zegwaard 1959:1028). Politically reflecting this emphasis, Asmat villages outside an adjacent zone of tenuous alliance raided each other with impunity. Wholesale killing and territorial dispossession of enemy groups were common. In the process, villages jockeyed to command exclusive access to both upstream sago and downstream fishing resources (Eyde 1967). Buffeted by internal disputes as well as external attacks, settlements were very unstable in the prepacification era; often if not usually, they only lasted two or three years before splitting up, moving, or being driven out by a
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
193
more powerful, if temporary, coalition of enemies (Sowada 1961:62f.). Larger villages clustered several longhouses for defensive purposes but were generally unable to maintain an enduring alliance among themselves, being constituted through a range of individual ties that were as uncertain as they were opportunistic and disparate.14 In the precolonial era, low female status appears to have been predisposed in part by combative male aggressiveness: this general ethic infused domestic and marital relations as well as relations between men. The singular competition of Asmat fertility cultism is illustrated by differences in areal integration between them and groups from the Middle Sepik of northern New Guinea. In the latter area, riverine groups raided and sometimes headhunted adjacent tribes further inland, but they also maintained extensive trading and subsistence complementarity with these people, for instance, regularly supplying fish to them in exchange for sago (e.g., Gewertz 1983). This contrasts with the Asmat pattern, in which single villages tried individually if temporarily to monopolize access to fish as well as sago. A closer contrast can be drawn between the Asmat and the Mimika, immediately to their west, among whom clan and totemic affiliations provided a trading and alliance network of confederated villages up and down the rivers (Pouwer 1955:91-93,1991:208; Eyde 1967:87). In summary, Asmat fertility emphasized competitive individuation in head-taking. As a cosmological theme, competition among men to acquire life-force from enemy heads reverberated in psychological, political, religious, and residential arenas. This individuated competition resonated in the sexual, economic, and political advantages that accrued to the successful head-taker and in the importance of individually possessing head-force for initiatory rebirth, crop growth, heterosexual exchange, empowering sacred carvings, and appeasing ancestral spirits. The sociopolitical concomitant of this cultural emphasis was endemic interpersonal and military rivalry both within shifting Asmat residential units and between villages in headhunting. In its relentless pursuit of headhunt victims, Asmat cosmology had the unintended consequence of putting its practitioners at great personal risk. An Asmat man confronted a stark reality: many of his brothers, fathers, and other relatives had been beheaded, and he, too, could easily be subject to the same fate. The existential threat that death from headhunting posed for every Asmat family undoubtedly fueled men's need to simultaneously glorify dead headhunt victims, materialize them, drive them away, appease them, avenge them, identify with them
194
Reconfiguration
generally, and, indeed, to become them. As reflected in the primal headhunting myth and in cult sacrae, there was strong emotional as well as cosmological bonding with headhunt victims - both one's own deceased relatives and the enemy heads used to give identity to oneself and one's children. Reciprocally, shields, houses, canoes, weapons, and all variety of artifacts were named - and frequently carved commemorations of one's deceased relatives. These included the decorated ancestor skull, a support on which living heads could sleep (see cover photo; Schneebaum 1990:50,56; Konrad etal. 1981:34). This identification was both reflected in and further fueled by military realities. In attacks on villages, women and children fled while men defended the settlement. Men sustained most of the casualties, and the attacking force as well as the defenders could incur significant losses. In a coordinated attack, a second contingent of attackers could cut off the retreat of women and children, slaughtering them wholesale. As many individuals were killed as possible, irrespective of age or sex.15 In contrast to other south coast groups, Asmat subsistence entailed almost perpetual armed patrolling by men, who formed a protective shield around women as they worked sago or fished (Sowada 1961:37, 40; Zegwaard 1959:1033). The rate of killing was extremely high. In one documented case, at least seventy-two persons were killed in a single raid: thirty-five married men, thirty-three single men, two women, and two children - comprising fourteen percent of the village's 514 inhabitants (Zegwaard 1978:12).16 In another case, at least sixty-two persons were killed and two abducted in five raids over a period of two years, the victim rate ranging from two to twenty-five persons per raid in a village with an initial population of 675 {ibid.). Raids claiming up to a half-dozen victims and followed by counter-raiding were chronic. Zegwaard (1978:21, 25) suggests that his figures were as much as thirty percent underreported, and he estimates after reviewing a range of information that an average of one to two percent of the total Asmat population was being killed each year. This rate of killing is among the very highest ethnographically reported from any world area (see comparative tabulations in Knauft 1987a). Since a disproportionate number of those killed were adult men, a successful attack on a village left it more weakly defended thereafter and hence an ever more attractive target of attack. Villages located along major river tributaries in prime subsistence locations were often subject to attack; with escalating losses, they could be quickly forced
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
195
into relocation or disbandonment. Zegwaard (1978:22) documents a number of villages that had been extinguished by sequential raiding, and he notes the impending demise of other settlements. Of the remainder, "I have repeatedly found that . . . [settlement] units are combinations of clans which were formerly independent but were forced, through violence and killings, to submit to a stronger unit for survival's sake." The emphasis Asmat placed on competitively accruing head-force was in strong dialectical relationship with the existential result that a man and his coresidents were continually at risk of being killed and decapitated. Even escaping this fate, people were frequently uprooted and continuously realigning themselves through a transitory plethora of kinship and other affiliations that were of uncertain trust and duration. The tenuousness of personal survival was both a product of Asmat fertility cultism and a glaring result against which it further elaborated. Uncertain existence intensified the cultural need to accrue life-power by individually taking it. Kiwai
Kiwai fertility cultism emphasized the collective creation of life-force through festive heterosexuality. Celebratory sexuality was a focal point of the main mouguru fertility rites and was an important accompaniment to other ceremonies and feasts. More frequently generalized than among the other south coast groups, this heterosexual activity was apparently engaged in by substantial numbers of adult men and women as willing sexual partners (Landtman 1927:ch.24).17 Linkages between heterosexual fertility and food production were also more strongly stressed by Kiwai than by other south coast groups. This emphasis is reflected in numerous Kiwai sexual rites for crop planting and garden growth as well as in the ultimate ritual purpose of the mouguru, that is, the collection of sexual fluids to anoint the trunks of sago palms and ensure their prolific growth. In the wake of sexual rejuvenation, Kiwai fertility was also promoted by the taking of life; at the last stage of the mouguru, a ferocious wild boar was captured, festooned, and sacrificed at the central house posts, thus making the men "hot for blood" in the ensuing headhunt {ibid.: 356-359). The giving of life and fertility was bought at the price of death within the Kiwai community. The coitus of an elder sponsor and his wife inaugurated the mouguru as well as events such as the dedication of the longhouse. The elder couple were believed to die shortly afterwards; their sexual bestowal of life and potency to others was a kind of
196
Reconfiguration
symbolic funeral for themselves (ibid. :9f, 356). Not surprisingly, Kiwai also maintained a vivid fear of sorcery retribution from community elders (Riley 1925:ch.23; Landtman 1927:ch.22). For Kiwai, then, sexual fertility was complemented by death through the depletion and demise of aging. Depletion of spiritual force was counteracted by the taking of heads as well as by heterosexual rejuvenation. Captured heads were kept as trophies and fertility relics, and they were freshly obtained to bloodstain different parts of the enormous longhouse at the various stages of its completion. The main houseposts were carved and decorated as headless warriors; when the house was to be inaugurated, a fresh head was taken to blood-stain the central posts and its skull was affixed to the top of the post, which was adorned as a highly decorated human effigy (ibid.: 15-18). In essence, the life-giving power of headhunt victims supported the longhouse. Heads were also used to strengthen and embolden novice warriors. To this end, blood from the heads was smeared on the young men's faces, and they were enjoined to crawl over and bite at the line of assembled heads as senior warriors straddled them (ibid. :160f.). Kiwai headhunting melded dimensions of warfare found variously among Marind, Purari, and Asmat. As with the Marind, coalitions of Kiwai in long-distance coastal raids could claim many victims, and some local groups were exterminated through headhunting (Landtman 1927:148f.; 1917:ch.l3; Riley 1925:265). Similar to Asmat and Purari practices, Kiwai headhunting could be targeted against rival settlements of one's own language group, though it was also directed in significant measure at the inland "bushmen," who were considered foreigners. Kiwai were distinctive for their complex web of local and longdistance alliances. These provided opportunity for both substantial temporary coalition and large-scale death contracting and treachery. The detailed accounts obtained by Landtman (1917:ch.l3) illustrate how astute leaders could effectively ally with other settlements; sometimes they would even contract and aid third parties to travel long distances in fleets of canoes to carry out surprise attacks. Many heads and renown - as well as substantial payment - accrued to the attackers, while local political advantage went to the leader who contracted the killing. In the Fly delta area, where coastal travel was particularly extensive, large-scale warfare and surprise attacks could occur between fleets of canoes in open water (Riley 1925:273; Beaver 1920:146,173). A knife-edge of shifting agreements and betrayals made alliances
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
197
temporary and uncertain. Moreover, an aggrieved group often found it more convenient to take revenge against the recent allies of an enemy than against the enemy village itself (Landtman 1917:ch.l3). In short, a shifting constellation of rivalries, coalitions, and tenuous secret understandings presented itself for political exploitation and countervailing suspicion. Large-scale feasting and ritual celebration offered special opportunities for forging or altering alliances - and occasionally for enticing and then attacking a particular visiting group. Large ceremonial gatherings were hence both risky and momentous; they both enacted the configuration of spiritual and military power and carried the potential for changing it. For most Kiwai language-family speakers, the archetypal Other targeted for sacrificial killing appears to have been the non-Kiwai "bushmen" from inland Trans-Fly and Gogodala areas; these people were both individually hunted and attacked en masse.18 The general sense one gets from the accounts of Landtman (1917:ch.l3, 1927:ch.9), Riley (1925:ch.22), and Beaver (1920:chs. 10-20, p. 173) is that warfare among Kiwai themselves was driven by political disputes and revenge more than by ritual mandate. Perhaps correspondingly (and in contrast to Purari, Asmat, Kolopom, and to some extent Marind), the western and central Kiwai apparently did not practice whole-body cannibalism; like the Trans-Fly peoples (Williams 1936:281), they seem to have consumed only small portions of the victim's body for ritual strengthening purposes (Landtman 1927:160f.).19 A coastal and riverine people, Kiwai were highly mobile in subsistence activities and visiting, and they could easily aggregate at central longhouse sites for major cult activities, sexual celebrations, and leaders' feast-giving-for-renown (Landtman 1927:chs. 13, 23-28). This temporary cohesion was marked by sociopolitical as well as spiritual effervescence. Visitors enjoyed food and sexual hospitality while donating their sexual fluids to strengthen the sago-palms, bodies, and health of the hosting group. Long-distance visitations, when successful, added significantly to the renown, enjoyment, and sense of successful adventure among those participating and also allowed them a special chance to trade. This accomplishment was cross-cut by rivalry between leaders in competitive feast-giving, through which they furthered their alliances and promoted the memory of their own ancestors in ritual celebration. Effective temporary alliance despite sub-group autonomy was well illustrated in the Kiwai horiomu ceremonial. In the horiomu, clans of a region incarnated their totem-ancestors by donning spectacular
198
Reconfiguration
Figure 6 Kiwai horiomu costume. Wood, grass, vines, feathers; mask face carved from turtle shell. (Illustration after Landtman 1927:fig. 98, p. 339.)
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
199
costumes (see figure 6; Landtman 1927:ch.23).20 Each totem-clan had a shrine area adjacent to those of others, was allocated its own exclusive portion of the collective stage, and performed primarily in front of its own audience section. In contrast to the Marind-anim, costumed performers from the different totem-clans did not co-participate in a communal cosmological enactment. Incarnations from one totem-clan were not allowed to co-appear with those of another, and though different totem-clan presentations followed one another, there was no particular order, theme, or larger mythic association linking their performances. Yet horiomu were held collectively on an annual basis to commemorate recent deaths and ancestral figures from all five totemclans. The general populace from an extensive area would attend. In short, sub-group autonomy as well as temporary collectivity was clearly indicated during the rites and their associated feasts. In primary residence, each totem-clan within a local area ideally maintained its own longhouse; where more than one totem-clan coresided, each maintained its own housepost shrines, heads, and other sacrae within its demarcated longhouse-section (ibid. :ch.2; for eastern Kiwai, see Haddon 1918). Persons from different areas but with the same totem-clan affiliation were predisposed to host and support each other for alliance or trading, sometimes over long distances. Beaver (1920:172, 182) states that members of a single totem-clan formed a "brotherhood" who avoided killing each other in battle, for instance, by recognizing each other on the basis of totem crests painted on their bodies. Long-distance affiliations were particularly important for trading. The most important items traded were large outrigger canoes, which were transacted in a roughly northeast-to-southwest direction across virtually the entire Kiwai language family.21 Commonly arranged over long distances, this trade was the basis for continuing payment or prestation between the groups involved and provided an armature for exchanging a wide range of other goods that originated or were specially fashioned in particular Kiwai areas. Though figures were unavailable, Kiwai could temporarily aggregate in very large numbers at ceremonial feasts or for headhunting. Extraordinary longhouses, some over 150 meters long, were constructed to serve as the residential locus of ceremonial and feasting aggregations. Landtman (1927:204) states that the entire southeast section of Kiwai Island would coalesce for many weeks at ceremonies and feasts, and Haddon (1901:97) notes that visitation to major ceremonial sites could
200
Reconfiguration
result in an annual migration of up to two or three months duration. That major celebrations such as the horiomu ancestor pantomime or the mouguru life-giving ceremony overlapped or were coincident with large feasts such as the gaera facilitated population aggregation. 22 In the course of these events, Kiwai spiritual force could be drawn upon to galvanize a large action-group for warfare or later inter-group alliance. Ceremonial coalescence of population from a wide area thus afforded Kiwai a great ability to attack enemies after infusing themselves with sexual, spiritual, and political power. In summary terms, Kiwai fertility emphasized temporary celebratory union, epitomized in the aggregation of persons from large areas for general heterosexual celebration, for ceremonial performance of diverse totem-clan enactments, and for large-scale feasts. These activities frequently if not typically co-occurred. Politically concomitant was pulsating aggregation of Kiwai population for collective activities, visiting and trading, headhunting raids, and attending feasts and ceremonies. The existential counterpart of temporary large-scale aggregation, however, was large-scale social repulsion. Bringing together groups from a large area provided the seeds of their active dispersal, both culturally and demographically. Given diverse social affiliations and cross-cutting alliances, the political rivalry of feast-giving was supplemented by balance-of-power shifts or outright treachery. As noted above, alliances, death contracts, and deception led to a double-edged sword of polity-creating and polity-destroying coalitions. As a particular group's status shifted from predatory partner to target of common attack, a strong impetus was created for relocation or migration. Kiwai leaders sometimes took their followers, attracted others, and founded a new settlement outside their local area. Through this process, Kiwai both spread into new areas and maintained alliances with their former neighbors. Landtman's (1917:ch.l3) accounts penetrate this dynamic and illustrate how Kiwai expansion exterminated indigenous populations on Kiwai Island, expelled them from Daru, and displaced them along the western Kiwai coast. Beaver's (1920:156) account confirms these patterns of expansive displacement and describes how in the process one community "threw off several colonies in search of planting lands," each under the direction of its own renowned leader. The unintended fallout of celebratory union was the widespread dispersal of Kiwai across social and geographic space. Landtman (1927:204) summarizes:
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
201
Considerable migrations have been caused by war and hostilities. In larger fighting expeditions not merely single tribes take part, but the belligerents are eager to secure assistance from near and far, and thus a large district may be set in motion. After a war, the defeated party will, in many cases, leave their former habitations and take refuge in a safer locality.
As participants in a pulsating fertility cycle, local Kiwai groups were alternately drawn together and actively dispersed. In so doing, they actively expanded the Kiwai language family along the south coast. The relative ease of long-distance coastal travel and sago-dependent subsistence facilitated this process. Combining distinctive cosmological impetus with ecological potential, the extensive Kiwai language family spread to abut against the fortress villages of the Purari in the east and was actively expanding west and south at the expense of groups in the Trans-Fly and northern Torres Strait. Elema
To the far east of New Guinea's nonAustronesian south coast, the predominant fertility cult was the hevehe of the Elema-speaking peoples (Williams 1940). Literally, hevehe were huge body masks made of a light cane and palm-wood frame across which bark cloth was stretched and sewn. The bark cloth was then painted with intricate designs and fitted at the bottom with a face and gaping sculptured mouth (see figure 7). Hevehe were multitudinous and unique, and each connoted personal totemic and clan affiliations as well as evoking more diffuse or vague association with sea spirits and bullroarers. Though up to seven meters in height, hevehe masks were mobile enough to be paraded by a single wearer around the village and adjoining beaches. A huge vaulted longhouse was built to house the construction of the masks, and they were prepared laboriously during the course of a generational ceremonial and feasting cycle. This hevehe cycle corresponded to the many stages of the masks' manufacture and, along with them, it usually took between ten and twenty years to complete; it was the preeminent dimension of Elema sociopolitical as well as religious life. Near the end of the cycle, more than one hundred different hevehe finally emerged from their longhouse for more than a month of celebration and general feasting. After the final climactic feast, the masks were each shot with bow and arrow, piled, and burned; thereafter, a raiding party was organized and a bushman (or later, a pig) was captured and sacrificed to conclude the cycle (Williams 1940:ch.l4). The hevehe cycle was politically orchestrated by gerontocratic elders
202
Reconfiguration
Figure 7 Elema hevehe mask. Bark cloth, wood, cane, grasses, feathers; designs stitched and painted. Mask attached at back to woven cane body-casing worn by the bearer. 6-7 m high. (Illustration after Williams 1940:plates 28, 38, 51, 55; see his ch. 16.)
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
203
and was marked by the progressive gaining of renown through escalating exchanges of pigs, shells, and large amounts of garden produce. Elema ceremonial focused on gift-exchanges, the production of the huge masks themselves, and relatively benign cult revelations of the bullroarer and of men as sea-serpent impersonators; in contrast to other south coast areas, it placed little overt emphasis on spiritual substance transmission and none at all on headhunting or ritual sexuality, both of which were absent. Outside the parameters of the hevehe, the spiritual authority of bullroarers and body masks such as the kovave or harisu could be used at the direction of male owners. Men donning these masks could prowl the village and exert social control or restore order, authorize the mediation of disputes, obtain food, or initiate ritual fights against neighboring villages (Williams 1923a:47-54,1940:ch.7,1977b:104-115). Highlighting their practical dimensions, Williams (1939a,c, 1940:ch.l3) suggests that Elema cults were less important as deep socializing or spiritual experiences than as means for initiators to assert political authority and receive pigs in ritual payment from novices. Reciprocally, sons of wealthy men with many pigs might undergo initiation (for instance, in the bullroarer cult) several times as a dimension of their matrilateral exchange relationship. Cult life was inextricable from the politics of gift-exchange (see also Holmes 1924:ch.l3). Williams (1940:chs. 17,21) suggests that even the hevehe masks had a dearth of spiritual meaning or mythic significance; the masks were individually owned and transmitted, and they evoked only hazy totemic and ancestral associations or vague connotations of magical power. In this respect, they seem to contrast with Asmat and Purari ritual artifacts and with the elaborate body decoration of Marind and Kiwai, all of which had deep and elaborate cosmological significance. In the same way that fertility power was embodied individually in the unique design, name, and magic of each mask, so, too, political authority was exercised individually by mask owners through large-scale exchanges of foods, pigs, and shell valuables. As noted in chapter 4, Elema husbanded a large number of pigs per capita and relied intensively on root crop production to generate surplus for food exchanges. In addition to their preeminent place in large-scale ceremonials, pigs, tubers, and shell valuables were crucial in bridewealth transactions, in ongoing affinal and matrilateral exchange relationships, and in exchange partnerships between nonrelatives. Substantialization of status was also
204
Reconfiguration
reflected in the prestige accruing to Elema clans that maintained enduring ancestral ties to local land. In general, then, Elema fertility emphasized graduated corporeal embodiment of life-power in prolonged ceremonial cycles, in huge mask-embodiments, in gerontocratic elders, in amassed prestation of material wealth, and in values of residential and land-owning permanence. Concomitant politicoeconomic emphasis was placed on material substantialization of status in long-term residence, landed property/pigs, large-scale exchanges, large ceremonial houses, and eldership. Social organization corresponded with these patterns; dual organization was undeveloped in favor of diffuse cumulative patrifiliation, through which incoming members were gradually merged with the patronymic identity of the longhouse's founders and descendants (/6/d.:chs.l-2). Holmes (1924:ch.ll) emphasizes the integrity of Elema affiliation through what he calls "totem-kinship." Concerning political economy and leadership, Cochrane (1970:32) suggests, Hevehe, like the "big men," presented a synthesized cultural image, a microcosmic view of the cosmos . . . They were a symbol of the "big-man's" power, their creation was a reaffirmation of Elema social values. Maintenance of Elema life and culture was the work of the "big man." Apa-Hevehe symbolized the "big man's" ability to carry out this task.
In some ways, Elema do approximate the politics of highland New Guinea indigenous leadership more closely than do other south coast culture areas. Elema marriage was unprescriptive, bridewealth was important, competitive giving was highly developed, and exchanges transacted food, pigs, and shells in great quantities. In apparent contrast to at least some New Guinea highlands areas, however, Elema gardening was predominantly a male activity, polygyny was rare, marital optation was high, the status of women was not particularly low, and gerontocracy was pronounced. Elema perhaps bear greater comparison to selected societies in the Massim, the Sepik, or areas of insular Melanesia, that is, they combine an emphasis on exchange preeminence with the spiritual and cult performance authority of elders. As discussed above and in chapter 4, these themes are also present in various guises along other parts of the New Guinea south coast. Unfortunately, the cosmological grounding of Elema fertility cultism is relatively difficult to assess. The extensive corpus of Elema myths collected by Williams was apparently lost during World War Two (van Baal 1966:955). We are thus left with the elaborate surface description
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
205
of the hevehe ceremonial without either its symbolic infrastructure or its political sociology (Williams 1940; cf. Cochrane 1970:chs.l-2). In addition, the hevehe portrayed by Williams may have been significantly influenced by colonial developments; along adjacent parts of the Elema coast, indigenous ritual had already been greatly transformed by cargo cult activity (Williams 1923a; Worsley 1968:ch.4). Given that the prepacification details of Elema politics and warfare are largely unknown, it remains an open question how much Elema exchange proliferated as a traditional alternative to warfare, in conjunction with indigenous armed conflict, or as a sequel to fighting during the period of colonial pacification. Circumstantial evidence suggests that Elema were never particularly prone to warfare, especially in comparison to the other south coast groups. The sizable Elema language family appears to have been relatively free of systematic raiding (see Hope 1979; Williams 1940). Holmes (1924:262-265) contrasts Elema with the Purari on this score, and he found features of Elema warfare that were surprisingly rule-governed. These elements of fighting included prior agreement as to the day of the fight, exchange of persons as temporary hostages for the duration of the hostilities, exchange of arrow-fire between groups of massed opponents on the open beach, and either exact reciprocity or material compensation for those killed and wounded. The possibility of other warfare modalities notwithstanding, available evidence collectively suggests Elema may have reached intercommunity accommodation indigenously on the basis of hevehe cult performances (which were widely attended), and extensive economic exchange relations, including material compensation in bridewealth and homicide. In contrast to Marind-anim, inter-settlement accommodation among Elema was apparently based on politicoeconomic exchange rather than cosmological or military affiliation, and the Elema were prone neither to long-distance raiding nor diffuse military alliance. The relative disarticulation between Elema cosmological beliefs, myths, rites, and political organization is to some extent a product of Williams' own aversion to systematic cultural interpretation. Such an assessment of Williams' Orokolo monograph has been strongly implied by van Baal (1966:955). On the other hand, a relative lack of connection between myth, rite, and general cosmology may also reflect a somewhat greater Elema emphasis on material than spiritual dimensions of art, wealth, and gerontocracy. Williams' (1940:337) painstaking, biased, and yet revealing comments on Elema religious understanding suggest that
206
Reconfiguration
their myths, rites, and beliefs were at once copious, conflicting, and disjointed from each other. Leaving aside questions of cultural coherence or disarticulation, it seems likely that the social actualization of the hevehe cycle had rebounded back on its symbolic impetus well prior to colonial pacification. The individual prestige that accrued to participation in the hevehe motivated increasingly large and diverse prestations and increasingly long periods of preparation. This process was both facilitated by and reflected in the enormous size and elaborateness of the masks, which were made in so many stages over the course of so many years. The Elema linkage between physical longevity and politico-religious authority, reflected in strong gerontocracy, mirrors the long growth and delayed maturation of the hevehe themselves. Reciprocally, when an elder died, work on the masks had to stop. As Williams (1940:ch.ll) emphasizes, deaths of aged elders were accompanied by intrigue, rivalry, and accusations of sorcery that regularly postponed the completion of hevehe ceremonial phases. Because deaths tend to be frequent among elderly persons, the instantiation of hevehe through eldership introduced a special demographic impediment that both delayed the ceremonial cycle and was reappropriated to further intensify its scale and longevity. The very size and duration of the hevehe cycle, reciprocally, could also have contributed to the disarticulation and economization of its various parts. And as Barth (1987) has suggested for the Baktaman of the Mountain Ok region, coherent transmission of secret cultural knowledge is easily compromised when it must be passed through the faltering memories and idiosyncratic deaths of a few men who are both very old and greatly feared. Williams (1940:188) presents convincing evidence from his older informants that the hevehe had been a protracted and compromised affair at least as far back as the 1880s, that is, prior to any significant Western influence. It appears, then, that the increasing scale and economization of the hevehe was an indigenous trend that had been fueled by the social and demographic effects of gerontocratic political economy. This trend was likely reinforced by the effects of colonial influence and perhaps further magnified by the anti-systemic perspective of Williams' ethnography. Processual patterns
Drawing on a shared constellation of fertility themes, each languageculture area of south coast New Guinea accentuated particular motifs
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
207
and minimized others. Over time, distinctive cultural permutations informed and in turn responded to significant areal divergences in political economy and human ecology. This regional pattern of differentiation through cultural permutation is common in New Guinea and can be found in pre-state societies from many world areas (Knauft 1985b; cf. Levi-Strauss 1964-1971). In all seven south coast New Guinea culture areas, life-force was incarnated in sacred ritual objects, but this embodiment was particularly elaborate among Asmat and particularly centralized among Purari. Dual organization occurred widely, but with particular involution among Kolopom and with particular expansiveness among Marind. Ritual heterosexuality was generally associated with collective wellbeing and cosmological rejuvenation, but this association was especially pervasive among Kiwai and Marind. Women were excluded from some cult secrets and activities in all the south coast areas, but with special vehemence among Kolopom and Trans-Fly peoples. Headhunting was widely associated with male prestige, but particularly so among Asmat; the economic dimensions of feasting exchange were everywhere salient, but they were particularly accentuated among Elema. In each area, distinctive symbolic orientations resonated in sociopolitical organization. Indeed, in the Durkheimian tradition, religious and political organization may appear as if they were isomorphic within each area. In fact, however, the relationship between culture and practice was dialectic and developmental in each case. The apparent similarity of form between cultural and sociopolitical organization was in fact an engine of tension, change, and development. As cultural orientations were actualized in sociomaterial life, they were confronted with the often unintended existential effects of their own legacy. Repercussions of this nature were highly important in the development of each language-culture area. They are exemplified in the compromised fertility of the Marind; the relative defenselessness of the Trans-Fly people to ethnic encroachment; the relentless self-killing of the Asmat; the oscillating repulsion and spread of the Kiwai; the competitive atomization of the Kolopom; the autonomous separation of Purari villages; and the great duration and economic scale of the Elema's hevehe. These outcomes reflect the recursive effects of divergent symbolic orientations as they became actualized in specific demographic, material, and biological conditions. If the south coast examples illustrate how symbolic orientations inform divergence of action, they also illustrate how subjective impetus
208
Reconfiguration
is confronted by the effects of its own practice. Cultural orientation responds to a history that it guides but does not totally determine; history engages not only metaphors and mythical realities, but the constraints and opportunities of a nonsymbolic world. Symbolic formations develop in reaction to and in appropriation of these results - the existential results of their own actualization. These repercussions selectively reinforce, irritate, and confound cultural impetus; in the process, they stimulate further symbolic elaboration. As cultural orientations elaborate, they grow prominently in the fault lines, cleavages, and potentials of the symblic formations in place. Because the local interface between culture and practice is both recursive and generative, it produces remarkable differences among culture areas that nonetheless retain striking larger similarities. Along the New Guinea south coast, these differences were not trivial. They included great variation in residential aggregation versus dispersal, political hierarchy versus decentralization, alliance versus enmity, and social expansion versus constriction or eradication. Penetrating the dialect between culture and practice reveals the specifics in each case, for instance, how Marind-anim became an ethnically and politically expanding people through diffuse alliances and cultural amalgamation. In contrast, Purari became highly nucleated and hierarchical, with large-scale residential centralization and polarization. Other variants are illuminated analogously: the atomized competition of the Kolopom through dualistic involution, and the Trans-Fly vulnerability to outside military attack, as predisposed by its subordinated fertility introversion and narrow ties to local land. Further divergences are shown in the pulsating migrations and coastal expansion of the central and western Kiwai and the perpetual self-displacement of the Asmat through killing and transitory affiliation. To these may be contrasted the stable strings of Elema villages accommodating each other through the politics of gift-giving and material exchange. Differing configurations of social inequality also come into view. The Marind complemented their domination of outsiders with intra-ethnic political equality and a conflicted position for women. In contrast stand Purari patterns of rank hierarchy, static village opposition, and very high female status within the safe confines of the community. Among Elema one finds stable gerontocracy and local economic rather than military accommodation, whereas Asmat and Kolopom exhibited low female status and invidious male rivalry that focused respectively on killing and gardening. Trans-Fly peoples dovetailed gerontocracy and
Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations
209
male fertility retention with subordination of women in a context of great male insecurity caused by external predation. These divergences cannot be reduced to simple features of ecology or exchange logic nor explained as presenting different stages of political evolution. Nor are they straightforward projections of different "dominant cultural emphases" in each area. Though areal divergences existed as structural variations on regional cultural themes, these differences quickly elaborated through the recursive impact of practice upon the symbolic formation in each case. Cultures have histories; their divergence stems from the developmental interface between a distinct cultural impetus and the effects of this impetus in specific social and material conditions. Just as importantly, these conditions rebound back on symbolic orientations. Sociocultural development is hence inadequately penetrated by assuming causation "in the final instance" by an autonomous cultural logic, on the one hand, or by politicoeconomic or material determinism, on the other. It would be possible to compare the many axes of south coast variation in a complex grid of atomized similarities and differences. But as Barth (1987) has effectively critiqued in the Mountain Ok context, this would create discrete divisions at the expense of processual interconnection both within and between cases. Comparative trait tabulations easily neglect the developmental configurations that are crucial for understanding cultural divergence. Given that one primary purpose of the present chapter has been to penetrate the distinct pattern of cultural richness within each south coast language-culture area, these interconnections cannot be left aside. A similar argument pertains to the exposition and analysis of social inequality. Just as inequality in ownership of the means of production cannot be taken as the archetypal form of inequality to which age, sex, ethnicity, and race are subordinate (Donham 1990), so, too, the forms of inequality found in south coast New Guinea - between ethnic groups, between male status groups, and between men and women - should be considered as interrelated elements of sociopolitical development. The various dimensions of social inequality are difficult to meaningfully assess in isolation from each other. And given that social inequality intrinsically engages moral valuations and the cultural constitution of prestige and disparagement, inequalities beg consideration of underlying symbolic orientations. South coast New Guinea exhibits striking areal variations generated as permutations upon equally striking regional commonalities. The outcomes are different in each area; the generative process is the same.
10 Regional characteristics and comparisons
Distinctive cultural orientations can be identified at regional as well as local levels and then analyzed in relation to existential conditions. The analysis is similar to that undertaken in the previous chapter; its scale is increased. As a region, nonAustronesian south coast New Guinea placed particular cultural emphasis on the sexual creation of fertility and the violent taking of life-force through headhunting. These themes were manifested as part of larger culturally constituted linkages between reproduction, growth, and death - an encompassing fertility cycle. The south coast thus provided a distinctive regional permutation on beliefs and practices found elsewhere in Melanesia that linked cultural fertility through various dimensions of sexuality, bodily substance, growth, labor productivity, social exchange, depletion, and death (Knauft 1989a). Within this cycle, the south coast region culturally accentuated (a) the creation of life-power through ritual heterosexuality and sometimes also homosexuality, and (b) the taking of life-force by severing enemy heads, as if in military copulation. The close relationship between these twin emphases was epitomized in the cry of the Trans-Fly raider as he struck his victim for decapitation with a headhunting club: "Tokujenjeni is copulating with you!" tokujenjeni was the primal phallic bullroarer obtained by the Originator from his wife's vagina (Williams 1936:182f.). Among Marind-anim, as discussed in chapter 8, themes of hypersexuality linked directly to headhunting and engaged dramatic demographic as well as social, ritual, and mythic developments. Kiwai, Purari, Kolopom, and Asmat culture areas also demonstrated elaborate social and political as well as cosmological linkage between the fertility power of ritual sexuality and
Regional characteristics and comparisons
211
that of headhunting. In most of the south coast groups, headhunting and ritual sexuality - the cultural taking and giving of life - were focal points in elaborate fertility cycles. Their connection was socially underscored in celebratory sexual congress before or after the headhunting raid. The Elema, considered in more detail below, constitute the greatest exception to these generalizations. Regional New Guinea comparisons and cross-currents
South coast fertility emphases are thrown into relief by comparing and contrasting them with dominant fertility features found elsewhere in New Guinea. Relative to the south coast, New Guinea highland cultures placed less stress on the celebratory creation of sexual fertility and relatively greater cultural emphasis on land-kin affiliation and the transfer of substance through food and material exchange.1 This is not to say that the highlands were more "secular" and the lowlands more "religious" (contrast Lawrence and Meggitt 1965), nor that the politicoeconomic importance of food-giving was minimal along the south coast. In both regions, production and reproduction were inextricably symbolic and political - linked in cycles of social exchange as well as spiritual transaction. But if in Melanesia the wheel of life was frequently imaged through sociocultural processes of sexual creation, productive growth, vitality depletion, and the entrainments of death, the south coast cultures accentuated a particular linkage within this cycle: between the sexual generation of life-power and the violent taking of life in order to recreate it. Core highland areas culturally highlighted a complementary fertility tension: between the threat of enervation and the drive to increase productive growth in land, kin, and material exchange. Both regions metaphorized social as well as symbolic connections between reproduction, productive growth, depletion, death, and rebirth. But they contrasted in their emphasis and punctuation within this cycle. In different regions of Melanesia, one finds emphasis on complementary themes. For instance, various parts of the Massim and Austronesian insular Melanesia have stressed regeneration from death to life through mortuary rites and exchanges. These prestations simultaneously encoded spiritual and political power; they promulgated the differential ability of the living to reproduce the substance and authority of their deceased's ancestral legacy.2 This regional emphasis combined in multiple permutations with beliefs and practices concerning sexual creation, growth, and labor as well as with long-distance exchange
212
Reconfiguration
systems such as the kula (e.g., A. Weiner 1976; Munn 1986; Leach and Leach 1983). Like the south coast, some areas of the New Guinea highlands south fringe, such as the Anga and Strickland-Bosavi areas, highlighted the cultural power of sexual fertility, but with a more exclusive focus on male-autonomous homosexuality and a corresponding absence of ritual heterosexuality (Herdt 1981, 1982, 1987a; Godelier 1986; Kelly 1976; S0rum 1984; Knauft 1987b; cf. 1986). Life-force was acquired particularly through the transmission of semen and semen-like substances, which variously augmented or depleted bodily life-power of men and women (Kelly 1976; Herdt 1984b). Relative to the south coast, less cultural emphasis was placed on the military acquisition of life-force from enemies in order to increase its store within the local group. Headhunting was absent in the south highlands fringe, as it was in the highlands. Tangible accretion of life-force in trophy shrines and elaborate ancestral incarnations was also far less developed in these areas than along the south coast. Among Strickland-Bosavi groups in particular, life-power was stolen especially by the sorcerer or witch, who frequently lived within the deceased's community. Conversely, the community took retribution by killing and cannibalizing persons who were publicly accused of sorcery or witchcraft (Knauft 1985a,b, 1987c, 1989b; Kelly 1976, n.d.; see A. Strathern 1982b). In contrast to the south coast, Strickland-Bosavi cannibalism was not explicitly conceived of or ceremonialized as the replenishment of life-force, but it did provide a structural analogue to the taking of life-power in headhunting. In short, the Strickland-Bosavi area and the south coast both emphasized a cycle of ritual sexuality and life-taking, but in the former area this included (a) a particular focus on ritual homosexuality in the absence of ritual heterosexuality, (b) an emphasis on sorcerer-killing rather than headhunting, and (c) the implicit reabsorption of life-power through unceremonial cannibalism, often from persons within the community, as opposed to ritually momentous headhunting and cannibalism of outsiders. Whether the Strickland-Bosavi fertility cycle is "different" or "similar" to that of the south coast is, of course, a matter of definition. But the issue persists as variants from other south highlands fringe groups are considered. How similar and how different from south lowland emphases was the clannish endocannibalism found in parts of the southeastern highlands (e.g., Lindenbaum 1979; Gillison 1980,1983; cf. Meigs 1984)? How much similarity is there between Angan/Strickland-Bosavi patterns
Regional characteristics and comparisons
213
of ritual homosexuality and the nonsexual ingestion of greasy or semen-//A:e substances as crucial features of bodily ecology among south fringe groups like the Daribi (e.g., Wagner 1983, 1977:628)? Given such gradations, permutations, and intermediate cases, establishing clear cultural contrasts between regions or types of exchange logic becomes difficult. In other respects, south coast cultural emphases were similar to those found among some Sepik groups from northern New Guinea. In these, spiritual incarnations and carvings were sometimes especially elaborate, and social and totemic dualism was highly developed (e.g., Bateson 1936; Tuzin 1976, 1980). In some Sepik areas, moreover, ritual heterosexuality or headhunting was practiced. Among the Iatmul, the head of the victim was placed on the ancestral stones (mbwan), where it was associated with the prosperity of the village (Bateson 1936:138-141). These stones were also phallic symbols, and copulation was referred to in shaman's speech as mbwan tou, "setting up a standing stone." After successful headhunting, copulation was publicly feigned by a novice initiand's sponsor (his MB), who dressed up like a woman, and his wife, who dressed like a man (ibid. :19f.).3 Headhunting was thus associated in a general way with both spiritual well-being and with heterosexual copulation. However, actual sexual intercourse and explicit beliefs in life-force and sexual substance incorporation - for instance, as a dimension of initiatory rejuvenation - appear to have been absent or but vaguely developed in Iatmul ceremonial life. Unfortunately, it is difficult to compare these cultural strains to the most distinctive cultural features of the south coast. There is relatively little information on Sepik headhunting, and its distribution in northern New Guinea appears to have been spotty (D'Amato 1979; Bowden 1983:99, 105, 110, 165; Bateson 1936). Likewise, there are only a few accounts documenting heterosexual intercourse in Sepik ritual or ceremonial life,4 and there are apparently no accounts of ritual homosexuality in the region (see Thurnwald 1916; Meeker et al. 1986; Herdt 1984a:43f.). Sepik River societies accentuated inter-group complementarity through trading, giving, or "selling" cult insignia, dances, and artifact copyrights as well as subsistence goods (Gewertz 1983; Harrison 1990:20; Lipset 1984, 1985). The resulting system of areal integration was complemented by political rivalry and intense disputes within the community, particularly between clans over legitimate possession of totemic and mythical knowledge, names, and identities (ibid.; Bateson
214
Reconfiguration
1936; Meeker et al. 1986). Along the New Guinea south coast, in contrast, there was less dispute over ritual or mythic knowledge within communities and more clear-cut opposition between groups - that is, as competitors for life-force. This pattern was epitomized in group creation of sexual fertility, on the one hand, and pervasive headhunting of enemies, on the other. For reasons of indigenous custom as well as those of Western ethnographic history, then, the connection between sexually creating and violently taking life-force seems to be more emphatic, more pervasive, and more elaborate along the New Guinea south coast than in the Sepik. Such a connection appears yet more muted in selected areas of southeast Asia, where head-taking was associated with other features of emotional, social, or ritual well-being (see M. Rosaldo 1980; R. Rosaldo 1980; McKinley 1976; contrast Needham 1976). It may be asked, however, why headhunting and sexuality should be privileged in regional comparison and other factors left in the background. It could be asserted that an emphasis on sexually creating and violently appropriating life-force is structurally not very different from highlands emphases on reproducing clanship and defeating rivals militarily or in competitive exchange. Though it tends to preclude the possibility of internal contrast, one could expand and blur the differences between regions, making them parts of a single undifferentiated cultural system for all of New Guinea, all of Melanesia, or even all of Oceania and Southeast Asia (see Bonnemere 1990; M. Strathern 1988; Meeker et al. 1986; Levi-Strauss 1969). Simply expanding the scale of analysis, however, does not resolve the basic problem: because cultural permutations exist between as well as within regions, regional contrasts are intrinsically contestable. As discussed in chapters 4 and 6, this problem also afflicts the attribution of discrete exchange logics to noncontiguous societal types: local variants shade across the cultural landscape in a series of complex permutations that recombine a wide range of features and belie simple alignment. As the analytic contrast between different typological "logics" becomes increasingly general and abstract, it also becomes increasingly reified; it either gerrymanders the actual patterns of ethnographic emphasis or disconnects them from its analysis. It may be noted for the south coast, for example, that, similar to many highlanders, men among Keraki, Kiwai, and Kolopom harbored fears of menstrual pollution. In ways quite reminiscent of the Sepik and parts of the Massim, Kolopom combined this concern with great emphasis on
Regional characteristics and comparisons
215
men's careful cultivation of large root crop tubers for use in competitive exchange (cf. Tuzin 1972; Young 1971). Kolopom emphasis on mortuary ritual in cycles of cultural regeneration resonates with Austronesian Melanesia to the east, as well as with insular southeast Asia to the west. Anomalies of regional characterization become particularly great if the south coast is configured to include rather than exclude Elemaspeaking peoples. As discussed in chapters 4 and 9 above, Elema lacked headhunting and ritual sexuality, had a relatively high population density and large pig population, and placed strong cultural emphasis on concretizing prowess through large-scale competitive exchanges. Elema elaborated bride-price exchanges, lacked a developed system of dual organization, valued stability on clan land, and combined longhouse residence with cumulative patrifiliation, gradually recruiting newcomers to the dominant identity of the founding clan-parish. Historically, Elema were an inland population that had extruded to the coast from hilly hinterland areas (H. Brown 1986:xix). Though these sociopolitical features liken Elema to groups of interior New Guinea, they fail to differentiate Elema from other south coast areas. Evidence presented in chapter 4 suggests, among other things, that large-scale competitive exchanges of food and valuables were important to male prestige in many south coast areas, sometimes also linked to patronymic residence or clan-parish identity. Moreover, Elema cultural emphases were deeply infused and amalgamated with cult genres typical of the south coast, as emphasized by Holmes (1902, 1924:chs.9-14) and Wirz 1934b, 1937; cf. Williams 1939a,b). Though headhunting was absent, Elema did hunt a human victim and sacrifice him or her at the culmination of the hevehe, and, though details could not be reconstructed, the treatment of this victim in effigy closely echoed the Purari cannibal cult (Williams 1940:390; cf. 1924:chs.9,14). Though ritual sexuality of all forms was apparently absent among Elema, Elema men actively participated sexually with Kiwai women when the opportunity arose (Williams 1940:52n), and in so doing, they exhibited no fear of semen loss. In short, the Elema serve as a salutary caution that areal typologies are bound to fail as absolute discriminators between groups of one cultural region and those of the next. From the highlands, correspondingly, one could belie a south coast/ highlands contrast by noting the ritual incorporation of life-force from slain enemies among a few highland groups, such as the Grand Valley Dani (Heider 1979). Customs of serial ritual heterosexuality were found
216
Reconfiguration
in some Awan groups of the eastern highlands (Newman and Boyd 1982). Though occurring in the absence of headhunting, cannibalism of enemies was also pronounced in parts of the eastern highlands, as it was in the Star Mountains of central New Guinea (Berndt 1962; Koch 1974). Broad regions of New Guinea such as the Sepik, the highlands, and the south highlands fringe exhibit important ranges of internal permutation and variation. Significant differences exist between western versus eastern highland areas, the Strickland-Bosavi versus Bosavi-Karamui versus Anga areas of the south highlands fringe, and different regions within the Sepik.5 As Terence Hays (1991b) has suggested, even the New Guinea highlands lack consistent boundaries or features if one looks closely at how the region is configured in existing analyses. If variation within south New Guinea has been frequently collapsed by configuring it as a negative contrast to the highlands, as implied in chapters 3-5, it would hardly be better to commit a similar error in reverse, that is, vigorously to use south coast New Guinea as the baseline against which other regions are negatively defined. Though different in important ways, a "lowlands-centric" comparative view of New Guinea is ultimately no more inclusive than a "highlands-centric" one. Whether one chooses to cluster areal variants within lines of broader regional contrast or to view them as continuous chains of permutation as a single Melanesian Mythologique - is as much an issue of analytic choice as one of ethnographic truth or falsity (see M. Strathern 1988). Nevertheless, a scheme that does not view cultural impetus in relation to pragmatic outcomes and focuses instead on abstract structure or formal properties is likely to be arbitrary and ungrounded. Conversely, approaches that do not distinguish some regional variants from others but view them all as parts of an undifferentiated mass are likely to be vague. For the present, I stress those features of fertility emphasis that most clearly distinguished south coast areas: a strong and complementary linkage between celebratory creation of life-force through ritual sexuality and violent taking of life-force through headhunting. The connection between these themes appears more socially evident and cosmologically eminent along the nonAustronesian coast of south New Guinea for perhaps 2,000 km - from the Purari in the east to the Asmat in the west - than in any other ethnographic area of Melanesia and, indeed, in the world. Moreover, as illustrated in chapter 9, these distinct emphases did not exist in cultural isolation but provided an important
Regional characteristics and comparisons
217
underpinning for patterns of social and residential organization, male status hierarchy, gender relations, and inter-ethnic domination. In their actualization, these orientations engaged existential conditions and their own hard-world entailments; they were not self-contained symbolic systems or cultural gestalts. In practice, they generated both the most distinctive sources of cultural richness and the most pervasive forms of social inequality along the New Guinea south coast. That sociocultural permutations and gradations form complex patterns does not mean that it is impossible to generalize about them. It does, however, raise larger questions about the nature of ethnographic characterization and classification. On the one hand, classifications are ultimately relative and are influenced by our own cultural perceptions. As discussed in chapters 6 and 7, the objectivist assumption that classification is a transparent window upon reality is untenable. On the other hand, however, there are indeed patterns of ethnographic reality that exist independently of our attempts to comprehend them. It would be a mistake to subscribe to the nominalist position that this reality exists only as a function of our references for it. Such a position, to paraphrase Bateson (1972:455), is to mistake the map for the territory. What is needed, then, arc pragmatic grounds for advancing a particular classificatory scheme as a way of generalizing about and comprehending ethnographic complexity. The complementary goals of delineating cultural richness and exposing social inequalities are particularly apt in this regard, that is, as practical objectives of ethnographic analysis (see chapter 7). Approaches that draw critically on theories of practice and agency provide particularly effective ways, among others, to pursue these goals. The present analysis thus highlights features of south coast New Guinea that provided the most distinctive sources of cultural richness and underpinned the most pervasive forms of social inequality. In order to penetrate these dynamics, empirical scholarship cannot be left on the periphery but must be engaged rigorously and critically. Socioecological contrast and regional implications
Regional symbolic divergences are not mere superstructure below which material features create an autonomous social reality. As discussed in chapters 6 and 7, south coast fertility orientations engaged quite forcefully with both ecological conditions and the concrete effects of their own actualization. Like complementary highland culture emphases, the dominant themes of south coast fertility exerted not just a logical but a deep practical influence on their regional world.
218
Reconfiguration
This cultural actualization drew on ecological as well as cosmological conditions; history is powerfully influenced by cultural orientation but is not its simple reflection (Sahlins 1981). As Braudel (1973) effectively illustrated, history in the longue duree is powerfully influenced by environment, though it is not reducible to it either. South coast and highland regions of New Guinea afforded obviously different potentials for subsistence exploitation, on the one hand, and for transport, communication, and travel, on the other. Highland areas of New Guinea were much more amenable to large-scale cultivation of root crops such as sweet potatoes than were lowland areas. South coast areas such as the Trans-Fly and Kolopom did depend on root crops as starch staples, but the land was not as easily and generally arable as in the highlands; high yields per hectare could not be generalized across the landscape to produce widespread cultivation and dense settlement. Once forest was cleared, highland valleys offered the potential for feeding relatively large numbers of pigs with tubers, particularly sweet potatoes. Widespread fodder-feeding facilitated intensive animal husbandry and accommodated high human population density. Along the south coast, pigs were often highly important, but they were raised in large numbers only among Elema. A number of south coast ceremonial contexts focused on killing a wild boar rather than giving pork obtained from domesticated pigs, and, in contrast to core highland areas, live pigs were seldom transacted in exchange. Pigs were virtually never given in large numbers when alive. Coastal areas, on the other hand, frequently afforded great opportunity for long-distance travel, communication, and transport by canoe. Canoe use was particularly extensive along the south New Guinea coast, where low-lying alluvial formations channelled into numerous small inland waterways. Riverine and shoreline mobility along the south coast frequently co-occurred with wild sago as an abundant and relatively easy-toprocure starch staple. Sago was also easily stored; when amassed in a village, it supported a large feast; when cached in a large war canoe, it could sustain travellers for a long time. Plentiful stands of sago were supplemented by relatively abundant fish and other maritime resources in many south coast areas and particularly among the five largest language families: Asmat, Marind, Kiwai, Purari, and Elema. All of these areas exhibited a capacity for relatively large-scale population aggregation, either residentially or in temporary alliance, despite a low population density overall. In Marind, Kolopom, Kiwai, and Elema
Regional characteristics and comparisons
219
areas, the habitation or creation of selected non-swamp areas additionally permitted locally intensive if geographically dispersed gardening. These socioecological potentials interacted in important ways with the distinctive strains of south coast fertility cultism. The ability to amass or move relatively large numbers of people over extensive areas afforded a special potential both for large rituals of sociosexual union and for long-distance raids, especially against populations that were temporarily dispersed. Travel in large war canoes also facilitated quick return to the group's home territory without dispersing or diluting its fighting strength. Long-distance encounters with alien populations in which the intruders had the numerical and tactical advantage were hence more easily arranged in south coastal environments than in the highlands. In some cases, these attacks were made by leapfrogging intervening groups entirely. Where sago was plentiful in conjunction with easy water transport, headhunting was most prolific: among Asmat, Marind, Purari, and Kiwai. Each of these areas had abundant sago resources and innumerable inland channels and inlets for travel and communication in addition to the more risky option of travel on the open ocean off the coast.6 Large-scale headhunting was pursued much less frequently and intensely by Kolopom and Trans-Fly peoples than it was in neighboring culture areas; among Elema, it was totally absent. Kolopom and central Trans-Fly peoples both lacked sago and were strongly tied to labor investment in garden land; their local subsistence demands and related travel constraints were great. Elema were prolific gardeners who had migrated from the hinterland; moreover, they lived along an exposed beach coast that made water travel difficult and dangerous for a significant part of the year.7 In coastal and riverine areas where major settlements were far apart but readily accessible, an approach-avoidance fascination with a distant enemy was ripe for cultural and symbolic elaboration in headhunting. South coast headhunting emphasized not just the taking of life but the erotic attraction to and incorporation of the enemy as a conceptual Other.8 The south coast capacity for bringing diverse local clans together as somewhat cohesive and yet partially autonomous units can be seen in concert with elaborate dualism that variously integrated and opposed the region's longhouse or territorial groups. On the one hand, individual totem-clans or analogous units within a multi-clan longhouse typically
220
Reconfiguration
maintained their own longhouse section and fertility shrine of trophies, sacrae, and carved ancestral embodiments. Such a group usually constituted a "single canoe" that could act with some autonomy in subsistence, trading, war-making, alliance, treachery, or relocation. On the other hand, these sub-groups - which can in some ways be glossed as fertility clans (Whitehead 1986) - typically coordinated their efforts with those of the longhouse or territorial group as a whole, which usually also shared a larger spiritual or even patronymic identity. In various forms, this tendency toward residential or political aggregation of diverse local groups characterized the social organization of all south coast societies, but was pronounced in language-culture areas that headhunted most frequently, that is, among Asmat, Marind, Kiwai, and Purari. This pattern notwithstanding, the degree of antagonism versus cohesion between areally coresident fertility clans showed a great range of empirical variation, as reflected in the fortress-village nucleation of the Purari, expansive decentralized alliances among Marind, endemic rivalry among Asmat, and pulsating temporary aggregation and dispersal among Kiwai. None of these patterns is a simple reflex of south coast ecological conditions. On the other hand, environmental factors such as ease of travel and relative ease of resource procurement did create both opportunities and constraints for social organization. Though it would be easy to overstate the connection, lowland riverine rain forest areas such as the Sepik, the New Guinea south coast, parts of insular southeast Asia, and the Amazon basin all supported at least some groups that lived in sizable men's houses, developed elaborate dual organization, and practiced headhunting. Few other areas of the world are known to have exhibited this particular cluster of traits. All these propensities were largely or virtually absent in highland New Guinea. The gross impact and yet great imprecision of socioecological determination leads us back to the interrelationship between symbolic and nonsymbolic dimensions of social life. It seems undeniable that ecological differences between highland and lowland New Guinea were selectively appropriated and developed through divergent cultural emphases. Within the south coast region, local variations in fertility cult emphasis were crucial in differentiating and galvanizing distinctive sociopolitical formations and ecological appropriations. The reinforcing "fit" between cosmological orientation and sociomaterial condition in each of the seven major language-culture areas of south coast New Guinea was predictable neither by cultural logic nor by environment.
Regional characteristics and comparisons
221
So, too, regional divergence between the south coast and interior New Guinea occurred in the longue duree of histories that mediated regional permutations of Melanesian fertility with environmental opportunity and constraint. Comparison in historical context
Regional comparison is not easily isolated from historical patterns of Western influence. After my criticism of the ahistoricism of ethnographic comparison in previous chapters, it is all too easy for it to reemerge here. To what degree can the south coast fertility emphasis on headhunting and ritual sexuality - customs suppressed by colonial intervention - be synchronically contrasted to a presumed highland fertility emphasis on material production and man-land affiliation customs that were approved by the colonial regime and, indeed, intensified by its actions and policies? Headhunting and ritual sexuality were, if anything, particularly abhorrent to Westerners. By contrast, the competitive orientation of material exchange in the highlands was, if anything, too easily assumed to parallel Western materialist inclinations. The subtlety of this bias is revealed by a simple cross-current: warfare was important to male prestige in interior New Guinea, particularly in the eastern highlands and fringe areas. 9 This fact is tacitly neglected by positing a contrast between the precolonial south coast and the "ethnographic present" of the post-pacification New Guinea highlands. When the juncture between comparison and historical critique is confronted within ethnography itself, comparative analysis need not give up. Rather, it can move forward by considering sociocultural dialectics in a diachronic and reflexive manner. In the present case, I use this perspective to illustrate, if too briefly and broadly, contrasting patterns of violence in south coastal and highland regions of New Guinea as they emerged in the colonial and postcolonial eras. Both core highland and south coastal areas of New Guinea were effectively "pacified" during the colonial era. But the longevity of pacification and its link to cultural reproduction of indigenous sociocultural formations were different in each region. In core highland areas, suppression of warfare under the colonial kiaps did little to undermine those culturally valued dimensions of male prestige that pertained to the politicoeconomics of Big-Manship. As discussed in chapter 6, following Godelier and Strathern (1991), Big-Manship and colonial impact were themselves linked in significant ways. Pacification in the highlands was
222
Reconfiguration
quickly joined by the expansion of indigenous competitive exchange networks (Connolly and Anderson 1987; A. Strathern 1984). Along the south coast, in contrast, the cultural reproduction of life-force was often highly dependent on head-taking. Even in areas such as Purari where headhunting may not have been frequent uper capita," it still had deep cosmological significance. Yet it was just this head-taking that was the preeminent target of colonial intervention and suppression (e.g., Hope 1979; Lett 1935:pt.2, ch.4; cf. Bevan 1890). Second only to this impact was the Western campaign against ritualized sexuality, which was culturally entwined with headhunting as well as with cosmological reproduction more generally. Ritual sexuality was subject to particular opposition by missionaries, who were the primary conduits of Western influence in many south coast areas. In short, the features of south coast indigenous life most subject to colonial suppression and reprobation - headhunting and ritual sexuality - were the features both particularly distinctive to south New Guinea and particularly central to reproduction of indigenous symbolic formations. Whether colonial officers and missionaries realized this or not, they saw that these practices were inextricably associated with south coast fertility cults and ceremonial life in general. Tacitly and often actively, they suppressed cult activity. The character of south coast societies changed greatly as a result of pacification, as Maher (1961) effectively documents for the Purari and van Baal (1966) laments for the Marind (see Vogel and Richens 1989). Once headhunting, ritual sexuality, initiation cults, and public fertility ceremonials were suppressed or moribund, the basis for indigenous cultural reproduction was fundamentally altered. After many decades of pacification and missionary influence, these could not spontaneously reemerge when colonial influence was officially withdrawn in the mid-1970s (see poignant case study for the Gogodala by Crawford [1981]). Perhaps the greatest exception here does confirm the rule; the Trans-Fly peoples, whose fertility cultism had been less dependent on warfare than on mythology and place location, appear to be the south coast group least affected by introduced cultural change (Ayres 1983). Indeed, the same introversion and cultural conservatism that made Trans-Fly peoples most susceptible to outside intrusion and immanent extinction in the precolonial era may have made their culture the most self-sufficient and enduring in the context of pacification. The situation was different in core highland areas for reasons of
Regional characteristics and comparisons
223
indigenous cultural as well as colonial and environmental history. Though violence and male aggressiveness were often highly esteemed (e.g., Read 1959; Langness 1972; Watson 1971), and though bloodfeuding was often endemic, the taking of life was not valued in and of itself as it was along the south coast. Particularly in core highland areas, killing was not a requisite for achieving male self-worth. Highlanders were almost as willing to fight alongside the kiaps or through the courts as against them (A. Strathern 1984). In the colonial encounter, particular features of history combined to make pacification of bellicose highland areas surprisingly nonviolent, at least relative to the subjugation of tribal populations by colonial powers in most other areas of the world (contrast for the south coast Langmore 1972; Bevan 1890; Strachan 1888). These features of highlands pacification included lateness of geographic discovery, the personality and pluck of the first explorers and administrators, and, ironically, the deadly efficient use of high-powered twentieth century repeating firearms in open highland areas by those making initial contact (Connolly and Anderson 1987; Nelson 1982:Chs.13-15; Leahy 1991). The temporary demise of highlands warfare through Western pacification facilitated many changes, including the extension and intensification of competitive exchange networks. The dimensions of male prestige that were related to these practices expanded while the significance of warfare prowess correspondingly narrowed. If the period from first pacification to colonial departure was as much as three or four decades in the highlands, this was but little more than half of the duration of colonial pacification along the south coast. Moreover, though exceptions from fringe highland and west New Guinea areas could be noted,10 highlands warfare appears to have had fewer ritual and ceremonial prerequisites, motivations, and entailments than along the south coast. The undercutting of highlands ritual life hence did not undermine warfare motivation as it did in south coast areas; warfare easily remained as the latent negative-reciprocity dimension of highlands political rivalry. In the postcolonial environment, highlands warfare easily reemerged as a continuation of political strategy by prior indigenous means. Combined with these regional differences in cultural and colonial history were contrasts in human geography. In the core highlands, clan land was at a premium both culturally and ecologically. The core highlands had population densities that were high and political units that were large (Brown and Podolefsky 1976). Given indigenous fertility
224
Reconfiguration
emphasis on productive labor and material exchange, highlanders' response to colonial opportunities for economic development was especially keen. An avid army of potential laborers inhabited highlands valleys that were both fertile and hospitable in climate to Westerners: core highland areas were quickly embroiled in colonial economic development schemes. Goods became increasingly available, indigenous exchange systems ramified, and increasing pressure was placed on valued and yet highly limited resources such as land. Given highlanders' cultural orientations, land had always had particular value, and the widespread adoption of cash-cropping made land both all the more valuable and all the more scarce. With the departure of the colonial kiaps, unsurprisingly, it has been the crowded core areas of the western Papua New Guinea highlands that have seen the greatest resurgence of tribal fighting (Meggitt 1977; Gordon and Meggitt 1985; A. Strathern 1977; P. Brown 1982a,b; see Knauft 1990a:271f.). By this time along the south New Guinea coast, a quite different interface had taken root, that is, between severely altered or Christianized cultural orientations and a dearth of ecological potentials for Western economic development. Cash-cropping was minimal or negligible, the indigenous labor force was thin and highly dispersed, and Western goods were difficult and often impossible to obtain, particularly in significant quantities. 11 Cargo cults and movements sprang up in the context of this simultaneous exposure to Christianity and general inability to obtain Western goods (Knauft 1978).12 Along the south coast, cargo cults occurred from the Asmat in the west to the Elema in the east.13 Those south coast areas most strongly influenced by cargo cults and movements, such as Asmat, Purari, and Elema, were also those most deeply committed to enduring incarnations of fertility power in elaborate carvings, masks, and totems. These material instantiations of political and economic as well as spiritual force were perhaps the indigenous analogue of and precursor to "cargo." As such, they presaged the elaboration of mythic beliefs and ritual activity to attain Western objects of spiritual power and political authority. On the other hand, the Trans-Fly and Marind were relatively immune and resistant to cargo cults and movements (van Baal 1966:956; Ayres 1983:10-18). This response is consistent with their Australian-like cultural propensity for reliance on personal mythical enactment rather than the accretion of spiritual force in large and long-lasting material artifacts.
Regional characteristics and comparisons
225
A systematic consideration of south coast versus core highlands colonial and postcolonial trajectories is outside the scope of the present analysis. Unfortunately, substantial information on social and cultural development during the colonial and postcolonial periods is lacking for many south coast areas in any event. My point is that regional comparison can easily consider historical trajectories and developmental processes of the colonial and post-colonial eras. This analysis is greatly facilitated by focusing on the dialectical interface between developing cultural orientations and changing existential conditions. Comparative history, evolution, and interpretation
The present approach to regional analysis selectively combines and differs from evolutionary perspectives, on the one hand, and interpretive ones, on the other. Evolutionary perspectives are intrinsically reductionist and deterministic; they look for parallel trends of social development that have occurred in different areas despite cultural differences between them - and for infrastructural divergence between adjacent areas that may otherwise exhibit cultural similarity. The causal features adduced tend to be ecological and economic rather than cultural, and they tend to view politics as a functional if not rational means of satisfying the need for organization under varying conditions. Regional analyses based on cultural interpretation, in contrast, tend to be relativizing. In the tradition of Geertz, Benedict, and Dumont, culture areas emerge as independent entities with distinctive and separate symbolic orientations. This outcome is informed by the assumption that culture is at once determinant, distinctive, irreducible, and relatively homogenous within each area. The present approach attempts to transcend these perspectives. It takes cultural differences as a crucial point of departure but considers the historical development of culture through the existential features of practice. As a result, a dynamic and processual perspective on culture emerges. This approach contrasts with Weberian ideal-type regional characterizations, which tend to collapse the subjective and existential dimensions of action and assume that these are isomorphic rather than contingently related. While comparative historical analysis needs to take symbolic orientations seriously, it also needs to consider their variable relationship with existential constraints and opportunities. Because these dimensions of reality are mutually contingent, their relationship is systematic over time but cannot be predicted by considering either of them separately. It is for this reason that cultural
226
Reconfiguration
interpretive perspectives, much less postmodern ones, cannot comprehend the larger patterns of existential regularity and difference that connect as well as differentiate sociocultural regions. Conversely, evolutionary or reductive politicoeconomic perspectives, by themselves, are inadequately suited for comprehending the developmental complexities of cultural change. As highlighted in chaos theory, our inability to accurately assess minute differences in a system's initial state makes it very difficult to predict how these conditions will ramify when played out in a complex universe of interacting factors over a long period. In the study of sociocultural life, we can correct for this difficulty by reassessing the reciprocal development of symbolic orientations and existential conditions at various points in time, that is, to ascertain their larger systemic relationship. Because sociocultural formations develop as a product of this relationship, a one-sided assessment of cultural orientations or of existential conditions - no matter how sophisticated - cannot accurately comprehend sociocultural development. This book has focused on the mutually reactive relationship between symbolic and existential forces in the development of sociocultural formations. Analysis commences by considering the distinctive features of the cultural gestalt; these strongly influence action and are not easily reconstituted once universal assumptions of politicoeconomic or material causation have been taken as a prior point of departure. Symbolic formations exert a decisive influence on the way the environment is perceived and appropriated and on the way that society is organized. The actualization of symbolic formations through economic, sociodemographic, and ecological realities, however, presents constraints and opportunities that cultural impetus itself adjusts and responds to. This symbolic elaboration cannot be predicted on the basis of material properties alone nor solely on the basis of symbolic orientations in place; its development depends on the spiralling interaction and progressive reinforcement of the symbolic-existential interface in each case. External impingement and influence from ethnic groups or agents of state societies is similarly appropriated by symbolic formations as an existential constraint and opportunity. In all instances, symbolic orientations and existential effects depend on the reciprocal relations of qualitative difference that each simultaneously exerts and has exerted on it by the other. As equally real orders of reality, symbolic and existential dimensions of social life engage in a dialectical relationship that is mediated by the
Regional characteristics and comparisons
227
actualization of culture in practice. As this relationship is analyzed, both the richness of local cultural formations and patterns of social inequality are illuminated. As a range of cases is considered, analysis can be "built up" from local areas to broader levels, allowing ethnographic regions and their histories to be compared. Afterward: Primitive historicism and postmodern dialectic
Anthropology in the twenty-first century will deal increasingly with the competitive richness of the human diaspora - the displaced peoples, multivalent selves, and fragmented idioms of the postmodern world. Given this, of what value is it to analytically exhume and systematically examine older if not classic ethnographic information? A plethora of subjective richness and social inequalities is neither unique to the postmodern present nor diminished by it as a topic of study in either the present or the past. It would be folly to stress the importance of contemporary historical circumstance without drawing on the strengths as well as illuminating the weaknesses of ethnography's own history. Anthropology needs to confront its present through its past; we should not shun the modernist impulse to learn about today through the patterns of yesterday. This endeavor, it seems to me, entails looking at the ethnographic record as both content and image, neither dismissing the first nor ignoring the second. Insofar as the articulation of past concerns to present theory is vital to anthropology, serious as well as critical reexamination of classic information should be one of anthropology's sharpest cutting edges. Especially in a postmodern world, the work of the present will soon itself be history. Learning how to critically historicize our work is hence increasingly important. Put in terms of the present theoretical perspective, ethnographic analysis elaborates in relation to the existential products of its own knowledge - its own previous books, articles, papers, conferences, films, notes, and recordings. Being self-conscious about this process without losing sight of its richness and value is critical if anthropology is to move beyond mere proliferation of hermeneutic circles. When we retain empiricism and objectivism but use them self-critically, we can engage a forward-moving dialectic.
Appendix Evidence concerning Asmat homosexuality
Though information concerning Asmat homosexuality is disparate, independent accounts concur on several basic points. Information concerning the central Asmat and the Casuarina coast Asmat is reviewed separately; results are summarized in conclusion. Central Asmat
The clearest evidence concerning homosexuality among the populous central Asmat comes from Eyde (1967:206) and Schneebaum (1988:85-87), both of whom emphasize the casual and reciprocal nature of sexual relations between male adolescents who are "bond friends." Eyde (1967:206) writes, The two bond-friends are playmates during childhood. At least in some cases the relationship involves homosexual behavior prior to marriage. Such behavior is not strongly disapproved among adolescents. It is discontinued after marriage of the two men. In some cases an older man will choose a young boy as a bond-friend, his aj akap, probably meaning something like "new junior." This relationship may also involve homosexual behavior until the marriage of the younger partner.
Schneebaum (1988:85f.) documents that bond-friend age mates casually engaged in homosexual liaisons prior to marriage. The pair regularly reversed roles in anal intercourse. Schneebaum (ibid. :42f.) witnessed central Asmat boys matter-of-factly engaging in anal intercourse and then switching roles in the course of private bathing, and he provides a poignant description of this activity. Consistent with this observation, Amelsvoort (1964:13) indicates cryptically that among central Asmat, "homosexual relationships are less institutionalized than among the neighboring Jaquai people." Schneebaum's information on sexual practices among central Asmat is punctuated by a detailed informant account. Schneebaum precedes this account with a background portrait of his informant - whom he had known for eight years - and with a candid discussion of the difficulties that beset the collection of information about indigenous sexual practices. The account of Allo Sosokcemen, the leader of a central Asmat village, begins by freely acknowledging the practice of wife-exchange, including Sosokcemen's personal participation in the custom. He also describes intense and promiscuous heterosexual intercourse, including incest, that took place during a recent cargo cult (1988:83; see
Appendix
229
Trenkenschuh 1982e). Given Sosokcemen's candor in relating this and other highly privileged information, his corollary affirmation seems truthful that ritual sexuality was exclusively heterosexual and that "I have never had sex with a man" (ibid.). Sosokcemen freely acknowledges that Asmat boys so-inclined are free to pursue homosexual relations on an individual basis. At this point, Sosokcemen's account, quoted by Schneebaum (ibid. :85f.) adds detail to those cited above: "The word for sexual activity between two boys or between a boy and a man is faper. Fa means ass; per is to hook together. It is the same word we use for sex between animals because of the way they connect themselves. When families arrange for papisj [wifeexchange] partners in childhood, the boys usually begin having sex together when they are about five; that is, they play with one another's penis. Later, they have sex by pushing the penis into the ass of the other. First, one does it to his friend; then the other gets his turn. There is always balance between them. We use the words faper ameris. There are no words for a man or a boy who is on top or for the one on bottom. It doesn't happen that one partner takes the same role all the time . . . Sometimes there is faper between men after marriage, but this does not happen often."
The virtual absence of asymmetrical or prescribed sexual relations, along with Sosokcemen's statement that he himself has never had sex with a man, suggests that age-structured or ritualized homosexuality was absent among central Asmat. That Schneebaum, the researcher, makes no secret of his own homosexual predilections makes it less likely that the significance of homosexuality in Sosokcemen's account is underemphasized or incompletely revealed. The possibility of ritual homosexuality was raised but was never confirmed by the first resident missionary in Asmat, Gerard Zegwaard, in 1953 (Zegwaard and Boelaars 1982:25 [original 1955]): This [Imu-mu] ritual implies a strange relationship between older men and young boys. The boys in this relationship are called imu ipitsj and are subjected to all kinds of dirty jokes and treatment at the hands of the older men. They are made to sit in front of the old men and then the old men are told, "Here is your wife!" There is a lot of physical familiarity between the boys and these old men - seemingly in the context of playing. How far this ritual, which may be afinaleof many other rituals, includes homosexuality, has not been established. Informants denied any existence of homosexual relations in the Imu-mu ritual. At this time I don't know whether there are any social consequences of this ritual. During a feast, however, the men and the boys share food and smear each other's foreheads with sago flour. They also exchange armbands. Whether this offers any evidence of existing social bonds is impossible to say. Usually the Imu relationship exists between one boy and an old man and his classificatory and real brothers. Even the sisters of these old men will call this boy Imu Ipitsj.
No other information of any kind is given about the Imu ritual. In light of the evidence discussed above, this account can lead one to different conclusions. If Zegwaard's informants thought that as a missionary he would condemn homosexuality, it might explain their flat denial of the practice. Their reference to the initiate novices as "wives" may be particularly significant, and the reciprocal smearing of sago flour by boys and men on each other's foreheads could also be important. Context for this latter practice is provided in
230
Appendix
Trenkenschuh's (1982b:52) account of a similar practice in wife-exchange [papisj] among central Asmat: It is known that it is necessary for the two men to agree on a need for the wife exchange. After the agreement they rub sago flour on each other's forehead (Komor [village]) and return to their wives in order to convince them into agreement as regards the exchange. When the wives agree and exchange homes the men meet the women at the door and greet them with sagoflourrubbed onto the forehead. Then the woman immediately prepares sago meal for the entire family - and then sleeps with the man. In the morning she again prepares a meal of sago for the host family and then is again decorated with sago flour and feathers and sent back to her husband.
The linkage between sago-flouring the forehead and sexual exchange of wives suggests that homosexual exchange of "wives" may also mark the imu-mu ritual. It is also possible, however, that this custom is a general marker of exchange relations - heterosexual or nonsexual - between the novice's kin group and that of the senior initiator. Adult married men, themselves not current homosexual partners, also rub sago flour on each other's foreheads to indicate their linkage through exchange. The custom also seems to be practiced on other nonsexual occasions. It is curious that the boys' partners are repeatedly described as "old men." Though the term might have an anomalous connotation in translation from Dutch to English, the notion that boys would be inseminated by old men rather than by young men who were recently initiated would be unusual for New Guinea. This irregularity is deepened by the fact that brothers and even sisters of the elders adopt the same term of bonding-patronage for the young boys as do the old men, that is, imu ipitsj. This terminological usage is consistent with a collective relationship of nonsexual exchange between kin groups. If this exchange also included asymmetric homosexual initiation, it appears to have compromised the exclusivity of male homosexual address and the secrecy from women that were common in Melanesian ritual homosexuality elsewhere. Catholic missionaries easily documented ritual homosexuality in other groups of southwest New Guinea, including the Jaquai, the Kolopom, and the Marindanim. This deepens the question as to why a similar discovery was not made by Zegwaard if ritual homosexuality had indeed been present in 1953, that is, before Asmat had been subject to significant mission or government influence. Zegwaard's ethnographic sensitivities underscore this point. Zegwaard published sympathetic and nuanced descriptions of activities such as heterosexual wifeexchange and headhunting - practices that could likewise have been considered unChristian - and he appears to have had little difficulty obtaining truthful admissions about these activities (Zegwaard and Boelaars 1982:21-23; Zegwaard 1959). Moreover, a perusal of Zegwaard's extensive personal notes on Asmat myth and ceremonial life reveals no evidence of ritual homosexuality (Eyde p.c. 1992). Given this context, the denials of Zegwaard's informants concerning ritual homosexuality may well have been truthful. If ritual homosexuality had been discovered by resident catechists, who established a tentative foothold among central Asmat in subsequent years, one would think they would have publicized their crusade against this behavior to Zegwaard and to other mission staff.
Appendix
231
The personal journal kept by Gajdusek (1964) during his extended visit to southwest New Guinea in 1960 tends to corroborate this interpretation. In addition to his other concerns, Gajdusek was highly interested in the occurrence of ritual homosexuality, which he documented among the Anga peoples and claimed to have found in highland New Guinea among the Mulia (ibid. :11). If anything, Gajdusek appears overly disposed to infer the existence of homosexual activity, and his journal entries reflect great attention to the possibility of erotic attraction among boys and men. Among Asmat, however, he makes no mention of homosexual belief or ritual practice. Indeed, there is none of the overt, and little of the clandestine sex play of a homosexual sort here among the naked men and boys, so prevalent among the Kukukuku [Anga]. They rarely show even the slightest erection in public . . . Although their talk and everyday speech is filled with references to the penis and testes, and these organs are handled, pulled, and at times waved in public (as by some men when our ship approaches shore), there is little or no overt sexual content in all this, and lascivious, licentious, or sexually arousing behavior is very rare. When we enter houses suddenly at night, boys and men are sleeping far apart, and only when really cold do they sleep together in close contact, rolled up and covered in the pandanus frond mats. (ibid. :46)
As for ritual homosexuality, Gajdusek (ibid. :49f.) notes the pelvic thrust in lines of dancing boys and speculates without evidence that it might under some circumstances result in ritual masturbatory ejaculation. But the dance was said to be Mimikan, that is, it was of an ethnic tradition that did not include ritual homosexuality (Herdt 1984a:30). Especially in the 1970s and 1980s, mission presence had a much stronger impact in suppressing Asmat sexual customs. This influence was evident during the course of Schneebaum's (1988:169) investigation concerning the ritual significance of omu, an artifact distinctive to northwestern Asmat. Omu were cylindrical wood carvings three meters long sculpted with a human body at one end and aflaccidpenis and testicles toward the other (Schneebaum 1985:104f.; Konrad etal. 1981:80, 174). Schneebaum (1988:169) was told that "the omu are carved and painted and are brought into the dze [northwest Asmat longhouse] with dancing and drumming. The omu are hidden from the women and children. The omu are tied to a beam and the men climb up. The young men and the boys are on top of the beam, dancing and joking. They stick their fingers in each other's asses and take their own penises in their hands." The men around Paiir [the headman narrating] were gesturing with their fingers and laughing and slapping their thighs. They got up and humped their hips and held onto their crotches as if having sexual intercourse with one another. Suddenly, the noise, the gestures and movements, stopped. There was only silence until someone whispered, "Guru Mateus! Guru!" Mateus, the teacher of catechism, had returned with taro roots from his garden upstream. The men would not talk again, Guru Mateus had cast his deadening influence over them all. Schneebaum's (ibid. :168) account of the omu from a different suggests it was a defloration and marriage rite:
informant
"Yes, I saw an omu feast in Pupis one time. It was many years ago, when I was young. Pupis was then on the River Djinim. The dze, the men's house, was long, very long. It was in the forest . . . [The men caught a large snake, gutted it, and wrapped the intestines and
232
Appendix
put them in the rafters. Several omu were placed on one side of the longhouse opposite the men. Sago grubs were gathered in a festive spirit by men and women, and the women danced. Grubs were given to the carvers of the omu, who divided them up "among their families." Then,] the omu were tied to a beam of the dze from the far end and the men danced all night. A section of the roof was taken off. A young girl came into the dze from the far end and climbed onto the central beam. A young fellow came from the other end, also on the beam. In the middle, where the omu were, they met and the young fellow began to stab at her anus with his finger. Then all the men jumped up and stabbed her in the ass. They were all shouting and screaming. The young man stabbed hisfingerinto her vagina and blood squirted out. Everyone stopped dancing. The boy and the girl were married. The boy went outside to the hole in the ground and washed himself there. All the men, women, and children, washed themselves in the water . . . They ate the worms and they ate sago, wild pig, and the shoots of the sago palm."
As a female analogue, collective female homoerotic joking and "poking" (without indication of sexual liaison) were prominent in some Asmat ritual feasting dances (Schneebaum 1980:73). Given this evidence, the question of ritualized homosexuality in the omu and in the imu-mu remains equivocal. Was ritual homosexuality involved, or did Asmat practices entail nonorgasmic homoerotic horseplay, as occurred among the Iatmul (Bateson 1936 [1958]), ritual masturbation of initiates on the center ridgepole of the initiation house, as occurred among the Bimin-Kuskusmin (Poole 1981:160nl9), serial heterosexual intercourse with a young bride, as among the Awa (Newman and Boyd 1982:281) and Banaro (Thurnwald 1916:260-270), or ritual heterosexuality associated with exclusion of other women from the cult house, as among the Tor (Oosterwal 1961, 1967)? None of these other societies practiced ritualized homosexuality. There is little or no evidence of central Asmat life-force beliefs associated with insemination and there is no concrete evidence of age-graded homosexuality in myth, ritual, or behavioral custom. This negative evidence does not preclude the possibility of prescriptive ritual homosexuality in the central Asmat imu or in the northwestern Asmat omu rite but it does make the slim evidence that might be used to support such an interpretation equivocal. Given the large central Asmat population and the substantial number of open-minded Dutch and American researchers who went there at relatively early periods of culture contact, one would expect that if ritual homosexuality had existed, it would have been documented much more thoroughly. The documentation of ritual homosexuality by similar groups of Westerners among non-Asmat groups such as the Jaquai, Kolopom, and Marind - groups that were subject to government influence and missionization much earlier than the Asmat - underscores the absence of similar documentation among central Asmat. Casuarina Coast Asmat To the southeast, among Casuarina coast Asmat, there is evidence from several sources of distinctive sexual customs that include a "sucking ceremony" (Trenkenschuh 1982d:58): Several reports are made of a submission ritual which is almost unique in this [Casuarina] area. This is the ritual sucking of the penis. When a village has offended another village
Appendix
233
reparation must be made to prevent bloodshed. One way is for the chiefs to come to the chiefs of the offended village and suck their penis [sic] to indicate submission. There seems to be no homosexual intention or even erotic behavior involved in this action. This account compares well with Schneebaum's (1988:188-190) fuller and more personal description: They took my arms and legs and held me horizontally at waist level, grunting all the time, "Uh! Uh! Uh!" There were fourteen, all older men, thirty-five or more. Some were naked; others, like myself, wore shorts. They carried me slowly to one end of the long room, turned and carried me to the other end, then back to the central fireplace . . . The man at my right shoulder leaned down and sucked my nose. The grunting continued. The man moved to suck my chin, my earlobes, my fingers one by one. He sucked my nipples, opened my pants and sucked my penis, then sucked on each of my ten toes. My body was not held rigidly, but seemed to be levitating slowly up and down. By the time thefirstman had passed my head and was at my nipples, the man next to him was leaning over to suck my nose. A third man started, then a fourth, until all fourteen had sucked on all extensions of my body. It was not an erotic experience. Although the men were sucking my penis, I had no erection; my penis and nipples were quiescent. I found myself involved in being the object of a ritual whose purpose was unknown to me. Upon later inquiry, Schneebaum's main Casaurina Asmat informant states: "Mbi urum, it is called . . . We have it when we are trying to make peace in the village, when we want nothing to disturb the life here. When we suck on your chin and nose and penis and fingers, we take in some of your spirit with the waters of your body. This makes us strong and calms the spirits of the dead. It is like when a man dies . . . we suck on his penis, too, and we keep something of him inside ourselves, inside the village. We want to get rid of his spirit as quickly as possible before it can do us harm. The relatives put bands of rattan on their arms, on their shoulders, on their legs. The men and the women are together. Drums are beaten from morning until evening. The women are wearing hats so they cannot see what is happening and be ashamed. The men open the women's skirts and suck their vaginas. The women suck the men's penes, too, absorbing the healthy essence that will drive away all evil. Those who are sucked are carried around the house to the sound of grunting, "Uh! Uh! Uh!, a sound we call omen. In the morning all the bad spirits are gone." In short, the mbi urum rite was used by Casuarina coast Asmat to simultaneously draw life-power from and appease angry or potentially angry living persons (such as enemy chiefs or outsiders) or the dead, which were greatly feared by Asmat. The practice of homosexual sucking parallels the fertility beliefs associated with Asmat ritual heterosexuality on occasions of disturbance such as bad thunderstorms, early contact with whites, widespread sickness, monsoon change, or, as mentioned earlier, impending millenarian transformation (Zegwaard and Boelaars 1982:22). Schneebaum's account gives the first evidence for Asmat that homosexual penile contact was thought to have a significant spiritual effect through absorption of life-power. The sucking ritual and Schneebaum's additional evidence described below are distinctive to the Casuarina Asmat; by all accounts, they did not pertain to the central Asmat further north. According to Schneebaum, Casuarina coast Asmat have a regularized homosexual relationship, called mbai, that is analogous to their papisj wife-exchange
234
Appendix
relationship in adulthood. The highly personal nature of some sections of Schneebaum's account - including subsequent revelation of his own homosexual involvement with his principal Casuarina Asmat informant - makes it necessary to treat his information with special caution. It should also be noted, however, that Schneebaum shows awareness of pertinent issues and literature in the anthropological study of New Guinea homosexuality, that his published work includes significant contributions to Asmat ethnography - including matters of spiritual belief and extensive documentation and curation of Asmat art (e.g., Schneebaum 1980, 1985, 1990; Konrad, Konrad, and Schneebaum 1981), and that he has had many years of travel and living experience over a large range of Asmat territory. His 1988 account should be examined critically but certainly not dismissed out of hand. Schneebaum (1988:193f.) cites his main informant, Akatpitsjin, as follows: "Having a mbai is like having apapisj partner, an exchange partner. We all have our mbai here. Pastor has stopped us from papisj, from exchanging wives, but we still have our mbai. He does not know this . . . Before, in the past, two mbai exchanged wives at mask feasts and at sago worm feasts and when there was warfare, or when there was so much thunder we were all frightened. But even though there is no longer papisj we still have our mbai." "Mbai choose one another and are close, like brothers, but even closer. When mbai are children they play together and touch each other's penis and examine their entire bodies. They have erections together and when they are old enough they masturbate one another, they ypit a minau tamen emefafarimis, they peel back one another's penis. They do this any time, any place, whenever they feel like it. Maybe they are outfishingor they are in the forest together; maybe there is no one else in the house and they are alone. "Sometimes an older man will play with the penis of a young boy; sometimes a young boy will play with the penis of an older man. But it is the mbai who have sexual intercourse together here. Sometimes there is tamen mbe mbakumna, when a man sucks the penis of another man, his mbai. Sometimes a man enters the ass of his friend, tamen mbai sumapun, or sometimes we might say feper mbimar, for the same thing. "We know it is different with the Marind. There are no mbai. There are no young men who have sexual intercourse together. There it is always a young boy with an older man. The boy is given to his mother's brother, who teaches him to cut down sago trees, to fish, and to go to war, and is his sexual partner at night. It is not like here at all. The Marind believe that only an older man may enter the ass of the young. This is so that the sperm will make the boy grow more quickly into a great warrior. There is no sucking of the penis. It is wrong for them to do this, they say." The extent of mbai sexual bonding and jealousy is then elaborated by Akatpitsjin: "Mbai . . . are always friends and always help one another when there is trouble. They are always friends no matter what happens. They remain mbai all their lives, until one of them dies. Sometimes one is jealous because his mbai has been with another man. He is not jealous when he goes with a woman who is not his wife, only when he is with another man. It is all right to play with another man. He may suck his penis or even enter his ass; that is all right. But he may not have an orgasm. Then, his mbai is very angry." At each of Akatpitsjin's statements, the others nodded their heads in agreement or
Appendix
235
added slightly different versions of what he was saying. There was no embarrassment or holding back. The only problem was in knowing what questions to ask. (ibid. :195)
The most pronounced social dimension of the mbai relationship appears to be its reciprocity and the lack of age-grade or semen-giving asymmetry between partners. This aspect is emphasized by Akatpitsjin: "Yes, Tombias," Akatpitsjin said in answer to a specific question. "There must be balance. There must always be balance between mbai. There is no other way. When one mbai sucks the penis of his friend, the two may not part until the friend turns around and sucks his penis. If one enters the ass of another, the other must turn around and enter his ass. Mbai must always give back what they take. When I bring fish to the house of Kayet, my mbai, he will bring me sago the next time he goes into the jungle. When I bring him sago, he will later bring me fish or sago worms. When I am angry at someone in Pirimapun, Kayet must come with me to fight him. When Kayet has a fight, I must help him. We must share what we have. Everything must remain in balance."
The mbai sexual relationship appears to have had an important cosmological and ritual as well as emotional significance: A constant flow of semen was obligatory in times of strife to ward off dangers that threatened the cosmos and was a requisite in equalizing the powers of the ancestors with that of their living relations. Akatpitsjin suggested that equilibrium was necessary not only between men, but between men and women as well, for it was the vagina that acted as a counterbalance to the penis. (ibid.:195i.)
Among Casuarina coast Asmat, the mbai relationship is clearly a homosexual parallel of the heterosexual papisj relationship. But it is possible that historical change has increased the emphasis on homosexual reciprocity or increased the variety of sexual practices to include both oral and anal homosexual intercourse. The spontaneous linkage between the importance of the mbai relationship and the demise of the papisj in Akatpitsjin's account could be interpreted as suggesting that the former increased in importance as the latter diminished. If the relationship between male papisj partners had been primarily heterosexual in adulthood but had included a legacy of casual homosexuality in adolescence, the eradication of papisj by missionaries may have led to an increase in less publicly visible means of continuing semen-exchange among the married men so-linked, that is, through homosexual liaisons. In this case, the ritualization of homosexuality as a response to sociocultural and cosmological change could have been induced unwittingly by the missionaries themselves. Whatever its origin, homosexuality among Casuarina coast Asmat, which co-occurred with significant bridewealth in marriage (Trenkenschuh 1982b:3If.), contravenes Lindenbaum's (1984) assessment that homosexuality naturally gives way to "post-homosexual" modes of organization as direct reciprocity in heterosexual exchange is supplanted by bridewealth transactions. Moreover, the presence of beliefs and ritual practices - such as ceremonial penis-sucking and homosexual semen-exchange in times of crisis - attests to the fertility significance of Casuarina Asmat homosexuality. It is difficult to conjecture that Casuarina Asmat in the colonial context totally redirected not
236
Appendix
only their adult object choice in sexual exchange relations but their corresponding fertility beliefs as well. Judging from Schneebaum's evidence, Casuarina male homosexuality (a) lacked asymmetrical insemination but involved sexual reciprocity persisting into adulthood between age-mates; (b) took place in partnerships that were initiated by personal preference and jealously guarded;(c) involved a variety of homosexual techniques, both anal and oral; and (d) reflected spiritual beliefs in the importance of exchanging bodily fluids through homosexual intercourse or ceremonial penis-sucking during times of crisis or cosmological transition. This last point suggests that Casuarina Asmat homosexuality was spiritually and ritually important and was related to beliefs concerning the cosmological importance of semen exchange, notwithstanding its casual and optional occurrence on other occasions. It appears likely that ritualized homosexuality was present in some measure among Casuarina Asmat prior to missionization. Whether it was practiced precolonially more or less frequently than at present remains uncertain. Central Asmat revisited
Given that, as Trenkenschuh (1982d:59) puts it, "contact [among Casuarina coast Asmat] is almost ten years younger than in central Asmat," it may be asked if their distinctive pattern of homosexuality previously characterized the much more populous Asmat groups to their northwest. Akatpitsjin explicitly limited his comments to the Casuarina coast and states that the practices he describes extend to Jow, the northernmost major Casuarina Asmat village, but that he has no knowledge of them beyond that point (Schneebaum 1988:197). Schneebaum concurs, noting a regional gradient of decreasing homosexual emphasis as one moves northwest from the southern Asmat (bordering the Jaquai, where such customs were more pronounced) to the Mimika or Kamoro area, where homosexual customs were definitely absent (Pouwer 1955; Herdt 1984a:30). Schneebaum (1988:87) concludes: It was therefore to be expected that, in the south [Casuarina Asmat], there would be considerable sexual activity among men, and a diminution of such contact as one moved north and west toward Mimika. This was, in fact, precisely the information that came to me as I traveled on. This conclusion seems sound, the more so because Schneebaum would appear to have no motive to interpretively restrict the geographical extent of Asmat ritual homosexuality. The pattern suggested by Schneebaum is strongly concurred with by Eyde, who is our best early documentary source on homosexuality among the populous central Asmat (1967:206). On the basis of his extendedfieldwork,he states of the Casuarina Asmat sexual practices that were documented by Schneebaum, "They may be true for the Casuarine Coast, but I am certain don't apply to AmanNamkey nor, I think, to other Central Asmat Groups" (Eyde p.c. 1989). Conclusions
Though subject to a host of historical and definitional questions, present evidence suggests that a distinctive variant of ritualized homosexuality has been present
Appendix
237
among the Casuarina coast Asmat but that ritualized homosexuality is unattested and was likely absent among the more populous central Asmat. Further northwest, homosexuality was absent in the Kamoro region. Among the Casuarina coast Asmat, male homosexuality was both casual and ritualized; in the latter instance, it was believed to produce therapeutic cosmological effects under conditions of stress or ritual celebration. Casuarina Asmat male homosexuality (a) entailed reciprocal sexual exchange between age-mates into adulthood, (b) occurred through personal preference rather than by kinship or senior/junior prescription, (c) was ritually mandated in ways that clearly paralleled the cultural fertility of ritualized heterosexuality; and (d) included both anal and oral means of reaching orgasm. In several of these respects, Casuarina coast Asmat men explicitly contrasted their own homosexual practices to those of the Marind to their south. In the populous central Asmat area, available evidence suggests that homosexuality was limited to casual reciprocal liaisons among adolescents. While certainly subject to alternative opinion, these conclusions appear most consistent with the overall evidence and the recent assessments of Schneebaum and Eyde as well as the early accounts of Zegwaard, Eyde, and Gajdusek. All of these persons lived among Asmat during an early period of their culture contact history with Westerners. Zegwaard and Eyde had extensive experience in Asmat and appear to have had no interest in downplaying the existence of homosexuality, and Schneebaum and Gajdusek appear to have had special interest in documenting homosexual patterns. The Crosier Missions' tolerance of homosexual orientation is evident in their continuing affiliation with Schneebaum in curating Asmat art and their sending out information (along with their other publication notices) advertising the existence of his recent book. To avoid underrating the possibility of culture change and mission impact, however, it would be most conservative for purposes of overall south New Guinea population estimates to simply not register central Asmat as either practicing or not practicing ritualized homosexuality, noting them rather as a likely negative but ultimately uncertain case (see table 1, chapter 1). The Casuarina Asmat, by contrast, may be considered a population among whom ritualized homosexuality was present in a distinctive form. Collectively, the Asmat evidence illustrates that the distribution of Melanesian homosexual practices can be complex within language families. More generally, homosexuality in precolonial New Guinea may not be a unitary custom or causal index of other customs so much as a set of separable features which may or may not include ritualization, asymmetrical insemination of youths by their elders, male initiation, prescriptive as opposed to optional or casual sexual relations, and linkage with male growth-substance beliefs. These features do not necessarily co-vary as a cluster, and they do not necessarily rise or fall as a cluster over time. Asmat patterns of sexual belief and practice were unlikely to have been static. They exhibited an intriguing range of variation both in the precolonial era and under conditions of colonial mission and government influence.
Notes
1 Theoretical and ethnographic context 1. See, for instance, Braudel 1973, 1980a,b; Bloch 1967; and Le Roy Ladurie 1987. Burke (1990) provides an effective overview of the French Annales tradition. 2. The tension between Marxism and postmodernism is evident in recent works such as Taussig 1987; Lavie 1990; Gudeman and Rivera 1990; R. Rosaldo 1989; Marcus and Fischer 1986; Clifford and Marcus 1986; Fischer and Abedi 1990; Tyler 1990. 3. For general consideration of this issue, see Lyotard 1984; Jameson 1991; Poster 1990; cf. McGowan 1991. 4. For example, Wallerstein 1974, 1979, 1980, 1989, 1991; Wolf 1982; Smith 1976; Skinner 1985; contrast Asad 1982. 5. Concerning Giddens' theoretical scheme, see also Held and Thompson 1989; Bryant and Jary 1991; Clark, Modgil, and Modgil 1990. 6. For an exception that rather proves the rule, see Giddens 1985; compare critiques of Giddens' consideration of space by Gregory 1989 and particularly Urryl991. 7. See in the Pacific context Thomas 1990a; Dening 1988; and more generally, deCerteau 1988 [1975]. 8. This criticism may be vitiated by some of Bourdieu's recent work on the origin of the modern intellectual field (1988b, 1990c, 1991b, see also Harker et al. 1990:220-222). It does appear, however, that Bourdieu favors a certain degree of hegemonic voice in his own scholasticism (1990b:389, 1990c:ch.7; cf. Marcus 1990). 9. These issues form the dominant emphases of the major highlands monographs, e.g., by Meggitt 1965, 1974, 1977; A. Strathern 1971, 1972; Brookfield and Brown 1963; P. Brown 1972,1978; Reay 1959; Glasse 1968; Rappaport 1984 [1968]; Ploeg 1969; Pospisil 1958, 1963; Salisbury 1962; Berndt 1962; Heider 1970; M. Strathern 1972; Feil 1984; and Lederman 1986; see also Glasse and Meggitt 1969; Berndt and Lawrence 1971. These emphases mark a trend rather than an absolute characterization; different volumes could be adduced as counterexamples (e.g., Read 1965), and alternative emphases are especially evident in journal articles as opposed to primary monographs. It remains striking, however, that a volume such as Strauss' (1990), which views Mt. Hagen
Notes to pages 7-18
239
peoples through a primarily symbolic and experiential perspective, is so importantly at odds with the tone of the mainstream monographs for core highlands areas in the 1960s and 1970s (contrast also M. Strathern 1988). This is perhaps a contributing reason why Strauss' work languished unpublished and untranslated for so long (see Sturzenhofecker 1990). 10. This emphasis is reflected in major south coast works by Landtman 1917, 1927; Wirz 1922-1925, 1928; van Baal 1934, 1966; Williams 1924, 1940; Riley 1925; Holmes 1924; and Zegwaard 1959. 11. See Adam 1987; Greenberg 1988:ch.ll; Seidman 1989, 1991:Ch.6. 12. For example, Sedgwick 1990; Butler 1990; Minh-ha 1990; see Foucault 1980a,b. 13. For example, Ortner 1989; Sahlins 1981, 1990; Hefner 1990; cf. C. Smith 1984. 14. Ortner's (1990a) important recent paper addresses this issue by subsuming structural features into the Gramscian concept of hegemony. In so doing, she mediates the tension between more static cultural-symbolic conceptualizations and more dialectical Marxist ones. Since Gramscian hegemonies mask social inequality, they are themselves driven by the potential of alternative critical ideologies (see recent discussion by Comaroff and Comaroff [1991:19-27]). Ortner analyzes this potential in her penetrating discussion of ideological "loose strands" and "counterhegemonies" (1990a:46). Nevertheless, there remains a danger that "hegemony" as a conceptual label may too easily partake of its own substance and collapse or render into the background the internal dialectic that gives rise to it. This problem is only latent in analysis of individual cases, but it comes increasingly to the fore as a wider range of cases is considered and comparison is attempted. 15. Bourdieu's (1990a: 123) designation of "constructivist structuralism" is in some respects homologous to Giddens' theory of structuration, which draws on a grammatically informed notion of rule-governed structural generation (1984:16-37). The status of "rule" and the objectivity of "structure" remain ontologically murky in both cases, blurring social practice and pure form. 16. A highly selective overture can be found in Knauft (1990a); see also Carrier (in press). 17. For example, Codrington 1891; Haddon 1901, 1901-1935; Seligmann 1910; Lewis 1932. 18. Missionary ethnography has been important in Melanesian anthropology since its inception (e.g., Codrington 1891) and has held a particularly prominent place in Dutch, French, and German ethnography of Melanesia (e.g., Leenhardt 1930, 1947; Dupeyrat 1954; Vicedom and Tischner 1943^8; Strauss 1990; Held 1957; Oosterwal 1961; Kamma 1972; cf. also contributions by English-speaking missionaries, e.g., Brown 1910; Hopkins 1928; Bromilow 1929; Ivens 1927, 1930). Of special interest for south coast New Guinea is the work of Dutch missionaries Boelaars (1981), Zegwaard (1959; Zegwaard and Boelaars 1982), Verschueren (van Baal 1966, 1982), and, in an earlier era, James Chalmers (1887, 1895, 1903a,b); see also Riley (1925) and Holmes (1924). 19. For example, Fison 1872-1873; Miklouho-Maclay 1874, 1881; Moresby
240
Notes to pages 18-23
1876b; Inglis 1872; Macdonald 1878; Markham 1873; Steel 1880; Palmer 1871; Paton 1907; R. Paton 1913; see discussion in Knauft 1990a:253f., 258f. 20.1 thank Robert Welsch for bringing this point to my attention. 21. Note may be taken of Malinowski's highly ambivalent relationship with Papua's Lieutenant-Governor, Hubert Murray (West 1968:ch.lO). 22. Malinowski championed a British colonial policy of indirect rule particularly in Africa, and he institutionally supported its combination with anthropology through the International African Institute (Feuchtwang 1973; cf. Mucha 1988:154-156). In partial tension with this stance, however, he also vigorously defended indigenous rights against colonial repression (James 1973). 23. See Leenhardt 1930, 1932, 1937, 1947; Guiart 1956, 1958, 1963a,b, 1966, 1983. The present characterization of French Melanesia is quite cursory, as the area is geographically distant from New Guinea. Also crucial but here left in the background is the important interface between ethnographic knowledge and colonial administration, missionization, and economic exploitation in Vanuatu [New Hebrides] and Fiji. See particularly Harrisson 1937; Macnaught 1982; Thomas 1989b, 1990b; Clammer 1973. 24. Illustrative monographs of the period, largely from insular and coastal Melanesia, include Jenness and Ballantyne 1920; Humphreys 1926; Armstrong 1928; Williams 1930; Blackwood 1935; Fortune 1932; Deacon 1934; Layard 1942; Ivens 1927, 1930; Fox 1925; Hopkins 1928; Williamson 1912; Saville 1926; see also Kaberry 1941a,b; H. Hogbin 1951; Oliver 1955; Belshaw 1957. 25. In much of coastal Melanesia, a relative decline of interest in religion during this period was accompanied by the perception that as the main cult forms were altered or eradicated, there was little of Melanesian religion left to document. A marked exception was the strong interest in cargo cults, which posed a significant threat to colonial administration in selected parts of Melanesia in the pre- as well as post World War Two eras (see overviews in Worsley 1968; Bodrogi 1951; Steinbauer 1979; Knauft 1978; see prominent case studies by Williams 1923a; Lawrence 1964; Burridge 1960; Schwartz 1962; Kamma 1972; Laracy 1983; Keesing 1980; cf. McDowell 1988). Much of the pre-World War Two primary information on cargo cults is in the form of selected articles by missionaries, officials, and ethnographers. For an interesting compendium concerning Melanesian religions in their changing guises, see Herdt and Stephen 1989; Herdt (ed.) 1982; Trompf 1991; cf. Lawrence and Meggitt 1965. 26. Works on highland New Guinea are compiled in Hays' (1976) comprehensive bibliography. 27. These focal interests of core highlands ethnography are consistently evident in the major monographs of the region listed above in note no. 9. 28. Concerning critiques of descent group theory in Melanesian context, see Barnes 1962, 1967; de Lepervanche 1967-68; Langness 1964; Scheffler 1966; Kelly 1977; cf. M. Strathern 1990. Concerning critiques of cultural materialism, see M. McArthur 1974; Sillitoe 1977; Kelly 1968; Friedman 1974; Bergmann 1975. 29. Recent volumes on these areas of Melanesia include Wagner 1986; Munn 1986; Battaglia 1990; Pomponio 1992; Damon 1990; Damon and Wagner 1989; Clay 1986; Young 1983, 1988; Leach and Leach 1983; Kahn 1986; Carrier and
Notes to pages 25-34
241
Carrier 1989, 1991; Lutkehaus et al. 1990; Harrison 1990; Huber 1988; Gesch 1985; Errington and Gewertz 1987; Gewertz 1983; Gewertz and Errington 1991; Keesing 1982; Watson-Gegeo and White 1990; White and Lindstrom 1989; Lindstrom 1990. 2 Historical background and regional configuration 1. One of the few exceptions was Mawatta, at the westernmost edge of Kiwai extension, where pearling and trading boats found a convenient landing place and traded with the local population for fresh food and water as early as the 1860s (see Haddon 1901:112; Milman 1888,1889). 2. See early accounts in Strachan 1888; Bevan 1890; McFarlane 1888; D'Albertis 1880; Chalmers 1895; see van Baal etal. 1984:43f. for Dutch references. See also Beaver 1920; Hope 1979. 3. See ethnographic data on south coast headhunting in Williams 1924:ch.9, 1936:ch.l5; Beaver 1920:chs.6-9; Landtman 1927:ch.9; Haddon 1891, 1923; Wirz 1933; van Baal 1966:ch.l2; van der Kroef 1952; Serpenti 1968; Zegwaard 1959; see overview in Knauft 1990a:281-285. 4. Compare Docker 1970; Corris 1968, 1973; Scarr 1967; S. Firth 1982. One of the very few examples of nineteenth-century labor recruitment in this region occurred among selected Kiwai settlements in the early 1890s to obtain men for the early Papuan Constabulary (Beaver 1920:34; BNG 1890-1891:46). 5. Chalmers' compatriot and predecessor, the Reverend Samuel McFarlane, was confined mostly to the Torres Strait and its islands to the north lying off the south New Guinea coast (McFarlane 1888). 6. See D'Albertis 1880; Jukes 1847; Bevan 1890; see Hope 1979:ch.l; Beaver 1920:ch.3; Murray 1912:ch.3. 7. See Haddon 1901,1901-1935; Quiggin 1942:ch.4; Moore 1984. 8. Haddon introduced the work of Williams 1936, Beaver 1920, Holmes 1924, and also Williamson 1912, Armstrong 1928, and Beardmore 1890. 9. Haddon helped edit and promulgate the early versions of Notes and Queries. Not surprisingly, the first published account for south New Guinea in The Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute is apparently the remarks of a pearlsheller, Edward Beardmore, made in response to a list of Frazer's "Ethnographic Questions" left with him by Haddon in 1888. Beardmore's responses were eagerly published by Haddon along with his own commentary in JRAFs 1890 volume (see discussion in Knauft 1990b: 193-197). 10. Van Baal (1966:958-959) reveals at the conclusion of Dema: Apart from all other motivations, I began this work because I was aware of a debt, somehow feeling guilty of many things, most of which I cannot help and nobody can help, but things for which destiny made me responsible. Twice I have been vested with authority over them. I have tried to pay my debt, calling up the image of the past.
11. Van Baal does maintain an awareness of structural concerns, following in the tradition of the Leiden school (de Josselin de Jong 1960, 1972). Nevertheless, he is highly constrained by the ethnographic data available, both its uneven quality and its inattention to political and economic matters. His structural perspective in Dema is largely limited to establishing an organizational framework for the
242
Notes to pages 34-39
documentation of ethnographic fact and showing the comparative similarity of various rites and myths. 12. See Souter 1963:ch.lO; Serpenti 1977:8-9; Militaire Exploratie 1920; Rawling 1913; Wollaston 1912; Alder 1922; Trenkenschuh 1982a; cf. Hastings 1968,1982; see further references in van Baal etal. 1984:44-54. 13. See Zegwaard 1953, 1954, 1959, 1978, 1982; Zegwaard and Boelaars 1982 [1954]; see also Renselaar and Mellema 1956; van Kampen 1956. 14. See Schneebaum 1985, 1990; Konrad etal. 1981; Rockefeller and Gerbrands 1967; Hoggebrugge and Kooijman 1977. See additional references for Asmat in van Baal et ai 1984:131-140. 15. See reanalysis by Cochrane 1970:chs.l-4; also Ryan 1969. 16. See particularly Ryan 1965, 1969; Morauta and Ryan 1982; Moraes-Gorecki 1983; G. Hogbin 1964; H. Brown 1957,1973,1986. 17. Compare for the neighboring Gogodala, Crawford (1981). 18. It might be tempting to include the Jaquai in a comparative regional analysis, but Boelaars' monograph is highly uneven in coverage and deals with an inland population that migrated south and never reached the coast (Boelaars 1981:3). Further, Boelaars' primary responsibilities as a missionary and the retrospective nature of his information, based on informants' stories, color his account, albeit quite intriguingly. Apart from reports by government officers, Gogodala indigenous customs are known almost entirely through the observations of the intrepid but untrained and sometimes speculative Wirz (1934a), whose report remains as yet untranslated from the German (cf. Lyons 1926; Haddon 1916; Beaver 1914, 1920:chs. 15-16). The frustrations of sifting this material into a coherent view of indigenous Gogodala custom and belief are evident in various text sections of Crawford's (1981) photographic portrayal. An effective thumbnail sketch of the Gogodala has been provided by Hays (1991a). 19. Unpublished dissertations have been completed on the Boazi (Busse 1987, see 1991), the Kamula (Wood 1982; cf. 1987), and the Yonggom (Kirsch 1991). 20. For coastal areas, see primary ethnographic information on ritual homosexuality in Williams (1936); van Baal (1966, 1984); Serpenti (1977, 1984); cf. Knauft (1990b); concerning adjacent areas see Boelaars (1981); Wood (1982), and Busse (1987). Ritual homosexuality in the Strickland-Bosavi area has been documented by Kelly (1976), Knauft (1986, 1987a,b), Cantrell (n.d.), Ernst (1991), S0rum (1984), and Schieffelin (1976). The Strickland-Bosavi area has been subject to intense ethnographic research from the late 1960s to the early 1980s - see monographs published by Kelly (1977), E. Schieffelin (1976), Feld (1982), Knauft (1985a), B. Schieffelin (1990), Shaw (1990), and Dwyer (1989), and important dissertations by Ernst (1984), van Beek (1987), S0rum (1989), and Eileen Cantrell (in process, n.d.). See also Schieffelin and Crittenden (1991). For a complete bibliography of the Strickland-Bosavi areas, see Hays (n.d.). 21. The name Purari is geographically associated with the people of the like-named river and has been adopted both by Williams (1924) and by Wurm and Hattori (1981) in their designation of the Purari language family. "Namau" has recently been suggested as an ethnic designation of these people (J. Weiner
Notes to pages 39-56
243
1988b; Gratton 1991). However, this name has a pejorative colonial origin, meaning literally "deaf, inattentive, or stupid." An interpreter suggests that by some misunderstanding the name had its origin in the despair of an early missionary, who,findingthe natives turned a deaf ear to his teaching, dubbed them all "Namau" (Williams 1924:4).
I have retained "Purari" as a more value-neutral term as well as for its familiarity and preponderance in the ethnographic literature. 22. The Morehead area of the Trans-Fly that was the central focus of Williams' research was also subject to an important restudy in doctoral fieldworkby Ayres (1983) and is presently taken as the focal point of the Trans-Fly language-culture region. The three other language families in the Trans-Fly pose important but insufficiently documented variants; see selective work by Ohtsuka (1977a,b, 1983) on ecology in the Oriomo Plateau area; van Baal's (1982) compilation of Verschueren's information on the Yei-nan; and an early general overview of the Trans-Fly area by Beaver (1920:chs.6-9). 23. These were absent among Elema, as was headhunting. 3 Sexuality in the regional analysis of south New Guinea 1. Schiefenhovel (1990:411) has also noted the absence of ritual homosexuality along the Papuan Gulf coast. 2. The Elema apparently welcomed but did not themselves give women for widespread heterosexual activity (Williams 1940:52n). 3. Female homosexuality is reported among the Kamula to the north of the coastal area (Wood 1982). Among the Jaquai, just beyond the purview of the present analysis, Boelaars (1981:33) states that "homosexuality . . . is not uncommon among both sexes" but gives no further details. 4. Concerning homosexual partnerships on Kolopom Island, Serpenti (1984:305) writes: I even had the impression that many an adoptive relationship originated, in fact, not so much from an adoptive agreement with the boy's father as from casual erotic experiences with the bachelor's house. In practice, the cross-cousin relationship is extended to such a degree that everyone who is not classified as a real or classificatory brother can be a homosexual partner in such relationships.
5. These works include Toward an Anthropology of Women (Reiter 1975); Women, Culture, and Society (Rosaldo and Lamphere 1974); Sisters and Wives (Sacks 1979); Sexual Stratification (Schlegel 1977); Female Power and Male Dominance (Sanday 1981); Sexual Meanings: The Cultural Construction of Gender and Sexuality (Ortner and Whitehead 1981); Women and Men: An Anthropologist's View (Friedl 1975); Women's Role in Economic Development (Boserup 1970); and The Status of Women in Preindustrial Societies (Whyte 1978). The same period saw noteworthy books emerge about women and gender relations in New Guinea, e.g., Women in Between (M. Strathern 1972); Women of Value, Men of Renown (A. Weiner 1976), and Man and Woman in the New Guinea Highlands (Brown and Buchbinder 1976); see also Josephides 1985; Sexton 1986. It goes almost without saying that feminism and post-feminism
244
Notes to pages 56-61
have developed much further in 1980s and 1990s anthropology. 6. See Herdt 1980, 1981, 1982, 1984a,b, (ed.) 1984, 1987a,b, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992; Herdt and Davidson 1988; Herdt and Stoller 1990; Stoller and Herdt 1985a,b. 7. Whitehead (1985) argues that despite its attempts, Herdt's 1984 volume fails fundamentally to escape from damaging psychiatric biases (see also Stoller and Herdt [1985b: 128], who suggest that "for all the spectacular differences, Sambia boys and those of our culture who will be heterosexual proceed along a similar Oedipal path"). For a critical discussion of the pros and cons of a psychodynamic perspective on Melanesian homosexuality, see Knauft (1987b). 8. Herdt (1991:609) suggests that "ritual homosexuality" - once selected as a trope to reveal the unknown and to represent the unspeakable - has caught on; indeed it threatens to insinuate itself (as Devereux's "institutionalized homosexuality" once did) as canonical. But why privilege the "ritual" aspect of these age-graded homoerotic relationships? . . . These are not rhetorical questions for me: I assume that each descriptor conveys cultural and psychological images to the audience that make a difference in understanding the text.
Such awareness notwithstanding, Herdt in the same work favors Feil's and Lindenbaum's concept of "homosexual societies" within Melanesia, as quoted further above (ibid. :606). 4 The analytic legacy of homosexual emphasis 1. Kamoro or Mimika practiced sister-exchange but not ritualized homosexuality (Pouwer 1991:207; Herdt 1984a:30). Kiwai and central Asmat both practiced versions of sister-exchange without exhibiting a documentable pattern of ritualized homosexuality (see Appendix and Knauft 1990b). Etoro and Bedamini practiced ritual homosexuality without same-generation sisterexchange being dominant (Kelly 1976, 1977; S0rum 1984, 1989). The Marind case is curious; the presence of sister-exchange in the core coastal area was not reported either as an empirical trend or as a cultural preference by Wirz or any of the many other observers who reported on Marind customs during the first half of the twentieth century. Van Baal (1966:121-130) found a statistical tendency toward sister-exchange for Marind when analyzing genealogical data pursuant to suggestions made in the Dutch depopulation report (South Pacific Commission 1955). This finding gives rise to larger questions. What percentage of exchange marriages must occur to constitute a "sister-exchange society"? If cultural preference is the guiding criterion, how strong does the sisterexchange preference have to be relative to alternative marriage rules and preferences also found in these societies? Use of "sister-exchange" as a societal characteristic ultimately requires an operational definition of the term; when used in a loose fashion, it can be selectively configured to include or exclude particular cases. 2. Lindenbaum's (1984) implication that "homosexual societies" of the lowlands were somehow not as advanced on an evolutionary politicoeconomic scale as what she terms the "posthomosexual" societies of the New Guinea highlands has been criticized by Whitehead (1985).
Notes to pages 62-96
245
3. Trans-Fly peoples are exceptional along the south coast in using very few tidewater resources and following a basically "inland" subsistence regime (see below). 4. Language families that are internally split, with some groups practicing and others not practicing ritual homosexuality, have been omitted from this calculation. Nevertheless, inclusion of the large central Asmat population in the latter group would be highly consistent with the overall pattern observed. 5. Williams (1940:27) tabulated 4,465 western Elema in 1937, and his maps {ibid. :2) and text suggest that this population inhabited approximately thirty km of beach-front up to three km inland. This gives a population density of about fifty per sq. km in the coastal area. If the tribal boundary is extended to its maximal inland extent, the population density is still in excess of thirty per sq. km even without adding the population of these inland areas, the demography of which is not considered by Williams. 6. A smaller Asmat village documented by Zegwaard (Zegwaard and Boelaars 1982) had a population of 650 residing in five men's houses and fifty-nine family houses. 7. Large house size appears to be common throughout the Kiwai-Purari area. Hurley's photos document an exceptionally large longhouse at the mouth of the Turama River and other very large longhouses at Urama in Deception Bay at the far eastern extent of the Kiwai language family (Specht and Fields 1984:140f., 156f.). 8. This rough estimate of attendance at large central Asmat feasts assumes, as sources suggest, that a substantial number of persons from neighboring villages congregated at the host community for the event. Similar feasts, though frequently smaller, might take place when a new men's house was completed or when a commissioned war canoe - up to twenty meters long, including special carvings had been completed. 9. See English summary in Sowada 1961:83-89. 10. Compensation that either failed to meet or too greatly exceeded this (ethnographically unspecified) standard could be taken as an affront. 11. Kolopom are perhaps the south coast group best researched from the vantage point of gift exchange and political economy (Serpenti 1977). Eyde's (1967) thesis on the Asmat also forms a partial exception. 5 Women's status 1. Among both Gebusi and Kiwai, female marital choice was especially great among late adolescent women but compromised for females transferred for marriage as children. 2. See McDowell (1978) for a detailed description from northern New Guinea of how kinship can be manipulated to satisfy the requirements of sister-exchange marriage. 3. By contrast, sister-exchange was much more culturally emphasized and obvious to observers, particularly to van Baal himself, among the Bian Marind to the north. 4. These rites were particularly pronounced among the Bian Marind and in the Imo rites along the coast. 5. By emphasizing otiv-bombari, van Baal tends to underweight its
246
Notes to pages 96-122
coexistence with more mutual ritual sexuality on other occasions, and he discounts evidence that heterosexual intercourse of a communal nature was widespread (e.g., 1966:510,582f., 637). The information supplied by Wirz and several others tends to belie this conclusion; it appears likely that these variants of ritual heterosexuality coexisted in various permutations throughout Marind territory. 6. Williams' accounts, in which variations in women's status emerge inductively and quite incidentally, may be contrasted to Margaret Mead's (1935) comparative study of gender in three Sepik New Guinea societies (see reanalysis by Errington and Gewertz 1987). 7. Conversely, there is no assumption that the indices of female status used here are necessarily appropriate for cultures from other world areas. 8. For example, cursory inspection of the ethnography suggests that Etoro women might merit an index of 4-3 for the measures of female status indicated in table 6 (Kelly n.d.). Gebusi women would probably have a ranking of +2 (Cantrell n.d; cf. also S0rum 1984; see generally Knauft 1987b: 164). 9. To these cases could be added the Gebusi and Jaquai from south lowland areas further inland. 10. These findings contrast with those of Sanday (1981:174), which suggest that male dominance is highly correlated with warfare. A consideration of Sanday's methods, however, reveals that her categories make this association true in part by definition. Thus, for instance, she indexes "male dominance" in part by the occurrence of chronic raiding between groups (e.g., for women) {ibid. :254). 11. Van Baal's (1966:46-65) analysis appears to overlook Marind processes of cumulative patrifiliation similar to those of the Elema. These processes were cross-cut by the aggregation of diverse clan residences during periods of depopulation. Van Baal tries to accommodate these complexities within a static model of phratry-affiliated residence, but the information available seems to contravene such an assessment. 12. Whitehead does not propose direct correspondence between her varieties of fertility cultism and female status; this consideration is my own. 13. I thank Raymond Kelly for bringing this issue to my attention. 6 Trends in comparative analysis 1. Prominent critiques of Sahlins' Big Man model for Melanesia include A. Strathern 1971; Schwartz 1963; Chowning 1979; Douglas 1979; Lindstrom 1984; Godelier 1986; and Lederman 1990. 2. For example, Lemonnier 1991:23; Liep 1991:46; Battaglia 1991:85; Schwimmer 1991:144, 154f.; see also Jolly 1991:76f.; Juillerat 1991:139; Lederman 1991:219; Godelier 1991:297. 3. Actually Weber adopted the term 'ideal type' from the writings of his contemporary, Georg Jellinek, though the development and use of the concept was clearly his own (see Runciman 1978:5f.). 4. For instance, Feil's (1987:166) analysis of the region asserts that maternal relations were not only fundamental but "prior" and even "predominant over agnatic ones."
Notes to pages 125-148
247
5. Significant exceptions to this generalization include Barth (1987) and M. Strathern(1988). 7 Theoretical reconfiguration 1. Thus, for instance, when Bourdieu (1990c: 112) discusses his concept of symbolic capital, he states: It must be asserted at the same time that a capital (or power) becomes symbolic capital, that is, capital endowed with a specifically symbolic efficacy, only when it is misrecognized in its arbitrary truth as capital and recognized as legitimate and, on the other hand, that this act of (false) knowledge and recognition is an act of practical knowledge which in no way implies that the object known and recognized be posited as object.
In short (ibid. :135), "the symbolic power relations tend to reproduce and to reinforce the power relations which constitute the structure of the social space." And reciprocally, "objective power relations tend to reproduce themselves in symbolic power relations." 8 Marind-anim 1. Ernst (1979) importantly reanalyzed parts of van Baal's large volume; see also van Baal's (1984,1991) densely abridged summaries. 2. Van Baal (1966:97) continues significantly: there is plenty of reason to consider the system as the outcome of continuous intervillage traffic and co-operation in feasts and rituals between linguistically closely related communities, all based on a moiety-pattern and, perhaps, having a tendency toward quadripartition in common. If that is accepted, the more curious traits of the system become understandable: it is a matter of course, then, for the solidarity of the phratry to be based upon mythology and totemic relations and resemblances rather than on genealogical relations. It need not baffle us any more that, locally, we are not confronted with the four phratries as such, but always with parts of phratries and invariably to such numbers that all four phratries are represented.
3. Villages in intermediate areas had some residents initiated into each cult. Since mayo areas were closer to the main Dutch post at Merauke, suppression of mayo cult activity by early Dutch administrators allowed the more secretive imo cult to persist and spread. In some respects, the imo cult later became a resistance or revivalist movement (van Baal 1966:607). 4. In some versions all non-Marind come out of the second hole. 5. Among the activities learned/re-learned in a context of mythic and cosmological meaning were how to climb palm trees, beat sago, open coconuts, catch fish/crabs, hunt game, and conduct headhunting raids. 6. Van Baal's own account mutes the energetic festivity and enjoyment of extra-marital sexual license. In part, this conservatism protected the richness and cultural value of Marind sexual customs from colonial disparagement; most other portrayals, particularly mission articles and travel-adventure accounts, rendered Marind sexual customs as immoral and depraved as well as (more accurately) licentious, exuberant, and frequent (e.g., Annalen 1915; Alder 1922; Miller 1950).
248
Notes to pages 154-169
7. Van Baal (1966:489f.) realized that adherence to the Sosom cult was extremely strong among coastal Marind and even inland despite fervent government attempts to eradicate it. In addition, some of the eastern-most Marind villages did not conduct Sosom rites, having the rapa fire cult as a functional substitute. 8. Like the Upper Bian peoples prior to their assimilation as Marind, Boazi comprised separate territorial groups that warred chronically with each other (Busse 1991:30). 9. These figures were obtained among western Marind in 1910, that is, prior to the onset of donavanosis in this region (van Baal 1966:29). 10. As part of this intervention, nuclear family living compounds were set up, extra-marital sexuality was prohibited, and cult practices were vigorously suppressed. 11. Since the Dutch depopulation report contains important demographic and nutritional as well as ethnographical data, it is strongly hoped that a full English translation of it will some day be published. A partial translation of it is available in microfilm (South Pacific Commission 1952-1953); I am indebted to John Richens for help in supplying me a copy. 12. Verschueren resided in the area from 1931 to the 1960s. Parts of his Marind ethnography were published as articles but it was mostly made available in extensive documentary correspondence with van Baal as incorporated into the latter's Dema. Van Baal indicates on the volume's title page that the work was written "with the collaboration of Father J. Verschueren MSC." Van Baal has also revised and published Jan Verschueren's Description of Yei-nan Culture (1982), drawn posthumously from Verschueren's notes on the group adjacent and to the northeast of the Marind. 13. In the absence of hard evidence, it might be reasoned that a colonial commission would be predisposed to attribute a prior cause of Marind depopulation to indigenous practices rather than attributing it entirely to introduced disease. 14. As a result, "the variation in the [pregnancy] rates for all women is closely related to the proportion of childless women, which increased progressively with the age of the cohorts." Correspondingly, in terms of inter-regional Marind variation "the differences between the regions are more marked for the rates related to all married women than for those related to fertile women" (McArthur 1955:10). 15. That these children were not considered the result of "true" pregnancy further helps explain the high rate of reported primary sterility and the absence of evidence for partially reduced fertility among childbearing women of the same age cohort. 16. Other venereal diseases may have been introduced to the Marind slightly prior to donavanosis. Richens (Vogel and Richens 1989:217n22), alludes in a note to the similarity between chlamydial infection and symptoms such as chronic ischaemia and atypical chronic inflammation. 17. Eventually, of course, the Marind's expanding cultural boundary would make long-distance headhunting unfeasible by virtue of pure distance; there were hard material limits to Marind expansion (Ernst 1979). There is little
Notes to pages 173-190
249
evidence that these limits had been reached by the precolonial Marind, however, and even in the east, their expansion might have continued to the Fly River if it had not been halted by colonial force. The ingenious features of Marind expansion and cultural elaboration minimized the restrictiveness of technoenvironmental constraints. 9 Symbolic and sociopolitical permutations 1. The principal exception here were the Elema, who lacked headhunting and ritual sexuality but articulated fertility cult practices in elaborate masked embodiments and the taking of a sacrificial victim at the end of the ceremonies. 2. For example, Wagner 1967, 1972, 1986a; A. Strathern 1972; A. Weiner 1976; J. Weiner 1982; Schwimmer 1973; LiPuma 1988; Kelly 1976; Knauft 1985a; Battaglia 1990; Munn 1986; see generally M. Strathern 1988; for a Melanesiawide review see Knauft 1989a. 3. Relatedly, the other village-half also buried the deceased. The kin of the deceased's own half-village could not bury him, lest the deceased's spirit think it was they who wanted or caused his death (Serpenti 1977:195). 4. Kolopom torture of headhunt victims was probably most closely approximated by Asmat, who took prisoners whenever possible and "stripped and ill-treated [them] in many ways" prior to cutting off their heads (Zegwaard 1959:1036). 5. Boys entering seclusion in the bachelor's house were of a younger age grade than those who received heads; only boys from the eldest initiation grade within the bachelor's house could be indoctrinated in headhunting (Serpenti 1977:169). 6. Peace could be arranged when the score of dead was even on both sides by reciprocal payment of homicide compensation (Serpenti 1968:125). 7. See Landtman 1917:ch.l3, 1927:ch.9; van Baal 1966:ch.l2; Beaver 1920:102f., 115, ch.9; Williams 1936:288, ch.15; Austen 1923; Riley 1923; Haddon 1923. 8. In one documented case, remnants of inland groups who fled southeast and amalgamated to escape Marind raids were attacked again by more distant Marind raiding parties and were forced to flee southeast to the coast at Buji (Bugilai). Here they were yet again attacked by Marind. Their southeast movement had also put them within range of attacks by Kiwai and Torres Strait Islanders to the east and south (Williams 1936:32n; Ray 1907:295; Strachan 1888:ch.9). 9. Ayres (1983:188) documents that of 725 marriages, 82.6 per cent (599) were between men and women of different sections and different place affiliations. 10. Ayres (1983:223) notes, however, that by 1979-1981 there was evidence of only one such marriage. 11. There appear to be no comprehensive ethnographic descriptions of the Asmat ceremonial cycle, and its relationship to Asmat mythology is also sketchy. Important but selected information can be found in Zegwaard (1959); synoptic overviews and some observational comments are presented by Konrad et al. (1981), Eyde (1967:Appendix III), and Schneebaum (1980, 1990). An interesting study of Asmat ceremonial music by K. van Arsdale (1982) is in An Asmat Sketch Book No. 8, and a selection of Asmat myths is compiled in
250
Notes to pages 191-211
An Asmat Sketch Book No. 6, with others scattered in no. 4 and no. 7 of the same series; see also Zegwaard (1959). A brief but important portrayal of Asmat spiritual concepts has recently been supplied by Sowada (1990; see also van Arsdale and Radetsky 1983). 12. This oratory was followed by the boasting of other war-leaders who had taken fewer heads. Kuruwaip's (1984:19f.) account suggests that the eminence and order of war leaders was determined by the number of heads each had personally taken. 13. Zegwaard (1959:1027) notes that head-name identity gave the recipient a virtual diplomatic immunity in the victim's village. This allowed him to be an emissary of information (or misinformation) between enemy communities (ibid. :1032). 14. Eyde's (1967) thesis describes the diverse categories of kindred affiliation that temporarily bound Asmat together in the prepacification era. Important overviews of Asmat social organization have been provided by Zegwaard (1953, see 1982; Zegwaard and Boelaars 1955) and a useful summary of information from early Dutch sources has been compiled by Sowada (1961). The transitory and yet complex nature of Asmat social organization may be one reason why it has not been subject to more thorough documentation and analysis in published literature. 15. Men might occasionally spare a women or child to take as their own, but in contrast to the Marind, this does not appear to have been a general practice (Zegwaard 1959:1036). 16. This killing, which occurred in 1948, took place in the aftermath of furtive Japanese attempts to infiltrate the area during World War Two. As Zegwaard emphasizes, the incident illustrates features of large-scale killing indigenous to Asmat. 17. In the mouguru, only "closest blood relations" were excluded from being potential sexual partners (Landtman 1927:352). 18. See Landtman 1927:17f., 249; 1917:ch.l3; Hays 1991a:84. 19. Eastern Kiwai language family peoples, however, are reputed to have eaten the skin, flesh, and eyes of captured heads (Landtman 1927:164). Beaver (1920:220, 225, 249) suggests that peoples living in the Bamu estuary and at Goaribari Island cannibalized other parts of the body as well. 20. Horiomu were performed especially in western Kiwai areas (Landtman 1927:330). 21. See Landtman 1927:213-217; Beaver 1920:175-177, cf. 163-175. 22. The horiomu entailed large-scale food-giving and has some similarities to the gaera (Landtman 1927:330); the gaera involved feasting with ritual significance likened to that of the horiomu (ibid. :387); and the mouguru rites "were preceded by elaborate preparations of the same kind as those for the gaera" (ibid. :350). 10 Regional characteristics and comparisons 1. See A. Strathern 1971, 1972; Strauss 1990; Wagner 1967, 1972; Rappaport 1984; J. Weiner 1982; LiPuma 1988; Lederman 1986; Feil 1984; see also Whitehead 1986. 2. For example, Wagner 1986; Damon and Wagner 1989; Battaglia 1990; Young 1971,1983; Keesing 1982; Allen 1984; Errington 1974. 3. This display was highly comic, though it was considered shameful by the young male initiate novice.
Notes to pages 213-224
251
4. Among the Yafar, women rubbed themselves with semen to assure better sago production (Juillerat 1986:257). 5. See Feil 1987; J. Weiner (ed.) 1988; Knauft 1985b; Gewertz 1983; Lutkehaus etal 1990. 6. Marind, whose area combined savannah with swamp, tailored their raids in part to their environment, going westward into the perpetually swampy areas of the Digul during the drier season and travelling eastward along the coast to the drier Trans-Fly areas in the wet season (since during the dry season, the Trans-Fly was largely bereft of inland waterways). This seasonal variation also gave Marind the wind at their backs in both areas as they paddled home (van Baall966:715f.). 7. The Elema coast comprised 120 miles of exposed beach hardly broken except by river mouths. This coast bore the direct brunt of Gulf winds that pounded it with surf and cut off sea communication for both indigenous peoples and colonial personnel for a significant portion of the year (Williams 1940:1). Elema were, however, visited by Motu trading expeditions which sailed along the coast during the calmer season (Barton 1910). 8. A version of this argument has also been suggested for southeast Asian headhunting by McKinley (1976:lllf.). 9. See especially Watson 1971; Langness 1972; Berndt 1962; Hallpike 1977; Koch 1974; Godelier 1986; see generally Knauft 1990a. 10. See especially Rappaport (1984) and Heider (1979). 11. See for the Elema, G. Hogbin (1964); for the Purari, Maher (1961, 1967); for the Trans-Fly, Laba (1975a,b; cf. Ohtsuka 1983); and for the Asmat, Monbiot (1989:ens.8-9) and van Arsdale and Gallus (1974). 12. In the New Guinea highlands, cargo cults were experimented with but typically had little lasting social or cultural influence (e.g., Berndt 1951-1953, 1953-1954; A. Strathern 1970-1971; Meggitt 1973; Reay 1959, 1977; but cf. O'Brien and Ploeg 1964). 13. Concerning cargo cults along the south coast see (Asmat) Trenkenschuh 1982e, 1982f; Sowada 1980a; van Arsdale and Gallus 1974; (Kolopom) Serpenti 1977:ix; (Purari) Maher 1961, 1984; (Elema) Williams 1923a, 1934; Worsley 1968:ch.4: Cochrane 1970:ch.4.
References
Adam, Barry D. 1986 Age, Structure, and Sexuality: Reflections on the Anthropological Evidence on Homosexual Relations. Journal of Homosexuality 11:19-33. 1987 The Rise of a Gay and Lesbian Movement. Boston: Twayne Publishers. Akerlund, M., P. Mardh, and L. Estrom 1975 On the Diagnosis and Aetiology of Infections of the Lower Genital Tract in the Female. In Genital Infections and their Complications. Edited by D. Danielsson, V. Falk, and L. Lorslin, pp. 169-175. Stockholm: Almqvist and Wiksell International. Alder, William, F. 1922 The Isle of Vanishing Men: A Narrative of Adventure in Cannibal-land. New York: Century Co. Aldrich, Robert 1990 The French Presence in the South Pacific, 1842-1940. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press. Allen, Michael R. 1981 (ed.) Vanuatu: Politics, Economics and Ritual in Island Melanesia. New York: Academic press. 1984 Elders, Chiefs, and Big Men: Authority Legitimation and Political Evolution in Melanesia. American Ethnologist 11:20-41. Amelsvoort, V.F.P.M. van 1964 Culture, Stone Age and Modern Medicine: The Early Introduction of Integrated Rural Health in a Non-literate Society. A New Guinea Case Study in Medical Anthropology. Assen: Van Gorcum. Annalen 1915 Annalen van O.L. Vrouw van Het H. Hart: Dire en Dertigste Jaargang. Tilburg: Missiehuis van Het H. Hart. Appadurai, Arjun 1986 Theory in Anthropology: Center and Periphery. Comparative Studies in Society and History 28:356-361. 1988 Introduction: Place and Voice in Anthropological Theory. Cultural Anthropology 3:16-20. Armstrong, Wallace E. 1928 Rossel Island: An Ethnological Study. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Arsdale, Kathleen, O. van 1982 Music and Culture of the Bismam Asmat of New Guinea: A Preliminary Investigation. In An Asmat Sketch Book no. 8. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 9-94. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. Arsdale, Peter W. van 1975 Perspectives on Development in Asmat. (Published as An Asmat Sketch Book no. 5, parts A and B; edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh.) Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions.
References
253
1978 Activity Patterns of Asmat Hunter-Gatherers: A Time Budget Analysis. Mankind 11:453-460. Arsdale, Peter W. van and Kathleen O. van Arsdale 1991 Asmat. In Encyclopedia of World Cultures, Vol. 2: Oceania. Edited by Terence E. Hays, pp. 19-21. Boston: G.K. Hall. Arsdale, Peter W. van and D.E. Gallus 1974 The "Lord of the Earth" Cult among the Asmat: Prestige, Power, and Politics in a Transitional Society. Irian: Bulletin of Irian Jay a Development 3(2): 1-31. Arsdale, Peter W. van and Carol L. Radetsky 1983 Life and Death in New Guinea. Omega 14:155-169. Asad, Talal 1973 (ed.) Anthropology and the Colonial Encounter. New York: Humanities Press. 1982 Are There Histories of Peoples Without Europe?: A Review Article. Comparative Studies in Society and History 29:594-608. Austen, Leo 1923 Karigara Customs. Man 23(19):35-36. Ayres, Mary C. 1983 This Side, That Side: Locality and Exogamous Group Definition in Morehead Area, Southwestern Papua. Ph.D. Dissertation, Department of Anthropology, The University of Chicago. Baal, Jan van 1934 Godsdienst en Samenleving in Nederlandsch-Zuid-NieuwGuinea. Amsterdam: Noord-Hollandsche Uitgeversmaatschappy. 1966 Dema: Description and Analysis of Marind-Anim Culture (South New Guinea). The Hague: Martinus Nijhoff. 1975 Reciprocity and the Position of Women. Assen: Van Gorcum. 1981 Man's Quest for Partnership. Assen: Van Gorcum. 1982 Jan Verschuerens Description of Yei-nan Culture. The Hague: Martinus Nijhoff. 1984 The Dialectics of Sex in Marind-anim Culture. In Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia. Edited by Gilbert H. Herdt, pp. 128-166. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1986 Ontglipt Verleden I, Tot 1947: Indisch Bestuursambtenaar in vrede en oorlog. [A Past Which Has Slipped Away Part I, Until 1947: Public Servant in the Indies, in Peace and War.] Franeker: T. Wever. 1988 Ontglipt Verleden II, Lev en in Verandering: 1947-1958. [A Past Which Has Slipped Away, Part II, Living in a Context of Change: 1947-1958.] Franeker: van Wijnen. 1991 Marind-anim. In Encyclopedia of World Cultures, Vol. 2: Oceania. Edited by Terence E. Hays, pp. 182-185. Boston: G.K. Hall. Baal, Jan van and W.E.A. van Beek 1985 Symbols for Communication: An Introduction to the Anthropological Study of Religion (2nd rev. edn.). Assen: van Gorcum. Baal, Jan van, K.W. Galis and R.M. Koentjaraningrat 1984 West Irian: A Bibliography. (Koninklijk Instituut voor Taal-, Land- en Volkenkunde, Bibliographic Series no. 15.) Dordrecht, Holland/Cinnaminson, NJ: Foris Publications. Barnes, John 1962 African Models in the New Guinea Highlands. Man 62:5-9. 1967 Agnation among the Enga: A Review Article. Oceania 38:33^43.
254
References
Barrau, Jacques 1958 Subsistence Agriculture in Melanesia. (Bernice P. Bishop Museum, Bulletin 219). Honolulu: Bishop Museum. Barth, Fredrik 1975 Ritual and Knowledge among the Baktaman of New Guinea. New Haven: Yale University Press. 1987 Cosmologies in the Making: A Generative Approach to Cultural Variation in Inner New Guinea. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Barton, F.R. 1910 The Annual Trading Expedition to the Papuan Gulf. In The Melanesians of British New Guinea. By Charles G. Seligmann, pp. 96-120. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Bateson, Gregory 1936 Naven: A Survey of the Problems Suggested by a Composite Picture of a Culture of a New Guinea Tribe Drawn from Three Points of View. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press [2nd edn.; Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press, 1958]. 1972 Steps to an Ecology of Mind: Collected Essays in Anthropology, Psychiatry, Evolution, and Epistemology. San Francisco: Chandler. Battaglia, Debbora 1990 On the Bones of the Serpent: Person, Memory, and Mortality in Sabarl Island Society. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. 1991 Punishing the Yams: Leadership and Gender Ambivalence on Sabarl Island. In Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Edited by Maurice Godelier and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 83-96. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Beardmore, Edward 1890 The Natives of Mowat, Daudai, New Guinea. Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 19:459466. Beaver, Wilfred N. 1914 A Description of the Girara District, Western Papua. Geographical Journal 43:407-413. 1920 Unexplored New Guinea: A record of the travels, adventures, and experiences of a resident magistrate amongst the head-hunting savages and cannibals of the unexplored interior of New Guinea. London: Seeley, Service & Co. Beek, Albert Gosewijn van 1987 The Way of All Flesh: Hunting and Ideology of the Bedamuni of the Great Papuan Plateau (Papua New Guinea). Doctoral Thesis, Leiden. Bell, Alan P. and Martin S. Weinberg 1978 Homosexualities: A Study of Diversity among Men and Women. New York: Simon and Schuster. Belshaw, Cyril S. 1957 The Great Village: The Economic and Social Welfare of Hanuabada, an Urban Community in Papua. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul. Bennett, Judith A. 1987 Wealth of the Solomons: A History of a Pacific Archipelago, 1800-1978. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press. Bergmann, Frithjof 1975 On the Inadequacies of Functionalism. Michigan Discussions in Anthropology 1:2-23. Berndt, Ronald M. 1952-1953 A Cargo Movement in the East Central Highlands of New Guinea. Oceania 23:40-65,137-158. 1953-1954 Reaction to Contact in the Eastern Central Highlands of New Guinea. Oceania24:190-228,255-275. 1962 Excess and Restraint: Social Control among a New Guinea Mountain People. Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
References
255
Berndt, Ronald M. and Peter Lawrence (eds.) 1971 Politics in New Guinea. Nedlands: University of Western Australia Press. Bevan, Theodore F. 1890 Toil, Travel, and Discovery in British New Guinea. London: Kegan Paul, Trench, Trubner & Co. Blackwood, Beatrice 1935 Both Sides of Buka Passage: An Ethnographic Study of Social, Sexual, and Economic Questions in the North-Western Solomon Islands. Oxford: Clarendon Press. Bloch, Marc 1967 A Contribution Towards the Comparative History of European Societies. In Land and Work in Medieval Europe: Selected Papers by Marc Bloch, pp. 44-81. (Translated by J.E. Anderson.) London: Routledge and Kegan Paul. [Original, 1928.] 1971 The Ile-de-France: The Country Around Paris. (Translated by J.E. Anderson.) Ithaca: Cornell University Press. [Original, 1913.] BNG Annual Reports 1889-1896 Annual Colonial Reports on British New Guinea. London and Brisbane: Government Printing Offices. Bodrogi, Tibor 1951 Colonization and Religious Movements in Melanesia. Acta Ethnografica Academiae Hungaricae 2:259-292. Boelaars, J.H.M.C. 1981 Head-Hunters about Themselves: An Ethnographic Report from Irian Jay a, Indonesia. (Verhandelingen van het Koninklijk Instituut voor Taal-, Land- en Volkenkunde, no. 92.) The Hague: Martinus Nijhoff. Bone, Robert C. 1964 The International Status of West New Guinea until 1884. Journal of South Asian History 5:102-118. Bonnemere, Pascale 1990 Considerations Relatives aux Representations des Substances Corporelles en Nouvelle-Guinee. VHomme 30 114:101-120. Boon, James A. 1990 Affinities and Extremes: Crisscrossing the Bittersweet Ethnology of East Indies History, Hindu-Balinese Culture, and IndoEuropean Allure. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Boserup, Ester 1970 Woman's Role in Economic Development. New York: St. Martin's Press. Bourdieu, Pierre 1977 Outline of a Theory of Practice. (Translated by Richard Nice.) Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1984 Distinction: A Social Critique of the Judgment of Taste. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. 1988a Homo Academicus. (Translated by P. Collier.) Stanford: Stanford University Press. 1988b Flaubert's Point of View. Critical Inquiry 14:539-562. 1990a The Logic of Practice. (Translated by Richard Nice.) Stanford: Stanford University Press. 1990b The Scholastic Point of View. Cultural Anthropology 5:380-391. 1990c In Other Words: Essays Towards a Reflexive Sociology. (Translated by Matthew Adamson.) Stanford: Stanford University Press. 1991a Language and Symbolic Power: The Economy of Linguistic Exchange. (Edited by John B. Thompson; translated by Gino Raymond and Matthew Adamson.) Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. 1991b The Political Ontology of Martin Heidegger. Stanford: Stanford University Press.
256
References
Bowden, Ross 1983 Yena: Art and Ceremony in a Sepik Society. Oxford: Pitt Rivers Museum. Braudel, Fernand 1973 The Mediterranean and the Mediterranean World in the Age of Philip II (2 vols.). (Translated by Sian Reynolds.) New York: Harper & Row. [1st edn., 1949; rev. French edn., 1966.] 1980a History and the Social Sciences: the Longue Duree. In On History. By F. Braudel, translated by Sarah Matthews, pp. 25-54. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. 1980b The History of Civilizations: The Past Explains the Present. In On History. By F. Braudel, translated by Sarah Matthews, pp. 177-218. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Bromilow, William Edward 1929 Twenty Years among Primitive Papuans. London: Epworth Press. [Reprint, New York: AMS Press, 1977.] Brookfield, Harold C. [with Doreen Hart] 1971 Melanesia: A Geographical Interpretation of an Island World. London: Methuen. Brookfield, Harold C. and Paula Brown 1963 Struggle for Land: Agriculture and Group Territories among the Chimbu of the New Guinea Highlands. Melbourne: Oxford University Press. Brown, D.J.J. 1979 The Structuring of Polopa Feasting and Warfare. Man 14:712-732. Brown, George 1910 Melanesians and Polynesians: Their Life-Histories Described and Compared. London. [Reprint, New York: Benjamin Blom.] Brown, Herbert A. 1957 The Eastern Elema. Thesis for Post-Graduate Diploma in Anthropology. London School of Economics and Political Science. London. 1973 The Eleman Language Family. In The Linguistic Situation in the Gulf District and Adjacent Areas, Papua New Guinea. Edited by Karl Franklin, pp. 279-376. Pacific Linguistics, Series C, no. 26. Canberra: Australian National University. 1986 A Comparative Dictionary of Orokolo, Gulf of Papua. Pacific Linguistics, Series C, No. 84. Canberra: Research School of Pacific Studies, Department of Linguistics, Australian National University. Brown, Paula 1972 The Chimbu: A Study of Change in the New Guinea Highlands. Cambridge, MA: Schenkman. 1978 Highland Peoples of New Guinea. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press 1982a Conflict in the New Guinea Highlands. Journal of Conflict Resolution 26:525-546. 1982b Chimbu Disorder: Tribal Fighting in Newly Independent Papua New Guinea. Pacific Viewpoint22:1-21. Brown, Paula and Georgeda Buchbinder (eds.) 1976 Man and Woman in the New Guinea Highlands. Washington, DC: American Anthropological Association. Brown, Paula and Aaron Podolefsky 1976 Population Density, Agricultural Intensity, Land Tenure, and Group Size in the New Guinea Highlands. Ethnology 15:211-238. Brunton, Ron 1975 Why Do the Trobriands Have Chiefs? Man 10:544-558.
References
257
Bryant, Christopher G.A. and David Jary (eds.) 1991 Giddens' Theory of Structuration: A Critical Appreciation. London: Routledge. Buckley, Thomas 1989 Kroeber's Theory of Culture Areas and the Ethnology of Northwestern California. Anthropological Quarterly 62:15-26. Bureau for Native Affairs 1957 Anthropological Research in Netherlands New Guinea Since 1950. Paper presented to the Ninth Pacific Science Conference. Burke, Peter 1990 The French Historical Revolution: The Annales School, 1929-1989. Stanford: Stanford University Press. Burridge, Kenelm O.L. 1960 Mambu: A Melanesian Millennium. London: Methuen. Busse, Mark 1987 Sister Exchange among the Wamek. Ph.D. Dissertation, Department of Anthropology, The University of California, San Diego. 1991 Boazi. In Encyclopedia of World Cultures, Vol. 2: Oceania. Edited by Terence E. Hays, pp. 28-31. Boston: G.K. Hall. Butcher, Benjamin T 1964 My Friends, the New Guinea Headhunters. Garden City, NY: Doubleday. Butler, Judith 1990 Gender Trouble: Feminism and the Subversion of Identity. New York: Routledge. Cantrell, Eileen M. n.d. Gebusi Gender Relations. Ph.D. Dissertation (in progress). Department of Anthropology. The University of Michigan, Ann Arbor. Carrier, Achsah, H. and James G. Carrier 1991 Structure and Process in a Melanesian Society: Ponam's Progress in the Twentieth Century. Chur, Switzerland: Harwood Academic. Carrier, James G. (ed.) in press Tradition and History in Melanesian Anthropology. Carrier, James G. and Achsah H. Carrier 1989 Wage, Trade, and Exchange in Melanesia: A Manus Society in the Modern State. Berkeley: University of California Press. Chalmers, James 1887 Pioneering in New Guinea. London: Religious Tract Society. 1895 Pioneer Life and Work in New Guinea, 1877-1894. London: Religious Tract Society. 1903a Notes on the Natives of Kiwai Island, Fly River, British New Guinea. Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 33:117-124. 1903b Notes on the Bugilai, British New Guinea. Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 33:108-110. Chowning, Ann 1979 Leadership in Melanesia. Journal of Pacific History 14:66-84. Clammer, John 1973 Colonialism and the Perception of Tradition in Fiji. In Anthropology and the Colonial Encounter. Edited by Talal Asad, pp. 199-220. London: Ithaca Press. Clark, John, Celia Modgil, and Sohan Modgil (eds.) 1990 Anthony Giddens: Consensus and Controversy. London: Falmer Press. Clay, Brenda Johnson 1986 Mandak Realities: Person and Power in Central New Ireland. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press.
258
References
Clifford, James 1988 The Predicament of Culture. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Clifford, James and George E. Marcus (eds.) 1986 Writing Culture: The Poetics and Politics of Ethnography. Berkeley: University of California Press. Cochrane, Glynn 1970 Big Men and Cargo Cults. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Codrington, R.H. 1891 The Melanesians: Studies in their Anthropology and Folklore. Oxford: Clarendon Press. [Reprint, New York: Dover, 1972.] Cohen, G.A. 1978 Karl Marx's Theory of History: A Defense. Oxford: Clarendon Press. 1988 History, Labour, and Freedom: Themes from Marx. Oxford: Clarendon Press. Collier, Jane F. 1988 Marriage and Inequality in Classless Societies. Stanford: Stanford University Press. Collier, Jane F. and Michelle Z. Rosaldo, 1981 Politics and Gender in Simple Societies. In Sexual Meanings: The Cultural Construction of Gender and Sexuality. Edited by Sherry B. Ortner and Harriet Whitehead, pp. 275-329. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Comaroff, Jean and John Comaroff 1991 Of Revelation and Revolution: Christianity, Colonialism, and Consciousness in South Africa, Vol. 1. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Connell, John 1987 New Caledonia or Kanaky? The Political History of a French Colony. Pacific Research Monograph no. 16. Canberra: Australian National University Press. Connolly, B., and R. Anderson 1987 First Contact. New York: Viking. Cook, James (Captain) 1955 The Journals of Captain James Cook on his Voyages of Discovery (4 vols.). Edited by J.C. Beaglehole. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Corris, Peter 1968 "Blackbirding" in New Guinea Waters, 1883-1884: An Episode in the Queensland Labour Trade. Journal of Pacific History 3:85-105. 1973 Passage, Port and Plantation: A History of Solomon Islands Labor Migration, 1870-1914. Melbourne: Melbourne University Press. Craig, Barry and David Hyndman (eds.) 1990 Children of Afek: Tradition and Change among the Mountain-Ok of Central New Guinea. Oceania Monograph no. 40. Sydney: University of Sydney. Crawford, Anthony L. 1981 Aida: Life and Ceremony of the Gogodala. Bathurst, Australia: National Cultural Council of Papua New Guinea/ Robert Brown & Assoc. Creed, Gerald W. 1984 Sexual Subordination: Institutionalized Homosexuality and Social Control in Melanesia. Ethnology 23:157-176. D'Albertis, Luigi M. 1880 New Guinea: What I Did, What I Saw (2 vols.). London: Sampson Low, Marston, Searle and Rivington. D'Amato, J. 1979 The Wind and the Amber: Notes on Headhunting and the Interpretation of Accounts. Journal of Anthropological Research 35:61— 84.
References
259
Damon, Frederick H. 1990 From Muyuw to the Trobriands: Transformations along the Northern Side of the Kula Ring. Tucson: University of Arizona Press. Damon, Frederick H. and Roy Wagner (eds.) 1989 Death Rituals and Life in the Societies of the Kula Ring. DeKalb, IL: Northern Illinois University Press. Davenport, William H. 1965 Sexual Patterns and their Regulation in a Society of the Southwest Pacific. In Sex and Behavior. Edited by F. A. Beach, pp. 164^207. New York: John Wiley. 1977 Sex in Cross-cultural Perspective. In Human Sexuality in Four Perspectives. Edited by F.A. Beach and M. Diamond, pp. 155-163. Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press. de Certeau, Michel 1988 The Writing of History. (Translated by Tom Conley.) New York: Columbia University Press. [Original, Paris, 1975.] de Josselin de Jong, P.E. 1960 Cultural Anthropology in the Netherlands. Higher Education and Research in the Netherlands 4 (4): 13-26. 1972 Marcel Mauss et les Origines de L'Anthropologie Structurale Hollandaise. L'homme 12:62-84. de Lepervanche, Marie 1967-1968 Descent, Residence, and Leadership in the New Guinea Highlands. Oceania 38:134-158,163-189. Deacon, A. Bernard 1934 Malekula: A Vanishing People in the New Hebrides. (Edited by Camille Wedgwood.) London: George Routledge. Dening, Greg 1988 History's Anthropology: The Death of William Gooch. Lanham, MD: University Press of America. Docker, Edward W. 1970 The Blackbirders: The Recruiting of South Sea Labour for Queensland, 1863-1907. Sydney: Angus and Robertson. Dongen, W. an 1982 The Opening of the Undir, Pomatsj and Momatsj Rivers: July, 1957. An Asmat Sketch Book no. 2. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 17-24. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. Donham, Donald L. 1990 History, Power, Ideology: Central Issues in Marxism and Anthropology. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Douglas, Bronwen 1979 Rank, Power, Authority: A Reassessment of Traditional Leadership in South Pacific Societies. Journal of Pacific History 14:2-27. Dover, Kenneth J. 1989 Greek Homosexuality, rev. edn. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Drabbe, P. 1959 Grammar of the Asmat Language. (Translated by J. Fichtner.) Syracuse, IN: Our Lady of the Lake Press. Dundes, Alan 1976 A Psychoanalytic Study of the Bull-Roarer. Man 11:220238. 1978 Into the Endzone for a Touchdown: A Psychoanalytic Analysis of American Football. Western Folklore 37:75-88. Dupeyrat, Andrew 1954 Savage Papua: A Missionary among Cannibals. New York: Dutton. Durham, William H. 1991 Coevolution: Genes, Culture, and Human Diversity. Stanford: Stanford University Press. Dwyer, Peter 1989 The Pigs that Ate the Garden: A Human Ecology from Papua New Guinea. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press.
260
References
Eggan, Fred 1954 Social Anthropology and the Method of Controlled Comparison. American Anthropologist 56:743-763. Ellen, Roy F. 1976 The Development of Anthropology and Colonial Policy in the Netherlands, 1800-1960. Journal of the History of the Behavioural Sciences 12:303-324. Ernst, Thomas M. 1979 Myth, Ritual and Population among the MarindAnim. Social Analysis 1:32-53. 1984 Onabasulu Local Organization. Ph.D. Dissertation. Department of Anthropology, The University of Michigan, Ann Arbor. 1991 Onabasulu Male Homosexuality: Cosmology, Affect, and Prescribed Male Homosexual Activity among the Onabasulu of the Great Papuan Plateau. Oceania 62:1-11. Errington, Frederick 1974 Karavar: Masks and Ritual in a Melanesian Ritual. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press. Errington, Frederick and Deborah Gewertz 1987 Cultural Alternatives and a Feminist Anthropology: An Analysis of Culturally Constructed Gender Interests in Papua New Guinea. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Eschenbach, D. 1980 Epidemiology and Diagnosis of Acute Pelvic Inflammatory Disease. Obstetrics and Gynecology 55, Supplement 5, 142S. Eyde, David B. 1967 Cultural Correlates of Warfare among the Asmat of South-West New Guinea. Ph.D. dissertation, Department of Anthropology, Yale University. New Haven, CT. Fardon, Richard (ed.) 1990 Localizing Strategies: Regional Traditions of Ethnographic Writing. Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press. Feil, Daryl K. 1984 Ways of Exchange: The Enga Tee of Papua New Guinea. St. Lucia: University of Queensland Press. 1987 The Evolution of Highland Papua New Guinea Societies. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Feld, Steven 1982 Sound and Sentiment: Birds, Weeping, Poetics, and Song in Kaluli Expression. Philadelphia: University of Pennsylvania Press. Feuchtwang, Stephan 1973 The Colonial Formation of British Social Anthropology. In Anthropology and the Colonial Encounter. Edited by Talal Asad, pp. 71-100. London: Ithaca Press. Firth, Raymond 1936 We, the Tikopia. London: George Allen and Unwin. 1939 Primitive Polynesian Economy. London: Routledge and Sons. 1940 The Work of the Gods in Tikopia. London: London School of Economics and Political Science, Monographs on Social Anthropology, 1 and 2. Firth, Stewart 1978 Albert Hahl: Governor of German New Guinea. In Papua New Guinea Portraits: The Expatriate Experience. Edited by James Griffin, pp. 28-47. Canberra: Australian National University Press. 1982 The Germans in New Guinea. Melbourne: Melbourne University Press. Fischer, Michael M.J. and Mehdi Abedi 1990 Debating Muslims: Cultural Dialogues in Postmodernity and Tradition. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press.
References
261
Fison, Lorimar 1872-1873 The South Seas Labour Traffic. Daily Telegraph. (Series of nine articles from December 21, 1872 to March 15, 1873, under the nom de plume "Outis".) Flint, L.A. 1919 Muguru at Torobina, Bamu River. Man 19:38-39. Fortune, Reo F. 1932 Sorcerers of Dobu: The Social Anthropology of the Dobu Islanders. London: E.P. Dutton. [Reprinted, New York: Dutton, 1963.] 1935 Manus Religion. Philadelphia: American Philosophical Society. Foucault, Michel 1980a The History of Sexuality, Vol. 1: An Introduction. (Translated by Robert Hurley.) New York: Vintage. 1980b Herculine Barb in, Being the Recently Discovered Memoirs of a Nineteenth Century Hermaphrodite. (Translated by Richard McDongall.) New York: Colophon. 1984 The Foucault Reader. Edited by Paul Rabinow. New York: Pantheon. Fox, Charles Elliot 1925 The Threshold of the Pacific: An Account of the Social Organization, Magic and Religion of the People of San Cristoval in the Solomon Islands. New York: A.A. Knopf. Freund, Paul J. 1977 Social Change among the Kasua, Southern Highlands, Papua New Guinea. Ph.D. Thesis, Department of Anthropology, University of Iowa. Friedl, Ernestine 1975 Women and Men: An Anthropologist's View. New York: Holt, Rinehart, and Winston. Friedman, Jonathan 1974 Marxism, Structuralism and Vulgar Materialism. Man 9:444-469. Gajdusek, D. Carleton 1964 West New Guinea Journal: May 6, I960 to July 10, 1960. Bethesda, MD: National Institutes of Health. Galis, K.W. 1955 Papua's van de Humboldt-Baai. The Hague. Gell, Alfred 1975 Metamorphosis of the Cassowaries: Umeda Society, Language and Ritual. London: Athlone. Gesch, Patrick F. 1985 Initiative and Initiation: A Cargo-Type Movement in the Sepik Against its Background in Traditional Village Religion. (Studia Instituti Anthropos, Vol. 33.) St. Augustin, Germany: Anthropos. Gewertz, Deborah 1983 Sepik River Societies: A Historical Ethnography of the Chambri and their Neighbors. New Haven: Yale University Press. Giddens, Anthony 1979 Central Problems in Modern Social Theory. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1984 The Constitution of Society: Outline of the Theory of Structuration. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1985 Time, Space, and Regionalization. In Social Relations and Spatial Structures. Edited by Derek Gregory and John Urry, pp. 265-295. New York: St. Martin's. 1987 Social Theory and Modern Sociology. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1989 Response to My Critics. In Anthony Giddens and His Critics. Edited by D. Held and J. Thompson, pp. 249-301. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1990 Structuration Theory and Sociological Analysis. In Anthony Giddens:
262
References
Consensus and Controversy. Edited by John Clark, Celia Modgil, and Sohan Modgil, pp. 297-315. London: Falmer Press. Gietzelt, Dale 1988 The Indonesianization of West Papua. Oceania 59:201-221. Gillison, Gillian 1980 Images of Nature in Gimi Thought. In Nature, Culture and Gender. Edited by Carol MacCormack and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 143173. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1983 Cannibalism among Women in the Eastern Highlands of Papua New Guinea. In The Ethnography of Cannibalism. Edited by Paula Brown and Donald F. Tuzin, pp. 33-51. Washington, D C : Special Publication of the Society for Psychological Anthropology. Glasse, Robert M. 1968 Huli of Papua: A Cognatic Descent System. (Cahiers de L'Homme, Nouvelle Serie 8.) Paris: Mouton. Glasse, Robert M. and Mervyn J. Meggitt (eds.) 1969 Pigs, Pearshells, and Women: Marriage in the New Guinea Highlands. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall. 1982 Social Hierarchies among the Baruya of New Guinea. In Inequality in New Guinea Highlands Societies. Edited by Andrew J. Strathern, pp. 3-34. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Godelier, Maurice 1986 The Making of Great Men: Male Domination and Power among the New Guinea Baruya. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1991 An Unfinished Attempt at Reconstructing the Social Processes which May Have Prompted the Transformation of Great-Men Societies into Big-Men Societies. In Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Edited by Maurice Godelier and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 275304. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Godelier, Maurice and Marilyn Strathern (eds.) 1991 Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Goldman, Irving 1970 Ancient Polynesian Society. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Gordon, Robert and Mervyn J. Meggitt 1985 Law and Order in the New Guinea Highlands. Hanover, NH: University Press of New England. Gratton, Nancy E. 1991 Namau. In Encyclopedia of World Cultures, Vol. 2: Oceania. Edited by Terence E. Hays, pp. 230-233. Boston: G.K. Hall. Greenberg, David F. 1988 The Construction of Homosexuality. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Gregory, Derek 1989 Presences and Absences: Time-Space Relations and Structuration Theory. In Social Theory of Modern Societies: Anthony Giddens and His Critics. Edited by David Held and John B. Thompson, pp. 185-214. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Griffin, James, Hank Nelson, and Stewart Firth 1979 Papua New Guinea: A Political History. Richmond, Victoria (Australia): Heinemann Educational Australia. Griffiths, Deidre J.F. 1977 The Career of F.E. Wiliams, Government Anthropologist of Papua, 1922-1943. M.A. Thesis, Australian National University, Canberra. Gudeman, Stephen and Alberto Rivera 1990 Conversations in Colombia: The
References
263
Domestic Economy in Life and Text. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Guiart, Jean 1956 Un Siecle et Demi de Contacts Culturels a Tanna, NouvellesHebrides: Rapport General d'une Mission Effectuee au Cours de Vete 1952-1953. Paris: Musee de l'Homme. 1958 Espiritu Santo (Nouvelles Hebrides). Cahiers d'ethnologie, de geographie et de linguistique, n.s., Vol. 2. Paris: Plon. 1963a La Structure de la Chefferie en Melanesie du Sud. (Travaux et Memoires de l'lnstitut d'Ethnologie, 66.) Paris: Universite de Paris. 1963b The Arts of the South Pacific. London: Thames and Hudson. 1966 Mythologies du Masque en Nouvelle-Caledonie. Paris: Musee de l'Homme. 1983 La Terre est le Sang des Morts: La Confrontation entre Blancs et Noirs dans le Pacifique sud Frangais. Paris: Editions Anthropos. Guppy, Henry B. 1887 The Solomon Islands and their Natives. London: Swan Sonnenschein, Lowery. Haddon, Alfred C. 1890 Notes on Mr. Beardmore's Paper. Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 19:466-473. 1891 The Tugeri Head-hunters of New Guinea. Internationales Archiv fur Ethnographie 4:177-181. 1897 The Saving of Vanishing Knowledge. Nature 55:305-306. 1901 Headhunters, Black, White and Brown. London: Methuen. [Reprinted New York, AMS Press, 1978.] 1901-1935 (ed.) Reports of the Cambridge Anthropological Expedition to Torres Strait. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1905 South African Ethnology. Nature 72:471-479. 1911 The Wanderings of Peoples. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1912 Introduction to The Mafulu, Mountain People of British New Guinea, by Robert Williamson. London: Macmillan. 1916 The Kabiri and Girara District, Fly River, Papua. Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 46:334-352. 1918 The Agiba Cult of the Kerewa Culture. Man 18 (99): 177-183. 1919 The Kopiravi Cult of the Namau, Papua. Man 19 (91): 177-179. 1920a Introduction to Unexplored New Guinea, by Wilfred N. Beaver, pp. 7-10. London: Seeley, Service and Co. 1920b The Migrations of Cultures in British New Guinea. Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 50:234-280. 1923 Stuffed Human Heads from New Guinea. Man 23 (20): 36-39. 1924 Introduction to In Primitive New Guinea, by John H. Holmes, pp. i-xii. New York: G.P. Putnam's Sons. 1927 Introduction to The Kiwai Papuans of British New Guinea, by Gunnar Landtman, pp. ix-xx. London: Macmillan [Reprinted 1970, New York: Johnson Reprint Co.] 1928 Introduction to Rossel Island: An Ethnological Study, by Wallace E. Armstrong. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1936 Introduction to Papuans of the Trans-Fly, by F.E. Williams, pp. xxiiixxxiv. Oxford: Clarendon Press.
264
References
Hallpike, Christopher R. 1977 Bloodshed and Vengeance in the Papuan Mountains: The Generation of Conflict in Tuade Society. Oxford: Clarendon. Halperin, David M. 1990 Two Views of Greek Love: Harald Patzer and Michel Foucault. In One Hundred Years of Homosexuality, and Other Essays on Greek Love. New York: Routledge. Harker, Richard, Cheleen Mahar, and Chris Wilkes (eds.) 1990 An Introduction to the Work of Pierre Bourdieu: The Practice of Theory. London: Macmillan. Harris, David R. and Billai Laba 1982 The Mystery of the Papuan MoundBuilders. Geographical Magazine 54:386-391. Harris, Marvin 1974 The Potlatch. In Cows, Pigs, Wars, and Witches. New York: Vintage. 1979 Cultural Materialism: The Struggle for a Science of Culture. New York: Vintage. Harrison, Simon 1990 Stealing People's Names: History and Politics in a Sepik River Cosmology. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Harrisson, Tom 1937 Savage Civilization. London: Victor Gollancz. Hastings, Peter 1968 West Irian - 1969: The end of the line? New Guinea (and Australia, the Pacific and South-East Asia) Sept.-Oct., pp. 12-16. 1982 Double Dutch and Indons. In Melanesia: Beyond Diversity, Vol. 1. Edited by R.J. May and Hank Nelson, pp. 157-161. Canberra: Australian National University Press. Hays, Terence E. 1976 Anthropology in the New Guinea Highlands: An Annotated Bibliography. New York: Garland. 1991a Gogodala. In Encyclopedia of World Cultures, Vol. 2: Oceania. Edited by Terence E. Hays, pp. 82-85. Boston: G.K. Hall. 1991b The New Guinea Highlands: Region, Culture Area, or Fuzzy Set. (ms.) 1992 (ed.) Ethnographic Presents: Pioneering Anthropologists in the Papua New Guinea Highlands. Berkeley: University of California Press, n.d. Strickland-Bosavi Bibliography. Department of Anthropology and Geography, Rhode Island College. Hefner, Robert W. 1990 The Political Economy of Mountain Java: An Interpretive History. Berkeley: University of California Press. Heider, Karl G. 1970 The Dugam Dani: A Papuan Culture in the Highlands of West New Guinea. Chicago: Aldine. 1979 Grand Valley Dani: Peaceful Warriors. New York: Holt, Rinehart, and Winston. Held, David and John B. Thompson (eds.) 1989 Anthony Giddens and His Critics. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Held, G. Jan 1953 Applied Anthropology in Government: The Netherlands. In Anthropology Today: An Encyclopedic Inventory. Edited by Alfred L. Kroeber, pp. 866-879. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. 1957 The Papuas of Waropen. (Koninklijk Instituut voor Taal-, Land- en Volkenkunde, Translation Series, no. 2.) The Hague: Martinus Nijhoff. Hempenstall, Peter J. 1978 Pacific Islanders Under German Rule: A Study in
References
265
the Meaning of Colonial Resistance. Canberra: Australian National University Press. Herdt, Gilbert H. 1980 Semen Depletion and the Sense of Maleness. Ethnopsychiatrica 3:79-116. 1981 Guardians of the Flutes: Idioms of Masculinity. New York: McGrawHill. 1982 Fetish and Fantasy in Sambia Initiation. In Rituals of Manhood: Male Initiation in Papua New Guinea. Edited by Gilbert H. Herdt, pp. 44-98. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1982 (ed.) Rituals of Manhood: Male Initiation in Papua New Guinea. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1984a Ritualized Homosexual Behavior in the Male Cults of Melanesia, 1862-1983: An Introduction. In Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia. Edited by Gilbert H. Herdt, pp. 1-81. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1984b Semen Transactions in Sambia Culture. In Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia. Edited by Gilbert H. Herdt, pp. 167-210. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1984 (ed.) Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1987a The Sambia: Ritual and Gender in New Guinea. New York: Holt, Rinehart, and Winston. 1987b Homosexuality. In The Encyclopedia of Religion 6:445^52. Edited by Mircea Eliade. New York: Macmillan. 1989 Father Presence and Ritualized Homosexuality: Paternal Deprivation and Masculine Development in Melanesia Reconsidered. Ethos 17:326370. 1990 Mistaken Gender: Five-Alpha Reductase Deficiency and Biological Reductionism in Gender Identity Reconsidered. American Anthropologist 92:433-446. 1991 Representations of Homosexuality: An Essay on Cultural Ontology and Historical Comparison, parts I and II. Journal of the History of Sexuality 1:481-504,603-632. 1992 Retrospective on Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia: Introduction to the New Edition. In Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia, 2nd edn. Berkeley: University of California Press. Herdt, Gilbert H. and J. Davidson 1988 The Sambia "Turnim-Man": Sociocultural and Clinical Aspects of Gender Formation in Male Pseudohermaphrodites with 5-Alpha Reductase Deficiency in Papua New Guinea. Archives of Sexual Behavior 17:33-56. Herdt, Gilbert H. and Michele Stephen (eds.) 1989 The Religious Imagination in New Guinea. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press. Herdt, Gilbert H. and Robert J. Stoller 1990 Intimate Communications: Erotics and the Study of Culture. New York: Columbia University Press. Hogbin, Geoffrey R. 1964 A Survey of Indigenous Rubber Producers in the Kerema Bay Area. New Guinea Research Unit Bulletin no. 5. Port Moresby: New Guinea Research Unit.
266
References
Hogbin, H. Ian 1951 Transformation Scene: The Changing Culture of a New Guinea Village. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul. Holmes, John H. 1902 Initiation Ceremonies of the Papua Gulf. Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 32:418-425. 1924 In Primitive New Guinea: An account of a quarter of a century spent amongst the primitive Ipi and Namau groups of tribes of the Gulf of Papua, with an interesting description of their manner of living, their customs and habits, feasts and festivals, totems and cults. London: Seeley Service. Hoggebrugge J. and Simon Kooijman 1977 70 Jaar Asmat Houtsnijkunst. Breda, Netherlands: Volkenkundig Museum Justinus van Nassau; Rijksmuseum voor Volkenkunde. Hope, Penelope 1979 Long Ago is Far Away: Accounts of the Early Exploration and Settlement of the Papuan Gulf Area. Canberra: Australian National University Press. Hopkins, A.I. 1928 In the Isles of King Solomon: Twenty-Five Years among the Primitive Solomon Islanders. London: Seeley, Service and Co. Huber, Mary T. 1988 The Bishops' Progress: A Historical Ethnography of Catholic Missionary Experience on the Sepik Frontier. Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press. Hughes-Freeland, Felicia 1989 Indonesian Image Enhancement. Anthropology Today 5(6):3-5. Humphreys, Clarence Blake 1926 The Southern New Hebrides: An Ethnological Record. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. [Reprint, 1978, New York: AMS Press.] Inglis, John (ed.) 1872 The Slave Trade in the New Hebrides. Edinburgh: Edmonson and Douglas. Ivens, Walter G. 1927 Melanesians of the Southeast Solomon Islands. London: Kegan Paul, Trench, Trubner & Co. 1930 The Island Builders of the Pacific. London: Seeley, Service and Co. James, Wendy 1973 The Anthropologist as Reluctant Imperialist. In Anthropology and the Colonial Encounter. Edited by Talal Asad, pp. 41-69. London: Ithaca Press. Jameson, Frederick 1991 Postmodernism, or, the Cultural Logic of Late Capitalism. Durham, NC: Duke University Press. Jenness, Diamond, and the Rev. A. Ballantyne 1920 The Northern d Entrecasteaux. Oxford: Clarendon Press. [Reprinted, 1970, New York: Johnson Reprint Corp.] Jolly, Margaret 1991 Soaring Hawks and Grounded Persons: The Politics of Rank and Gender in North Vanuatu. In Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Edited by Maurice Godelier and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 48-80. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Josephides, Lisette 1985 The Production of Inequality: Gender and Exchange among the Kewa. New York: Tavistock. Joyce, R.B. 1971 Sir William MacGregor. Melbourne: Oxford University Press. Juillerat, Bernard 1986 Les Enfants du Sang: Societe, Reproduction et Imaginaire en Nouvelle-Guinee. Paris: Editions de la Maison des Sciences de L'Homme.
References
267
1991 Complementarity and Rivalry: Two Contradictory Principles in Yafar Society. In Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Edited by Maurice Godelier and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 130141. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Jukes, J. Beete 1847 Narrative of the Surveying Voyage of the H.M.S. Fly, Commanded by Captain F.P. Blackwood . . . (2 vols.). London. Kaberry, Phyllis M. 1941a The Abelam Tribe, Sepik District, New Guinea: A Preliminary Report. Oceania 11:233-258, 345-367. 1941b Law and Political Organization in the Abelam Tribe, New Guinea. Oceania 12:79-95, 209-225, 331-363. Kahn, Miriam 1986 Always Hungry, Never Greedy: Food and the Expression of Gender in a Melanesian Society. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Kamma, Freerk C. 1972 Koreri Messianic Movements in the Biak-Numfor Culture Area. Translated by M.J. van de Vathorst-Smit. Koninklijk Institut voor Taal-, Land- en Volkenkunde. The Hague: Martinus Nijhoff. Kampen, A. van 1956 Wilkende Wildernis: Onder Kannibalen en ChristenPapoea's. Amsterdam: Uitgeverij C. de Boer, Jr. Keesing, Roger M. 1980 Lightning Meets the West Wind: The Malaita Massacre. New York: Oxford University Press. 1982 Kwaio Religion: The Living and the Dead in a Solomon Island Society. New York: Columbia University Press. Kelly, Raymond C. 1968 Demographic Pressure and Descent Group Structure in the New Guinea Highlands. Oceania 39:36-63. 1976 Witchcraft and Sexual Relations: An Exploration in the Social and Semantic Implications of the Structure of Belief. In Man and Woman in the New Guinea Highlands. Edited by Paula Brown and Georgeda Buchbinder, pp. 36-53. Washington, DC: American Anthropological Association (Special Publication no. 8). 1977 Etoro Social Structure: A Study in Structural Contradiction. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press. 1985 The Nuer Conquest: The Structure and Development of an Expansionist System. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press. 1988 Etoro Suidology: A Reassessment of the Pig's Role in the Prehistory and Comparative Ethnology of New Guinea. In Mountain Papuans: Historical and Comparative Perspectives from New Guinea Fringe Highlands Societies. Edited by James F. Weiner, pp. 111-186. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, n.d. Constructing Inequality: The Fabrication of a Hierarchy of Virtue among the Etoro. (ms.) Kennedy, Raymond [with commentary by Claire Holt] 1944 Applied Anthropology in the Dutch East Indies. Transaction of the New York Academy of Sciences, Series 2, 6(5): 157-166. Kirsch, Stuart 1991 The Yonggom of New Guinea: An Ethnography of Sorcery, Magic, and Ritual. Ph.D. Dissertation, Department of Anthropology, The University of Pennsylvania, Philadelphia. Knauft, Bruce M. 1978 Cargo Cults and Relational Separation. Behavior Science Research 13:185-240.
268
References
1985a Good Company and Violence: Sorcery and Social Action in a Lowland New Guinea Society. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1985b Ritual Form and Permutation in New Guinea: Implications of Symbolic Process for Sociopolitical Evolution. American Ethnologist 12:321-340. 1986 Text and Social Practice: Narrative 'Longing' and Bisexuality among the Gebusi of New Guinea. Ethos 14:252-281. 1987a Review of Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia. American Ethnologist 14:401-404. 1987b Homosexuality In Melanesia. The Journal of Psychoanalytic Anthropology 10:155-191. 1987c Reconsidering Violence in Simple Human Societies: Homicide among the Gebusi of New Guinea. Current Anthropology 28:457-500. 1987d Divergence Between Cultural Success and Reproductive Fitness in Preindustrial Cities. Cultural Anthropology 2:94-114. 1989a Bodily Images in Melanesia: Cultural Substances and Natural Metaphors. In Fragments for a History of the Human Body, Part Three. Edited by Michel Feher, Ramona Nadaff, and Nadia Tazi, pp. 198-279. New York: Urzone. 1989b Imagery, Pronouncement, and the Aesthetics of Reception in Gebusi Spirit Mediumship. In The Religious Imagination in New Guinea. Edited by Gilbert H. Herdt and Michele Stephen, pp. 67-98. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press. 1990a Melanesian Warfare: A Theoretical History. Oceania 60:250-311. 1990b The Question of Homosexuality among the Kiwai of South New Guinea. Journal of Pacific History 25:188-210. 1991 Violence and Sociality in Human Evolution. Current Anthropology 32:391-428. Koch, Klaus-Friedrich 1974 War and Peace in Jalemo: The Management of Conflict in Highland New Guinea. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Konrad, Gunter, Ursula Konrad, and Tobias Schneebaum 1981 Asmat: Life with the Ancestors. Glasshutten, Germany: Friedhelm Bruckner. Kooijman, S. 1959 Population Research Project Among the Marind-anim and Jeei-nan Peoples of Netherlands South New Guinea: Summary of a Report. Nieuw Guinea Studien 3:9-43. Kroef, Justus van der 1952 Some Head-hunting Traditions of Southern New Guinea. American Anthropologist 54:221-235. Kuper, Adam 1983 Anthropology and Anthropologists: The Modern British School. London: Routledge. 1988 The Invention of Primitive Society: Transformations of an Illusion. London: Routledge. Kuruwaip, Abraham 1984 The Asmat Bis Pole: Its Background and Meaning. In An Asmat Sketch Book No. 4. Edited by Frank Trenkenschuh, pp. 11-30. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. Laba, Billai 1975a Waidoro-A Papuan Village in an Era of Change. Part One: The Village and its Neighbours. South Pacific Bulletin (Official Journal of the South Pacific Commission) 25(3):31-37.
References
269
1975b Waidoro-A Papuan Village in an Era of Change. Part Two: The Village Today. South Pacific Bulletin (Official Journal of the South Pacific Commission) 25(4): 15-23. Landtman, Gunnar 1917 The Folk-Tales of the Kiwai Papuans. (Acta Societatis Scientiarum Fennicae, vol. 47.) Helsinki: Finnish Society of Literature. 1927 The Kiwai Papuans of British New Guinea: A Nature-born Instance of Rousseau's Ideal Community. London: Macmillan, [Reprinted, 1970, Johnson Reprint Co.] 1933 Ethnographical Collection from the Kiwai District of British New Guinea in the National Museum of Finland, Helsingfors (Helsinki): A Descriptive Survey of the Material Culture of the Kiwai People. Helsinki: Commission of the Antell Collection. 1954 Initiation Ceremonies of the Kiwai Papuans. In Primitive Heritage. Edited by Margaret Mead and N. Calas, pp. 179-186. London: Victor Gollancz. Langmore, Diane 1972 Goaribari, 1904. Journal of the Papua New Guinea Society 6:53-78. 1974 Tamate—a King: James Chalmers in New Guinea, 1877-1901. Melbourne: Melbourne University Press. 1978 James Chalmers: Missionary. In Papua New Guinea Portraits: The Expatriate Experience. Edited by James Griffin, pp. 1-27. Canberra: Australian National University Press. 1989 Missionary Lives: Papua, 1874-1914. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press. Langness, L.L. 1964 Some Problems in the Conceptualization of Highlands Social Structures. American Anthropologist 66 (pt. 2): 162-182. 1967 Sexual Antagonism in the New Guinea Highlands: A Bena Bena Example. Oceania 37:161-177. 1972 Violence in the New Guinea Highlands. In Collective Violence. Edited by James F. Short and Marvin E. Wolfgang, pp. 171-185. Chicago: Aldine. 1974 Ritual Power and Male Domination in the New Guinea Highlands. Ethos 2:189-212. Laracy, Hugh (ed.) 1983 Pacific Protest: The Maasina Rule Movement, Solomon Islands, 1944-1952. Suva, Fiji: Institute of Pacific Studies. Lavie, Smadar 1990 The Poetics of Military Occupation: Mazeina Allegories of Bedouin Identity Under Israeli and Egyptian Rule. Berkeley: University of California Press. Lawrence, Peter 1964 Road Belong Cargo: A Study of the Cargo Cult in the Southern Madang District, New Guinea. New York: Humanities Press. Lawrence, Peter and Mervyn J. Meggitt 1965 Introduction. In Gods, Ghosts and Men in Melanesia. Edited by Peter Lawrence and Mervyn J. Meggitt, pp. 1-26. Melbourne: Oxford University Press. Layard, John 1942 Stone Men ofMalekula. London: Chatto and Windus. Le Roy Ladurie, Emmanuel 1987 The French Peasantry 1450—1660. (Translated by Alan Sheridan.) Aldershot, England: Scolar. Leach, Edmund R. 1961 Rethinking Anthropology. London: Athlone. Leach, Jerry and Edmund R. Leach (eds.) 1983 The Kula: New Perspectives on Massim Exchange. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
270
References
Leahy, Michael J. 1991 Explorations into Highland New Guinea, 1930-1935. Edited by Douglas E. Jones. Tuscaloosa: University of Alabama Press. Lederman, Rena 1986 What Gifts Engender: Social Relations and Politics in Mendi, Highland Papua New Guinea. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1989 Contested Order: Gender and Society in the Southern New Guinea Highlands. American Ethnologist 16:230-247. 1990 Big Men, Large and Small? Towards a Comparative Perspective. Ethnology 29:3-15. 1991 'Interest' in Exchange: Increment, Equivalence, and the Limits of BigManship. In Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Edited by Maurice Godelier and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 215-233. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Leenhardt, Maurice 1930 Notes d'Ethnologie Neo-Caledonienne. Paris: L'Institut d'Ethnologie, Universite de Paris. 1932 Documents Neo-Caledoniens. Paris: L'Institut d'Ethnologie. 1937 Gens de la Grande Terre. Paris: Gallimard. 1947 Do Kamo: La Personne et le Mythe Dans le Monde Melanesien. Paris: Gallimard. [English translation, 1979, University of Chicago Press.] Lemonnier, Pierre 1991 From Great Men to Big Men: Peace, Substitution, and Competition in the Highlands of New Guinea. In Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Edited by Maurice Godelier and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 7-27. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. LeRoy, John 1985a Kewa Tales. Vancouver: University of British Columbia Press. 1985b Fabricated World: An Interpretation of Kewa Tales. Vancouver: University of British Columbia Press. Lett, Lewis 1935 Knights Errant of Papua. Edinburgh: William Blackwood and Sons. 1949 Sir Hubert Murray of Papua: Statesman and Empire Builder. London and Sydney: Collins. Levi-Strauss, Claude 1960 On Manipulated Sociological Models. Bijdragen totde Taal-, Land- en Volkenkunde 116:45-54. 1964^1971 Mythologiques I-1V. Paris: Plon. 1969 The Elementary Structures of Kinship. (Translated by James H. Bell, John von Sturmer, and Rodney Needham.) Boston: Beacon. [Original, 1949, Paris.] Lewis, Albert B. 1932 Ethnology of Melanesia. Chicago: Field Museum of Natural History. [Reprinted, 1945.] Lewis, Gilbert 1980 Day of Shining Red: An Essay on Understanding Ritual. New York: Cambridge University Press. Liep, John 1991 Great Man, Big Man, Chief: A Triangulation of the Massim. In Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Edited by Maurice Godelier and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 28-47. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Lindenbaum, Shirley 1979 Kuru Sorcery: Disease and Danger in the New Guinea Highlands. Palo Alto, CA: Mayfield.
References
271
1984 Variations on a Sociosexual Theme in Melanesia. In Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia. Edited by Gilbert H. Herdt, pp. 337-361. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1987 The Mystification of Female Labors. In Gender and Kinship: Essays toward a Unified Analysis. Edited by Jane F. Collier and Sylvia J. Yanagisako, pp. 221-243. Stanford: Stanford University Press. Lindstrom, Lamont 1984 Doctor, Lawyer, Wise Man, Priest: Big-Men and Knowledge in Melanesia. Man 19:291-309. 1990 Knowledge and Power. Washington, DC: Smithsonian University Press. Lipset, David M. 1984 Boars' Tusks and Flying Foxes: Authority and Stratification in Murik Society. Paper presented at Wenner-Gren Foundation Symposium, "Sepik Research Today," Basel. 1985 Seafaring Sepiks: Warfare, Prestige, and Change in Murik Trade. Research in Economic Anthropology 1:61-9A. LiPuma, Edward 1988 The Gift of Kinship: Structure and Practice in Maring Social Organization. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Lomnitz-Adler, Claudio 1991 Concepts for the Study of Regional Culture. American Ethnologist 18:195-214. Lutkehaus, Nancy, Christian Kaufmann, William E. Mitchell, Douglas Newton, Lita Osmundsen, and Neinhard Schuster (eds.) 1990 Sepik Heritage: Tradition and Change in Papua New Guinea. Durham, NC: Carolina Academic Press. Luyken, R. 1955 Voeding en Voedingstoestan van de Marind-anim in Zuid Nieuw-Guinea. Medische Bijlage, pp. 1^8. In Rapport van het Bevolkingsonderzoek onder de Marind-anim van Nederlands Zuid Nieuw Guinea. South Pacific Commission, Population Study S-18. Lyons, A.P. 1926 Notes on the Gogodara Tribe of Western Papua. Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 56:329-359. Lyotard, Jean-Frangois 1984 The Postmodern Condition: A Report on Knowledge. (Translated by Geoff Bennington and Brian Massumi.) Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press. Macdonald, D. 1878 The Labour Traffic versus Christianity in the South Sea Islands. Melbourne: Hutchinson. MacGregor, Sir William 1897 British New Guinea: Country and People. London: John Murray. Machlin, Milt 1972 The Search for Michael Rockefeller. New York: G.P. Putnam's Sons. Macnaught, Timothy J. 1982 The Fijian Colonial Experience. Canberra: Research School of Pacific Studies, Australian National University. Maher, Robert F. 1961 New Men of Papua: A Study in Culture Change. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press. 1967 From Cannibal Raid to Copra Kompani: Changing Patterns of Koriki Politics. Ethnology 6:309-331. 1974 Koriki Chieftainship: Hereditary Status and Mana in Papua. Ethnology 13:239-246. 1984 The Purari River Delta Societies, Papua New Guinea, after the Tomi Kabu Movement. Ethnology 23:217-227.
272
References
Mair, Lucy P. 1970 Australia in New Guinea, 2nd edn. Carlton, (Australia): Melbourne University Press. Malinowski, Bronislaw 1922 Argonauts of the Western Pacific: An Account of the Native Enterprise and Adventure in the Archipelagoes of Melanesian New Guinea. [Reprint, 1961, New York: E.P. Dutton.] 1926 Crime and Custom in Savage Society. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul. [Reprint, 1982, Totowa, NJ: Littlefield, Adams and Co.] 1929 The Sexual Lives of Savages in North-Western Melanesia. London: George Routledge and Sons. [Reprint, 1987, Boston: Beacon Press.] 1935 Coral Gardens and Their Magic: A Study of the Methods of Tilling the Soil and of Agricultural Rites in the Trobriand Islands (2 vols.). London: Allen & Unwin. Manganaro, Marc (ed.) 1990 Modernist Anthropology: From Field Work to Text. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press. Marcus, George E. 1990 Some Quotes as Queries Pertaining to Bourdieu's own Scholastic Point of View. Cultural Anthropology 5:392-395. Marcus, George E. and Michael M.J. Fischer 1986 Anthropology as Cultural Critique: An Experimental Moment in the Human Sciences. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Markham, Albert Hastings 1873 The Cruise of the "Rosario" amongst the New Hebrides and Santa Cruz Islands, Exposing the Recent Atrocities with the Kidnapping of Natives of the South Seas, 2nd edn. London: S. Low, Marston, Low and Searle, Dawsons, Folkstone. Maruyama, Magoroh 1963 The Second Cybernetics: Deviation-Amplifying Mutual Causal Processes. American Scientist 51:164-179. Marx, Karl 1964 Economic and Philosophic Manuscripts. New York: International. [Original, 1844.] Marx, Karl and Friedrich Engels 1970 The German Ideology. New York: International. [Original, 1846.] Mauss, Marcel 1967 The Gift. New York: W.W. Norton. [Original, Paris, 1925.] Maybury-Lewis, David 1960 The Analysis of Dual Organization: A Methodological Critique. Bijdragen tot de Taal, Land- en Volkenkunde 116:17-44. Maybury-Lewis, David, and Uri Almagor (eds.) 1989 The Attraction of Opposites: Thought and Society in the Dualistic Mode. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press. Me Arthur, Margaret 1974 Pigs for the Ancestors: A Review Article. Oceania 45:87-123. McArthur, Norma 1955 Demographical Appendix: The Statistical Data Concerning the Fertility of the Marind-anim and the Jeei-nan. In Rapport van het Bevolkingsonderzoek onder de Marind-anim van Nederlands Zuid Nieuw Guinea. South Pacific Commission, Population Study S-18. McDowell, Nancy 1978 Flexibility of Sister Exchange in Bun. Oceania 48:207231. 1988 A Note on Cargo Cults and Cultural Constructions of Change. Pacific Studies n:\2l-\3A. McFalls, Joseph A., Jr. and Marguerite H. McFalls 1984 Disease and Fertility. Orlando: Academic.
References
273
McFarlane, Samuel 1888 Among the Cannibals of New Guinea, Being the Story of the New Guinea Mission of the London Missionary Society. Philadelphia: Presbyterian Board of Publication. McGowan, John 1991 Postmodernism and its Critics. Ithica, NY: Cornell University Press. McKinley Robert, 1976 Human and Proud of It! A Structural Treatment of Headhunting Rites and the Social Definition of Enemies. In Studies in Borneo Societies: Social Process and Anthropological Explanation. Edited by G.N. Appell, pp. 92-145. Special Report no. 12, Center for Southeast Asian Studies, Northern Illinois University. McLaren, Jack 1923 My Odyssey. London: Ernest Benn Ltd. Mead, Margaret 1930 Growing Up in New Guinea: A Comparative Study of Primitive Education. New York: Blue Ribbon. 1935 Sex and Temperament in Three Primitive Societies. New York: William Morrow. [Reprint, 1963, New York: Dell.] Meeker, Michael E., Kathleen Barlow, and David M. Lipset 1986 Culture, Exchange, and Gender: Lessons from the Murik. Cultural Anthropology 1:6-73. Meggitt, Mervyn J. 1965 The Lineage System of the Mae-Enga of New Guinea. Edinburgh: Oliver and Boyd. 1973 The Sun and the Shakers: A Millenarian Cult and its Transformation in the New Guinea Highlands. Oceania 44:1-37, 109-126. 1974 'Pigs are our Hearts!': The Te Exchange Cycle among the Mae Enga of New Guinea. Oceania 44:165-203. 1977 Blood Is Their Argument: Warfare among the Mae Enga Tribesmen of the New Guinea Highlands. Palo Alto, CA: Mayfield. Meigs, Anna S. 1984 Food, Sex, and Pollution: A New Guinea Religion. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press. Miedema, Jelle 1984 De Kabar 1855-1980: Sociale Structuur en Religie in de Vogelkop van West-Nieuw-Guinea. (Verhandelingen van het Koninklijk Instituut voor Taal-, Land- en Volkenkunde, no. 155). Dordrecht: Foris Publications. 1988a War and Exchange: The Bird's Head of Irian Jaya in a Historical and Structural Comparative Perspective. Paper presented at the meetings of the Association for Social Anthropology in Oceania, San Antonio, Texas. 1988b Anthropology, Demography and History: Shortage of Women, Intertribal Marriage Relations and Slave Trading in the Bird's Head of New Guinea. Bijdragen tot de Taal-, Land- en Volkenkunde 144:494-509. Miklouho-Maclay, Nikolai 1874 On the Political and Social Position of the Papuans of the Papua Kowiai Coast on the Southwestern Shore of New Guinea. (Memorandum presented in 1874 to the Governor-General of the Netherlands Indies.) In Travels to New Guinea: Diaries, Letters, Documents. Edited by D. Tumarkin, translated by S. Mikhailov, pp. 439-444. Moscow, USSR: Progress Publishers, 1982. 1881 Notes In Re Kidnapping and Slavery in the Western Pacific. In Travels to New Guinea: Diaries, Letters, Documents. Edited by D.
274
References
Tumarkin, translated by S. Mikhailov, pp. 461^71. Moscow, USSR: Progress Publishers, 1982. Militaire Exploratie 1920 Verslag van de Militaire Exploratie van NederlandschNieuw-Guinea, 1907-1915. Weltevreden: Landsdrukkerij. Miller, Charles 1950 Cannibal Caravan. London: Methuen. Milman, Hugh 1888 Report from Deputy Commissioner Hugh Milman. British New Guinea Colonial Office; Report of the Special Commissioner for 1887, Appendix D. London: Government Printer. 1889 Deputy Commissioner Hugh Milman to the Special Commissioner. British New Guinea Colonial Office; Report of the Special Commissioner for 1888, Appendix C. London: Government Printer. Minh-ha, Trinh T. 1990 Woman, Native, Other. Bloomington: University of Indiana Press. Monbiot, George 1989 Poisoned Arrows: An Investigative Journey through Indonesia. London: Michael Joseph. Moore, David R. 1984 The Torres Strait Collections of A.C. Haddon: A Descriptive Catalogue. London: British Museum Press. Moraes-Gorecki, Vanda 1983 Notes on the Ownership and Utilization of Sago, and on Social Change, among the Moveavi-Toaripi of the Papuan Gulf. Oceania 53:233-241. Morauta, Louise and Dawn Ryan 1982 From Temporary to Permanent Townsmen: Migrants from the Malalaua District, Papua New Guinea. Oceania 53:39-55. Moresby, John (Captain) 1876a Discoveries and Surveys in New Guinea and the D'Entrecasteaux Islands: A Cruise in Polynesia and Visits to the PearlShelling Stations in Torres Straits of H.M.S. Basilisk. London: John Murray. 1876b Our Duty to New Guinea and Polynesia. In Discoveries and Surveys in New Guinea and the D'Entrecasteaux Islands. By John Moresby, pp. 295-305. London: John Murray. Mraz, Louis 1978 Mbai of Atsj. In An Asmat Sketch Book no. 6. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 84-85. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. Mucha, Janusz 1988 Malinowski and Contemporary Civilization. In Malinowski Between Two Worlds: The Polish Roots of an Anthropological Tradition. Edited by Roy Ellen, Ernest Gellner, Grazyna Kubica, and Janusz Mucha, pp. 149-163. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Munn, Nancy D. 1969 The Effectiveness of Symbols in Murngin Rite and Myth. In Forms of Symbolic Action. (Proceedings of the American Ethnological Society.) Edited by R. Spencer. Seattle: American Ethnological Society/ University of Washington Press. 1970 The Transformation of Subjects into Objects in Walbiri and Pitjantjara Myth. In Australian Aboriginal Anthropology. Edited by Ronald M. Berndt, pp. 141-163. Nedlands: University of Western Australian Press. 1986 The Fame of Gawa: A Symbolic Study of Value Transformation in a Massim (Papua New Guinea) Society. New York: Cambridge University Press. Murray, J. Hubert P. 1912 Papua or British New Guinea. London: T. Fisher Unwin.
References
275
Needham, Rodney 1976 Skulls and Causality. Man 11:71-88. Nelson, Hank 1976 Black, White, and Gold: Goldmining in Papua New Guinea, 1878-1930. Canberra: Australian National University Press. 1982 Taim Bilong Masta: The Australian Involvement with Papua New Guinea. Sydney: Australian Broadcasting Commission. Nevermann, H. 1939 Die Kanum-irebe und ihre Nachbarn. Zeitschrift fiir
EthnologielYAii. Newman, Philip L. and David J. Boyd 1982 The Making of Men: Ritual and Meaning in Awa Male Initiation. In Rituals of Manhood: Male Initiation in Papua New Guinea. Edited by Gilbert H. Herdt, pp. 239-285. Berkeley: University of California Press. O'Brien, Denise and Anton Ploeg 1964 Acculturation Movements among the Western Dani. American Anthropologist 66 (4, no. 2):281-292. (Special Publication New Guinea: The Central Highlands, edited by James B. Watson.) Ohtsuka, Ryutaro 1977a Time-Space Use of the Papuans Depending on Sago and Game. In Human Activity Systems: Its Spatiotemporal Structure. Edited by H. Watanabe, pp. 41-59. Tokyo: University of Tokyo Press. 1977b The Sago Eaters: An Ecological Discussion with Special Reference to the Oriomo Papuans. In Sunda and Sahul: Prehistoric Studies in Southeast Asia, Melanesia and Australia. Edited by J. Allen, J. Golson, and R. Jones, pp. 465^92. London: Academic Press. 1983 Oriomo Papuans: Ecology of Sago-Eaters in Lowland Papua. Tokyo: University of Tokyo Press. Oliver, Douglas L. 1955 A Solomon Island Society: Kinship and Leadership among the Siuai of Bougainville. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Oosterwal, Gottfried 1961 People of the Tor: A Cultural-Anthropological Study on the Tribes of the Tor Territory (Northern Netherlands New-Guinea). Assen: Van Gorcum. 1967 Muremarew: A Dual Organized Village on the Mamberamo, West Irian. In Villages in Indonesia. Edited by R.M. Koentjaraningrat. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press. Ortner, Sherry B. 1984 Theory in Anthropology Since the Sixties. Comparative Studies in Society and History 26:126-166. 1989 High Religion: A Cultural and Political History of Sherpa Buddhism. Princeton: Princeton University Press. 1990a Gender Hegemonies. Cultural Critique 14:35-80. 1990b Patterns of History: Cultural Schemas in the Founding of Sherpa Religious Institutions. In Culture Through Time: Anthropological Approaches. Edited by Emiko Ohnuki-Tierney, pp. 57-93. Stanford: Stanford University Press. Ortner, Sherry B. and Harriet Whitehead 1981 Introduction: Accounting for Sexual Meanings. In Sexual Meanings: The Cultural Construction of Gender and Sexuality. Edited by Sherry B. Ortner and Harriet Whitehead, pp. 1-27. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Palmer, George 1871 Kidnapping in the South Seas: Being a Narrative of a Three Month's Cruise of H.M. Ship "Rosario." Edinburgh.
276
References
Parnaby, Owen W. 1964 Britain and the Labor Trade in the Southwest Pacific. Durham, NC: Duke University Press. Paton, John G. 1907 John G. Paton, Missionary to the New Hebrides: An Autobiography. Chicago: Fleming H. Revell. Paton, Rank H.L. 1913 Slavery under the British Flag. Melbourne: Brown Prior. Ploeg, Anton 1969 Government in Wanggulam. Verhandelingen Van Het Koninklijk Instituut voor Taal-, Land- en Volkenkunde 57. The Hague. 1987 Review of Jan van Baal's Ontglipt Verleden /, 1986. Journal de la Societe des Oceanistes 85:266-268. 1988 Legacies of an Unknown Past. Bijdragen Tot de Taal-, Land- en Volkenkunde 144:510-522. 1991 A Colonial Governor in Dutch New Guinea. Review of Jan van Baal's Ontglipt Verleden 1,11 (1986,1989). Journal of Pacific History 26:363-366. Pomponio, Alice 1992 Seagulls Don't Fly Into the Bush: Cultural Identity and Development in Melanesia. Belmont, CA: Wadsworth. Poole, Fitz John Porter 1981 Transforming "Natural" Woman: Female Ritual Leaders and Gender Ideology among Bimin-Kiskusmin. In Sexual Meanings: The Cultural Construction of Gender and Sexuality. Edited by Sherry B. Ortner and Harriet Whitehead, pp. 116-165. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Pospisil, Leopold 1958 Kapauku Papuans and Their Law. Yale University Publications in Anthropology, no. 54. New Haven, CT: Yale University Press. 1963 Kapauku Papuan Economy. Yale University Publications in Anthropology, no. 67. New Haven, CT: Yale University Press. Poster, Mark 1990 The Mode of Information: Postmodernism and Social Context. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Pouwer, Jan 1955 Enkele Aspecten Van De Mimika-Cultuur (Nederlands Zuidwest Nieuw Guinea). The Hague: Staatsdrukkerij- en Uitgeversbedrijf. 1956 A Masquerade in Mimika. Antiquity and Survival 1:373-387. 1975 Structural History: A New Guinea Case Study. In Explorations in the Anthropology of Religion: Essays in Honour of Jan Van Baal. Edited by W.E.A. van Beek and J.H. Scherer, pp. 80-112. The Hague: Martinus Nijhoff. 1991 Mimika. In Encyclopedia of World Cultures, Vol. 2: Oceania. Edited by Terence E. Hays, pp. 206-208. Boston: G.K. Hall. Pratt, A.E. 1906 Two Years Among New Guinea Cannibals. Philadelphia: J.B. Lippincott. Quiggin, A. Hingston 1942 Haddon the Head Hunter: A Short Sketch of the Life ofA.C. Haddon. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Rappaport, Roy A. 1984 Pigs for the Ancestors: Ritual in the Ecology of a New Guinea People, 2nd enlarged edn. New Haven, CT: Yale University Press. [1st edn., 1968.] Rawling, C.G. (Captain) 1913 The Land of the New Guinea Pygmies. London: Seeley, Service and Co. Ray, Sidney H. 1907 Reports of the Cambridge Anthropological Expedition to
References
277
Torres Strait, Vol. 3: Linguistics. Edited by A.C. Haddon. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Read, Kenneth E. 1959 Leadership and Consensus in a New Guinea Society. American Anthropologist 61:425-^O6. 1965 The High Valley. New York: Scribners. Reay, Marie O. 1959 The Kuma: Freedom and Conformity in the New Guinea Highlands. Melbourne: Melbourne University Press. 1977 Ritual Madness Observed: A Discarded Pattern of Fate in Papua New Guinea. Journal of Pacific History 12:55-79. Redlich, Edwin 1876 Gale wo Strait and Salwatti Islands [off Vogelkop Peninsula]. In Discoveries and Surveys in New Guinea and the D'Entrecasteaux Islands, by John Moresby, pp. 318-321. London: John Murray. Reiter, R. (ed.) 1975 Toward an Anthropology of Women. New York: Monthly Review Press. Renselaar, H.C. and R.L. Mellema 1956 Asmat Zuidwest Nieuw Guinea. Koninkluk Instituut voor de Tropen: Afdeling Culturele en Physische Anthropologieno. 55. Amsterdam: N.V. Drukkerij Sigfried. Riley, E. Baxter 1923 Dorro Head-Hunters. Man 23 (18):33-35. 1925 Among Papuan Headhunters: An account of the manners & customs of the old Fly River headhunters, with a description of the secrets of the initiation ceremonies divulged by those who have passed through all the different orders of the craft, by one who has spent many years in their midst. Philadelphia: J.B. Lippincott. [Reprinted, 1982, New York: AMS Press.] Rivers, W.H.R. 1914 The History of Melanesian Society (2 vols.). Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1922 (ed.) Essays on the Depopulation of Melanesia. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Rockefeller, Michael C. and Adrian A. Gerbrands 1967 The Asmat of New Guinea: The Journal of Michael Clark Rockefeller. New York: Museum of Primitive Art. Rosaldo, Michelle Z. 1980 Knowledge and Passion: Ilongot Conceptions of Self and Social Life. New York: Cambridge University Press. Rosaldo, Michelle Z. and Louise Lamphere (eds.) 1974 Women, Culture, and Society. Stanford: Stanford University Press. Rosaldo, Renato 1980 Ilongot Headhunting, 1883-1974: A Study in Society and History. Stanford: Stanford University Press. 1989 Culture and Truth: The Remaking ofSocial Analysis. Boston: Beacon. Roseberry, William 1989 Anthropologies and Histories: Essays in Culture, History, and Political Economy. New Brunswick, NJ: Rutgers University Press. Ruddle, Kenneth, Dennis Johnson, Patricia K. Townsend, and John D. Rees 1978 Palm Sago: A Tropical Starch from Marginal Lands. Honolulu: EastWest Center/University Press of Hawaii. Runciman, W.G. 1978 Introduction to "The Foundations of Social Theory". In Max Weber: Selections in Translation. Edited by W.G. Runciman, pp. 3-6. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Ryan, Dawn 1965 Social Change among the Toaripi of Papua. M.A. Thesis, Department of Anthropology, University of Sydney, Australia.
278
References
1969 Christianity, Cargo Cults, and Politics among the Toaripi of Papua. Oceania 40:99-118. Sacks, Karen 1979 Sisters and Wives: The Past and Future of Sexual Equality. Westport, CT: Greenwood. Sahlins, Marshall D. 1963 Poor Man, Rich Man, Big-Man, Chief: Political Types in Melanesia and Polynesia. Comparative Studies in Society and History 5:285-303. 1976 Culture and Practical Reason. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. 1981 Historical Metaphors and Mythical Realities: Structure in the Early History of the Sandwich Islands Kingdom. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press. 1983 Other Times, Other Customs: The Anthropology of History. American Anthropologist 85:517-544. 1985 Islands of History. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. 1990 The Return of the Event, Again; With Reflections on the Beginnings of the Great Fijian War of 1843 to 1855 between the Kingdoms of Bau and Rewa. In Clio in Oceania: Toward a Historical Anthropology. Edited by Aletta Biersack, pp. 37-99. Washington, DC: Smithsonian Institution Press. Said, Edward 1978 Orientalism. New York: Pantheon. Salisbury, Richard F. 1962 From Stone to Steel. Melbourne: Melbourne University Press. 1970 Vunamami. Berkeley: University of California Press. Sanday, Peggy R. 1981 Female Power and Male Dominance: On the Origins of Sexual Inequality. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Saville, William J.V. 1926 In Unknown New Guinea: A Record of Twenty-Five Years of Personal Observation and Experience Amongst the Interesting People of an Almost Unknown Part of this Vast Island . . . Philadelphia: J.B. Lippincott. Scarr, Deryk 1967 Recruits and Recruiters: A Portrait of the Pacific Islands Labour Trade. Journal of Pacific History 2:5-24. Scheffler, Harold W. 1966 Ancestor Worship in Anthropology: Or, Observations on Descent and Descent Groups. Current Anthropology 7:541-551. Schiefenhovel, Wulf 1990 Ritualized Adult-Male/Adolescent-Male Sexual Behavior in Melanesia: An Anthropological and Ethological Perspective. In Pedophilia: Biosocial Dimensions. Edited by Jay R. Feierman, pp. 394-421. New York: Springer-Verlag. Schieffelin, Bambi B. 1990 The Give and Take of Everyday Life: Language Socialization ofKaluli Children. New York: Cambridge University Press. Schieffelin, Edward L. 1976 The Sorrow of the Lonely and the Burning of the Dancers. New York: St. Martin's Press. Schieffelin, Edward L. and Robert Crittenden 1991 Like People You See in a Dream: First Contact in Six Papuan Societies. Stanford: Stanford University Press. Schlegel, Alice (ed.) 1977 Sexual Stratification. New York: Columbia University Press. Schneebaum, Tobias 1980 The Basu-Suangkus Feast. In An Asmat Sketch Book
References
279
No. 7. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 68-79. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. 1985 Asmat Images: From the Collection of the Asmat Museum of Culture and Progress. Minneapolis: Crosier Missions. 1988 Where the Spirits Dwell: An Odyssey in the New Guinea Jungle. New York: Grove Weidenfeld. 1990 Embodied Spirits: Ritual Carvings of the Asmat. Salem, MA: Peabody Museum of Salem. Schoorl, J.W. 1957 Kultuur en Kultuurveranderingen in het Moejoe-gebied. The Hague: Voorhoeve. 1970 Muyu Land Tenure. New Guinea Research Bulletin No. 38. Boroko and Canberra: New Guinea Research Unit and the Australian National University. 1976 Shell Capitalism among the Muyu People. Irian 5(3):3-72. 1978 Salvation Movements among the Muyu of Irian Jaya. Irian 7(l):3-35. 1988 Mobility and Migration in Muyu Culture. Bijdragen tot de Taal-, Landen Volkenkunde 144:540-556. 1991 Muyu. In Encyclopedia of World Cultures, Vol. 2: Oceania. Edited by Terence E. Hays, pp. 227-230. Boston: G.K. Hall. Schwartz, Theodore 1962 The Paliau Movement in the Admiralty Islands, 1946-1954. Anthropological Papers of the American Museum of Natural History 49, pt. 2. New York. 1963 Systems of Areal Integration: Some Considerations Based on the Admiralty Islands of Northern Melanesia. Anthropological Forum 1:56-97. 1975 Cultural Totemism: Ethnic Identity, Primitive and Modern. In Ethnic Identity: Cultural Continuities and Change. Edited by George DeVos and Lola Romanucci-Ross, pp. 106-131. Palo Alto, CA: Mayfield. Schwimmer, Erik [Eric] 1973 Exchange in the Social Structure of the Orokaiva. New York: St. Martin's Press. 1977 Introduction: F.E. Williams as Ancestor and Rain-Maker. In 'The Vailala Madness' and Other Essays, by Francis Edgar Williams. Edited by Erik Schwimmer, pp. 11^7. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press. 1991 How Oro Province Societies Fit Godelier's Model. In Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Edited by Maurice Godelier and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 142-155. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Sedgwick, Eve K. 1990 Epistemology of the Closet. Berkeley: University of California Press. Seidman, Steven 1989 Constructing Sex as a Domain of Pleasure and SelfExpression: Sexual Ideology in the Sixties. Theory, Culture, and Society 6:293-315. 1991 Romantic Longings: Love in America, 1830-1980. New York: Routledge. Seligman[n], Charles G. 1910 The Melanesians of British New Guinea. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Serpenti, Laurent M. 1968 Headhunting and Magic on Kolepom (FrederikHendrik Island, Irian Barat). Tropical Man 1:116-139.
280
References
1969 On the Social Significance of an Intoxicant. Tropical Man 2:31^4. 1972-1973 Ndambu, the Feast of Competitive Giving. Tropical Man 5:162187. 1977 Cultivators in the Swamps, [2ndprinting], Assen, The Netherlands: Van Gorcum. [Original, 1965.] 1984 The Ritual Meaning of Homosexuality and Pedophilia among the KimamPapuans of South Irian Jay a. In Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia. Edited by Gilbert H. Herdt, pp. 292-336. Berkeley: University of California Press. Sewell, William H., Jr. 1989 Toward a Theory of Structure: Duality, Agency, and Transformation. Comparative Study of Social Transformations, Working Paper no. 29. The University of Michigan, Ann Arbor. Sexton Lorraine 1986 Mothers of Money, Daughters of Coffee: The Wok Meri Movement. Ann Arbor, MI: UMI Research Press. Shaw, R. Daniel 1990 Kandila: Samo Ceremonial and Interpersonal Relationships. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press. Shore, Bradd 1988 Interpretation Under Fire. Anthropological Quarterly 61:161— 176. Sillitoe,Paul 1977 Land Shortage and War in New Guinea. Ethnology 16:71-81. Skinner, G. William 1985 The Structure of Chinese History. Journal of Asian Studies 44:271-292. Smith, Carol A. 1976 (ed.) Regional Analysis (2 vols.). New York: Academic. 1984 Local History in Global Context: Social and Economic Transitions in Western Guatamala. Comparative Studies in Society and History 26:193-228. S0rum, Arve 1984 Growth and Decay: Bedamini Notions of Sexuality. In Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia. Edited by Gilbert H. Herdt, pp. 337-361. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1989 The Forked Branch: A Study of Meaning in Bedamini Ceremonial. University of Oslo, Norway. Souter, Gavin 1963 New Guinea: The Last Unknown. Sydney: Angus and Robertson. South Pacific Commission 1952-53 Marind-anim Report: An Investigation into the Medical and Social Causes of the Depopulation amongst the Marindanim. Microfilm no. WP14, The Western Pacific Archives, Government House Grounds, Suva, Fiji. [This ms. is a partial translation and partial elaboration of South Pacific Commission 1955, below, but is dated 19521953.] 1955 Rapport van het Bevolkingsonderzoek onder de Marind-anim van Nederlands ZuidNieuw Guinea. South Pacific Commission, Population Study S-18 Project. Sowada, Alphonse (Msgr.) 1961 Socio-Economic Survey of the Asmat Peoples of Southwestern New Guinea. M.A. Thesis, Department of Anthropology, Catholic University of America, Washington, DC. 1980a Ayam Revolt. In An Asmat Sketch Book No. 7. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 5-51. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. 1980b The Epic of Beorpitsj. In An Asmat Sketch Book No. 7. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 82-85. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions.
References
281
1990 Primary Asmat Religious and Philosophical Concepts. In Embodied Spirits: Ritual Carvings of the Asmat. By Tobias Schneebaum, pp. 65-70. Salem, MA: Peabody Museum of Salem. Specht, Jim and John Fields 1984 Frank Hurley in Papua: Photographs of the 1920-1923 Expeditions. Bathurst, Australia: Robert Brown and Associates/ Australian Museum Trust. Stanner, William E.H. 1979 White Man Got No Dreaming: Essays 1938-1973. Canberra: Australian National University Press. Steel, Robert 1880 The New Hebrides and Christian Missions, with a Sketch of the Labour Trade. London: Nisbet. Steinbauer, Friedrich 1979 Melanesian Cargo Cults: New Salvation Movements in the South Pacific. (Translated by Max Wohlwill.) St. Lucia: University of Queensland Press. Stocking, George W., Jr. 1984 Radcliffe-Brown and British Social Anthropology. In Functionalism Historicized: Essays on British Social Anthropology. Edited by G.W. Stocking, Jr., pp. 131-191. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press. 1987 Victorian Anthropology. New York: Free Press. Stoller, Robert J. and Gilbert H. Herdt 1985a The Development of Masculinity: A Cross-Cultural Contribution. In Presentations of Gender, by Robert J. Stoller, pp. 181-199. New Haven: Yale University Press. 1985b Theories of Origins of Male Homosexuality: A Cross-cultural Look. In Observing the Erotic Imagination, by Robert J. Stoller, pp. 104-134. New Haven: Yale University Press. Strachan, John (Captain) 1888 Explorations and Adventures in New Guinea. London: Sampson Low, Marston, Searle, and Rivington. Strathern, Andrew J. 1969 Finance and Production: Two Strategies in New Guinea Highlands Exchange Systems. Oceania 40:42-67. 1970-1971 Cargo and Inflation in Mount Hagen. Oceania 41:255-265. 1971 The Rope of Moka: Big Men and Ceremonial Exchange in Mount Hagen, New Guinea. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1972 One Father, One Blood: Descent and Group Structure among the Melpa People. London: Tavistock. 1977 Contemporary Warfare in the New Guinea Highlands: Breakdown or Revival? Yagl-Ambu 4:135-146. 1982a Two Waves of African Models in the New Guinea Highlands. In Inequality in New Guinea Highlands Societies. Edited by Andrew J. Strathern, pp. 35-49. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1982b Witchcraft, Greed, Cannibalism, and Death: Some Related Themes from the New Guinea Highlands. In Death and the Regeneration of Life. Edited by Maurice Bloch and Jonathan Parry, pp. 111-133. New York: Cambridge University Press. 1982 (ed.) Inequality in New Guinea Highland Societies. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1984^4 Line of Power. London: Tavistock. 1990 Which Way to the Boundary? American Ethnologist 17:376-383. Strathern, Marilyn 1972 Women in Between: Female Roles in a Male World, Mount Hagen, New Guinea. London: Seminar Press.
282
References
1988 The Gender of the Gift: Problems with Women and Problems with Society in Melanesia. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1990 Negative Strategies in Melanesia. In Localizing Strategies: Regional Traditions of Ethnographic Writing. Edited by Richard Fardon, pp. 204216. Washington DC: Smithsonian Institution Press. 1991 Introduction. In Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Edited by Maurice Godelier and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 1-4. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Strauss, Hermann [with Herbert Tischner] 1990 The Mi-Culture of the Mount Hagen People, Papua New Guinea. Translated by Brian Shields. Edited by Gabriele Sturzenhofecker and Andrew J. Strathern. (Ethnology Monographs no. 13.) Pittsburgh: University of Pittsburgh, Department of Anthropology. [Original, 1962.] Sturzenhofecker, Gabriele 1990 Introduction. In The Mi-Culture of the Mount Hagen People, Papua New Guinea, by Hermann Strauss. Translated by Brian Shields, edited by Gabriele Sturzenhofecker and Andrew J. Strathern. (Ethnology Monographs no. 13.) Pittsburgh: University of Pittsburgh, Department of Anthropology. Taussig, Michael 1987 Shamanism, Colonialism, and the Wild Man: A Study in Terror and Healing. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Thomas, Nicholas 1989a The Force of Ethnology: Origins and Significance of the Melanesia/Polynesia Division. Current Anthropology 30:27-41. 1989b Material Culture and Colonial Power: Ethnological Collecting and the Establishment of Colonial Rule in Fiji. Man 24:41-56. 1989c Out of Time: History and Evolution in Anthropological Discourse. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1990a Partial Texts: Representation, Colonialism and Agency in Pacific History. Journal of Pacific History 25:139-158. 1990b Sanitation and Seeing: The Creation of State Power in Early Colonial Fiji. Comparative Studies in Society and History 32:149-170. 1991 Entangled Objects: Exchange, Material Culture, and Colonialism in the Pacific. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Thompson, Anne-Gabrielle 1984 The Uses and Misuses of Capital: New Caledonia's Mining Industry, 1870-1901. Journal of Pacific History 19:6686. Thurnwald, B.R. 1916 Banaro Society: Social Organization and Kinship System of a Tribe in the Interior of New Guinea. American Anthropological Association Memoirs 3:253-391. Trenkenschuh, Frank A. (Father) 1982a An Outline of Asmat History in Perspective. In An Asmat Sketch Book No. 2. Edited by Frank Trenkenschuh, pp. 25-38. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. 1982b Asmat Sago Gathering Practices. In An Asmat Sketch Book No. 1. Edited by Frank Trenkenschuh, pp. 45-54. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. 1982c Some Additional Notes on Zegwaard from a 1970 Vantage. In An Asmat Sketch Book No. 1. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 31-44. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions.
References
283
1982d The Asmat People of the Casuarina Coast. In An Asmat Sketch Book No. 1. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 55-59. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. 1982e Cargo Cult in Asmat: Examples and Prospects. In An Asmat Sketch Book No. 2. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 59-65. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. 1982f The Ayam Revolt, April 1981: A Report and Analysis. In An Asmat Sketch Book No. 8. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 95-120. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. Trompf, Gary W. 1991 Melanesian Religion. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Tuzin, Donald F. 1972 Yam Symbolism in the Sepik: An Interpretive Account. Southwestern Journal of Anthropology 28:230-254. 1976 The Ilahita Arapesh: Dimensions of Unity. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1980 The Voice of the Tambaran: Truth and Illusion in Ilahita Arapesh Religion. Berkeley: University of California Press. Tyler, Stephen 1990 The Unspeakable: Discourse, Dialogue, and Rhetoric in the Postmodern World. Madison: University of Wisconsin Press. Urry, James 1972 Notes and Queries on Anthropology and the Development of Field Methods in British Anthropology, 1870-1920. Proceedings of the Royal Anthropological Institute for 1972, pp. 45-57. London: Royal Anthropological Institute. 1982 From Zoology to Ethnology: A.C. Haddon's Conversion to Anthropology, 1890-1900. Canberra Anthropology 5:58-85. 1984 A History of Field Methods. In Ethnographic Research: A Guide to General Conduct. Edited by Roy F. Ellen, pp. 35-61. London: Academic. Urry, John 1991 Time and Space in Giddens' Social Theory. In Giddens' Theory of Structuration: A Critical Appreciation. Edited by Christopher G.A. Bryant and David Jary, pp. 160-175. London: Routledge. Vertenten, P. 1923 Het Koppensnellen in Zuid-Nieuw-Guinea. Bijdragen tot de Taal, Land- en Volkenkunde 79:45ff. Vicedom, G.F. and H. Tischner 1943-1948 Die Mbowamb: Die Kultur der Hagenberg-stamme im Ostlichen Zentral-Neuguiney. Museum fur Volkerkunde und Voreschichte, Monographien zur Volkerkunde (3 vols.). Hamburg: Friederichsen, de Gruyter and Co. Vining, Daniel R., Jr. 1986 Social versus Reproductive Success: The Central Theoretical Problem of Human Sociobiology. Behavioral and Brain Sciences 9:167-216. Vogel, L.D. and John Richens 1989 Donovanosis in Dutch South New Guinea: History, Evolution of the Epidemic and Control. Papua New Guinea Medical Journal 32:203-218. Wagner, Roy 1967 The Curse of Souw: Principles of Daribi Clan Definition and Alliance in New Guinea. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. 1972 Habu: The Innovation of Meaning in Daribi Religion. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. 1977 Analogic Kinship: A Daribi Example. American Ethnologist 4:623-642.
284
References
1978 Lethal Speech: Daribi Myth as Symbolic Obviation. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press. 1983 The Ends of Innocence: Conception and Seduction among the Daribi of Karimui and the Barok of New Ireland. Mankind 14:75-83. 1986 Asiwinarong: Ethos, Image, and Social Power among the Usen Barok of New Ireland. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press. 1991 The Fractal Person. In Big Men and Great Men: Personifications of Power in Melanesia. Edited by Maurice Godelier and Marilyn Strathern, pp. 159-173. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Wallerstein, Immanuel 1974 Capitalist Agriculture and the Origins of the European World-Economy in the Sixteenth Century. New York: Academic. 1979 The Capitalist World-Economy. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1980 Mercantilism and the Consolidation of the European World Economy, 1600-1750. New York: Academic. 1989 The Second Great Era of Great Expansion of the Capitalist World Economy, 1730-1840s. San Diego: Academic. 1991 Geopolitics and Geoculture: Essays on the Changing World-System. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Watson, James B. 1971 Tairora: The Politics of Despotism in a Small Society. In Politics in New Guinea. Edited by Ronald M. Berndt and Peter Lawrence. Nedlands: University of Western Australia Press. Watson-Gegeo, Karen Ann and Geoffrey M. White (eds.) 1990 Disentangling: Conflict Discourse in Pacific Societies. Stanford: Stanford University Press. Weber, Max 1958 The Protestant Ethic and the Spirit of Capitalism. (Translated by Talcott Parsons.) New York: Charles Scribners' Sons [Original, 19041905]. 1978 Economy and Society: An Outline of Interpretive Sociology (2 vols.). Edited by Guenther Roth and Claus Wittich. Translated from the 4th German edn. Berkeley: University of California Press. [Original, J.C.B. Mohr,edn.,1956.] Weiner, Annette B. 1976 Women of Value, Men of Renown: New Perspectives in Trobriand Exchange. Austin: University of Texas Press. Weiner, James F. 1982 Substance, Siblingship and Exchange: Aspects of Social Structure in New Guinea. Social Analysis 11:3-34. 1988a The Heart of the Pearls hell: The Mythological Dimension of Foi Sociality. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1988b Durkheim and the Papuan Male Cult: Whitehead's views on Social Structure and Ritual in New Guinea. American Ethnologist 15:567-573. 1988 (ed.) Mountain Papuans: Historical and Comparative Perspectives from New Guinea Fringe Highlands Societies. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press. Weitzman, Marc 1985 Nouvelle-Caledonie: Un Siecle de Balles Perdues. [With the collaboration of Jean Guiart and Jean Chesneaux.] Paris: Vertige. West, Francis 1968 Hubert Murray: The Australian Pro-Consul. Melbourne: Oxford University Press. White, Geoffrey and Lamont Lindstrom (eds.) 1989 The Pacific Theater: Island
References
285
Representations of World War II. Honolulu: Center for Pacific Islands Study/University of Hawaii Press. Whitehead, Harriet 1985 Review of Ritualized Homosexuality in Melanesia, edited by Gilbert H. Herdt. Journal of Homosexuality 11:201-205. 1986 The Varieties of Fertility Cultism in New Guinea: Parts I and II. American Ethnologist 13:80-99, 271-289. Whiteman, Daryl L. 1983 Melanesians and Missionaries: An Ethnohistorical Study of Social And Religious Change in the Southwest Pacific. Pasadena, CA: William Carey. Whyte, Martin K. 1978 The Status of Women in Preindustrial Societies. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press. Williams, Francis E. 1923a The Vailala Madness and the Destruction of Native Ceremonies in the Gulf Division. Papuan Anthropology Reports no. 4. Port Moresby. [Reprinted in Schwimmer 1977.] 1923b The Pairama Ceremony in the Purari Delta, Papua. Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 59:379-397. 1924 The Natives of the Purari Delta. Territory of Papua, Anthropology Report no. 5. Port Moresby: Government Printer. 1930 Orokaiva Society. Oxford: Oxford University Press. 1934 The Vailala Madness in Retrospect. In Essays Presented to C.G. Seligman. Edited by E.E. Evans-Pritchard et at., pp. 369-379. [Reprinted in Schwimmer 1977.] 1935a Some Effects of European Influence on the Natives of Papua. Australian and New Zealand Association for the Advancement of Science, Report of the 22nd Meeting, pp. 215—222. Melbourne. 1935b The Blending of Cultures: An Essay on the Aims of Native Education. Territory of Papua Anthropology Report No. 16. Port Moresby: Government Printer. 1936 Papuans of the Trans-Fly. Oxford: Clarendon Press. 1939a Seclusion and Age Grouping in the Gulf of Papua. Oceania 9:359381. 1939b The Kaiamunu-Ebiha-Gi Cult in Papua. Man 39 (50):48. 1939c A Cycle of Ceremonies in Orokolo Bay. Mankind 2:145-155. 1940 Drama of Orokolo: The Social and Ceremonial Life of the Elema. Oxford: Clarendon Press. 1977a F.E. Williams' Account of his Study in Europe. In Francis Edgar Williams: 'The Vailala Madness' and Other Essays. By F.E. Williams, edited with an introduction by Erik Schwimmer, pp. 419^421. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press. 1977b Bull-roarers in the Papuan Gulf. In Francis Edgar Williams: 'The Vailala Madness7 and Other Essays. By F.E. Williams, edited with an introduction by Erik Schwimmer, pp. 73-122. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press. [Original, 1936.] 1977c Trading Voyages from the Gulf of Papua. In Francis Edgar Williams: 'The Vailala Madness' and Other Essays. By F.E. Williams, edited with an introduction by Erik Schwimmer, pp. 48-72. Honolulu: University of Hawaii Press.
286
References
Williamson, Robert W. 1912 The Mafulu, Mountain People of British New Guinea. London: Macmillan. Wirz, Paul 1922-1925 Die Marind-anim von Hollandisch-Sud-Neu-Guinea, I-IV (2 vols.). Hamburg: Friederichsen. (Hamburgische Universitat, Abhandlungen aus dem Gebiet der Auslandskund, Band 10 and 16 [Reihe B, Band 6 and 9].) 1928 Damonen und Wilde in Neuguinea. Stuttgart: Strecker und Schroder. 1933 Head-hunting Expeditions of the Tugeri into the Western Division of British New Guinea. Tijdschrift voor Indische Taal, -Land -en Volkenkunde 73: 105-122. 1934a Die Gemeinde der Gogodara. Nova Guinea 16(4):371-490. 1934b Beitrage zur Ethnographie des Papua-Golfes, Britisch-Neuguinea. Abhandlungen und Berichte der Museenfiir Tierkunde und Volkerkunde zu Dresden 19:1-103. 1937 The Kaiamunu-Ebiha-Gi-Cult in the Delta-Region and Western Division of Papua. Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland 67:407^13. Wolf, Eric 1982 Europe and the People Without History. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1988 Inventing Society. American Ethnologist 15:752-761. Wollaston, A.F.R. 1912 Pygmies and Papuans. London: Smith, Elder, and Co. Wood, Michael 1982 Kamula Social Structure and Ritual. Ph.D. Dissertation. Department of Behavioral Sciences. MacQuarrie University, N.S.W. Australia. 1987 Brideservice Societies and the Kamula. Canberra Anthropology 10:1-23. Woodford, Charles M. 1890 A Naturalist among the Head-hunters: Being an Account of Three Visits to the Solomon Islands, 1886, 1887, 1888. London: George Philip and Son. Worsley, Peter 1968 The Trumpet Shall Sound, 2ndedn. New York: Schocken. Wurm, Stephen A. and Shiro Hattori (eds.) 1981 Language Atlas of the Pacific Area. (Pacific Linguistics Series C, no. 66.) Canberra: Australian Academy of Humanities/Japanese Academy. Young, Michael W. 1971 Fighting with Food: Leadership, Values and Social Control in a Massim Society. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 1983 Magicians of Manumanua: Living Myth in Kalauna. Berkeley: University of California Press. 1988 Malinowski among the Magi: Editor's Introduction. In Malinowski among the Magi: 'The Natives of Mailu'. By Bronislaw Malinowski, edited by Michael W. Young, pp. 1-76. London: Routledge. Zegwaard, Gerard A. 1953 Bevolkingsgegevens van de Asmatters. Hollandia: Bureau for Native Affairs. 1954 Een Bis-Paal iut Sjuru: Legende en Ritueel op Nieuw-Guinea. Nederlands Nieuw-Guinea 2(1): 11-13. 1959 Headhunting Practices of the Asmat of West New Guinea. American Anthropologist 61:1020-1041. 1978 1953 Data on the Asmat People. (Translation of Zegwaard [1953] by M. van Roosmalen and F. Trenkenschuh.) An Asmat Sketch Book No. 6.
References
287
Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 15-31. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. 1982 An Asmat Mission History. (A Translation by Joseph de Louw of "De Missie Geschiedenis Asmat Missie") An Asmat Sketch Book No. 2. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 5-15. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions. Zegwaard, Gerard A. and J.H.M.C. Boelaars 1955 De Sociale Structuur van de Asmat-bevolking. Adatrechtbundel 45:244-302. 1982 Social Structure of the Asmat People. [Annotated translation by Frank A. Trenkenschuh and J. Hoggebrugge of "De Sociale Structuur van de Asmat-bevolking."] In An Asmat Sketch Book No. 1. Edited by Frank A. Trenkenschuh, pp. 13-29. Hastings, NE: Crosier Missions.
Index
Adam, Barry D., 56, 239nll Akerlund,M.,165 Alder, William F., 95-96, 242nl2, 248n6 Aldrich, Robert, 20 Allen, Michael R., 23,123, 250nl Amelsvoort, V. F. P. M. van, 190, 228 Angan area, 212 Appadurai, Arjun, 8, 45, 124 Armstrong, Wallace E., 240n24, 241n8 Arsdale, Kathleen O. van, 250nll Arsdale, Peter W. van, 35, 66, 100-101, 190,251nllnl3 Asad,Talal, 19, 238n4 Asmat, 188-95 cannibalism, 107 fertility cult, 72-74, 190-192, 249nll gift exchange 80-82, 245n8 headhunting, 188-195 history, 34-35 homosexuality, 228-237 leadership, 71-74, 189-190, 250nl2 ritual heterosexuality, 53, 101, 189, 229233,235 social organization 190-193, 250nl4 subsistence, 66, 74 women's status, 99-101, 193 Austen, Leo, 249n7 Australian aboriginal dreamtime, 137, 185 Ayres, Mary C , 36, 76,105,185-188, 243n22, 249n9nlO Baal, Jan van,84,94-97, ch. 8,204-205, 222,247n2 Dema as text, 33-34, 241nl0nll see also Marind-anim Barnes, J. A., 112, 240n28 Barrau, Jacques, 63-64 Barth, Fredrik, x, 22-23, 206, 209, 247n5 Barton, F. R.,88,110,251n7 Bateson, Gregory, 21,183, 213, 217, 232 Battaglia, Debbora, 240n29, 246n2, 249n2, 250n2 Beardmore, Edward, 47, 241n9 Beaver, Wilfred N., 27-29, 38-39, 90-91, 184-185,196-200 Bedamini,55,57,61,244nl Beek, Albert Gosewijn van, 242n20 Bell, Alan P., 58 Belshaw, Cyril S., 240n24 Bennett, Judith A., 19
Bergmann, Frithjof, 240n28 Berndt, Ronald M., 22,216,238n9,251n9 Bevan, Theodore F., 222-223,241n2 Big Men and Great Men, 79-80,117-123, 246nl birds-of-paradise, 25,34 Blackwood, Beatrice, 240n24 Bloch,Marc,37,238nl BNG Annual reports, 25 Boazi, 38,61,159,242nl9,248n8 Bodrogi,Tibor,240n25 Boelaars, J. H. M. C., 49,95,239nl8, 242nl8,243n3 Bone, Robert C , 32-33 Bonnemere, Pascale, 214 Boon, James A., 3 Boserup, Ester, 243n5 Bourdieu, Pierre critique of, 10-13,133,239nl5 practice theory of, 5-6,9,132,247ch7nl reflexive awareness of, 17,123,129,238n8 Bowden, Ross, 213 Braudel, Fernand, 37,218,238nl British New Guinea, 19,27-31 Bromilow, William E., 239nl8 Brookfield, Harold C., 62-64,238n9 Brown, D.J.J., 183 Brown, George, 239nl8 Brown, Herbert A., 215,242nl5 Brown, Paula, 22-23,223,238n9 Brunton,Ron,119,122 Bryant, Christopher G. A., 238n5 Buckley, Thomas, 124 Bureau for Native Affairs, 112,190 Burke, Peter, 238nl Burridge, Kenelm O. L., 240n25 Busse, Mark, 49,242nl9,248n8 Butcher, Benjamin T., 25,65,67,92 Butler, Judith, 58,239nl2 cannibalism, 107 by Asmat, 107 byKiwai,197,250nl9 by Kolopom, 179-180 by Marind-anim, 157 by Purari, 174 by Trans-Fly peoples, 197 Cantrell, Eileen M., 53,93,242n20,246n8 cargo cults,205,224,240n25,251nl2-13 Carrier, AchsahH., 119,241n29
Index Carrier, James G., x, 119, 239nl6, 240n29 Carstenz, Jan, 31 Chalmers, James, 25-28, 30, 239nl8 chaos theory, 226 Chowning, Ann, 118, 246nl Clammer, John, 240n23 Clark, John, 238n5 Clay, Brenda J., 118, 240n29 Clifford, James, 3, 238n2 Cochrane, Glynn, 28, 36, 204-205, 242nl5, 251nl3 Codrington, R. H., 18,239nl8 Cohen, G. A., 14 Collier, Jane F., 119 colonial administration, 19-20, 28-30, 33-34 Comaroff, Jean, 239nl4 Connell, John, 20 Connolly, B., 222-223 Cook, James (Captain), 25, 32 copra, 28 Corns, Peter, 241n4 Craig, Barry, 23 Crawford, Anthony L., 222, 242nl8 Creed, Gerald W., 55 Crosier Missions, 35, 36, 237 D'Albertis, Luigi M., 27, 241n2 D'Amato,J.,213 Damon, Frederick H., 23, 240n29, 250n2 Dani, 215 Daribi, 213 Dam, 28,200 Davenport, William H., 55 de Certeau, Michel, 6, 238n7 de Josselin de Jong, P. E., 20-21, 241nll de Lepervanche, Marie, 122, 240n28 Deacon, A. Bernard, 240n23 Dening, Greg, 238n7 dialectics, 131-134 Digul River area, 157,178 Docker, Edward W., 241n4 Dongen, W. an, 35 Donham, Donald L., x, 10,12,14, 209 Douglas, Bronwen, 118, 246nl Dover, Kenneth, J., 47 Drabbe,P.,74 dual organization 183, 207, 220 see also social organization Dundes, Alan, 47 Dupeyrat, Andrew, 239nl8 Durham, William H., 170 Durkheim, Emile, 30, 207 Dwyer, Peter, xi, 50n, 242n20 East Bay, 55, 57 economic development, 28 failure of, 25-29, 32, 224
289
in highland New Guinea, 223-224 Eggan,Fred, 124 Elema fertility cult, 201-203,206 gift exchange, 69-70,203-205 headhunting, 215 history, 26-28 leadership, 70,203 mythology, 204,206 ritual heterosexuality, 215 social organization, 204 subsistence, 64 warfare, 81n, 205 women's status, 97-99 Ellen, Roy F., 20 Ernst, Thomas M., 54,161,169,242n20, 247nl Errington, Frederick, 241n29,246n6,250n2 Eschenbach,D.,165 ethnic totemism, 135 Etoro, 61, 111, 244nl, 246n8 evolutionary perspectives, 225 exploration, 27,223,241n2 Eyde, David B., xi, 35,39,78,81,99-101, 189-193,249nll on Asmat homosexuality, 228,230,236237 on Asmat social organization, 71-74,112, 250nl4 Fardon, Richard, 4 Feil,DarylK. acknowledgment of, x, 55 on homosexual societies, 8,45-46,60-61, 86,106 on New Guinea highlands, 23,113,122123,246n4 Feld, Steven,22,242n20 Feuchtwang, Stephan, 19,240n22 fertility cult of Asmat, 72-74,190-192,249nll of Elema, 201-203,206 ofKiwai, 195-197,199 of Kolopom, 178-181 of Marind-anim, 147-154 of Purari, 174-175 of Trans-Fly peoples, 185-187 firearms, 32,223 Firth, Raymond, 21 Firth, Stewart, 20,26,241n4 Fischer, Michael M. J., 238n2 Fison, Lorimar, 239nl9 Flint, L. A., 65,92 Fortune, Reo F., 240n24 Foucault, Michel, 6,9,239nl2 Fox, Charles E.,240n24 Frazer, James G., 30 Freund.PaulJ..49
290
Index
Friedl, Ernestine, 243n5 Friedman, Jonathan, 14, 240n28 Gajdusek, D. Carleton, 231, 237 Galis,K. W.,26,32 Gebusi, 54, 57, 61, 93,183, 245nl, 246n8 Gell, Alfred, 22 geography, 25,37,218-220 German New Guinea, 18, 20 Gesch, Patrick F., 22, 241n29 Geertz, Clifford, 130 Gewertz, Deborah, 23,193, 213, 241n29, 246n6, 251n5 Giddens, Anthony, 5,11-13,15,132, 238n5n6,239nl5 Gietzelt, Dale, 36 gift exchange, 67-79 complex versus restricted, 60-61, 80-83, 121 Gillison, Gillian, 212 Glasse, Robert M., 22, 238n9 Goaribari Island, 27, 250nl9 Godelier, Maurice, 79-80,118-121,246nl Gogodala, 38, 55,197, 222, 242nl8 Goldman, Irving, 117,125 Gordon, Robert, 224 Gratton, Nancy E., 243n21 Great Men; see Big Men and Great Men Greek homosexuality, 58 Greenberg, David F., 56, 239nll Gregory, Derek, 238n6 Griffin, James, 19,27 Griffiths, Deidre J. F., 30 Gudeman, Stephen, 238n2 Guiart, Jean, 20, 240n23 Guppy, Henry B., 19 Haddon, Alfred C , 89,174,184,199, 241nl,242nl8 academic influence of, 7,17-18, 29-31 Hallpike, Christopher R., 251 Halperin, David M., 47, 57 Harker, Richard, 11-12, 238n8 Harris, David R., 65,188 Harris, Marvin, 132,183 Harrison, Simon, x, 22,161, 213, 241n29 Harrisson, Tom, 21, 240n23 Hastings, Peter, 242nl2 Hays, Terence E., 22, 216, 240n26, 242nl8 acknowledgment of, x, 50n headhunting, 25, 241n3 absence among Elema, 215 by Asmat, 188-195 by Kiwai, 196-197, 200-201 byKolopom, 179,182 byMarind-anim, 139-140,154-159, 251n6 by Purari, 174-175
by Trans-Fly peoples, 184 regional comparisons, 213-214,219-220 Hefner, Robert W.,239nl3 hegemony, 239nl4 Heider, Karl G., 215,238n9,251nlO Held, David, 238n5 Held, G. Jan, 20,26,239nl8 Hempenstall, Peter J., 20,26 Herdt, Gilbert H.,240n25 acknowledgment of, x, 55 on ritualized homosexuality, 8-9,45-48, 54-60,86,244n6 Hogbin, Geoffrey R., 242nl6,251nll Hogbin,H.Ian,240n24 Hoggebrugge, J., 242nl4 Holmes, John H., 30,81n, 88,204-205, 239nl8 homosexuality male, 8-9,45,55-59,228-37 female, 54,243n3 see also ritual homosexuality Hope, Penelope, 27-28,205,222,241n6 Hopkins, A. I., 239nl8,240n24 Huber,MaryT.,241n29 Hughes-Freeland, Felicia, 36 Humphreys, Clarence B., 240n24 Iatmul,213,232 idealtypes,121,122,246n3 Inglis,John,240nl9 Ivens, Walter G., 239nl8,240n24 James, Wendy, 240n22 Jameson, Frederic, 238n3 Jaquai,38,61,95,230,242nl8,243 Jenness, Diamond, 30,240n24 Jolly, Margaret, 246n2 Josephides, Lisette, 243n5 Joyce, R.B., 19 judgments of value, 131 Juillerat, Bernard, 22,246n2,251n4 Jukes, J.Beete,241n2 Kaberry, Phyllis M., 240n24 Kahn, Miriam, 240n29 Kamma, Freerk C., 240n25 Kamoro, 47-49,101,236-237,244nl history, 26,32,34 Kampen, A. van, 53,81-82,100,189 Kamula, 38,242nl9,243n3 Keesing, Roger M., 240n25,241n29,250n2 Kelly, Raymond C., x, 64,119,246nl3 on Etoro,23,111,242n20,249nl onNuer,14,133 Kennedy, Raymond, 20 Keraki, see Trans-Fly peoples Kerema,27 Kikori, 27-28
Index Kimaam, see Kolopom Kirsch, Stuart, 34, 38, 49,112, 242nl9 acknowledgment of, x-xi, 50n Kiwai, 195-201 cannibalism, 197, 250nl9 fertility cult, 195-197,199 gift exchange, 67-68 headhunting, 196-197, 200-201 leadership, 67-69,197 ritual heterosexuality, 52, 89-90, 92,195 social organization, 197-201 subsistence, 64-66 women's status, 68, 89-93 Knauft, Bruce M. on areal premutation, 41, 207 on Gebusi, 22, 54,183, 212, 242n20 on Melanesian history, 17, 239nl6, 244n7 on Melanesian sexuality, 47,169, 210 on warfare, 125,194, 224, 251n9 Koch, Klaus-Friedrich, 216, 251n9 Kolopom, 178-184 cannibalism, 179-180 fertility cult, 178-81 gift exchange and leadership, 74-76, 178, 181-182 headhunting, 179,182 predation of, 159 ritual heterosexuality, 52,101-103,179180 ritual homosexuality, 180 social organization, 178,181-183 subsistence, 62-63, 66, 178 women's status, 78n, 101-103, 182-183 Komolom, 159 Konrad, Gunter, 113,190,194, 231, 234, 249nll Kroef, Justus van der, 77, 241n3 Kuper, Adam, 17-18,129 Kuruwaip, Abraham, 53, 99,189, 191, 250nl2 Laba, Billai, xi, 36, 50n, 64, 188, 251nll labor trade, 28, 241n4 failure of, 26-27 Landtman, Gunnar as academician, 29-31 Kiwai ethnography of; see Kiwai Langmore, Diane, 17, 26-29, 223 Langness, L. L., 107, 223, 240n28, 251n9 Laracy, Hugh, 240n25 Lavie, Smadar, 238n2 Lawrence, Peter, 61, 117, 211, 238n9, 240n25 Layard, John, 240n24 Leach, Edmund R., 23, 118,121, 212, 240n29 Leach, Jerry, 23,118, 212, 240n29
291
leadership, 67-81,118,175-176,187-190, 197,204 Leahy, Michael J., 223 Lederman, Rena, 113,238n9,246n2,250nl Leenhardt, Maurice, 20-21,239nl8, 240n23 Lemonnier, Pierre, 246n2 Lenormand, Maurice, 20 LeRoy,John22 Le Roy Ladurie, Emmanuel, 238nl Lett, Lewis, 19,27,222 Levi-Strauss, Claude, 41,83,134,207,214 Lewis, Albert B., 18,239nl7 Lewis, Gilbert, 22 Liep, John, 123,246n2 Lindenbaum, Shirley acknowledgment of, x, 55 on ritual homosexuality, 45-46,53-55, 60-61,86,235,244n2 Lindstrom, Lamont, 123,241n29,246nl linguistic areas, 37-39 ritual homosexuality and, 62 Lipset, David M., 213 LiPuma, Edward, 118,249n2,250nl Lomnitz-Adler, Claudio, 3,124 London Mission Society, 26-29 Lutkehaus, Nancy, 23,241n29,251n5 Luyken,R.,66 Lyons, A. P.,242nl8 Lyotard, Jean-Frangois, 238n3 Me Arthur, Margaret, 240n28 McArthur, Norma, 163-164,248nl4 Macdonald,D.,240nl9 Mcdowell, Nancy, 93,240n25,245n2 McFalls, Joseph A., Jr., 165-166 McFarlane, Samuel, 214n5 McGowan, John, 238n3 MacGregor, Sir William, 19,27,156 Machlin,Milt,35 McKinley, Robert, 214,251n8 McLaren, Jack, 25,28-29 Macnaught, Timothy J., 240n23 Maher, Robert F. Purari ethnography of, see Purari Mair,LucyP.,28 Malay traders, 26,32 Malinowski, Bronislaw, 18-19,21,31, 240n22 Manganaro, Marc, 4 Marcus, George E., 3,238n2 Marett,R. R.,30 Marind-anim, 136-171 cannibalism, 157 cultural expansion, 160-161 dema-spihts, 136-138 demography and fertility, 161-167 ethnic sub-groups, 140-141
292
Index
fertility cults, 147-154 gift exchange and leadership, 76-78 headhunting, 139-140,154-159,251n6 mythology, 141-147 political decentralization, 160 ritual heterosexuality, 52, 95-96,148, 163-167, 246n5,247n6 ritual homosexuality, 143,149,152-154 sister-exchange, 93-95, 244nl, 245n3 social organization, 138-139, 246nll, 247n2 subsistence, 63-64, 66 Upper BianMarind, 141,159,168 women's status, 93-97,160 Markham, Albert H., 240nl9 marriage, see sister-exchange; social organization; women's status Maruyama, Magoroh, 169 Marx, Karl, 14,132 Marxism, 238n2 see also political economy Massim, 19, 23, 26, 204, 211, 214 Mauss, Marcel, 21 Maybury-Lewis, David, 83,183 Mead, Margaret, 21, 246n6 Meeker, Michael E., 213-214 Meggitt, Mervyn J., 61,117, 211 on Mae Enga, 22,122, 224, 238n9, 251nl2 Meigs, AnnaS., 22, 212 Merauke, 33-34, 36, 247n3 Miedema, Jelle, 32 Miklouho-Maclay, Nikolai, 26, 32, 239nl9 military exploration, 20 Miller, Charles, 248n6 Milman, Hugh, 241nl Mimika, 26, 34-35,193,236,244nl Minh-ha, Trinh T., 239nl2 missionaries, 29 anthropology and, 17-18, 30, 239nl8 Monbiot, George, 36, 25In 11 Moore, David R., 241n7 Moraes-Gorecki, Vanda, 242nl6 Morauta, Louise, 36, 242nl6 Moresby, John (Captain), 27, 239nl9 Motu,29,66,88,110,251n7 Mountain Ok, 206 Mraz, Louis, 189 Mucha, Janusz, 240n22 Munn, Nancy D., 133,137, 212, 240n29, 249n2 Murray, J. Hubert P., 19, 29, 240n21, 241n6 Muyu, 38, see also Yonggom "Namau", 39, 242n21, see also Purari Needham, Rodney, 214 Nelson, Hank, 27, 223
Nevermann, H., 158 New Caledonia, 20,118,122 New Guinea highlands ethnography of, 22-23,85,238n9 socioecology, 218 regional comparison with, 7,83,211 warfare in, 221-224 Newman, Philip L., 216,232 objectivism, 129-132 O'Brien, Denise, 251nl2 Ohtsuka, Ryutaro, 36,63,66,78n, 243n22, 251nll Oliver, Douglas L., 27,240n24 Onabasulu,54,57,96 Oosterwal, Gottfried, 232,239nl8 Orokolo, see Elema Ortner, Sherry B., x, 5,10-13,109,116, 132,239nl4,243n5 pacification, 221-223 Palmer, George, 240nl9 Parnaby, Owen W., 27 Paton,JohnG.,240nl9 Paton, Rank H. L., 240nl9 pelvic inflammatory disease, 165-166 pigs, 64,84,195,201-203 Ploeg, Anton, xi, 22,33,123,238n9,251nl2 political economy, 3-4,12,238n2 Polynesia, 117-118 Pomponio, Alice, 240n29 Poole, Fitz John Porter, 232 Port Moresby, 27 Pospisil, Leopold, 22,238n9 Poster, Mark, 238n3 postmodernism, 3-4,9,130,226-227, 238n3 Pouwer, Jan, 35 Kamoro ethnography of, see Kamoro Practice theories, 5,6,10-14,132-134 Pratt, A. E., 33 Purari, 173-178 fertility cult, 174-175 gift exchange, 70-71 headhunting, 174—175 leadership, 176 marriage, 71 ritual heterosexuality, 52,87-88,175 social organization, 173-174 subsistence, 65-66,173 women's status, 87-89,175 Quiggin, A. Hingston, 17,241 Rappaport, Roy A., 22,238n9,250nl, 251nlO Rawling, C. G. (Captain), 242nl2 Ray, Sidney H.,249n8
Index Read, Kenneth E., 223, 238n9 Reay, Marie O., 22, 238n9, 251nl2 Redlich, Edwin, 26 reification, 122-123 Reiter, R.,243n5 Renselaar, H. C , 74,191, 242nl3 Richens, John, 248nl6 Reily, E. Baxter, 30, 93,196-197, 239nlO, 249n7 ritual heterosexuality, 51-55 among Asmat, 53,101,189, 229-233, 235 among Kiwai, 52, 89-90, 92,195 among Kolopom, 52,102-103,179-180 among Marind-anim, 52, 95-96, 148, 163-167, 246n5,247n6 among Purari, 52, 87-88,175 among Trans-Fly peoples, 52,187 suppression by missionaries, 221-222, 231-234 ritual homosexuality, 8-9, 45-51, 54-61, 242n20, 244n7 among Casuarina coast Asmat, 232-237 among Kolopom, 180 among Marind-anim, 143,149,152-154 among Trans-Fly peoples, 187 evidence for central Asmat, 228-232, 236-237 women's status and, 86,106-107 Rivers, W.H.R., 18,21 Rockefeller, Michael C , 36, 73-74, 242nl4 Rosaldo, Michelle Z., 214 Rosaldo, Renato, 214, 238n2 Roseberry, William, 14 Rouku, 29 Ruddle, Kenneth, 37, 62 Runciman, W. G., 246n3 Ryan, Dawn, 36, 242nl6 Sacks, Karen, 243n5 Sahlins, Marshall D. on Big Men, 117-120,123, 246nl on structure and event, 5,10-15, 41, 132-133,218 Said, Edward, 19 Salisbury, Richard F., 22, 119, 238n9 Sambia, 57-58, 244n7 Sanday, Peggy R., 86, 243n5, 246nlO Saville, William J. V., 240n24 Scarr, Deryk, 241n4 Scheffler, Hardold W., 240n28 Schiefenhovel, Wulf, 46, 243nl Schieffelin, Bambi B., 242n20 Schieffelin, Edward L., 7, 22, 29, 242n20 Schlegel, Alice, 243n5 Schneebaum, Tobias, xi, 35, 66,190, 228237,249nll Schoorl,J. W.,38,112
293
Schwartz, Theodore, 134,240n25,246nl Schwimmer, Erik [Eric], 30,112,183, 246n2,249n2 Sedgwick, Eve K., 58,239nl2 Seidman, Steven, 56,239nll Seligman[n], Charles G., 239nl7 Sepik,62,193 regional analysis of 23,213-214,220 Serpenti, Laurent M., 34,39,245nll Kolopom ethnography of, see Kolopom Sewell, William H., Jr., 13 Sexton, Lorraine, 244n5 sexuality, see ritual heterosexuality and ritual homosexuality Shaw, R. Daniel, 22,50,242n20 Shore, Bradd, 10,134 Sillitoe,Paul,240n28 sister-exchange, 61,244nl among Kiwai, 93 among Kolopom, 102,181-183 among Kamoro, 244nl among Marind-anim, 93-95,244nl, 245ch5n3 among Trans-Fly peoples, 104,187 women's status and, 107 Skinner, G. William, 238n4 slave-raiding, 32 Smith, Carol A., 238n4,239nl3 social inequality, 130-131,135,209 social organization, 219-220 Asmat, 190-193,250nl4 Elema,204 Kiwai, 197-201 Kolopom, 178,181-183 Marind-anim, 138-139,246nll, 247n2 Purari, 173-174 Trans-Fly peoples, 187 women's status and, 111-114 sociobiology critique of, 169-171 sociocultural formations, 14-16,134,226227 sociocultural permutations, 40-41,207 Solomon Islands, 19 S0rum, Arve, 54,212,242n20,244nl Souter, Gavin, 20,31,33,242nl2 South Pacific Commission depopulation report, 52,163-165,248nll Sowada, Alphonse (Msgr.), 35,53,188, 245n9,250nll Specht,Jim,245n7 Speiser, Felix, 20 spice trade, 32 Steel, Robert, 240nl9 Steinbauer, Friedrich, 240n25 Stocking, George W., Jr. ,7,17,129 Stoller, Robert J., 56-57,244n6n7 Strachan, John (Captain), 32,156,184,
294
Index
241n2 Strathern, Andrew J., x, 125,183, 222-224, 246nl on Melpa, 22,113, 238n9, 251nl2 Strathern, Marilyn, 113,118, 214, 216, 247n5 on Melpa, 22, 238n9, 243n5 Strauss, Hermann, 238n9, 239nl8, 250nl Strickland-Bosavi area, 212, 242nl9 structure, 14 Sturzenhofecker, Gabriele, 239n9 subjectivism, 133 subsistence, 62-67, 218-220 female status and, 108-109 ritual homosexuality and, 61 Taussig, Michael, 4, 21, 238n2 Thomas, Nicholas, 82,118,125, 238n7, 240n23 Thompson, Anne-Gabrielle, 20 Thurnwald, B. Richard, 20, 213, 232 Tomkins, Oliver, 27 Torres Strait, 28,184,201 Trans-Fly peoples, 184-188 cannibalism, 197 fertility cult, 185-187 political economy, 76,187 headhunting, 184 predationof, 156-157,160-161, 184-185,222,249 ritual sexuality, 52,187 subsistence, 64-66,188 women's status, 103-105 Trenkenschuh, Frank A. (Father) on Asmat, 35, 71, 99-100, 229-230, 232, 235-236, 251nl3 Trompf, Gary W., 240 Tuzin, Donald F., 22,110,183, 213, 215 Tyler, Stephen, 10, 238n2 typology, 121 Urry, James, 7,17,29-30 Urry, John, 238n6 Verschueren, Jan, 33,163, 248nl2 Vertenten, P.,161 Vicedom, G. F.,239nl8 Vining, Daniel R., Jr., 170 Vogel, L. D., 33, 52,162, 222, 248nl6 Wagner, Roy, 7, 22,113,118,120, 213, 240n29 Wallerstein, Immanuel, 132, 238n4 warfare in highland New Guinea, 221-222 in south coast New Guinea, see headhunting regional contrasts in, 221-223
women's status and, 107 Watson, James B., 223,251n9 Watson-Gegeo, Karen A., 241n9 Weber, Max, 11,14-15,121,126,130-133, 246n3 Weiner, Annette B., 91,212,243n5,249n2 Weiner, James F.,x, 112-113,118,243n21, 249n2,251n5 Weitzman,Marc,20 Welsch, Robert acknowledgment of, xi, 50n, 240n20 West, Francis, 19,240n21 White, Geoffrey, 241n29 Whitehead, Harriet acknowledgment of, x, 55,109,116 on fertility cultism, 54,86,111,113-114, 119-120,246nl2 on south New Guinea sexuality, 46,61, 244n7,244n2 Whiteman, Daryl L., 17-18 Whyte, Martin K., 108,114,243n5 Williams, Francis E. as ethnographer, 7,30-31,36,84, 204-205 ethnography of, see Elema; Purari; and Trans-Fly peoples Williamson, Robert W., 240n24,241n8 Wirz, Paul as ethnographer, 20,30,33-34,55, 242nl8 ethnography of, see Gogodala and Marind-anim Wolf, Eric, 3,26,121,132,238n4 Wollaston,A.F.R.,242nl2 women's status, 86-116,160,175,182-183, 193 comparative assessment of, 105-106,114 definition of, 86,115 social organization and, 111-114 subsistence and, 108-109 women's initiation and, 92,96-97 Wood, Michael, 38,119,242nl9,243n3 Woodford, Charles M., 19 Worsley, Peter, 28,205,240n25,251nl3 Wurm, Stephen A., 25,39,48,61-62,185, 242n21 Yei, 157-158,248nl2 Yonggom,38,112,242nl9 Young, Michael W., 17,118,183,215, 240n29,250n2 Zegwaard, Gerard A. as ethnographer, 34-35,230 Asmat ethnography of, 52,71,80-82, 99-100,188-195,229-230,233, 242nl3,245n6,249n4,250nl4
Cambridge Studies in Social and Cultural Anthropology Editors: Ernest Gellner, Jack Goody, Stephen Gudeman, Michael Herzfeld, Jonathan Parry
11 Rethinking Symbolism* DAN SPERBER. Translated by Alice L. Morton 15 World Conqueror and World Renouncer: A Study of Buddhism and Polity in Thailand against a Historical Background* S.J. TAMBIAH
16 Outline of a Theory of Practice * PIERRE BOURDIEU. Translated by Richard Nice 17 Production and Reproduction: A Comparative Study of the Domestic Domain* JACK GOODY
27 Day of Shining Red: An Essay on Understanding Ritual* GILBERT LEWIS
28 Hunters, Pastoralists and Ranchers: Reindeer Economies and their Transformations * TIM INGOLD
32 Muslim Society* ERNEST GELLNER
36 Dravidian Kinship THOMAS R. TRAUTMANN
39 The Fish-People: Linguistic Exogamy and Tukanoan Identity in Northwest Amazonia JEAN E. JACKSON
41 Ecology and Exchange in the Andes Edited by DAVID LEHMANN
42 Traders without Trade: Responses to Trade in Two Dyula Communities ROBERT LAUNAY
45 Actions, Norms and Representations: Foundations of Anthropological Inquiry* LADISLAV HOLY AND MILAN STUCKLIK
46 Structural Models in Anthropology* PER HAGE AND FRANK HARARY
47 Servants of the Goddess: The Priests of a South Indian Temple C.J. FULLER
296
Series list
49 The Buddhist Saints of the Forest and the Cult of Amulets: A Study in Charisma, Hagiography, Sectarianism, and Millennial Buddhism*' S.J. TAMBIAH
51 Individual and Society in Guiana: A Comparative Study of Amerindian Social Organizations* PETER RIVIERE
53 Inequality among Brothers: Class and Kinship in South China RUBIE S. WATSON
54 On Anthropological Knowledge DAN SPERBER
55 Tales of the Yanomami: Daily Life in the Venezuelan Forest* JACQUES LIZOT. Translated by Ernest Simon 56 The Making of Great Men: Male Domination and Power among the New Guinea Baruya* MAURICE GODELIER. Translated by Ruper Swyer 57 Age Class Systems: Social Institutions and Politics Based on Age* BERNARDO BERNARDI. Translated by David I. Kertzer 58 Strategies and Norms in a Changing Matrilineal Society: Descent, Succession and Inheritance among the Toka of Zambia LADISLAV HOLY
59 Native Lords of Quito in the Age of the Incas: The Political Economy of North-Andean Chiefdoms FRANK SALOMON
60 Culture and Class in Anthropology and History: A Newfoundland Illustration* GERALD SIDER
61 From Blessing to Violence: History and Ideology in the Circumcision Ritual of the Merina of Madagascar* MAURICE BLOCH
62 The Huh Response to Illness STEPHEN FRANKEL
63 Social Inequality in a Northern Portuguese Hamlet: Land, Late Marriage, and Bastardy, 1870-1978 BRIAN JUAN O'NEILL
64 Cosmologies in the Making: A Generative Approach to Cultural Variation in Inner New Guinea* FREDRIK BARTH
65 Kinship and Class in the West Indies: A Genealogical Study of Jamaica and Guyana* RAYMOND T. SMITH
66 The Making of the Basque Nation MARIANNE HEIBERG
67 Out of Time: History and Evolution in Anthropological Discourse NICHOLAS THOMAS
68 Tradition as Truth and Communication PASCAL BOYER
Series list
297
69 The Abandoned Narcotic: Kava and Cultural Instability in Melanesia RON BRUNTON
70 The Anthropology of Numbers * THOMAS CRUMP
71 Stealing People's Names: History and Politics in a Sepik River Cosmology SIMON J. HARRISON
72 The Bedouin of Cyrenaica: Studies in Personal and Corporate Power EMRYS L. PETERS. Edited by Jack Goody and Emanuel Marx 73 Bartered Brides: Politics, Gender and Marriage in an Afghan Tribal Society NANCY TAPPER
74 Property, Production and Family in Neckerhausen* DAVID WARREN SABEAN
75 Fifteen Generations of Bretons: Kinship and Society in Lower Brittany, 1720-1980 MARTINE SEGALEN. Translated by J. A. Underwood
76 Honor and Grace in Anthropology Edited by J.G. PERISTIANY and JULIAN PITT-RIVERS
77 The Making of the Modern Greek Family: Marriage and Exchange in Nineteenth-Century Athens PAUL SANT CASSIA WITH CONSTANTINA BADA
78 Religion and Custom in a Muslim Society: The Berti of Sudan LADISLAV HOLY
79 Quiet Days in Burgundy: A Study of Local Politics MARC ABELES. Translated by Annella McDermott 80 Sacred Void: Spatial Images of Work and Ritual among the Giriama of Kenya DAVID PARKIN
81 A Place of their Own: Family Farming in Eastern Finland RAY ABRAHAMS
82 Power, Prayer and Production: The Jola of Casamance, Senegal OLGA F. LINARES
83 Identity through History: Living Stories in a Solomon Island Society GEOFFREY M. WHITE
84 Monk, Householder and Tantric Priest: Newar Buddhism and its Hierarchy of Ritual DAVID GELLNER
85 Hunters and Herders of Southern Africa: A Comparative Ethnography of the Khoisan Peoples* ALAN BARNARD
86 Belonging in the Two Berlins: Kin, State, Nation* JOHN BORNEMAN
87 Power and Religiosity in a Post-Colonial Setting: Sinhala Catholics in Contemporary Sri Lanka R.L. STIRRAT
298
Series list
88 Dialogues with the Dead: The Discussion of Mortality among the Sora of Eastern India PIERS VITEBSKY
89 South Coast New Guinea Cultures: History, Comparison, Dialectic* BRUCE M. KNAUFT
* available in paperback